12746 lines
488 KiB
Plaintext
12746 lines
488 KiB
Plaintext
\input texinfo @c -*-texinfo-*-
|
|
@c %**start of header
|
|
@setfilename openocd.info
|
|
@settitle OpenOCD User's Guide
|
|
@dircategory Development
|
|
@direntry
|
|
* OpenOCD: (openocd). OpenOCD User's Guide
|
|
@end direntry
|
|
@paragraphindent 0
|
|
@c %**end of header
|
|
|
|
@include version.texi
|
|
|
|
@copying
|
|
|
|
This User's Guide documents
|
|
release @value{VERSION},
|
|
dated @value{UPDATED},
|
|
of the Open On-Chip Debugger (OpenOCD).
|
|
|
|
@itemize @bullet
|
|
@item Copyright @copyright{} 2008-2022 The OpenOCD Project
|
|
@item Copyright @copyright{} 2007-2008 Spencer Oliver @email{spen@@spen-soft.co.uk}
|
|
@item Copyright @copyright{} 2008-2010 Oyvind Harboe @email{oyvind.harboe@@zylin.com}
|
|
@item Copyright @copyright{} 2008 Duane Ellis @email{openocd@@duaneellis.com}
|
|
@item Copyright @copyright{} 2009-2010 David Brownell
|
|
@end itemize
|
|
|
|
@quotation
|
|
Permission is granted to copy, distribute and/or modify this document
|
|
under the terms of the GNU Free Documentation License, Version 1.2 or
|
|
any later version published by the Free Software Foundation; with no
|
|
Invariant Sections, no Front-Cover Texts, and no Back-Cover Texts. A
|
|
copy of the license is included in the section entitled ``GNU Free
|
|
Documentation License''.
|
|
@end quotation
|
|
@end copying
|
|
|
|
@titlepage
|
|
@titlefont{@emph{Open On-Chip Debugger:}}
|
|
@sp 1
|
|
@title OpenOCD User's Guide
|
|
@subtitle for release @value{VERSION}
|
|
@subtitle @value{UPDATED}
|
|
|
|
@page
|
|
@vskip 0pt plus 1filll
|
|
@insertcopying
|
|
@end titlepage
|
|
|
|
@summarycontents
|
|
@contents
|
|
|
|
@ifnottex
|
|
@node Top
|
|
@top OpenOCD User's Guide
|
|
|
|
@insertcopying
|
|
@end ifnottex
|
|
|
|
@menu
|
|
* About:: About OpenOCD
|
|
* Developers:: OpenOCD Developer Resources
|
|
* Debug Adapter Hardware:: Debug Adapter Hardware
|
|
* About Jim-Tcl:: About Jim-Tcl
|
|
* Running:: Running OpenOCD
|
|
* OpenOCD Project Setup:: OpenOCD Project Setup
|
|
* Config File Guidelines:: Config File Guidelines
|
|
* Server Configuration:: Server Configuration
|
|
* Debug Adapter Configuration:: Debug Adapter Configuration
|
|
* Reset Configuration:: Reset Configuration
|
|
* TAP Declaration:: TAP Declaration
|
|
* CPU Configuration:: CPU Configuration
|
|
* Flash Commands:: Flash Commands
|
|
* Flash Programming:: Flash Programming
|
|
* PLD/FPGA Commands:: PLD/FPGA Commands
|
|
* General Commands:: General Commands
|
|
* Architecture and Core Commands:: Architecture and Core Commands
|
|
* JTAG Commands:: JTAG Commands
|
|
* Boundary Scan Commands:: Boundary Scan Commands
|
|
* Utility Commands:: Utility Commands
|
|
* GDB and OpenOCD:: Using GDB and OpenOCD
|
|
* Tcl Scripting API:: Tcl Scripting API
|
|
* FAQ:: Frequently Asked Questions
|
|
* Tcl Crash Course:: Tcl Crash Course
|
|
* License:: GNU Free Documentation License
|
|
|
|
@comment DO NOT use the plain word ``Index'', reason: CYGWIN filename
|
|
@comment case issue with ``Index.html'' and ``index.html''
|
|
@comment Occurs when creating ``--html --no-split'' output
|
|
@comment This fix is based on: http://sourceware.org/ml/binutils/2006-05/msg00215.html
|
|
* OpenOCD Concept Index:: Concept Index
|
|
* Command and Driver Index:: Command and Driver Index
|
|
@end menu
|
|
|
|
@node About
|
|
@unnumbered About
|
|
@cindex about
|
|
|
|
OpenOCD was created by Dominic Rath as part of a 2005 diploma thesis written
|
|
at the University of Applied Sciences Augsburg (@uref{http://www.hs-augsburg.de}).
|
|
Since that time, the project has grown into an active open-source project,
|
|
supported by a diverse community of software and hardware developers from
|
|
around the world.
|
|
|
|
@section What is OpenOCD?
|
|
@cindex TAP
|
|
@cindex JTAG
|
|
|
|
The Open On-Chip Debugger (OpenOCD) aims to provide debugging,
|
|
in-system programming and boundary-scan testing for embedded target
|
|
devices.
|
|
|
|
It does so with the assistance of a @dfn{debug adapter}, which is
|
|
a small hardware module which helps provide the right kind of
|
|
electrical signaling to the target being debugged. These are
|
|
required since the debug host (on which OpenOCD runs) won't
|
|
usually have native support for such signaling, or the connector
|
|
needed to hook up to the target.
|
|
|
|
Such debug adapters support one or more @dfn{transport} protocols,
|
|
each of which involves different electrical signaling (and uses
|
|
different messaging protocols on top of that signaling). There
|
|
are many types of debug adapter, and little uniformity in what
|
|
they are called. (There are also product naming differences.)
|
|
|
|
These adapters are sometimes packaged as discrete dongles, which
|
|
may generically be called @dfn{hardware interface dongles}.
|
|
Some development boards also integrate them directly, which may
|
|
let the development board connect directly to the debug
|
|
host over USB (and sometimes also to power it over USB).
|
|
|
|
For example, a @dfn{JTAG Adapter} supports JTAG
|
|
signaling, and is used to communicate
|
|
with JTAG (IEEE 1149.1) compliant TAPs on your target board.
|
|
A @dfn{TAP} is a ``Test Access Port'', a module which processes
|
|
special instructions and data. TAPs are daisy-chained within and
|
|
between chips and boards. JTAG supports debugging and boundary
|
|
scan operations.
|
|
|
|
There are also @dfn{SWD Adapters} that support Serial Wire Debug (SWD)
|
|
signaling to communicate with some newer ARM cores, as well as debug
|
|
adapters which support both JTAG and SWD transports. SWD supports only
|
|
debugging, whereas JTAG also supports boundary scan operations.
|
|
|
|
For some chips, there are also @dfn{Programming Adapters} supporting
|
|
special transports used only to write code to flash memory, without
|
|
support for on-chip debugging or boundary scan.
|
|
(At this writing, OpenOCD does not support such non-debug adapters.)
|
|
|
|
|
|
@b{Dongles:} OpenOCD currently supports many types of hardware dongles:
|
|
USB-based, parallel port-based, and other standalone boxes that run
|
|
OpenOCD internally. @xref{Debug Adapter Hardware}.
|
|
|
|
@b{GDB Debug:} It allows ARM7 (ARM7TDMI and ARM720t), ARM9 (ARM920T,
|
|
ARM922T, ARM926EJ--S, ARM966E--S), XScale (PXA25x, IXP42x), Cortex-M3
|
|
(Stellaris LM3, STMicroelectronics STM32 and Energy Micro EFM32) and
|
|
Intel Quark (x10xx) based cores to be debugged via the GDB protocol.
|
|
|
|
@b{Flash Programming:} Flash writing is supported for external
|
|
CFI-compatible NOR flashes (Intel and AMD/Spansion command set) and several
|
|
internal flashes (LPC1700, LPC1800, LPC2000, LPC4300, AT91SAM7, AT91SAM3U,
|
|
STR7x, STR9x, LM3, STM32x and EFM32). Preliminary support for various NAND flash
|
|
controllers (LPC3180, Orion, S3C24xx, more) is included.
|
|
|
|
@section OpenOCD Web Site
|
|
|
|
The OpenOCD web site provides the latest public news from the community:
|
|
|
|
@uref{http://openocd.org/}
|
|
|
|
@section Latest User's Guide:
|
|
|
|
The user's guide you are now reading may not be the latest one
|
|
available. A version for more recent code may be available.
|
|
Its HTML form is published regularly at:
|
|
|
|
@uref{http://openocd.org/doc/html/index.html}
|
|
|
|
PDF form is likewise published at:
|
|
|
|
@uref{http://openocd.org/doc/pdf/openocd.pdf}
|
|
|
|
@section OpenOCD User's Forum
|
|
|
|
There is an OpenOCD forum (phpBB) hosted by SparkFun,
|
|
which might be helpful to you. Note that if you want
|
|
anything to come to the attention of developers, you
|
|
should post it to the OpenOCD Developer Mailing List
|
|
instead of this forum.
|
|
|
|
@uref{http://forum.sparkfun.com/viewforum.php?f=18}
|
|
|
|
@section OpenOCD User's Mailing List
|
|
|
|
The OpenOCD User Mailing List provides the primary means of
|
|
communication between users:
|
|
|
|
@uref{https://lists.sourceforge.net/mailman/listinfo/openocd-user}
|
|
|
|
@section OpenOCD IRC
|
|
|
|
Support can also be found on irc:
|
|
@uref{irc://irc.libera.chat/openocd}
|
|
|
|
@node Developers
|
|
@chapter OpenOCD Developer Resources
|
|
@cindex developers
|
|
|
|
If you are interested in improving the state of OpenOCD's debugging and
|
|
testing support, new contributions will be welcome. Motivated developers
|
|
can produce new target, flash or interface drivers, improve the
|
|
documentation, as well as more conventional bug fixes and enhancements.
|
|
|
|
The resources in this chapter are available for developers wishing to explore
|
|
or expand the OpenOCD source code.
|
|
|
|
@section OpenOCD Git Repository
|
|
|
|
During the 0.3.x release cycle, OpenOCD switched from Subversion to
|
|
a Git repository hosted at SourceForge. The repository URL is:
|
|
|
|
@uref{git://git.code.sf.net/p/openocd/code}
|
|
|
|
or via http
|
|
|
|
@uref{http://git.code.sf.net/p/openocd/code}
|
|
|
|
You may prefer to use a mirror and the HTTP protocol:
|
|
|
|
@uref{http://repo.or.cz/r/openocd.git}
|
|
|
|
With standard Git tools, use @command{git clone} to initialize
|
|
a local repository, and @command{git pull} to update it.
|
|
There are also gitweb pages letting you browse the repository
|
|
with a web browser, or download arbitrary snapshots without
|
|
needing a Git client:
|
|
|
|
@uref{http://repo.or.cz/w/openocd.git}
|
|
|
|
The @file{README} file contains the instructions for building the project
|
|
from the repository or a snapshot.
|
|
|
|
Developers that want to contribute patches to the OpenOCD system are
|
|
@b{strongly} encouraged to work against mainline.
|
|
Patches created against older versions may require additional
|
|
work from their submitter in order to be updated for newer releases.
|
|
|
|
@section Doxygen Developer Manual
|
|
|
|
During the 0.2.x release cycle, the OpenOCD project began
|
|
providing a Doxygen reference manual. This document contains more
|
|
technical information about the software internals, development
|
|
processes, and similar documentation:
|
|
|
|
@uref{http://openocd.org/doc/doxygen/html/index.html}
|
|
|
|
This document is a work-in-progress, but contributions would be welcome
|
|
to fill in the gaps. All of the source files are provided in-tree,
|
|
listed in the Doxyfile configuration at the top of the source tree.
|
|
|
|
@section Gerrit Review System
|
|
|
|
All changes in the OpenOCD Git repository go through the web-based Gerrit
|
|
Code Review System:
|
|
|
|
@uref{https://review.openocd.org/}
|
|
|
|
After a one-time registration and repository setup, anyone can push commits
|
|
from their local Git repository directly into Gerrit.
|
|
All users and developers are encouraged to review, test, discuss and vote
|
|
for changes in Gerrit. The feedback provides the basis for a maintainer to
|
|
eventually submit the change to the main Git repository.
|
|
|
|
The @file{HACKING} file, also available as the Patch Guide in the Doxygen
|
|
Developer Manual, contains basic information about how to connect a
|
|
repository to Gerrit, prepare and push patches. Patch authors are expected to
|
|
maintain their changes while they're in Gerrit, respond to feedback and if
|
|
necessary rework and push improved versions of the change.
|
|
|
|
@section OpenOCD Developer Mailing List
|
|
|
|
The OpenOCD Developer Mailing List provides the primary means of
|
|
communication between developers:
|
|
|
|
@uref{https://lists.sourceforge.net/mailman/listinfo/openocd-devel}
|
|
|
|
@section OpenOCD Bug Tracker
|
|
|
|
The OpenOCD Bug Tracker is hosted on SourceForge:
|
|
|
|
@uref{http://bugs.openocd.org/}
|
|
|
|
|
|
@node Debug Adapter Hardware
|
|
@chapter Debug Adapter Hardware
|
|
@cindex dongles
|
|
@cindex FTDI
|
|
@cindex wiggler
|
|
@cindex printer port
|
|
@cindex USB Adapter
|
|
@cindex RTCK
|
|
|
|
Defined: @b{dongle}: A small device that plugs into a computer and serves as
|
|
an adapter .... [snip]
|
|
|
|
In the OpenOCD case, this generally refers to @b{a small adapter} that
|
|
attaches to your computer via USB or the parallel port.
|
|
|
|
|
|
@section Choosing a Dongle
|
|
|
|
There are several things you should keep in mind when choosing a dongle.
|
|
|
|
@enumerate
|
|
@item @b{Transport} Does it support the kind of communication that you need?
|
|
OpenOCD focuses mostly on JTAG. Your version may also support
|
|
other ways to communicate with target devices.
|
|
@item @b{Voltage} What voltage is your target - 1.8, 2.8, 3.3, or 5V?
|
|
Does your dongle support it? You might need a level converter.
|
|
@item @b{Pinout} What pinout does your target board use?
|
|
Does your dongle support it? You may be able to use jumper
|
|
wires, or an "octopus" connector, to convert pinouts.
|
|
@item @b{Connection} Does your computer have the USB, parallel, or
|
|
Ethernet port needed?
|
|
@item @b{RTCK} Do you expect to use it with ARM chips and boards with
|
|
RTCK support (also known as ``adaptive clocking'')?
|
|
@end enumerate
|
|
|
|
@section USB FT2232 Based
|
|
|
|
There are many USB JTAG dongles on the market, many of them based
|
|
on a chip from ``Future Technology Devices International'' (FTDI)
|
|
known as the FTDI FT2232; this is a USB full speed (12 Mbps) chip.
|
|
See: @url{http://www.ftdichip.com} for more information.
|
|
In summer 2009, USB high speed (480 Mbps) versions of these FTDI
|
|
chips started to become available in JTAG adapters. Around 2012, a new
|
|
variant appeared - FT232H - this is a single-channel version of FT2232H.
|
|
(Adapters using those high speed FT2232H or FT232H chips may support adaptive
|
|
clocking.)
|
|
|
|
The FT2232 chips are flexible enough to support some other
|
|
transport options, such as SWD or the SPI variants used to
|
|
program some chips. They have two communications channels,
|
|
and one can be used for a UART adapter at the same time the
|
|
other one is used to provide a debug adapter.
|
|
|
|
Also, some development boards integrate an FT2232 chip to serve as
|
|
a built-in low-cost debug adapter and USB-to-serial solution.
|
|
|
|
@itemize @bullet
|
|
@item @b{usbjtag}
|
|
@* Link @url{http://elk.informatik.fh-augsburg.de/hhweb/doc/openocd/usbjtag/usbjtag.html}
|
|
@item @b{jtagkey}
|
|
@* See: @url{http://www.amontec.com/jtagkey.shtml}
|
|
@item @b{jtagkey2}
|
|
@* See: @url{http://www.amontec.com/jtagkey2.shtml}
|
|
@item @b{oocdlink}
|
|
@* See: @url{http://www.oocdlink.com} By Joern Kaipf
|
|
@item @b{signalyzer}
|
|
@* See: @url{http://www.signalyzer.com}
|
|
@item @b{Stellaris Eval Boards}
|
|
@* See: @url{http://www.ti.com} - The Stellaris eval boards
|
|
bundle FT2232-based JTAG and SWD support, which can be used to debug
|
|
the Stellaris chips. Using separate JTAG adapters is optional.
|
|
These boards can also be used in a "pass through" mode as JTAG adapters
|
|
to other target boards, disabling the Stellaris chip.
|
|
@item @b{TI/Luminary ICDI}
|
|
@* See: @url{http://www.ti.com} - TI/Luminary In-Circuit Debug
|
|
Interface (ICDI) Boards are included in Stellaris LM3S9B9x
|
|
Evaluation Kits. Like the non-detachable FT2232 support on the other
|
|
Stellaris eval boards, they can be used to debug other target boards.
|
|
@item @b{olimex-jtag}
|
|
@* See: @url{http://www.olimex.com}
|
|
@item @b{Flyswatter/Flyswatter2}
|
|
@* See: @url{http://www.tincantools.com}
|
|
@item @b{turtelizer2}
|
|
@* See:
|
|
@uref{http://www.ethernut.de/en/hardware/turtelizer/index.html, Turtelizer 2}, or
|
|
@url{http://www.ethernut.de}
|
|
@item @b{comstick}
|
|
@* Link: @url{http://www.hitex.com/index.php?id=383}
|
|
@item @b{stm32stick}
|
|
@* Link @url{http://www.hitex.com/stm32-stick}
|
|
@item @b{axm0432_jtag}
|
|
@* Axiom AXM-0432 Link @url{http://www.axman.com} - NOTE: This JTAG does not appear
|
|
to be available anymore as of April 2012.
|
|
@item @b{cortino}
|
|
@* Link @url{http://www.hitex.com/index.php?id=cortino}
|
|
@item @b{dlp-usb1232h}
|
|
@* Link @url{http://www.dlpdesign.com/usb/usb1232h.shtml}
|
|
@item @b{digilent-hs1}
|
|
@* Link @url{http://www.digilentinc.com/Products/Detail.cfm?Prod=JTAG-HS1}
|
|
@item @b{opendous}
|
|
@* Link @url{http://code.google.com/p/opendous/wiki/JTAG} FT2232H-based
|
|
(OpenHardware).
|
|
@item @b{JTAG-lock-pick Tiny 2}
|
|
@* Link @url{http://www.distortec.com/jtag-lock-pick-tiny-2} FT232H-based
|
|
|
|
@item @b{GW16042}
|
|
@* Link: @url{http://shop.gateworks.com/index.php?route=product/product&path=70_80&product_id=64}
|
|
FT2232H-based
|
|
|
|
@end itemize
|
|
@section USB-JTAG / Altera USB-Blaster compatibles
|
|
|
|
These devices also show up as FTDI devices, but are not
|
|
protocol-compatible with the FT2232 devices. They are, however,
|
|
protocol-compatible among themselves. USB-JTAG devices typically consist
|
|
of a FT245 followed by a CPLD that understands a particular protocol,
|
|
or emulates this protocol using some other hardware.
|
|
|
|
They may appear under different USB VID/PID depending on the particular
|
|
product. The driver can be configured to search for any VID/PID pair
|
|
(see the section on driver commands).
|
|
|
|
@itemize
|
|
@item @b{USB-JTAG} Kolja Waschk's USB Blaster-compatible adapter
|
|
@* Link: @url{http://ixo-jtag.sourceforge.net/}
|
|
@item @b{Altera USB-Blaster}
|
|
@* Link: @url{http://www.altera.com/literature/ug/ug_usb_blstr.pdf}
|
|
@end itemize
|
|
|
|
@section USB J-Link based
|
|
There are several OEM versions of the SEGGER @b{J-Link} adapter. It is
|
|
an example of a microcontroller based JTAG adapter, it uses an
|
|
AT91SAM764 internally.
|
|
|
|
@itemize @bullet
|
|
@item @b{SEGGER J-Link}
|
|
@* Link: @url{http://www.segger.com/jlink.html}
|
|
@item @b{Atmel SAM-ICE} (Only works with Atmel chips!)
|
|
@* Link: @url{http://www.atmel.com/tools/atmelsam-ice.aspx}
|
|
@item @b{IAR J-Link}
|
|
@end itemize
|
|
|
|
@section USB RLINK based
|
|
Raisonance has an adapter called @b{RLink}. It exists in a stripped-down form on the STM32 Primer,
|
|
permanently attached to the JTAG lines. It also exists on the STM32 Primer2, but that is wired for
|
|
SWD and not JTAG, thus not supported.
|
|
|
|
@itemize @bullet
|
|
@item @b{Raisonance RLink}
|
|
@* Link: @url{http://www.mcu-raisonance.com/~rlink-debugger-programmer__@/microcontrollers__tool~tool__T018:4cn9ziz4bnx6.html}
|
|
@item @b{STM32 Primer}
|
|
@* Link: @url{http://www.stm32circle.com/resources/stm32primer.php}
|
|
@item @b{STM32 Primer2}
|
|
@* Link: @url{http://www.stm32circle.com/resources/stm32primer2.php}
|
|
@end itemize
|
|
|
|
@section USB ST-LINK based
|
|
STMicroelectronics has an adapter called @b{ST-LINK}.
|
|
They only work with STMicroelectronics chips, notably STM32 and STM8.
|
|
|
|
@itemize @bullet
|
|
@item @b{ST-LINK}
|
|
@* This is available standalone and as part of some kits, eg. STM32VLDISCOVERY.
|
|
@* Link: @url{http://www.st.com/internet/evalboard/product/219866.jsp}
|
|
@item @b{ST-LINK/V2}
|
|
@* This is available standalone and as part of some kits, eg. STM32F4DISCOVERY.
|
|
@* Link: @url{http://www.st.com/internet/evalboard/product/251168.jsp}
|
|
@item @b{STLINK-V3}
|
|
@* This is available standalone and as part of some kits.
|
|
@* Link: @url{http://www.st.com/stlink-v3}
|
|
@end itemize
|
|
|
|
For info the original ST-LINK enumerates using the mass storage usb class; however,
|
|
its implementation is completely broken. The result is this causes issues under Linux.
|
|
The simplest solution is to get Linux to ignore the ST-LINK using one of the following methods:
|
|
@itemize @bullet
|
|
@item modprobe -r usb-storage && modprobe usb-storage quirks=483:3744:i
|
|
@item add "options usb-storage quirks=483:3744:i" to /etc/modprobe.conf
|
|
@end itemize
|
|
|
|
@section USB TI/Stellaris ICDI based
|
|
Texas Instruments has an adapter called @b{ICDI}.
|
|
It is not to be confused with the FTDI based adapters that were originally fitted to their
|
|
evaluation boards. This is the adapter fitted to the Stellaris LaunchPad.
|
|
|
|
@section USB Nuvoton Nu-Link
|
|
Nuvoton has an adapter called @b{Nu-Link}.
|
|
It is available either as stand-alone dongle and embedded on development boards.
|
|
It supports SWD, serial port bridge and mass storage for firmware update.
|
|
Both Nu-Link v1 and v2 are supported.
|
|
|
|
@section USB CMSIS-DAP based
|
|
ARM has released a interface standard called CMSIS-DAP that simplifies connecting
|
|
debuggers to ARM Cortex based targets @url{http://www.keil.com/support/man/docs/dapdebug/dapdebug_introduction.htm}.
|
|
|
|
@section USB Other
|
|
@itemize @bullet
|
|
@item @b{USBprog}
|
|
@* Link: @url{http://shop.embedded-projects.net/} - which uses an Atmel MEGA32 and a UBN9604
|
|
|
|
@item @b{USB - Presto}
|
|
@* Link: @url{http://tools.asix.net/prg_presto.htm}
|
|
|
|
@item @b{Versaloon-Link}
|
|
@* Link: @url{http://www.versaloon.com}
|
|
|
|
@item @b{ARM-JTAG-EW}
|
|
@* Link: @url{http://www.olimex.com/dev/arm-jtag-ew.html}
|
|
|
|
@item @b{Buspirate}
|
|
@* Link: @url{http://dangerousprototypes.com/bus-pirate-manual/}
|
|
|
|
@item @b{opendous}
|
|
@* Link: @url{http://code.google.com/p/opendous-jtag/} - which uses an AT90USB162
|
|
|
|
@item @b{estick}
|
|
@* Link: @url{http://code.google.com/p/estick-jtag/}
|
|
|
|
@item @b{Keil ULINK v1}
|
|
@* Link: @url{http://www.keil.com/ulink1/}
|
|
|
|
@item @b{TI XDS110 Debug Probe}
|
|
@* Link: @url{https://software-dl.ti.com/ccs/esd/documents/xdsdebugprobes/emu_xds110.html}
|
|
@* Link: @url{https://software-dl.ti.com/ccs/esd/documents/xdsdebugprobes/emu_xds_software_package_download.html#xds110-support-utilities}
|
|
@end itemize
|
|
|
|
@section IBM PC Parallel Printer Port Based
|
|
|
|
The two well-known ``JTAG Parallel Ports'' cables are the Xilinx DLC5
|
|
and the Macraigor Wiggler. There are many clones and variations of
|
|
these on the market.
|
|
|
|
Note that parallel ports are becoming much less common, so if you
|
|
have the choice you should probably avoid these adapters in favor
|
|
of USB-based ones.
|
|
|
|
@itemize @bullet
|
|
|
|
@item @b{Wiggler} - There are many clones of this.
|
|
@* Link: @url{http://www.macraigor.com/wiggler.htm}
|
|
|
|
@item @b{DLC5} - From XILINX - There are many clones of this
|
|
@* Link: Search the web for: ``XILINX DLC5'' - it is no longer
|
|
produced, PDF schematics are easily found and it is easy to make.
|
|
|
|
@item @b{Amontec - JTAG Accelerator}
|
|
@* Link: @url{http://www.amontec.com/jtag_accelerator.shtml}
|
|
|
|
@item @b{Wiggler2}
|
|
@* Link: @url{http://www.ccac.rwth-aachen.de/~michaels/index.php/hardware/armjtag}
|
|
|
|
@item @b{Wiggler_ntrst_inverted}
|
|
@* Yet another variation - See the source code, src/jtag/parport.c
|
|
|
|
@item @b{old_amt_wiggler}
|
|
@* Unknown - probably not on the market today
|
|
|
|
@item @b{arm-jtag}
|
|
@* Link: Most likely @url{http://www.olimex.com/dev/arm-jtag.html} [another wiggler clone]
|
|
|
|
@item @b{chameleon}
|
|
@* Link: @url{http://www.amontec.com/chameleon.shtml}
|
|
|
|
@item @b{Triton}
|
|
@* Unknown.
|
|
|
|
@item @b{Lattice}
|
|
@* ispDownload from Lattice Semiconductor
|
|
@url{http://www.latticesemi.com/lit/docs/@/devtools/dlcable.pdf}
|
|
|
|
@item @b{flashlink}
|
|
@* From STMicroelectronics;
|
|
@* Link: @url{http://www.st.com/internet/com/TECHNICAL_RESOURCES/TECHNICAL_LITERATURE/DATA_BRIEF/DM00039500.pdf}
|
|
|
|
@end itemize
|
|
|
|
@section Other...
|
|
@itemize @bullet
|
|
|
|
@item @b{ep93xx}
|
|
@* An EP93xx based Linux machine using the GPIO pins directly.
|
|
|
|
@item @b{at91rm9200}
|
|
@* Like the EP93xx - but an ATMEL AT91RM9200 based solution using the GPIO pins on the chip.
|
|
|
|
@item @b{bcm2835gpio}
|
|
@* A BCM2835-based board (e.g. Raspberry Pi) using the GPIO pins of the expansion header.
|
|
|
|
@item @b{imx_gpio}
|
|
@* A NXP i.MX-based board (e.g. Wandboard) using the GPIO pins (should work on any i.MX processor).
|
|
|
|
@item @b{am335xgpio}
|
|
@* A Texas Instruments AM335x-based board (e.g. BeagleBone Black) using the GPIO pins of the expansion headers.
|
|
|
|
@item @b{jtag_vpi}
|
|
@* A JTAG driver acting as a client for the JTAG VPI server interface.
|
|
@* Link: @url{http://github.com/fjullien/jtag_vpi}
|
|
|
|
@item @b{vdebug}
|
|
@* A driver for Cadence virtual Debug Interface to emulated or simulated targets.
|
|
It implements a client connecting to the vdebug server, which in turn communicates
|
|
with the emulated or simulated RTL model through a transactor. The driver supports
|
|
JTAG and DAP-level transports.
|
|
|
|
@item @b{jtag_dpi}
|
|
@* A JTAG driver acting as a client for the SystemVerilog Direct Programming
|
|
Interface (DPI) for JTAG devices. DPI allows OpenOCD to connect to the JTAG
|
|
interface of a hardware model written in SystemVerilog, for example, on an
|
|
emulation model of target hardware.
|
|
|
|
@item @b{xlnx_pcie_xvc}
|
|
@* A JTAG driver exposing Xilinx Virtual Cable over PCI Express to OpenOCD as JTAG/SWD interface.
|
|
|
|
@item @b{linuxgpiod}
|
|
@* A bitbang JTAG driver using Linux GPIO through library libgpiod.
|
|
|
|
@item @b{sysfsgpio}
|
|
@* A bitbang JTAG driver using Linux legacy sysfs GPIO.
|
|
This is deprecated from Linux v5.3; prefer using @b{linuxgpiod}.
|
|
|
|
@item @b{esp_usb_jtag}
|
|
@* A JTAG driver to communicate with builtin debug modules of Espressif ESP32-C3 and ESP32-S3 chips using OpenOCD.
|
|
|
|
@end itemize
|
|
|
|
@node About Jim-Tcl
|
|
@chapter About Jim-Tcl
|
|
@cindex Jim-Tcl
|
|
@cindex tcl
|
|
|
|
OpenOCD uses a small ``Tcl Interpreter'' known as Jim-Tcl.
|
|
This programming language provides a simple and extensible
|
|
command interpreter.
|
|
|
|
All commands presented in this Guide are extensions to Jim-Tcl.
|
|
You can use them as simple commands, without needing to learn
|
|
much of anything about Tcl.
|
|
Alternatively, you can write Tcl programs with them.
|
|
|
|
You can learn more about Jim at its website, @url{http://jim.tcl.tk}.
|
|
There is an active and responsive community, get on the mailing list
|
|
if you have any questions. Jim-Tcl maintainers also lurk on the
|
|
OpenOCD mailing list.
|
|
|
|
@itemize @bullet
|
|
@item @b{Jim vs. Tcl}
|
|
@* Jim-Tcl is a stripped down version of the well known Tcl language,
|
|
which can be found here: @url{http://www.tcl.tk}. Jim-Tcl has far
|
|
fewer features. Jim-Tcl is several dozens of .C files and .H files and
|
|
implements the basic Tcl command set. In contrast: Tcl 8.6 is a
|
|
4.2 MB .zip file containing 1540 files.
|
|
|
|
@item @b{Missing Features}
|
|
@* Our practice has been: Add/clone the real Tcl feature if/when
|
|
needed. We welcome Jim-Tcl improvements, not bloat. Also there
|
|
are a large number of optional Jim-Tcl features that are not
|
|
enabled in OpenOCD.
|
|
|
|
@item @b{Scripts}
|
|
@* OpenOCD configuration scripts are Jim-Tcl Scripts. OpenOCD's
|
|
command interpreter today is a mixture of (newer)
|
|
Jim-Tcl commands, and the (older) original command interpreter.
|
|
|
|
@item @b{Commands}
|
|
@* At the OpenOCD telnet command line (or via the GDB monitor command) one
|
|
can type a Tcl for() loop, set variables, etc.
|
|
Some of the commands documented in this guide are implemented
|
|
as Tcl scripts, from a @file{startup.tcl} file internal to the server.
|
|
|
|
@item @b{Historical Note}
|
|
@* Jim-Tcl was introduced to OpenOCD in spring 2008. Fall 2010,
|
|
before OpenOCD 0.5 release, OpenOCD switched to using Jim-Tcl
|
|
as a Git submodule, which greatly simplified upgrading Jim-Tcl
|
|
to benefit from new features and bugfixes in Jim-Tcl.
|
|
|
|
@item @b{Need a crash course in Tcl?}
|
|
@*@xref{Tcl Crash Course}.
|
|
@end itemize
|
|
|
|
@node Running
|
|
@chapter Running
|
|
@cindex command line options
|
|
@cindex logfile
|
|
@cindex directory search
|
|
|
|
Properly installing OpenOCD sets up your operating system to grant it access
|
|
to the debug adapters. On Linux, this usually involves installing a file
|
|
in @file{/etc/udev/rules.d,} so OpenOCD has permissions. An example rules file
|
|
that works for many common adapters is shipped with OpenOCD in the
|
|
@file{contrib} directory. MS-Windows needs
|
|
complex and confusing driver configuration for every peripheral. Such issues
|
|
are unique to each operating system, and are not detailed in this User's Guide.
|
|
|
|
Then later you will invoke the OpenOCD server, with various options to
|
|
tell it how each debug session should work.
|
|
The @option{--help} option shows:
|
|
@verbatim
|
|
bash$ openocd --help
|
|
|
|
--help | -h display this help
|
|
--version | -v display OpenOCD version
|
|
--file | -f use configuration file <name>
|
|
--search | -s dir to search for config files and scripts
|
|
--debug | -d set debug level to 3
|
|
| -d<n> set debug level to <level>
|
|
--log_output | -l redirect log output to file <name>
|
|
--command | -c run <command>
|
|
@end verbatim
|
|
|
|
If you don't give any @option{-f} or @option{-c} options,
|
|
OpenOCD tries to read the configuration file @file{openocd.cfg}.
|
|
To specify one or more different
|
|
configuration files, use @option{-f} options. For example:
|
|
|
|
@example
|
|
openocd -f config1.cfg -f config2.cfg -f config3.cfg
|
|
@end example
|
|
|
|
Configuration files and scripts are searched for in
|
|
@enumerate
|
|
@item the current directory,
|
|
@item any search dir specified on the command line using the @option{-s} option,
|
|
@item any search dir specified using the @command{add_script_search_dir} command,
|
|
@item a directory in the @env{OPENOCD_SCRIPTS} environment variable (if set),
|
|
@item @file{%APPDATA%/OpenOCD} (only on Windows),
|
|
@item @file{$HOME/Library/Preferences/org.openocd} (only on Darwin),
|
|
@item @file{$XDG_CONFIG_HOME/openocd} (@env{$XDG_CONFIG_HOME} defaults to @file{$HOME/.config}),
|
|
@item @file{$HOME/.openocd},
|
|
@item the site wide script library @file{$pkgdatadir/site} and
|
|
@item the OpenOCD-supplied script library @file{$pkgdatadir/scripts}.
|
|
@end enumerate
|
|
The first found file with a matching file name will be used.
|
|
|
|
@quotation Note
|
|
Don't try to use configuration script names or paths which
|
|
include the "#" character. That character begins Tcl comments.
|
|
@end quotation
|
|
|
|
@section Simple setup, no customization
|
|
|
|
In the best case, you can use two scripts from one of the script
|
|
libraries, hook up your JTAG adapter, and start the server ... and
|
|
your JTAG setup will just work "out of the box". Always try to
|
|
start by reusing those scripts, but assume you'll need more
|
|
customization even if this works. @xref{OpenOCD Project Setup}.
|
|
|
|
If you find a script for your JTAG adapter, and for your board or
|
|
target, you may be able to hook up your JTAG adapter then start
|
|
the server with some variation of one of the following:
|
|
|
|
@example
|
|
openocd -f interface/ADAPTER.cfg -f board/MYBOARD.cfg
|
|
openocd -f interface/ftdi/ADAPTER.cfg -f board/MYBOARD.cfg
|
|
@end example
|
|
|
|
You might also need to configure which reset signals are present,
|
|
using @option{-c 'reset_config trst_and_srst'} or something similar.
|
|
If all goes well you'll see output something like
|
|
|
|
@example
|
|
Open On-Chip Debugger 0.4.0 (2010-01-14-15:06)
|
|
For bug reports, read
|
|
http://openocd.org/doc/doxygen/bugs.html
|
|
Info : JTAG tap: lm3s.cpu tap/device found: 0x3ba00477
|
|
(mfg: 0x23b, part: 0xba00, ver: 0x3)
|
|
@end example
|
|
|
|
Seeing that "tap/device found" message, and no warnings, means
|
|
the JTAG communication is working. That's a key milestone, but
|
|
you'll probably need more project-specific setup.
|
|
|
|
@section What OpenOCD does as it starts
|
|
|
|
OpenOCD starts by processing the configuration commands provided
|
|
on the command line or, if there were no @option{-c command} or
|
|
@option{-f file.cfg} options given, in @file{openocd.cfg}.
|
|
@xref{configurationstage,,Configuration Stage}.
|
|
At the end of the configuration stage it verifies the JTAG scan
|
|
chain defined using those commands; your configuration should
|
|
ensure that this always succeeds.
|
|
Normally, OpenOCD then starts running as a server.
|
|
Alternatively, commands may be used to terminate the configuration
|
|
stage early, perform work (such as updating some flash memory),
|
|
and then shut down without acting as a server.
|
|
|
|
Once OpenOCD starts running as a server, it waits for connections from
|
|
clients (Telnet, GDB, RPC) and processes the commands issued through
|
|
those channels.
|
|
|
|
If you are having problems, you can enable internal debug messages via
|
|
the @option{-d} option.
|
|
|
|
Also it is possible to interleave Jim-Tcl commands w/config scripts using the
|
|
@option{-c} command line switch.
|
|
|
|
To enable debug output (when reporting problems or working on OpenOCD
|
|
itself), use the @option{-d} command line switch. This sets the
|
|
@option{debug_level} to "3", outputting the most information,
|
|
including debug messages. The default setting is "2", outputting only
|
|
informational messages, warnings and errors. You can also change this
|
|
setting from within a telnet or gdb session using @command{debug_level<n>}
|
|
(@pxref{debuglevel,,debug_level}).
|
|
|
|
You can redirect all output from the server to a file using the
|
|
@option{-l <logfile>} switch.
|
|
|
|
Note! OpenOCD will launch the GDB & telnet server even if it can not
|
|
establish a connection with the target. In general, it is possible for
|
|
the JTAG controller to be unresponsive until the target is set up
|
|
correctly via e.g. GDB monitor commands in a GDB init script.
|
|
|
|
@node OpenOCD Project Setup
|
|
@chapter OpenOCD Project Setup
|
|
|
|
To use OpenOCD with your development projects, you need to do more than
|
|
just connect the JTAG adapter hardware (dongle) to your development board
|
|
and start the OpenOCD server.
|
|
You also need to configure your OpenOCD server so that it knows
|
|
about your adapter and board, and helps your work.
|
|
You may also want to connect OpenOCD to GDB, possibly
|
|
using Eclipse or some other GUI.
|
|
|
|
@section Hooking up the JTAG Adapter
|
|
|
|
Today's most common case is a dongle with a JTAG cable on one side
|
|
(such as a ribbon cable with a 10-pin or 20-pin IDC connector)
|
|
and a USB cable on the other.
|
|
Instead of USB, some dongles use Ethernet;
|
|
older ones may use a PC parallel port, or even a serial port.
|
|
|
|
@enumerate
|
|
@item @emph{Start with power to your target board turned off},
|
|
and nothing connected to your JTAG adapter.
|
|
If you're particularly paranoid, unplug power to the board.
|
|
It's important to have the ground signal properly set up,
|
|
unless you are using a JTAG adapter which provides
|
|
galvanic isolation between the target board and the
|
|
debugging host.
|
|
|
|
@item @emph{Be sure it's the right kind of JTAG connector.}
|
|
If your dongle has a 20-pin ARM connector, you need some kind
|
|
of adapter (or octopus, see below) to hook it up to
|
|
boards using 14-pin or 10-pin connectors ... or to 20-pin
|
|
connectors which don't use ARM's pinout.
|
|
|
|
In the same vein, make sure the voltage levels are compatible.
|
|
Not all JTAG adapters have the level shifters needed to work
|
|
with 1.2 Volt boards.
|
|
|
|
@item @emph{Be certain the cable is properly oriented} or you might
|
|
damage your board. In most cases there are only two possible
|
|
ways to connect the cable.
|
|
Connect the JTAG cable from your adapter to the board.
|
|
Be sure it's firmly connected.
|
|
|
|
In the best case, the connector is keyed to physically
|
|
prevent you from inserting it wrong.
|
|
This is most often done using a slot on the board's male connector
|
|
housing, which must match a key on the JTAG cable's female connector.
|
|
If there's no housing, then you must look carefully and
|
|
make sure pin 1 on the cable hooks up to pin 1 on the board.
|
|
Ribbon cables are frequently all grey except for a wire on one
|
|
edge, which is red. The red wire is pin 1.
|
|
|
|
Sometimes dongles provide cables where one end is an ``octopus'' of
|
|
color coded single-wire connectors, instead of a connector block.
|
|
These are great when converting from one JTAG pinout to another,
|
|
but are tedious to set up.
|
|
Use these with connector pinout diagrams to help you match up the
|
|
adapter signals to the right board pins.
|
|
|
|
@item @emph{Connect the adapter's other end} once the JTAG cable is connected.
|
|
A USB, parallel, or serial port connector will go to the host which
|
|
you are using to run OpenOCD.
|
|
For Ethernet, consult the documentation and your network administrator.
|
|
|
|
For USB-based JTAG adapters you have an easy sanity check at this point:
|
|
does the host operating system see the JTAG adapter? If you're running
|
|
Linux, try the @command{lsusb} command. If that host is an
|
|
MS-Windows host, you'll need to install a driver before OpenOCD works.
|
|
|
|
@item @emph{Connect the adapter's power supply, if needed.}
|
|
This step is primarily for non-USB adapters,
|
|
but sometimes USB adapters need extra power.
|
|
|
|
@item @emph{Power up the target board.}
|
|
Unless you just let the magic smoke escape,
|
|
you're now ready to set up the OpenOCD server
|
|
so you can use JTAG to work with that board.
|
|
|
|
@end enumerate
|
|
|
|
Talk with the OpenOCD server using
|
|
telnet (@code{telnet localhost 4444} on many systems) or GDB.
|
|
@xref{GDB and OpenOCD}.
|
|
|
|
@section Project Directory
|
|
|
|
There are many ways you can configure OpenOCD and start it up.
|
|
|
|
A simple way to organize them all involves keeping a
|
|
single directory for your work with a given board.
|
|
When you start OpenOCD from that directory,
|
|
it searches there first for configuration files, scripts,
|
|
files accessed through semihosting,
|
|
and for code you upload to the target board.
|
|
It is also the natural place to write files,
|
|
such as log files and data you download from the board.
|
|
|
|
@section Configuration Basics
|
|
|
|
There are two basic ways of configuring OpenOCD, and
|
|
a variety of ways you can mix them.
|
|
Think of the difference as just being how you start the server:
|
|
|
|
@itemize
|
|
@item Many @option{-f file} or @option{-c command} options on the command line
|
|
@item No options, but a @dfn{user config file}
|
|
in the current directory named @file{openocd.cfg}
|
|
@end itemize
|
|
|
|
Here is an example @file{openocd.cfg} file for a setup
|
|
using a Signalyzer FT2232-based JTAG adapter to talk to
|
|
a board with an Atmel AT91SAM7X256 microcontroller:
|
|
|
|
@example
|
|
source [find interface/ftdi/signalyzer.cfg]
|
|
|
|
# GDB can also flash my flash!
|
|
gdb_memory_map enable
|
|
gdb_flash_program enable
|
|
|
|
source [find target/sam7x256.cfg]
|
|
@end example
|
|
|
|
Here is the command line equivalent of that configuration:
|
|
|
|
@example
|
|
openocd -f interface/ftdi/signalyzer.cfg \
|
|
-c "gdb_memory_map enable" \
|
|
-c "gdb_flash_program enable" \
|
|
-f target/sam7x256.cfg
|
|
@end example
|
|
|
|
You could wrap such long command lines in shell scripts,
|
|
each supporting a different development task.
|
|
One might re-flash the board with a specific firmware version.
|
|
Another might set up a particular debugging or run-time environment.
|
|
|
|
@quotation Important
|
|
At this writing (October 2009) the command line method has
|
|
problems with how it treats variables.
|
|
For example, after @option{-c "set VAR value"}, or doing the
|
|
same in a script, the variable @var{VAR} will have no value
|
|
that can be tested in a later script.
|
|
@end quotation
|
|
|
|
Here we will focus on the simpler solution: one user config
|
|
file, including basic configuration plus any TCL procedures
|
|
to simplify your work.
|
|
|
|
@section User Config Files
|
|
@cindex config file, user
|
|
@cindex user config file
|
|
@cindex config file, overview
|
|
|
|
A user configuration file ties together all the parts of a project
|
|
in one place.
|
|
One of the following will match your situation best:
|
|
|
|
@itemize
|
|
@item Ideally almost everything comes from configuration files
|
|
provided by someone else.
|
|
For example, OpenOCD distributes a @file{scripts} directory
|
|
(probably in @file{/usr/share/openocd/scripts} on Linux).
|
|
Board and tool vendors can provide these too, as can individual
|
|
user sites; the @option{-s} command line option lets you say
|
|
where to find these files. (@xref{Running}.)
|
|
The AT91SAM7X256 example above works this way.
|
|
|
|
Three main types of non-user configuration file each have their
|
|
own subdirectory in the @file{scripts} directory:
|
|
|
|
@enumerate
|
|
@item @b{interface} -- one for each different debug adapter;
|
|
@item @b{board} -- one for each different board
|
|
@item @b{target} -- the chips which integrate CPUs and other JTAG TAPs
|
|
@end enumerate
|
|
|
|
Best case: include just two files, and they handle everything else.
|
|
The first is an interface config file.
|
|
The second is board-specific, and it sets up the JTAG TAPs and
|
|
their GDB targets (by deferring to some @file{target.cfg} file),
|
|
declares all flash memory, and leaves you nothing to do except
|
|
meet your deadline:
|
|
|
|
@example
|
|
source [find interface/olimex-jtag-tiny.cfg]
|
|
source [find board/csb337.cfg]
|
|
@end example
|
|
|
|
Boards with a single microcontroller often won't need more
|
|
than the target config file, as in the AT91SAM7X256 example.
|
|
That's because there is no external memory (flash, DDR RAM), and
|
|
the board differences are encapsulated by application code.
|
|
|
|
@item Maybe you don't know yet what your board looks like to JTAG.
|
|
Once you know the @file{interface.cfg} file to use, you may
|
|
need help from OpenOCD to discover what's on the board.
|
|
Once you find the JTAG TAPs, you can just search for appropriate
|
|
target and board
|
|
configuration files ... or write your own, from the bottom up.
|
|
@xref{autoprobing,,Autoprobing}.
|
|
|
|
@item You can often reuse some standard config files but
|
|
need to write a few new ones, probably a @file{board.cfg} file.
|
|
You will be using commands described later in this User's Guide,
|
|
and working with the guidelines in the next chapter.
|
|
|
|
For example, there may be configuration files for your JTAG adapter
|
|
and target chip, but you need a new board-specific config file
|
|
giving access to your particular flash chips.
|
|
Or you might need to write another target chip configuration file
|
|
for a new chip built around the Cortex-M3 core.
|
|
|
|
@quotation Note
|
|
When you write new configuration files, please submit
|
|
them for inclusion in the next OpenOCD release.
|
|
For example, a @file{board/newboard.cfg} file will help the
|
|
next users of that board, and a @file{target/newcpu.cfg}
|
|
will help support users of any board using that chip.
|
|
@end quotation
|
|
|
|
@item
|
|
You may need to write some C code.
|
|
It may be as simple as supporting a new FT2232 or parport
|
|
based adapter; a bit more involved, like a NAND or NOR flash
|
|
controller driver; or a big piece of work like supporting
|
|
a new chip architecture.
|
|
@end itemize
|
|
|
|
Reuse the existing config files when you can.
|
|
Look first in the @file{scripts/boards} area, then @file{scripts/targets}.
|
|
You may find a board configuration that's a good example to follow.
|
|
|
|
When you write config files, separate the reusable parts
|
|
(things every user of that interface, chip, or board needs)
|
|
from ones specific to your environment and debugging approach.
|
|
@itemize
|
|
|
|
@item
|
|
For example, a @code{gdb-attach} event handler that invokes
|
|
the @command{reset init} command will interfere with debugging
|
|
early boot code, which performs some of the same actions
|
|
that the @code{reset-init} event handler does.
|
|
|
|
@item
|
|
Likewise, the @command{arm9 vector_catch} command (or
|
|
@cindex vector_catch
|
|
its siblings @command{xscale vector_catch}
|
|
and @command{cortex_m vector_catch}) can be a time-saver
|
|
during some debug sessions, but don't make everyone use that either.
|
|
Keep those kinds of debugging aids in your user config file,
|
|
along with messaging and tracing setup.
|
|
(@xref{softwaredebugmessagesandtracing,,Software Debug Messages and Tracing}.)
|
|
|
|
@item
|
|
You might need to override some defaults.
|
|
For example, you might need to move, shrink, or back up the target's
|
|
work area if your application needs much SRAM.
|
|
|
|
@item
|
|
TCP/IP port configuration is another example of something which
|
|
is environment-specific, and should only appear in
|
|
a user config file. @xref{tcpipports,,TCP/IP Ports}.
|
|
@end itemize
|
|
|
|
@section Project-Specific Utilities
|
|
|
|
A few project-specific utility
|
|
routines may well speed up your work.
|
|
Write them, and keep them in your project's user config file.
|
|
|
|
For example, if you are making a boot loader work on a
|
|
board, it's nice to be able to debug the ``after it's
|
|
loaded to RAM'' parts separately from the finicky early
|
|
code which sets up the DDR RAM controller and clocks.
|
|
A script like this one, or a more GDB-aware sibling,
|
|
may help:
|
|
|
|
@example
|
|
proc ramboot @{ @} @{
|
|
# Reset, running the target's "reset-init" scripts
|
|
# to initialize clocks and the DDR RAM controller.
|
|
# Leave the CPU halted.
|
|
reset init
|
|
|
|
# Load CONFIG_SKIP_LOWLEVEL_INIT version into DDR RAM.
|
|
load_image u-boot.bin 0x20000000
|
|
|
|
# Start running.
|
|
resume 0x20000000
|
|
@}
|
|
@end example
|
|
|
|
Then once that code is working you will need to make it
|
|
boot from NOR flash; a different utility would help.
|
|
Alternatively, some developers write to flash using GDB.
|
|
(You might use a similar script if you're working with a flash
|
|
based microcontroller application instead of a boot loader.)
|
|
|
|
@example
|
|
proc newboot @{ @} @{
|
|
# Reset, leaving the CPU halted. The "reset-init" event
|
|
# proc gives faster access to the CPU and to NOR flash;
|
|
# "reset halt" would be slower.
|
|
reset init
|
|
|
|
# Write standard version of U-Boot into the first two
|
|
# sectors of NOR flash ... the standard version should
|
|
# do the same lowlevel init as "reset-init".
|
|
flash protect 0 0 1 off
|
|
flash erase_sector 0 0 1
|
|
flash write_bank 0 u-boot.bin 0x0
|
|
flash protect 0 0 1 on
|
|
|
|
# Reboot from scratch using that new boot loader.
|
|
reset run
|
|
@}
|
|
@end example
|
|
|
|
You may need more complicated utility procedures when booting
|
|
from NAND.
|
|
That often involves an extra bootloader stage,
|
|
running from on-chip SRAM to perform DDR RAM setup so it can load
|
|
the main bootloader code (which won't fit into that SRAM).
|
|
|
|
Other helper scripts might be used to write production system images,
|
|
involving considerably more than just a three stage bootloader.
|
|
|
|
@section Target Software Changes
|
|
|
|
Sometimes you may want to make some small changes to the software
|
|
you're developing, to help make JTAG debugging work better.
|
|
For example, in C or assembly language code you might
|
|
use @code{#ifdef JTAG_DEBUG} (or its converse) around code
|
|
handling issues like:
|
|
|
|
@itemize @bullet
|
|
|
|
@item @b{Watchdog Timers}...
|
|
Watchdog timers are typically used to automatically reset systems if
|
|
some application task doesn't periodically reset the timer. (The
|
|
assumption is that the system has locked up if the task can't run.)
|
|
When a JTAG debugger halts the system, that task won't be able to run
|
|
and reset the timer ... potentially causing resets in the middle of
|
|
your debug sessions.
|
|
|
|
It's rarely a good idea to disable such watchdogs, since their usage
|
|
needs to be debugged just like all other parts of your firmware.
|
|
That might however be your only option.
|
|
|
|
Look instead for chip-specific ways to stop the watchdog from counting
|
|
while the system is in a debug halt state. It may be simplest to set
|
|
that non-counting mode in your debugger startup scripts. You may however
|
|
need a different approach when, for example, a motor could be physically
|
|
damaged by firmware remaining inactive in a debug halt state. That might
|
|
involve a type of firmware mode where that "non-counting" mode is disabled
|
|
at the beginning then re-enabled at the end; a watchdog reset might fire
|
|
and complicate the debug session, but hardware (or people) would be
|
|
protected.@footnote{Note that many systems support a "monitor mode" debug
|
|
that is a somewhat cleaner way to address such issues. You can think of
|
|
it as only halting part of the system, maybe just one task,
|
|
instead of the whole thing.
|
|
At this writing, January 2010, OpenOCD based debugging does not support
|
|
monitor mode debug, only "halt mode" debug.}
|
|
|
|
@item @b{ARM Semihosting}...
|
|
@cindex ARM semihosting
|
|
When linked with a special runtime library provided with many
|
|
toolchains@footnote{See chapter 8 "Semihosting" in
|
|
@uref{http://infocenter.arm.com/help/topic/com.arm.doc.dui0203i/DUI0203I_rvct_developer_guide.pdf,
|
|
ARM DUI 0203I}, the "RealView Compilation Tools Developer Guide".
|
|
The CodeSourcery EABI toolchain also includes a semihosting library.},
|
|
your target code can use I/O facilities on the debug host. That library
|
|
provides a small set of system calls which are handled by OpenOCD.
|
|
It can let the debugger provide your system console and a file system,
|
|
helping with early debugging or providing a more capable environment
|
|
for sometimes-complex tasks like installing system firmware onto
|
|
NAND or SPI flash.
|
|
|
|
@item @b{ARM Wait-For-Interrupt}...
|
|
Many ARM chips synchronize the JTAG clock using the core clock.
|
|
Low power states which stop that core clock thus prevent JTAG access.
|
|
Idle loops in tasking environments often enter those low power states
|
|
via the @code{WFI} instruction (or its coprocessor equivalent, before ARMv7).
|
|
|
|
You may want to @emph{disable that instruction} in source code,
|
|
or otherwise prevent using that state,
|
|
to ensure you can get JTAG access at any time.@footnote{As a more
|
|
polite alternative, some processors have special debug-oriented
|
|
registers which can be used to change various features including
|
|
how the low power states are clocked while debugging.
|
|
The STM32 DBGMCU_CR register is an example; at the cost of extra
|
|
power consumption, JTAG can be used during low power states.}
|
|
For example, the OpenOCD @command{halt} command may not
|
|
work for an idle processor otherwise.
|
|
|
|
@item @b{Delay after reset}...
|
|
Not all chips have good support for debugger access
|
|
right after reset; many LPC2xxx chips have issues here.
|
|
Similarly, applications that reconfigure pins used for
|
|
JTAG access as they start will also block debugger access.
|
|
|
|
To work with boards like this, @emph{enable a short delay loop}
|
|
the first thing after reset, before "real" startup activities.
|
|
For example, one second's delay is usually more than enough
|
|
time for a JTAG debugger to attach, so that
|
|
early code execution can be debugged
|
|
or firmware can be replaced.
|
|
|
|
@item @b{Debug Communications Channel (DCC)}...
|
|
Some processors include mechanisms to send messages over JTAG.
|
|
Many ARM cores support these, as do some cores from other vendors.
|
|
(OpenOCD may be able to use this DCC internally, speeding up some
|
|
operations like writing to memory.)
|
|
|
|
Your application may want to deliver various debugging messages
|
|
over JTAG, by @emph{linking with a small library of code}
|
|
provided with OpenOCD and using the utilities there to send
|
|
various kinds of message.
|
|
@xref{softwaredebugmessagesandtracing,,Software Debug Messages and Tracing}.
|
|
|
|
@end itemize
|
|
|
|
@section Target Hardware Setup
|
|
|
|
Chip vendors often provide software development boards which
|
|
are highly configurable, so that they can support all options
|
|
that product boards may require. @emph{Make sure that any
|
|
jumpers or switches match the system configuration you are
|
|
working with.}
|
|
|
|
Common issues include:
|
|
|
|
@itemize @bullet
|
|
|
|
@item @b{JTAG setup} ...
|
|
Boards may support more than one JTAG configuration.
|
|
Examples include jumpers controlling pullups versus pulldowns
|
|
on the nTRST and/or nSRST signals, and choice of connectors
|
|
(e.g. which of two headers on the base board,
|
|
or one from a daughtercard).
|
|
For some Texas Instruments boards, you may need to jumper the
|
|
EMU0 and EMU1 signals (which OpenOCD won't currently control).
|
|
|
|
@item @b{Boot Modes} ...
|
|
Complex chips often support multiple boot modes, controlled
|
|
by external jumpers. Make sure this is set up correctly.
|
|
For example many i.MX boards from NXP need to be jumpered
|
|
to "ATX mode" to start booting using the on-chip ROM, when
|
|
using second stage bootloader code stored in a NAND flash chip.
|
|
|
|
Such explicit configuration is common, and not limited to
|
|
booting from NAND. You might also need to set jumpers to
|
|
start booting using code loaded from an MMC/SD card; external
|
|
SPI flash; Ethernet, UART, or USB links; NOR flash; OneNAND
|
|
flash; some external host; or various other sources.
|
|
|
|
|
|
@item @b{Memory Addressing} ...
|
|
Boards which support multiple boot modes may also have jumpers
|
|
to configure memory addressing. One board, for example, jumpers
|
|
external chipselect 0 (used for booting) to address either
|
|
a large SRAM (which must be pre-loaded via JTAG), NOR flash,
|
|
or NAND flash. When it's jumpered to address NAND flash, that
|
|
board must also be told to start booting from on-chip ROM.
|
|
|
|
Your @file{board.cfg} file may also need to be told this jumper
|
|
configuration, so that it can know whether to declare NOR flash
|
|
using @command{flash bank} or instead declare NAND flash with
|
|
@command{nand device}; and likewise which probe to perform in
|
|
its @code{reset-init} handler.
|
|
|
|
A closely related issue is bus width. Jumpers might need to
|
|
distinguish between 8 bit or 16 bit bus access for the flash
|
|
used to start booting.
|
|
|
|
@item @b{Peripheral Access} ...
|
|
Development boards generally provide access to every peripheral
|
|
on the chip, sometimes in multiple modes (such as by providing
|
|
multiple audio codec chips).
|
|
This interacts with software
|
|
configuration of pin multiplexing, where for example a
|
|
given pin may be routed either to the MMC/SD controller
|
|
or the GPIO controller. It also often interacts with
|
|
configuration jumpers. One jumper may be used to route
|
|
signals to an MMC/SD card slot or an expansion bus (which
|
|
might in turn affect booting); others might control which
|
|
audio or video codecs are used.
|
|
|
|
@end itemize
|
|
|
|
Plus you should of course have @code{reset-init} event handlers
|
|
which set up the hardware to match that jumper configuration.
|
|
That includes in particular any oscillator or PLL used to clock
|
|
the CPU, and any memory controllers needed to access external
|
|
memory and peripherals. Without such handlers, you won't be
|
|
able to access those resources without working target firmware
|
|
which can do that setup ... this can be awkward when you're
|
|
trying to debug that target firmware. Even if there's a ROM
|
|
bootloader which handles a few issues, it rarely provides full
|
|
access to all board-specific capabilities.
|
|
|
|
|
|
@node Config File Guidelines
|
|
@chapter Config File Guidelines
|
|
|
|
This chapter is aimed at any user who needs to write a config file,
|
|
including developers and integrators of OpenOCD and any user who
|
|
needs to get a new board working smoothly.
|
|
It provides guidelines for creating those files.
|
|
|
|
You should find the following directories under
|
|
@t{$(INSTALLDIR)/scripts}, with config files maintained upstream. Use
|
|
them as-is where you can; or as models for new files.
|
|
@itemize @bullet
|
|
@item @file{interface} ...
|
|
These are for debug adapters. Files that specify configuration to use
|
|
specific JTAG, SWD and other adapters go here.
|
|
@item @file{board} ...
|
|
Think Circuit Board, PWA, PCB, they go by many names. Board files
|
|
contain initialization items that are specific to a board.
|
|
|
|
They reuse target configuration files, since the same
|
|
microprocessor chips are used on many boards,
|
|
but support for external parts varies widely. For
|
|
example, the SDRAM initialization sequence for the board, or the type
|
|
of external flash and what address it uses. Any initialization
|
|
sequence to enable that external flash or SDRAM should be found in the
|
|
board file. Boards may also contain multiple targets: two CPUs; or
|
|
a CPU and an FPGA.
|
|
@item @file{target} ...
|
|
Think chip. The ``target'' directory represents the JTAG TAPs
|
|
on a chip
|
|
which OpenOCD should control, not a board. Two common types of targets
|
|
are ARM chips and FPGA or CPLD chips.
|
|
When a chip has multiple TAPs (maybe it has both ARM and DSP cores),
|
|
the target config file defines all of them.
|
|
@item @emph{more} ... browse for other library files which may be useful.
|
|
For example, there are various generic and CPU-specific utilities.
|
|
@end itemize
|
|
|
|
The @file{openocd.cfg} user config
|
|
file may override features in any of the above files by
|
|
setting variables before sourcing the target file, or by adding
|
|
commands specific to their situation.
|
|
|
|
@section Interface Config Files
|
|
|
|
The user config file
|
|
should be able to source one of these files with a command like this:
|
|
|
|
@example
|
|
source [find interface/FOOBAR.cfg]
|
|
@end example
|
|
|
|
A preconfigured interface file should exist for every debug adapter
|
|
in use today with OpenOCD.
|
|
That said, perhaps some of these config files
|
|
have only been used by the developer who created it.
|
|
|
|
A separate chapter gives information about how to set these up.
|
|
@xref{Debug Adapter Configuration}.
|
|
Read the OpenOCD source code (and Developer's Guide)
|
|
if you have a new kind of hardware interface
|
|
and need to provide a driver for it.
|
|
|
|
@deffn {Command} {find} 'filename'
|
|
Prints full path to @var{filename} according to OpenOCD search rules.
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
|
|
@deffn {Command} {ocd_find} 'filename'
|
|
Prints full path to @var{filename} according to OpenOCD search rules. This
|
|
is a low level function used by the @command{find}. Usually you want
|
|
to use @command{find}, instead.
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
|
|
@section Board Config Files
|
|
@cindex config file, board
|
|
@cindex board config file
|
|
|
|
The user config file
|
|
should be able to source one of these files with a command like this:
|
|
|
|
@example
|
|
source [find board/FOOBAR.cfg]
|
|
@end example
|
|
|
|
The point of a board config file is to package everything
|
|
about a given board that user config files need to know.
|
|
In summary the board files should contain (if present)
|
|
|
|
@enumerate
|
|
@item One or more @command{source [find target/...cfg]} statements
|
|
@item NOR flash configuration (@pxref{norconfiguration,,NOR Configuration})
|
|
@item NAND flash configuration (@pxref{nandconfiguration,,NAND Configuration})
|
|
@item Target @code{reset} handlers for SDRAM and I/O configuration
|
|
@item JTAG adapter reset configuration (@pxref{Reset Configuration})
|
|
@item All things that are not ``inside a chip''
|
|
@end enumerate
|
|
|
|
Generic things inside target chips belong in target config files,
|
|
not board config files. So for example a @code{reset-init} event
|
|
handler should know board-specific oscillator and PLL parameters,
|
|
which it passes to target-specific utility code.
|
|
|
|
The most complex task of a board config file is creating such a
|
|
@code{reset-init} event handler.
|
|
Define those handlers last, after you verify the rest of the board
|
|
configuration works.
|
|
|
|
@subsection Communication Between Config files
|
|
|
|
In addition to target-specific utility code, another way that
|
|
board and target config files communicate is by following a
|
|
convention on how to use certain variables.
|
|
|
|
The full Tcl/Tk language supports ``namespaces'', but Jim-Tcl does not.
|
|
Thus the rule we follow in OpenOCD is this: Variables that begin with
|
|
a leading underscore are temporary in nature, and can be modified and
|
|
used at will within a target configuration file.
|
|
|
|
Complex board config files can do the things like this,
|
|
for a board with three chips:
|
|
|
|
@example
|
|
# Chip #1: PXA270 for network side, big endian
|
|
set CHIPNAME network
|
|
set ENDIAN big
|
|
source [find target/pxa270.cfg]
|
|
# on return: _TARGETNAME = network.cpu
|
|
# other commands can refer to the "network.cpu" target.
|
|
$_TARGETNAME configure .... events for this CPU..
|
|
|
|
# Chip #2: PXA270 for video side, little endian
|
|
set CHIPNAME video
|
|
set ENDIAN little
|
|
source [find target/pxa270.cfg]
|
|
# on return: _TARGETNAME = video.cpu
|
|
# other commands can refer to the "video.cpu" target.
|
|
$_TARGETNAME configure .... events for this CPU..
|
|
|
|
# Chip #3: Xilinx FPGA for glue logic
|
|
set CHIPNAME xilinx
|
|
unset ENDIAN
|
|
source [find target/spartan3.cfg]
|
|
@end example
|
|
|
|
That example is oversimplified because it doesn't show any flash memory,
|
|
or the @code{reset-init} event handlers to initialize external DRAM
|
|
or (assuming it needs it) load a configuration into the FPGA.
|
|
Such features are usually needed for low-level work with many boards,
|
|
where ``low level'' implies that the board initialization software may
|
|
not be working. (That's a common reason to need JTAG tools. Another
|
|
is to enable working with microcontroller-based systems, which often
|
|
have no debugging support except a JTAG connector.)
|
|
|
|
Target config files may also export utility functions to board and user
|
|
config files. Such functions should use name prefixes, to help avoid
|
|
naming collisions.
|
|
|
|
Board files could also accept input variables from user config files.
|
|
For example, there might be a @code{J4_JUMPER} setting used to identify
|
|
what kind of flash memory a development board is using, or how to set
|
|
up other clocks and peripherals.
|
|
|
|
@subsection Variable Naming Convention
|
|
@cindex variable names
|
|
|
|
Most boards have only one instance of a chip.
|
|
However, it should be easy to create a board with more than
|
|
one such chip (as shown above).
|
|
Accordingly, we encourage these conventions for naming
|
|
variables associated with different @file{target.cfg} files,
|
|
to promote consistency and
|
|
so that board files can override target defaults.
|
|
|
|
Inputs to target config files include:
|
|
|
|
@itemize @bullet
|
|
@item @code{CHIPNAME} ...
|
|
This gives a name to the overall chip, and is used as part of
|
|
tap identifier dotted names.
|
|
While the default is normally provided by the chip manufacturer,
|
|
board files may need to distinguish between instances of a chip.
|
|
@item @code{ENDIAN} ...
|
|
By default @option{little} - although chips may hard-wire @option{big}.
|
|
Chips that can't change endianness don't need to use this variable.
|
|
@item @code{CPUTAPID} ...
|
|
When OpenOCD examines the JTAG chain, it can be told verify the
|
|
chips against the JTAG IDCODE register.
|
|
The target file will hold one or more defaults, but sometimes the
|
|
chip in a board will use a different ID (perhaps a newer revision).
|
|
@end itemize
|
|
|
|
Outputs from target config files include:
|
|
|
|
@itemize @bullet
|
|
@item @code{_TARGETNAME} ...
|
|
By convention, this variable is created by the target configuration
|
|
script. The board configuration file may make use of this variable to
|
|
configure things like a ``reset init'' script, or other things
|
|
specific to that board and that target.
|
|
If the chip has 2 targets, the names are @code{_TARGETNAME0},
|
|
@code{_TARGETNAME1}, ... etc.
|
|
@end itemize
|
|
|
|
@subsection The reset-init Event Handler
|
|
@cindex event, reset-init
|
|
@cindex reset-init handler
|
|
|
|
Board config files run in the OpenOCD configuration stage;
|
|
they can't use TAPs or targets, since they haven't been
|
|
fully set up yet.
|
|
This means you can't write memory or access chip registers;
|
|
you can't even verify that a flash chip is present.
|
|
That's done later in event handlers, of which the target @code{reset-init}
|
|
handler is one of the most important.
|
|
|
|
Except on microcontrollers, the basic job of @code{reset-init} event
|
|
handlers is setting up flash and DRAM, as normally handled by boot loaders.
|
|
Microcontrollers rarely use boot loaders; they run right out of their
|
|
on-chip flash and SRAM memory. But they may want to use one of these
|
|
handlers too, if just for developer convenience.
|
|
|
|
@quotation Note
|
|
Because this is so very board-specific, and chip-specific, no examples
|
|
are included here.
|
|
Instead, look at the board config files distributed with OpenOCD.
|
|
If you have a boot loader, its source code will help; so will
|
|
configuration files for other JTAG tools
|
|
(@pxref{translatingconfigurationfiles,,Translating Configuration Files}).
|
|
@end quotation
|
|
|
|
Some of this code could probably be shared between different boards.
|
|
For example, setting up a DRAM controller often doesn't differ by
|
|
much except the bus width (16 bits or 32?) and memory timings, so a
|
|
reusable TCL procedure loaded by the @file{target.cfg} file might take
|
|
those as parameters.
|
|
Similarly with oscillator, PLL, and clock setup;
|
|
and disabling the watchdog.
|
|
Structure the code cleanly, and provide comments to help
|
|
the next developer doing such work.
|
|
(@emph{You might be that next person} trying to reuse init code!)
|
|
|
|
The last thing normally done in a @code{reset-init} handler is probing
|
|
whatever flash memory was configured. For most chips that needs to be
|
|
done while the associated target is halted, either because JTAG memory
|
|
access uses the CPU or to prevent conflicting CPU access.
|
|
|
|
@subsection JTAG Clock Rate
|
|
|
|
Before your @code{reset-init} handler has set up
|
|
the PLLs and clocking, you may need to run with
|
|
a low JTAG clock rate.
|
|
@xref{jtagspeed,,JTAG Speed}.
|
|
Then you'd increase that rate after your handler has
|
|
made it possible to use the faster JTAG clock.
|
|
When the initial low speed is board-specific, for example
|
|
because it depends on a board-specific oscillator speed, then
|
|
you should probably set it up in the board config file;
|
|
if it's target-specific, it belongs in the target config file.
|
|
|
|
For most ARM-based processors the fastest JTAG clock@footnote{A FAQ
|
|
@uref{http://www.arm.com/support/faqdev/4170.html} gives details.}
|
|
is one sixth of the CPU clock; or one eighth for ARM11 cores.
|
|
Consult chip documentation to determine the peak JTAG clock rate,
|
|
which might be less than that.
|
|
|
|
@quotation Warning
|
|
On most ARMs, JTAG clock detection is coupled to the core clock, so
|
|
software using a @option{wait for interrupt} operation blocks JTAG access.
|
|
Adaptive clocking provides a partial workaround, but a more complete
|
|
solution just avoids using that instruction with JTAG debuggers.
|
|
@end quotation
|
|
|
|
If both the chip and the board support adaptive clocking,
|
|
use the @command{jtag_rclk}
|
|
command, in case your board is used with JTAG adapter which
|
|
also supports it. Otherwise use @command{adapter speed}.
|
|
Set the slow rate at the beginning of the reset sequence,
|
|
and the faster rate as soon as the clocks are at full speed.
|
|
|
|
@anchor{theinitboardprocedure}
|
|
@subsection The init_board procedure
|
|
@cindex init_board procedure
|
|
|
|
The concept of @code{init_board} procedure is very similar to @code{init_targets}
|
|
(@xref{theinittargetsprocedure,,The init_targets procedure}.) - it's a replacement of ``linear''
|
|
configuration scripts. This procedure is meant to be executed when OpenOCD enters run stage
|
|
(@xref{enteringtherunstage,,Entering the Run Stage},) after @code{init_targets}. The idea to have
|
|
separate @code{init_targets} and @code{init_board} procedures is to allow the first one to configure
|
|
everything target specific (internal flash, internal RAM, etc.) and the second one to configure
|
|
everything board specific (reset signals, chip frequency, reset-init event handler, external memory, etc.).
|
|
Additionally ``linear'' board config file will most likely fail when target config file uses
|
|
@code{init_targets} scheme (``linear'' script is executed before @code{init} and @code{init_targets} - after),
|
|
so separating these two configuration stages is very convenient, as the easiest way to overcome this
|
|
problem is to convert board config file to use @code{init_board} procedure. Board config scripts don't
|
|
need to override @code{init_targets} defined in target config files when they only need to add some specifics.
|
|
|
|
Just as @code{init_targets}, the @code{init_board} procedure can be overridden by ``next level'' script (which sources
|
|
the original), allowing greater code reuse.
|
|
|
|
@example
|
|
### board_file.cfg ###
|
|
|
|
# source target file that does most of the config in init_targets
|
|
source [find target/target.cfg]
|
|
|
|
proc enable_fast_clock @{@} @{
|
|
# enables fast on-board clock source
|
|
# configures the chip to use it
|
|
@}
|
|
|
|
# initialize only board specifics - reset, clock, adapter frequency
|
|
proc init_board @{@} @{
|
|
reset_config trst_and_srst trst_pulls_srst
|
|
|
|
$_TARGETNAME configure -event reset-start @{
|
|
adapter speed 100
|
|
@}
|
|
|
|
$_TARGETNAME configure -event reset-init @{
|
|
enable_fast_clock
|
|
adapter speed 10000
|
|
@}
|
|
@}
|
|
@end example
|
|
|
|
@section Target Config Files
|
|
@cindex config file, target
|
|
@cindex target config file
|
|
|
|
Board config files communicate with target config files using
|
|
naming conventions as described above, and may source one or
|
|
more target config files like this:
|
|
|
|
@example
|
|
source [find target/FOOBAR.cfg]
|
|
@end example
|
|
|
|
The point of a target config file is to package everything
|
|
about a given chip that board config files need to know.
|
|
In summary the target files should contain
|
|
|
|
@enumerate
|
|
@item Set defaults
|
|
@item Add TAPs to the scan chain
|
|
@item Add CPU targets (includes GDB support)
|
|
@item CPU/Chip/CPU-Core specific features
|
|
@item On-Chip flash
|
|
@end enumerate
|
|
|
|
As a rule of thumb, a target file sets up only one chip.
|
|
For a microcontroller, that will often include a single TAP,
|
|
which is a CPU needing a GDB target, and its on-chip flash.
|
|
|
|
More complex chips may include multiple TAPs, and the target
|
|
config file may need to define them all before OpenOCD
|
|
can talk to the chip.
|
|
For example, some phone chips have JTAG scan chains that include
|
|
an ARM core for operating system use, a DSP,
|
|
another ARM core embedded in an image processing engine,
|
|
and other processing engines.
|
|
|
|
@subsection Default Value Boiler Plate Code
|
|
|
|
All target configuration files should start with code like this,
|
|
letting board config files express environment-specific
|
|
differences in how things should be set up.
|
|
|
|
@example
|
|
# Boards may override chip names, perhaps based on role,
|
|
# but the default should match what the vendor uses
|
|
if @{ [info exists CHIPNAME] @} @{
|
|
set _CHIPNAME $CHIPNAME
|
|
@} else @{
|
|
set _CHIPNAME sam7x256
|
|
@}
|
|
|
|
# ONLY use ENDIAN with targets that can change it.
|
|
if @{ [info exists ENDIAN] @} @{
|
|
set _ENDIAN $ENDIAN
|
|
@} else @{
|
|
set _ENDIAN little
|
|
@}
|
|
|
|
# TAP identifiers may change as chips mature, for example with
|
|
# new revision fields (the "3" here). Pick a good default; you
|
|
# can pass several such identifiers to the "jtag newtap" command.
|
|
if @{ [info exists CPUTAPID ] @} @{
|
|
set _CPUTAPID $CPUTAPID
|
|
@} else @{
|
|
set _CPUTAPID 0x3f0f0f0f
|
|
@}
|
|
@end example
|
|
@c but 0x3f0f0f0f is for an str73x part ...
|
|
|
|
@emph{Remember:} Board config files may include multiple target
|
|
config files, or the same target file multiple times
|
|
(changing at least @code{CHIPNAME}).
|
|
|
|
Likewise, the target configuration file should define
|
|
@code{_TARGETNAME} (or @code{_TARGETNAME0} etc) and
|
|
use it later on when defining debug targets:
|
|
|
|
@example
|
|
set _TARGETNAME $_CHIPNAME.cpu
|
|
target create $_TARGETNAME arm7tdmi -chain-position $_TARGETNAME
|
|
@end example
|
|
|
|
@subsection Adding TAPs to the Scan Chain
|
|
After the ``defaults'' are set up,
|
|
add the TAPs on each chip to the JTAG scan chain.
|
|
@xref{TAP Declaration}, and the naming convention
|
|
for taps.
|
|
|
|
In the simplest case the chip has only one TAP,
|
|
probably for a CPU or FPGA.
|
|
The config file for the Atmel AT91SAM7X256
|
|
looks (in part) like this:
|
|
|
|
@example
|
|
jtag newtap $_CHIPNAME cpu -irlen 4 -expected-id $_CPUTAPID
|
|
@end example
|
|
|
|
A board with two such at91sam7 chips would be able
|
|
to source such a config file twice, with different
|
|
values for @code{CHIPNAME}, so
|
|
it adds a different TAP each time.
|
|
|
|
If there are nonzero @option{-expected-id} values,
|
|
OpenOCD attempts to verify the actual tap id against those values.
|
|
It will issue error messages if there is mismatch, which
|
|
can help to pinpoint problems in OpenOCD configurations.
|
|
|
|
@example
|
|
JTAG tap: sam7x256.cpu tap/device found: 0x3f0f0f0f
|
|
(Manufacturer: 0x787, Part: 0xf0f0, Version: 0x3)
|
|
ERROR: Tap: sam7x256.cpu - Expected id: 0x12345678, Got: 0x3f0f0f0f
|
|
ERROR: expected: mfg: 0x33c, part: 0x2345, ver: 0x1
|
|
ERROR: got: mfg: 0x787, part: 0xf0f0, ver: 0x3
|
|
@end example
|
|
|
|
There are more complex examples too, with chips that have
|
|
multiple TAPs. Ones worth looking at include:
|
|
|
|
@itemize
|
|
@item @file{target/omap3530.cfg} -- with disabled ARM and DSP,
|
|
plus a JRC to enable them
|
|
@item @file{target/str912.cfg} -- with flash, CPU, and boundary scan
|
|
@item @file{target/ti_dm355.cfg} -- with ETM, ARM, and JRC (this JRC
|
|
is not currently used)
|
|
@end itemize
|
|
|
|
@subsection Add CPU targets
|
|
|
|
After adding a TAP for a CPU, you should set it up so that
|
|
GDB and other commands can use it.
|
|
@xref{CPU Configuration}.
|
|
For the at91sam7 example above, the command can look like this;
|
|
note that @code{$_ENDIAN} is not needed, since OpenOCD defaults
|
|
to little endian, and this chip doesn't support changing that.
|
|
|
|
@example
|
|
set _TARGETNAME $_CHIPNAME.cpu
|
|
target create $_TARGETNAME arm7tdmi -chain-position $_TARGETNAME
|
|
@end example
|
|
|
|
Work areas are small RAM areas associated with CPU targets.
|
|
They are used by OpenOCD to speed up downloads,
|
|
and to download small snippets of code to program flash chips.
|
|
If the chip includes a form of ``on-chip-ram'' - and many do - define
|
|
a work area if you can.
|
|
Again using the at91sam7 as an example, this can look like:
|
|
|
|
@example
|
|
$_TARGETNAME configure -work-area-phys 0x00200000 \
|
|
-work-area-size 0x4000 -work-area-backup 0
|
|
@end example
|
|
|
|
@subsection Define CPU targets working in SMP
|
|
@cindex SMP
|
|
After setting targets, you can define a list of targets working in SMP.
|
|
|
|
@example
|
|
set _TARGETNAME_1 $_CHIPNAME.cpu1
|
|
set _TARGETNAME_2 $_CHIPNAME.cpu2
|
|
target create $_TARGETNAME_1 cortex_a -chain-position $_CHIPNAME.dap \
|
|
-coreid 0 -dbgbase $_DAP_DBG1
|
|
target create $_TARGETNAME_2 cortex_a -chain-position $_CHIPNAME.dap \
|
|
-coreid 1 -dbgbase $_DAP_DBG2
|
|
#define 2 targets working in smp.
|
|
target smp $_CHIPNAME.cpu2 $_CHIPNAME.cpu1
|
|
@end example
|
|
In the above example on cortex_a, 2 cpus are working in SMP.
|
|
In SMP only one GDB instance is created and :
|
|
@itemize @bullet
|
|
@item a set of hardware breakpoint sets the same breakpoint on all targets in the list.
|
|
@item halt command triggers the halt of all targets in the list.
|
|
@item resume command triggers the write context and the restart of all targets in the list.
|
|
@item following a breakpoint: the target stopped by the breakpoint is displayed to the GDB session.
|
|
@item dedicated GDB serial protocol packets are implemented for switching/retrieving the target
|
|
displayed by the GDB session @pxref{usingopenocdsmpwithgdb,,Using OpenOCD SMP with GDB}.
|
|
@end itemize
|
|
|
|
The SMP behaviour can be disabled/enabled dynamically. On cortex_a following
|
|
command have been implemented.
|
|
@itemize @bullet
|
|
@item cortex_a smp on : enable SMP mode, behaviour is as described above.
|
|
@item cortex_a smp off : disable SMP mode, the current target is the one
|
|
displayed in the GDB session, only this target is now controlled by GDB
|
|
session. This behaviour is useful during system boot up.
|
|
@item cortex_a smp : display current SMP mode.
|
|
@item cortex_a smp_gdb : display/fix the core id displayed in GDB session see
|
|
following example.
|
|
@end itemize
|
|
|
|
@example
|
|
>cortex_a smp_gdb
|
|
gdb coreid 0 -> -1
|
|
#0 : coreid 0 is displayed to GDB ,
|
|
#-> -1 : next resume triggers a real resume
|
|
> cortex_a smp_gdb 1
|
|
gdb coreid 0 -> 1
|
|
#0 :coreid 0 is displayed to GDB ,
|
|
#->1 : next resume displays coreid 1 to GDB
|
|
> resume
|
|
> cortex_a smp_gdb
|
|
gdb coreid 1 -> 1
|
|
#1 :coreid 1 is displayed to GDB ,
|
|
#->1 : next resume displays coreid 1 to GDB
|
|
> cortex_a smp_gdb -1
|
|
gdb coreid 1 -> -1
|
|
#1 :coreid 1 is displayed to GDB,
|
|
#->-1 : next resume triggers a real resume
|
|
@end example
|
|
|
|
|
|
@subsection Chip Reset Setup
|
|
|
|
As a rule, you should put the @command{reset_config} command
|
|
into the board file. Most things you think you know about a
|
|
chip can be tweaked by the board.
|
|
|
|
Some chips have specific ways the TRST and SRST signals are
|
|
managed. In the unusual case that these are @emph{chip specific}
|
|
and can never be changed by board wiring, they could go here.
|
|
For example, some chips can't support JTAG debugging without
|
|
both signals.
|
|
|
|
Provide a @code{reset-assert} event handler if you can.
|
|
Such a handler uses JTAG operations to reset the target,
|
|
letting this target config be used in systems which don't
|
|
provide the optional SRST signal, or on systems where you
|
|
don't want to reset all targets at once.
|
|
Such a handler might write to chip registers to force a reset,
|
|
use a JRC to do that (preferable -- the target may be wedged!),
|
|
or force a watchdog timer to trigger.
|
|
(For Cortex-M targets, this is not necessary. The target
|
|
driver knows how to use trigger an NVIC reset when SRST is
|
|
not available.)
|
|
|
|
Some chips need special attention during reset handling if
|
|
they're going to be used with JTAG.
|
|
An example might be needing to send some commands right
|
|
after the target's TAP has been reset, providing a
|
|
@code{reset-deassert-post} event handler that writes a chip
|
|
register to report that JTAG debugging is being done.
|
|
Another would be reconfiguring the watchdog so that it stops
|
|
counting while the core is halted in the debugger.
|
|
|
|
JTAG clocking constraints often change during reset, and in
|
|
some cases target config files (rather than board config files)
|
|
are the right places to handle some of those issues.
|
|
For example, immediately after reset most chips run using a
|
|
slower clock than they will use later.
|
|
That means that after reset (and potentially, as OpenOCD
|
|
first starts up) they must use a slower JTAG clock rate
|
|
than they will use later.
|
|
@xref{jtagspeed,,JTAG Speed}.
|
|
|
|
@quotation Important
|
|
When you are debugging code that runs right after chip
|
|
reset, getting these issues right is critical.
|
|
In particular, if you see intermittent failures when
|
|
OpenOCD verifies the scan chain after reset,
|
|
look at how you are setting up JTAG clocking.
|
|
@end quotation
|
|
|
|
@anchor{theinittargetsprocedure}
|
|
@subsection The init_targets procedure
|
|
@cindex init_targets procedure
|
|
|
|
Target config files can either be ``linear'' (script executed line-by-line when parsed in
|
|
configuration stage, @xref{configurationstage,,Configuration Stage},) or they can contain a special
|
|
procedure called @code{init_targets}, which will be executed when entering run stage
|
|
(after parsing all config files or after @code{init} command, @xref{enteringtherunstage,,Entering the Run Stage}.)
|
|
Such procedure can be overridden by ``next level'' script (which sources the original).
|
|
This concept facilitates code reuse when basic target config files provide generic configuration
|
|
procedures and @code{init_targets} procedure, which can then be sourced and enhanced or changed in
|
|
a ``more specific'' target config file. This is not possible with ``linear'' config scripts,
|
|
because sourcing them executes every initialization commands they provide.
|
|
|
|
@example
|
|
### generic_file.cfg ###
|
|
|
|
proc setup_my_chip @{chip_name flash_size ram_size@} @{
|
|
# basic initialization procedure ...
|
|
@}
|
|
|
|
proc init_targets @{@} @{
|
|
# initializes generic chip with 4kB of flash and 1kB of RAM
|
|
setup_my_chip MY_GENERIC_CHIP 4096 1024
|
|
@}
|
|
|
|
### specific_file.cfg ###
|
|
|
|
source [find target/generic_file.cfg]
|
|
|
|
proc init_targets @{@} @{
|
|
# initializes specific chip with 128kB of flash and 64kB of RAM
|
|
setup_my_chip MY_CHIP_WITH_128K_FLASH_64KB_RAM 131072 65536
|
|
@}
|
|
@end example
|
|
|
|
The easiest way to convert ``linear'' config files to @code{init_targets} version is to
|
|
enclose every line of ``code'' (i.e. not @code{source} commands, procedures, etc.) in this procedure.
|
|
|
|
For an example of this scheme see LPC2000 target config files.
|
|
|
|
The @code{init_boards} procedure is a similar concept concerning board config files
|
|
(@xref{theinitboardprocedure,,The init_board procedure}.)
|
|
|
|
@subsection The init_target_events procedure
|
|
@cindex init_target_events procedure
|
|
|
|
A special procedure called @code{init_target_events} is run just after
|
|
@code{init_targets} (@xref{theinittargetsprocedure,,The init_targets
|
|
procedure}.) and before @code{init_board}
|
|
(@xref{theinitboardprocedure,,The init_board procedure}.) It is used
|
|
to set up default target events for the targets that do not have those
|
|
events already assigned.
|
|
|
|
@subsection ARM Core Specific Hacks
|
|
|
|
If the chip has a DCC, enable it. If the chip is an ARM9 with some
|
|
special high speed download features - enable it.
|
|
|
|
If present, the MMU, the MPU and the CACHE should be disabled.
|
|
|
|
Some ARM cores are equipped with trace support, which permits
|
|
examination of the instruction and data bus activity. Trace
|
|
activity is controlled through an ``Embedded Trace Module'' (ETM)
|
|
on one of the core's scan chains. The ETM emits voluminous data
|
|
through a ``trace port''. (@xref{armhardwaretracing,,ARM Hardware Tracing}.)
|
|
If you are using an external trace port,
|
|
configure it in your board config file.
|
|
If you are using an on-chip ``Embedded Trace Buffer'' (ETB),
|
|
configure it in your target config file.
|
|
|
|
@example
|
|
etm config $_TARGETNAME 16 normal full etb
|
|
etb config $_TARGETNAME $_CHIPNAME.etb
|
|
@end example
|
|
|
|
@subsection Internal Flash Configuration
|
|
|
|
This applies @b{ONLY TO MICROCONTROLLERS} that have flash built in.
|
|
|
|
@b{Never ever} in the ``target configuration file'' define any type of
|
|
flash that is external to the chip. (For example a BOOT flash on
|
|
Chip Select 0.) Such flash information goes in a board file - not
|
|
the TARGET (chip) file.
|
|
|
|
Examples:
|
|
@itemize @bullet
|
|
@item at91sam7x256 - has 256K flash YES enable it.
|
|
@item str912 - has flash internal YES enable it.
|
|
@item imx27 - uses boot flash on CS0 - it goes in the board file.
|
|
@item pxa270 - again - CS0 flash - it goes in the board file.
|
|
@end itemize
|
|
|
|
@anchor{translatingconfigurationfiles}
|
|
@section Translating Configuration Files
|
|
@cindex translation
|
|
If you have a configuration file for another hardware debugger
|
|
or toolset (Abatron, BDI2000, BDI3000, CCS,
|
|
Lauterbach, SEGGER, Macraigor, etc.), translating
|
|
it into OpenOCD syntax is often quite straightforward. The most tricky
|
|
part of creating a configuration script is oftentimes the reset init
|
|
sequence where e.g. PLLs, DRAM and the like is set up.
|
|
|
|
One trick that you can use when translating is to write small
|
|
Tcl procedures to translate the syntax into OpenOCD syntax. This
|
|
can avoid manual translation errors and make it easier to
|
|
convert other scripts later on.
|
|
|
|
Example of transforming quirky arguments to a simple search and
|
|
replace job:
|
|
|
|
@example
|
|
# Lauterbach syntax(?)
|
|
#
|
|
# Data.Set c15:0x042f %long 0x40000015
|
|
#
|
|
# OpenOCD syntax when using procedure below.
|
|
#
|
|
# setc15 0x01 0x00050078
|
|
|
|
proc setc15 @{regs value@} @{
|
|
global TARGETNAME
|
|
|
|
echo [format "set p15 0x%04x, 0x%08x" $regs $value]
|
|
|
|
arm mcr 15 [expr @{($regs >> 12) & 0x7@}] \
|
|
[expr @{($regs >> 0) & 0xf@}] [expr @{($regs >> 4) & 0xf@}] \
|
|
[expr @{($regs >> 8) & 0x7@}] $value
|
|
@}
|
|
@end example
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@node Server Configuration
|
|
@chapter Server Configuration
|
|
@cindex initialization
|
|
The commands here are commonly found in the openocd.cfg file and are
|
|
used to specify what TCP/IP ports are used, and how GDB should be
|
|
supported.
|
|
|
|
@anchor{configurationstage}
|
|
@section Configuration Stage
|
|
@cindex configuration stage
|
|
@cindex config command
|
|
|
|
When the OpenOCD server process starts up, it enters a
|
|
@emph{configuration stage} which is the only time that
|
|
certain commands, @emph{configuration commands}, may be issued.
|
|
Normally, configuration commands are only available
|
|
inside startup scripts.
|
|
|
|
In this manual, the definition of a configuration command is
|
|
presented as a @emph{Config Command}, not as a @emph{Command}
|
|
which may be issued interactively.
|
|
The runtime @command{help} command also highlights configuration
|
|
commands, and those which may be issued at any time.
|
|
|
|
Those configuration commands include declaration of TAPs,
|
|
flash banks,
|
|
the interface used for JTAG communication,
|
|
and other basic setup.
|
|
The server must leave the configuration stage before it
|
|
may access or activate TAPs.
|
|
After it leaves this stage, configuration commands may no
|
|
longer be issued.
|
|
|
|
@deffn {Command} {command mode} [command_name]
|
|
Returns the command modes allowed by a command: 'any', 'config', or
|
|
'exec'. If no command is specified, returns the current command
|
|
mode. Returns 'unknown' if an unknown command is given. Command can be
|
|
multiple tokens. (command valid any time)
|
|
|
|
In this document, the modes are described as stages, 'config' and
|
|
'exec' mode correspond configuration stage and run stage. 'any' means
|
|
the command can be executed in either
|
|
stages. @xref{configurationstage,,Configuration Stage}, and
|
|
@xref{enteringtherunstage,,Entering the Run Stage}.
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
|
|
@anchor{enteringtherunstage}
|
|
@section Entering the Run Stage
|
|
|
|
The first thing OpenOCD does after leaving the configuration
|
|
stage is to verify that it can talk to the scan chain
|
|
(list of TAPs) which has been configured.
|
|
It will warn if it doesn't find TAPs it expects to find,
|
|
or finds TAPs that aren't supposed to be there.
|
|
You should see no errors at this point.
|
|
If you see errors, resolve them by correcting the
|
|
commands you used to configure the server.
|
|
Common errors include using an initial JTAG speed that's too
|
|
fast, and not providing the right IDCODE values for the TAPs
|
|
on the scan chain.
|
|
|
|
Once OpenOCD has entered the run stage, a number of commands
|
|
become available.
|
|
A number of these relate to the debug targets you may have declared.
|
|
For example, the @command{mww} command will not be available until
|
|
a target has been successfully instantiated.
|
|
If you want to use those commands, you may need to force
|
|
entry to the run stage.
|
|
|
|
@deffn {Config Command} {init}
|
|
This command terminates the configuration stage and
|
|
enters the run stage. This helps when you need to have
|
|
the startup scripts manage tasks such as resetting the target,
|
|
programming flash, etc. To reset the CPU upon startup, add "init" and
|
|
"reset" at the end of the config script or at the end of the OpenOCD
|
|
command line using the @option{-c} command line switch.
|
|
|
|
If this command does not appear in any startup/configuration file
|
|
OpenOCD executes the command for you after processing all
|
|
configuration files and/or command line options.
|
|
|
|
@b{NOTE:} This command normally occurs near the end of your
|
|
openocd.cfg file to force OpenOCD to ``initialize'' and make the
|
|
targets ready. For example: If your openocd.cfg file needs to
|
|
read/write memory on your target, @command{init} must occur before
|
|
the memory read/write commands. This includes @command{nand probe}.
|
|
|
|
@command{init} calls the following internal OpenOCD commands to initialize
|
|
corresponding subsystems:
|
|
@deffn {Config Command} {target init}
|
|
@deffnx {Command} {transport init}
|
|
@deffnx {Command} {dap init}
|
|
@deffnx {Config Command} {flash init}
|
|
@deffnx {Config Command} {nand init}
|
|
@deffnx {Config Command} {pld init}
|
|
@deffnx {Command} {tpiu init}
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
|
|
At last, @command{init} executes all the commands that are specified in
|
|
the TCL list @var{post_init_commands}. The commands are executed in the
|
|
same order they occupy in the list. If one of the commands fails, then
|
|
the error is propagated and OpenOCD fails too.
|
|
@example
|
|
lappend post_init_commands @{echo "OpenOCD successfully initialized."@}
|
|
lappend post_init_commands @{echo "Have fun with OpenOCD !"@}
|
|
@end example
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
|
|
@deffn {Config Command} {noinit}
|
|
Prevent OpenOCD from implicit @command{init} call at the end of startup.
|
|
Allows issuing configuration commands over telnet or Tcl connection.
|
|
When you are done with configuration use @command{init} to enter
|
|
the run stage.
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
|
|
@deffn {Overridable Procedure} {jtag_init}
|
|
This is invoked at server startup to verify that it can talk
|
|
to the scan chain (list of TAPs) which has been configured.
|
|
|
|
The default implementation first tries @command{jtag arp_init},
|
|
which uses only a lightweight JTAG reset before examining the
|
|
scan chain.
|
|
If that fails, it tries again, using a harder reset
|
|
from the overridable procedure @command{init_reset}.
|
|
|
|
Implementations must have verified the JTAG scan chain before
|
|
they return.
|
|
This is done by calling @command{jtag arp_init}
|
|
(or @command{jtag arp_init-reset}).
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
|
|
@anchor{tcpipports}
|
|
@section TCP/IP Ports
|
|
@cindex TCP port
|
|
@cindex server
|
|
@cindex port
|
|
@cindex security
|
|
The OpenOCD server accepts remote commands in several syntaxes.
|
|
Each syntax uses a different TCP/IP port, which you may specify
|
|
only during configuration (before those ports are opened).
|
|
|
|
For reasons including security, you may wish to prevent remote
|
|
access using one or more of these ports.
|
|
In such cases, just specify the relevant port number as "disabled".
|
|
If you disable all access through TCP/IP, you will need to
|
|
use the command line @option{-pipe} option.
|
|
|
|
@anchor{gdb_port}
|
|
@deffn {Config Command} {gdb_port} [number]
|
|
@cindex GDB server
|
|
Normally gdb listens to a TCP/IP port, but GDB can also
|
|
communicate via pipes(stdin/out or named pipes). The name
|
|
"gdb_port" stuck because it covers probably more than 90% of
|
|
the normal use cases.
|
|
|
|
No arguments reports GDB port. "pipe" means listen to stdin
|
|
output to stdout, an integer is base port number, "disabled"
|
|
disables the gdb server.
|
|
|
|
When using "pipe", also use log_output to redirect the log
|
|
output to a file so as not to flood the stdin/out pipes.
|
|
|
|
Any other string is interpreted as named pipe to listen to.
|
|
Output pipe is the same name as input pipe, but with 'o' appended,
|
|
e.g. /var/gdb, /var/gdbo.
|
|
|
|
The GDB port for the first target will be the base port, the
|
|
second target will listen on gdb_port + 1, and so on.
|
|
When not specified during the configuration stage,
|
|
the port @var{number} defaults to 3333.
|
|
When @var{number} is not a numeric value, incrementing it to compute
|
|
the next port number does not work. In this case, specify the proper
|
|
@var{number} for each target by using the option @code{-gdb-port} of the
|
|
commands @command{target create} or @command{$target_name configure}.
|
|
@xref{gdbportoverride,,option -gdb-port}.
|
|
|
|
Note: when using "gdb_port pipe", increasing the default remote timeout in
|
|
gdb (with 'set remotetimeout') is recommended. An insufficient timeout may
|
|
cause initialization to fail with "Unknown remote qXfer reply: OK".
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
|
|
@deffn {Config Command} {tcl_port} [number]
|
|
Specify or query the port used for a simplified RPC
|
|
connection that can be used by clients to issue TCL commands and get the
|
|
output from the Tcl engine.
|
|
Intended as a machine interface.
|
|
When not specified during the configuration stage,
|
|
the port @var{number} defaults to 6666.
|
|
When specified as "disabled", this service is not activated.
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
|
|
@deffn {Config Command} {telnet_port} [number]
|
|
Specify or query the
|
|
port on which to listen for incoming telnet connections.
|
|
This port is intended for interaction with one human through TCL commands.
|
|
When not specified during the configuration stage,
|
|
the port @var{number} defaults to 4444.
|
|
When specified as "disabled", this service is not activated.
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
|
|
@anchor{gdbconfiguration}
|
|
@section GDB Configuration
|
|
@cindex GDB
|
|
@cindex GDB configuration
|
|
You can reconfigure some GDB behaviors if needed.
|
|
The ones listed here are static and global.
|
|
@xref{targetconfiguration,,Target Configuration}, about configuring individual targets.
|
|
@xref{targetevents,,Target Events}, about configuring target-specific event handling.
|
|
|
|
@anchor{gdbbreakpointoverride}
|
|
@deffn {Command} {gdb_breakpoint_override} [@option{hard}|@option{soft}|@option{disable}]
|
|
Force breakpoint type for gdb @command{break} commands.
|
|
This option supports GDB GUIs which don't
|
|
distinguish hard versus soft breakpoints, if the default OpenOCD and
|
|
GDB behaviour is not sufficient. GDB normally uses hardware
|
|
breakpoints if the memory map has been set up for flash regions.
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
|
|
@anchor{gdbflashprogram}
|
|
@deffn {Config Command} {gdb_flash_program} (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
|
|
Set to @option{enable} to cause OpenOCD to program the flash memory when a
|
|
vFlash packet is received.
|
|
The default behaviour is @option{enable}.
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
|
|
@deffn {Config Command} {gdb_memory_map} (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
|
|
Set to @option{enable} to cause OpenOCD to send the memory configuration to GDB when
|
|
requested. GDB will then know when to set hardware breakpoints, and program flash
|
|
using the GDB load command. @command{gdb_flash_program enable} must also be enabled
|
|
for flash programming to work.
|
|
Default behaviour is @option{enable}.
|
|
@xref{gdbflashprogram,,gdb_flash_program}.
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
|
|
@deffn {Config Command} {gdb_report_data_abort} (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
|
|
Specifies whether data aborts cause an error to be reported
|
|
by GDB memory read packets.
|
|
The default behaviour is @option{disable};
|
|
use @option{enable} see these errors reported.
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
|
|
@deffn {Config Command} {gdb_report_register_access_error} (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
|
|
Specifies whether register accesses requested by GDB register read/write
|
|
packets report errors or not.
|
|
The default behaviour is @option{disable};
|
|
use @option{enable} see these errors reported.
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
|
|
@deffn {Config Command} {gdb_target_description} (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
|
|
Set to @option{enable} to cause OpenOCD to send the target descriptions to gdb via qXfer:features:read packet.
|
|
The default behaviour is @option{enable}.
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
|
|
@deffn {Command} {gdb_save_tdesc}
|
|
Saves the target description file to the local file system.
|
|
|
|
The file name is @i{target_name}.xml.
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
|
|
@anchor{eventpolling}
|
|
@section Event Polling
|
|
|
|
Hardware debuggers are parts of asynchronous systems,
|
|
where significant events can happen at any time.
|
|
The OpenOCD server needs to detect some of these events,
|
|
so it can report them to through TCL command line
|
|
or to GDB.
|
|
|
|
Examples of such events include:
|
|
|
|
@itemize
|
|
@item One of the targets can stop running ... maybe it triggers
|
|
a code breakpoint or data watchpoint, or halts itself.
|
|
@item Messages may be sent over ``debug message'' channels ... many
|
|
targets support such messages sent over JTAG,
|
|
for receipt by the person debugging or tools.
|
|
@item Loss of power ... some adapters can detect these events.
|
|
@item Resets not issued through JTAG ... such reset sources
|
|
can include button presses or other system hardware, sometimes
|
|
including the target itself (perhaps through a watchdog).
|
|
@item Debug instrumentation sometimes supports event triggering
|
|
such as ``trace buffer full'' (so it can quickly be emptied)
|
|
or other signals (to correlate with code behavior).
|
|
@end itemize
|
|
|
|
None of those events are signaled through standard JTAG signals.
|
|
However, most conventions for JTAG connectors include voltage
|
|
level and system reset (SRST) signal detection.
|
|
Some connectors also include instrumentation signals, which
|
|
can imply events when those signals are inputs.
|
|
|
|
In general, OpenOCD needs to periodically check for those events,
|
|
either by looking at the status of signals on the JTAG connector
|
|
or by sending synchronous ``tell me your status'' JTAG requests
|
|
to the various active targets.
|
|
There is a command to manage and monitor that polling,
|
|
which is normally done in the background.
|
|
|
|
@deffn {Command} {poll} [@option{on}|@option{off}]
|
|
Poll the current target for its current state.
|
|
(Also, @pxref{targetcurstate,,target curstate}.)
|
|
If that target is in debug mode, architecture
|
|
specific information about the current state is printed.
|
|
An optional parameter
|
|
allows background polling to be enabled and disabled.
|
|
|
|
You could use this from the TCL command shell, or
|
|
from GDB using @command{monitor poll} command.
|
|
Leave background polling enabled while you're using GDB.
|
|
@example
|
|
> poll
|
|
background polling: on
|
|
target state: halted
|
|
target halted in ARM state due to debug-request, \
|
|
current mode: Supervisor
|
|
cpsr: 0x800000d3 pc: 0x11081bfc
|
|
MMU: disabled, D-Cache: disabled, I-Cache: enabled
|
|
>
|
|
@end example
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
|
|
@node Debug Adapter Configuration
|
|
@chapter Debug Adapter Configuration
|
|
@cindex config file, interface
|
|
@cindex interface config file
|
|
|
|
Correctly installing OpenOCD includes making your operating system give
|
|
OpenOCD access to debug adapters. Once that has been done, Tcl commands
|
|
are used to select which one is used, and to configure how it is used.
|
|
|
|
@quotation Note
|
|
Because OpenOCD started out with a focus purely on JTAG, you may find
|
|
places where it wrongly presumes JTAG is the only transport protocol
|
|
in use. Be aware that recent versions of OpenOCD are removing that
|
|
limitation. JTAG remains more functional than most other transports.
|
|
Other transports do not support boundary scan operations, or may be
|
|
specific to a given chip vendor. Some might be usable only for
|
|
programming flash memory, instead of also for debugging.
|
|
@end quotation
|
|
|
|
Debug Adapters/Interfaces/Dongles are normally configured
|
|
through commands in an interface configuration
|
|
file which is sourced by your @file{openocd.cfg} file, or
|
|
through a command line @option{-f interface/....cfg} option.
|
|
|
|
@example
|
|
source [find interface/olimex-jtag-tiny.cfg]
|
|
@end example
|
|
|
|
These commands tell
|
|
OpenOCD what type of JTAG adapter you have, and how to talk to it.
|
|
A few cases are so simple that you only need to say what driver to use:
|
|
|
|
@example
|
|
# jlink interface
|
|
adapter driver jlink
|
|
@end example
|
|
|
|
Most adapters need a bit more configuration than that.
|
|
|
|
|
|
@section Adapter Configuration
|
|
|
|
The @command{adapter driver} command tells OpenOCD what type of debug adapter you are
|
|
using. Depending on the type of adapter, you may need to use one or
|
|
more additional commands to further identify or configure the adapter.
|
|
|
|
@deffn {Config Command} {adapter driver} name
|
|
Use the adapter driver @var{name} to connect to the
|
|
target.
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
|
|
@deffn {Command} {adapter list}
|
|
List the debug adapter drivers that have been built into
|
|
the running copy of OpenOCD.
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
@deffn {Config Command} {adapter transports} transport_name+
|
|
Specifies the transports supported by this debug adapter.
|
|
The adapter driver builds-in similar knowledge; use this only
|
|
when external configuration (such as jumpering) changes what
|
|
the hardware can support.
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
|
|
@anchor{adapter gpio}
|
|
@deffn {Config Command} {adapter gpio [ @
|
|
@option{tdo} | @option{tdi} | @option{tms} | @option{tck} | @option{trst} | @
|
|
@option{swdio} | @option{swdio_dir} | @option{swclk} | @option{srst} | @
|
|
@option{led} @
|
|
[ @
|
|
gpio_number | @option{-chip} chip_number | @
|
|
@option{-active-high} | @option{-active-low} | @
|
|
@option{-push-pull} | @option{-open-drain} | @option{-open-source} | @
|
|
@option{-pull-none} | @option{-pull-up} | @option{-pull-down} | @
|
|
@option{-init-inactive} | @option{-init-active} | @option{-init-input} @
|
|
] ]}
|
|
|
|
Define the GPIO mapping that the adapter will use. The following signals can be
|
|
defined:
|
|
|
|
@itemize @minus
|
|
@item @option{tdo}, @option{tdi}, @option{tms}, @option{tck}, @option{trst}:
|
|
JTAG transport signals
|
|
@item @option{swdio}, @option{swclk}: SWD transport signals
|
|
@item @option{swdio_dir}: optional swdio buffer control signal
|
|
@item @option{srst}: system reset signal
|
|
@item @option{led}: optional activity led
|
|
|
|
@end itemize
|
|
|
|
Some adapters require that the GPIO chip number is set in addition to the GPIO
|
|
number. The configuration options enable signals to be defined as active-high or
|
|
active-low. The output drive mode can be set to push-pull, open-drain or
|
|
open-source. Most adapters will have to emulate open-drain or open-source drive
|
|
modes by switching between an input and output. Input and output signals can be
|
|
instructed to use a pull-up or pull-down resistor, assuming it is supported by
|
|
the adaptor driver and hardware. The initial state of outputs may also be set,
|
|
"active" state means 1 for active-high outputs and 0 for active-low outputs.
|
|
Bidirectional signals may also be initialized as an input. If the swdio signal
|
|
is buffered the buffer direction can be controlled with the swdio_dir signal;
|
|
the active state means that the buffer should be set as an output with respect
|
|
to the adapter. The command options are cumulative with later commands able to
|
|
override settings defined by earlier ones. The two commands @command{gpio led 7
|
|
-active-high} and @command{gpio led -chip 1 -active-low} sent sequentially are
|
|
equivalent to issuing the single command @command{gpio led 7 -chip 1
|
|
-active-low}. It is not permissible to set the drive mode or initial state for
|
|
signals which are inputs. The drive mode for the srst and trst signals must be
|
|
set with the @command{adapter reset_config} command. It is not permissible to
|
|
set the initial state of swdio_dir as it is derived from the initial state of
|
|
swdio. The command @command{adapter gpio} prints the current configuration for
|
|
all GPIOs while the command @command{adapter gpio gpio_name} prints the current
|
|
configuration for gpio_name. Not all adapters support this generic GPIO mapping,
|
|
some require their own commands to define the GPIOs used. Adapters that support
|
|
the generic mapping may not support all of the listed options.
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
|
|
@deffn {Command} {adapter name}
|
|
Returns the name of the debug adapter driver being used.
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
|
|
@deffn {Config Command} {adapter usb location} [<bus>-<port>[.<port>]...]
|
|
Displays or specifies the physical USB port of the adapter to use. The path
|
|
roots at @var{bus} and walks down the physical ports, with each
|
|
@var{port} option specifying a deeper level in the bus topology, the last
|
|
@var{port} denoting where the target adapter is actually plugged.
|
|
The USB bus topology can be queried with the command @emph{lsusb -t} or @emph{dmesg}.
|
|
|
|
This command is only available if your libusb1 is at least version 1.0.16.
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
|
|
@deffn {Config Command} {adapter serial} serial_string
|
|
Specifies the @var{serial_string} of the adapter to use.
|
|
If this command is not specified, serial strings are not checked.
|
|
Only the following adapter drivers use the serial string from this command:
|
|
arm-jtag-ew, cmsis_dap, esp_usb_jtag, ft232r, ftdi, hla (stlink, ti-icdi), jlink, kitprog, opendus,
|
|
openjtag, osbdm, presto, rlink, st-link, usb_blaster (ublast2), usbprog, vsllink, xds110.
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
|
|
@section Interface Drivers
|
|
|
|
Each of the interface drivers listed here must be explicitly
|
|
enabled when OpenOCD is configured, in order to be made
|
|
available at run time.
|
|
|
|
@deffn {Interface Driver} {amt_jtagaccel}
|
|
Amontec Chameleon in its JTAG Accelerator configuration,
|
|
connected to a PC's EPP mode parallel port.
|
|
This defines some driver-specific commands:
|
|
|
|
@deffn {Config Command} {parport port} number
|
|
Specifies either the address of the I/O port (default: 0x378 for LPT1) or
|
|
the number of the @file{/dev/parport} device.
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
|
|
@deffn {Config Command} {rtck} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
|
|
Displays status of RTCK option.
|
|
Optionally sets that option first.
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
|
|
@deffn {Interface Driver} {arm-jtag-ew}
|
|
Olimex ARM-JTAG-EW USB adapter
|
|
This has one driver-specific command:
|
|
|
|
@deffn {Command} {armjtagew_info}
|
|
Logs some status
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
|
|
@deffn {Interface Driver} {at91rm9200}
|
|
Supports bitbanged JTAG from the local system,
|
|
presuming that system is an Atmel AT91rm9200
|
|
and a specific set of GPIOs is used.
|
|
@c command: at91rm9200_device NAME
|
|
@c chooses among list of bit configs ... only one option
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
|
|
@deffn {Interface Driver} {cmsis-dap}
|
|
ARM CMSIS-DAP compliant based adapter v1 (USB HID based)
|
|
or v2 (USB bulk).
|
|
|
|
@deffn {Config Command} {cmsis_dap_vid_pid} [vid pid]+
|
|
The vendor ID and product ID of the CMSIS-DAP device. If not specified
|
|
the driver will attempt to auto detect the CMSIS-DAP device.
|
|
Currently, up to eight [@var{vid}, @var{pid}] pairs may be given, e.g.
|
|
@example
|
|
cmsis_dap_vid_pid 0xc251 0xf001 0x0d28 0x0204
|
|
@end example
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
|
|
@deffn {Config Command} {cmsis_dap_backend} [@option{auto}|@option{usb_bulk}|@option{hid}]
|
|
Specifies how to communicate with the adapter:
|
|
|
|
@itemize @minus
|
|
@item @option{hid} Use HID generic reports - CMSIS-DAP v1
|
|
@item @option{usb_bulk} Use USB bulk - CMSIS-DAP v2
|
|
@item @option{auto} First try USB bulk CMSIS-DAP v2, if not found try HID CMSIS-DAP v1.
|
|
This is the default if @command{cmsis_dap_backend} is not specified.
|
|
@end itemize
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
|
|
@deffn {Config Command} {cmsis_dap_usb interface} [number]
|
|
Specifies the @var{number} of the USB interface to use in v2 mode (USB bulk).
|
|
In most cases need not to be specified and interfaces are searched by
|
|
interface string or for user class interface.
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
|
|
@deffn {Command} {cmsis-dap info}
|
|
Display various device information, like hardware version, firmware version, current bus status.
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
|
|
@deffn {Command} {cmsis-dap cmd} number number ...
|
|
Execute an arbitrary CMSIS-DAP command. Use for adapter testing or for handling
|
|
of an adapter vendor specific command from a Tcl script.
|
|
|
|
Take given numbers as bytes, assemble a CMSIS-DAP protocol command packet
|
|
from them and send it to the adapter. The first 4 bytes of the adapter response
|
|
are logged.
|
|
See @url{https://arm-software.github.io/CMSIS_5/DAP/html/group__DAP__Commands__gr.html}
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
|
|
@deffn {Interface Driver} {dummy}
|
|
A dummy software-only driver for debugging.
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
|
|
@deffn {Interface Driver} {ep93xx}
|
|
Cirrus Logic EP93xx based single-board computer bit-banging (in development)
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
|
|
@deffn {Interface Driver} {ftdi}
|
|
This driver is for adapters using the MPSSE (Multi-Protocol Synchronous Serial
|
|
Engine) mode built into many FTDI chips, such as the FT2232, FT4232 and FT232H.
|
|
|
|
The driver is using libusb-1.0 in asynchronous mode to talk to the FTDI device,
|
|
bypassing intermediate libraries like libftdi.
|
|
|
|
Support for new FTDI based adapters can be added completely through
|
|
configuration files, without the need to patch and rebuild OpenOCD.
|
|
|
|
The driver uses a signal abstraction to enable Tcl configuration files to
|
|
define outputs for one or several FTDI GPIO. These outputs can then be
|
|
controlled using the @command{ftdi set_signal} command. Special signal names
|
|
are reserved for nTRST, nSRST and LED (for blink) so that they, if defined,
|
|
will be used for their customary purpose. Inputs can be read using the
|
|
@command{ftdi get_signal} command.
|
|
|
|
To support SWD, a signal named SWD_EN must be defined. It is set to 1 when the
|
|
SWD protocol is selected. When set, the adapter should route the SWDIO pin to
|
|
the data input. An SWDIO_OE signal, if defined, will be set to 1 or 0 as
|
|
required by the protocol, to tell the adapter to drive the data output onto
|
|
the SWDIO pin or keep the SWDIO pin Hi-Z, respectively.
|
|
|
|
Depending on the type of buffer attached to the FTDI GPIO, the outputs have to
|
|
be controlled differently. In order to support tristateable signals such as
|
|
nSRST, both a data GPIO and an output-enable GPIO can be specified for each
|
|
signal. The following output buffer configurations are supported:
|
|
|
|
@itemize @minus
|
|
@item Push-pull with one FTDI output as (non-)inverted data line
|
|
@item Open drain with one FTDI output as (non-)inverted output-enable
|
|
@item Tristate with one FTDI output as (non-)inverted data line and another
|
|
FTDI output as (non-)inverted output-enable
|
|
@item Unbuffered, using the FTDI GPIO as a tristate output directly by
|
|
switching data and direction as necessary
|
|
@end itemize
|
|
|
|
These interfaces have several commands, used to configure the driver
|
|
before initializing the JTAG scan chain:
|
|
|
|
@deffn {Config Command} {ftdi vid_pid} [vid pid]+
|
|
The vendor ID and product ID of the adapter. Up to eight
|
|
[@var{vid}, @var{pid}] pairs may be given, e.g.
|
|
@example
|
|
ftdi vid_pid 0x0403 0xcff8 0x15ba 0x0003
|
|
@end example
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
|
|
@deffn {Config Command} {ftdi device_desc} description
|
|
Provides the USB device description (the @emph{iProduct string})
|
|
of the adapter. If not specified, the device description is ignored
|
|
during device selection.
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
|
|
@deffn {Config Command} {ftdi channel} channel
|
|
Selects the channel of the FTDI device to use for MPSSE operations. Most
|
|
adapters use the default, channel 0, but there are exceptions.
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
|
|
@deffn {Config Command} {ftdi layout_init} data direction
|
|
Specifies the initial values of the FTDI GPIO data and direction registers.
|
|
Each value is a 16-bit number corresponding to the concatenation of the high
|
|
and low FTDI GPIO registers. The values should be selected based on the
|
|
schematics of the adapter, such that all signals are set to safe levels with
|
|
minimal impact on the target system. Avoid floating inputs, conflicting outputs
|
|
and initially asserted reset signals.
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
|
|
@deffn {Command} {ftdi layout_signal} name [@option{-data}|@option{-ndata} data_mask] [@option{-input}|@option{-ninput} input_mask] [@option{-oe}|@option{-noe} oe_mask] [@option{-alias}|@option{-nalias} name]
|
|
Creates a signal with the specified @var{name}, controlled by one or more FTDI
|
|
GPIO pins via a range of possible buffer connections. The masks are FTDI GPIO
|
|
register bitmasks to tell the driver the connection and type of the output
|
|
buffer driving the respective signal. @var{data_mask} is the bitmask for the
|
|
pin(s) connected to the data input of the output buffer. @option{-ndata} is
|
|
used with inverting data inputs and @option{-data} with non-inverting inputs.
|
|
The @option{-oe} (or @option{-noe}) option tells where the output-enable (or
|
|
not-output-enable) input to the output buffer is connected. The options
|
|
@option{-input} and @option{-ninput} specify the bitmask for pins to be read
|
|
with the method @command{ftdi get_signal}.
|
|
|
|
Both @var{data_mask} and @var{oe_mask} need not be specified. For example, a
|
|
simple open-collector transistor driver would be specified with @option{-oe}
|
|
only. In that case the signal can only be set to drive low or to Hi-Z and the
|
|
driver will complain if the signal is set to drive high. Which means that if
|
|
it's a reset signal, @command{reset_config} must be specified as
|
|
@option{srst_open_drain}, not @option{srst_push_pull}.
|
|
|
|
A special case is provided when @option{-data} and @option{-oe} is set to the
|
|
same bitmask. Then the FTDI pin is considered being connected straight to the
|
|
target without any buffer. The FTDI pin is then switched between output and
|
|
input as necessary to provide the full set of low, high and Hi-Z
|
|
characteristics. In all other cases, the pins specified in a signal definition
|
|
are always driven by the FTDI.
|
|
|
|
If @option{-alias} or @option{-nalias} is used, the signal is created
|
|
identical (or with data inverted) to an already specified signal
|
|
@var{name}.
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
|
|
@deffn {Command} {ftdi set_signal} name @option{0}|@option{1}|@option{z}
|
|
Set a previously defined signal to the specified level.
|
|
@itemize @minus
|
|
@item @option{0}, drive low
|
|
@item @option{1}, drive high
|
|
@item @option{z}, set to high-impedance
|
|
@end itemize
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
|
|
@deffn {Command} {ftdi get_signal} name
|
|
Get the value of a previously defined signal.
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
|
|
@deffn {Command} {ftdi tdo_sample_edge} @option{rising}|@option{falling}
|
|
Configure TCK edge at which the adapter samples the value of the TDO signal
|
|
|
|
Due to signal propagation delays, sampling TDO on rising TCK can become quite
|
|
peculiar at high JTAG clock speeds. However, FTDI chips offer a possibility to sample
|
|
TDO on falling edge of TCK. With some board/adapter configurations, this may increase
|
|
stability at higher JTAG clocks.
|
|
@itemize @minus
|
|
@item @option{rising}, sample TDO on rising edge of TCK - this is the default
|
|
@item @option{falling}, sample TDO on falling edge of TCK
|
|
@end itemize
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
|
|
For example adapter definitions, see the configuration files shipped in the
|
|
@file{interface/ftdi} directory.
|
|
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
|
|
@deffn {Interface Driver} {ft232r}
|
|
This driver is implementing synchronous bitbang mode of an FTDI FT232R,
|
|
FT230X, FT231X and similar USB UART bridge ICs by reusing RS232 signals as GPIO.
|
|
It currently doesn't support using CBUS pins as GPIO.
|
|
|
|
List of connections (default physical pin numbers for FT232R in 28-pin SSOP package):
|
|
@itemize @minus
|
|
@item RXD(5) - TDI
|
|
@item TXD(1) - TCK
|
|
@item RTS(3) - TDO
|
|
@item CTS(11) - TMS
|
|
@item DTR(2) - TRST
|
|
@item DCD(10) - SRST
|
|
@end itemize
|
|
|
|
User can change default pinout by supplying configuration
|
|
commands with GPIO numbers or RS232 signal names.
|
|
GPIO numbers correspond to bit numbers in FTDI GPIO register.
|
|
They differ from physical pin numbers.
|
|
For details see actual FTDI chip datasheets.
|
|
Every JTAG line must be configured to unique GPIO number
|
|
different than any other JTAG line, even those lines
|
|
that are sometimes not used like TRST or SRST.
|
|
|
|
FT232R
|
|
@itemize @minus
|
|
@item bit 7 - RI
|
|
@item bit 6 - DCD
|
|
@item bit 5 - DSR
|
|
@item bit 4 - DTR
|
|
@item bit 3 - CTS
|
|
@item bit 2 - RTS
|
|
@item bit 1 - RXD
|
|
@item bit 0 - TXD
|
|
@end itemize
|
|
|
|
These interfaces have several commands, used to configure the driver
|
|
before initializing the JTAG scan chain:
|
|
|
|
@deffn {Config Command} {ft232r vid_pid} @var{vid} @var{pid}
|
|
The vendor ID and product ID of the adapter. If not specified, default
|
|
0x0403:0x6001 is used.
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
|
|
@deffn {Config Command} {ft232r jtag_nums} @var{tck} @var{tms} @var{tdi} @var{tdo}
|
|
Set four JTAG GPIO numbers at once.
|
|
If not specified, default 0 3 1 2 or TXD CTS RXD RTS is used.
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
|
|
@deffn {Config Command} {ft232r tck_num} @var{tck}
|
|
Set TCK GPIO number. If not specified, default 0 or TXD is used.
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
|
|
@deffn {Config Command} {ft232r tms_num} @var{tms}
|
|
Set TMS GPIO number. If not specified, default 3 or CTS is used.
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
|
|
@deffn {Config Command} {ft232r tdi_num} @var{tdi}
|
|
Set TDI GPIO number. If not specified, default 1 or RXD is used.
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
|
|
@deffn {Config Command} {ft232r tdo_num} @var{tdo}
|
|
Set TDO GPIO number. If not specified, default 2 or RTS is used.
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
|
|
@deffn {Config Command} {ft232r trst_num} @var{trst}
|
|
Set TRST GPIO number. If not specified, default 4 or DTR is used.
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
|
|
@deffn {Config Command} {ft232r srst_num} @var{srst}
|
|
Set SRST GPIO number. If not specified, default 6 or DCD is used.
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
|
|
@deffn {Config Command} {ft232r restore_serial} @var{word}
|
|
Restore serial port after JTAG. This USB bitmode control word
|
|
(16-bit) will be sent before quit. Lower byte should
|
|
set GPIO direction register to a "sane" state:
|
|
0x15 for TXD RTS DTR as outputs (1), others as inputs (0). Higher
|
|
byte is usually 0 to disable bitbang mode.
|
|
When kernel driver reattaches, serial port should continue to work.
|
|
Value 0xFFFF disables sending control word and serial port,
|
|
then kernel driver will not reattach.
|
|
If not specified, default 0xFFFF is used.
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
|
|
@deffn {Interface Driver} {remote_bitbang}
|
|
Drive JTAG from a remote process. This sets up a UNIX or TCP socket connection
|
|
with a remote process and sends ASCII encoded bitbang requests to that process
|
|
instead of directly driving JTAG.
|
|
|
|
The remote_bitbang driver is useful for debugging software running on
|
|
processors which are being simulated.
|
|
|
|
@deffn {Config Command} {remote_bitbang port} number
|
|
Specifies the TCP port of the remote process to connect to or 0 to use UNIX
|
|
sockets instead of TCP.
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
|
|
@deffn {Config Command} {remote_bitbang host} hostname
|
|
Specifies the hostname of the remote process to connect to using TCP, or the
|
|
name of the UNIX socket to use if remote_bitbang port is 0.
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
|
|
For example, to connect remotely via TCP to the host foobar you might have
|
|
something like:
|
|
|
|
@example
|
|
adapter driver remote_bitbang
|
|
remote_bitbang port 3335
|
|
remote_bitbang host foobar
|
|
@end example
|
|
|
|
To connect to another process running locally via UNIX sockets with socket
|
|
named mysocket:
|
|
|
|
@example
|
|
adapter driver remote_bitbang
|
|
remote_bitbang port 0
|
|
remote_bitbang host mysocket
|
|
@end example
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
|
|
@deffn {Interface Driver} {usb_blaster}
|
|
USB JTAG/USB-Blaster compatibles over one of the userspace libraries
|
|
for FTDI chips. These interfaces have several commands, used to
|
|
configure the driver before initializing the JTAG scan chain:
|
|
|
|
@deffn {Config Command} {usb_blaster vid_pid} vid pid
|
|
The vendor ID and product ID of the FTDI FT245 device. If not specified,
|
|
default values are used.
|
|
Currently, only one @var{vid}, @var{pid} pair may be given, e.g. for
|
|
Altera USB-Blaster (default):
|
|
@example
|
|
usb_blaster vid_pid 0x09FB 0x6001
|
|
@end example
|
|
The following VID/PID is for Kolja Waschk's USB JTAG:
|
|
@example
|
|
usb_blaster vid_pid 0x16C0 0x06AD
|
|
@end example
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
|
|
@deffn {Command} {usb_blaster pin} (@option{pin6}|@option{pin8}) (@option{0}|@option{1}|@option{s}|@option{t})
|
|
Sets the state or function of the unused GPIO pins on USB-Blasters
|
|
(pins 6 and 8 on the female JTAG header). These pins can be used as
|
|
SRST and/or TRST provided the appropriate connections are made on the
|
|
target board.
|
|
|
|
For example, to use pin 6 as SRST:
|
|
@example
|
|
usb_blaster pin pin6 s
|
|
reset_config srst_only
|
|
@end example
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
|
|
@deffn {Config Command} {usb_blaster lowlevel_driver} (@option{ftdi}|@option{ublast2})
|
|
Chooses the low level access method for the adapter. If not specified,
|
|
@option{ftdi} is selected unless it wasn't enabled during the
|
|
configure stage. USB-Blaster II needs @option{ublast2}.
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
|
|
@deffn {Config Command} {usb_blaster firmware} @var{path}
|
|
This command specifies @var{path} to access USB-Blaster II firmware
|
|
image. To be used with USB-Blaster II only.
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
|
|
@deffn {Interface Driver} {gw16012}
|
|
Gateworks GW16012 JTAG programmer.
|
|
This has one driver-specific command:
|
|
|
|
@deffn {Config Command} {parport port} [port_number]
|
|
Display either the address of the I/O port
|
|
(default: 0x378 for LPT1) or the number of the @file{/dev/parport} device.
|
|
If a parameter is provided, first switch to use that port.
|
|
This is a write-once setting.
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
|
|
@deffn {Interface Driver} {jlink}
|
|
SEGGER J-Link family of USB adapters. It currently supports JTAG and SWD
|
|
transports.
|
|
|
|
@quotation Compatibility Note
|
|
SEGGER released many firmware versions for the many hardware versions they
|
|
produced. OpenOCD was extensively tested and intended to run on all of them,
|
|
but some combinations were reported as incompatible. As a general
|
|
recommendation, it is advisable to use the latest firmware version
|
|
available for each hardware version. However the current V8 is a moving
|
|
target, and SEGGER firmware versions released after the OpenOCD was
|
|
released may not be compatible. In such cases it is recommended to
|
|
revert to the last known functional version. For 0.5.0, this is from
|
|
"Feb 8 2012 14:30:39", packed with 4.42c. For 0.6.0, the last known
|
|
version is from "May 3 2012 18:36:22", packed with 4.46f.
|
|
@end quotation
|
|
|
|
@deffn {Command} {jlink hwstatus}
|
|
Display various hardware related information, for example target voltage and pin
|
|
states.
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
@deffn {Command} {jlink freemem}
|
|
Display free device internal memory.
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
@deffn {Command} {jlink jtag} [@option{2}|@option{3}]
|
|
Set the JTAG command version to be used. Without argument, show the actual JTAG
|
|
command version.
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
@deffn {Command} {jlink config}
|
|
Display the device configuration.
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
@deffn {Command} {jlink config targetpower} [@option{on}|@option{off}]
|
|
Set the target power state on JTAG-pin 19. Without argument, show the target
|
|
power state.
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
@deffn {Command} {jlink config mac} [@option{ff:ff:ff:ff:ff:ff}]
|
|
Set the MAC address of the device. Without argument, show the MAC address.
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
@deffn {Command} {jlink config ip} [@option{A.B.C.D}(@option{/E}|@option{F.G.H.I})]
|
|
Set the IP configuration of the device, where A.B.C.D is the IP address, E the
|
|
bit of the subnet mask and F.G.H.I the subnet mask. Without arguments, show the
|
|
IP configuration.
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
@deffn {Command} {jlink config usb} [@option{0} to @option{3}]
|
|
Set the USB address of the device. This will also change the USB Product ID
|
|
(PID) of the device. Without argument, show the USB address.
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
@deffn {Command} {jlink config reset}
|
|
Reset the current configuration.
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
@deffn {Command} {jlink config write}
|
|
Write the current configuration to the internal persistent storage.
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
@deffn {Command} {jlink emucom write} <channel> <data>
|
|
Write data to an EMUCOM channel. The data needs to be encoded as hexadecimal
|
|
pairs.
|
|
|
|
The following example shows how to write the three bytes 0xaa, 0x0b and 0x23 to
|
|
the EMUCOM channel 0x10:
|
|
@example
|
|
> jlink emucom write 0x10 aa0b23
|
|
@end example
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
@deffn {Command} {jlink emucom read} <channel> <length>
|
|
Read data from an EMUCOM channel. The read data is encoded as hexadecimal
|
|
pairs.
|
|
|
|
The following example shows how to read 4 bytes from the EMUCOM channel 0x0:
|
|
@example
|
|
> jlink emucom read 0x0 4
|
|
77a90000
|
|
@end example
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
@deffn {Config Command} {jlink usb} <@option{0} to @option{3}>
|
|
Set the USB address of the interface, in case more than one adapter is connected
|
|
to the host. If not specified, USB addresses are not considered. Device
|
|
selection via USB address is not always unambiguous. It is recommended to use
|
|
the serial number instead, if possible.
|
|
|
|
As a configuration command, it can be used only before 'init'.
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
|
|
@deffn {Interface Driver} {kitprog}
|
|
This driver is for Cypress Semiconductor's KitProg adapters. The KitProg is an
|
|
SWD-only adapter that is designed to be used with Cypress's PSoC and PRoC device
|
|
families, but it is possible to use it with some other devices. If you are using
|
|
this adapter with a PSoC or a PRoC, you may need to add
|
|
@command{kitprog_init_acquire_psoc} or @command{kitprog acquire_psoc} to your
|
|
configuration script.
|
|
|
|
Note that this driver is for the proprietary KitProg protocol, not the CMSIS-DAP
|
|
mode introduced in firmware 2.14. If the KitProg is in CMSIS-DAP mode, it cannot
|
|
be used with this driver, and must either be used with the cmsis-dap driver or
|
|
switched back to KitProg mode. See the Cypress KitProg User Guide for
|
|
instructions on how to switch KitProg modes.
|
|
|
|
Known limitations:
|
|
@itemize @bullet
|
|
@item The frequency of SWCLK cannot be configured, and varies between 1.6 MHz
|
|
and 2.7 MHz.
|
|
@item For firmware versions below 2.14, "JTAG to SWD" sequences are replaced by
|
|
"SWD line reset" in the driver. This is for two reasons. First, the KitProg does
|
|
not support sending arbitrary SWD sequences, and only firmware 2.14 and later
|
|
implement both "JTAG to SWD" and "SWD line reset" in firmware. Earlier firmware
|
|
versions only implement "SWD line reset". Second, due to a firmware quirk, an
|
|
SWD sequence must be sent after every target reset in order to re-establish
|
|
communications with the target.
|
|
@item Due in part to the limitation above, KitProg devices with firmware below
|
|
version 2.14 will need to use @command{kitprog_init_acquire_psoc} in order to
|
|
communicate with PSoC 5LP devices. This is because, assuming debug is not
|
|
disabled on the PSoC, the PSoC 5LP needs its JTAG interface switched to SWD
|
|
mode before communication can begin, but prior to firmware 2.14, "JTAG to SWD"
|
|
could only be sent with an acquisition sequence.
|
|
@end itemize
|
|
|
|
@deffn {Config Command} {kitprog_init_acquire_psoc}
|
|
Indicate that a PSoC acquisition sequence needs to be run during adapter init.
|
|
Please be aware that the acquisition sequence hard-resets the target.
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
|
|
@deffn {Command} {kitprog acquire_psoc}
|
|
Run a PSoC acquisition sequence immediately. Typically, this should not be used
|
|
outside of the target-specific configuration scripts since it hard-resets the
|
|
target as a side-effect.
|
|
This is necessary for "reset halt" on some PSoC 4 series devices.
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
|
|
@deffn {Command} {kitprog info}
|
|
Display various adapter information, such as the hardware version, firmware
|
|
version, and target voltage.
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
|
|
@deffn {Interface Driver} {parport}
|
|
Supports PC parallel port bit-banging cables:
|
|
Wigglers, PLD download cable, and more.
|
|
These interfaces have several commands, used to configure the driver
|
|
before initializing the JTAG scan chain:
|
|
|
|
@deffn {Config Command} {parport cable} name
|
|
Set the layout of the parallel port cable used to connect to the target.
|
|
This is a write-once setting.
|
|
Currently valid cable @var{name} values include:
|
|
|
|
@itemize @minus
|
|
@item @b{altium} Altium Universal JTAG cable.
|
|
@item @b{arm-jtag} Same as original wiggler except SRST and
|
|
TRST connections reversed and TRST is also inverted.
|
|
@item @b{chameleon} The Amontec Chameleon's CPLD when operated
|
|
in configuration mode. This is only used to
|
|
program the Chameleon itself, not a connected target.
|
|
@item @b{dlc5} The Xilinx Parallel cable III.
|
|
@item @b{flashlink} The ST Parallel cable.
|
|
@item @b{lattice} Lattice ispDOWNLOAD Cable
|
|
@item @b{old_amt_wiggler} The Wiggler configuration that comes with
|
|
some versions of
|
|
Amontec's Chameleon Programmer. The new version available from
|
|
the website uses the original Wiggler layout ('@var{wiggler}')
|
|
@item @b{triton} The parallel port adapter found on the
|
|
``Karo Triton 1 Development Board''.
|
|
This is also the layout used by the HollyGates design
|
|
(see @uref{http://www.lartmaker.nl/projects/jtag/}).
|
|
@item @b{wiggler} The original Wiggler layout, also supported by
|
|
several clones, such as the Olimex ARM-JTAG
|
|
@item @b{wiggler2} Same as original wiggler except an led is fitted on D5.
|
|
@item @b{wiggler_ntrst_inverted} Same as original wiggler except TRST is inverted.
|
|
@end itemize
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
|
|
@deffn {Config Command} {parport port} [port_number]
|
|
Display either the address of the I/O port
|
|
(default: 0x378 for LPT1) or the number of the @file{/dev/parport} device.
|
|
If a parameter is provided, first switch to use that port.
|
|
This is a write-once setting.
|
|
|
|
When using PPDEV to access the parallel port, use the number of the parallel port:
|
|
@option{parport port 0} (the default). If @option{parport port 0x378} is specified
|
|
you may encounter a problem.
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
|
|
@deffn {Config Command} {parport toggling_time} [nanoseconds]
|
|
Displays how many nanoseconds the hardware needs to toggle TCK;
|
|
the parport driver uses this value to obey the
|
|
@command{adapter speed} configuration.
|
|
When the optional @var{nanoseconds} parameter is given,
|
|
that setting is changed before displaying the current value.
|
|
|
|
The default setting should work reasonably well on commodity PC hardware.
|
|
However, you may want to calibrate for your specific hardware.
|
|
@quotation Tip
|
|
To measure the toggling time with a logic analyzer or a digital storage
|
|
oscilloscope, follow the procedure below:
|
|
@example
|
|
> parport toggling_time 1000
|
|
> adapter speed 500
|
|
@end example
|
|
This sets the maximum JTAG clock speed of the hardware, but
|
|
the actual speed probably deviates from the requested 500 kHz.
|
|
Now, measure the time between the two closest spaced TCK transitions.
|
|
You can use @command{runtest 1000} or something similar to generate a
|
|
large set of samples.
|
|
Update the setting to match your measurement:
|
|
@example
|
|
> parport toggling_time <measured nanoseconds>
|
|
@end example
|
|
Now the clock speed will be a better match for @command{adapter speed}
|
|
command given in OpenOCD scripts and event handlers.
|
|
|
|
You can do something similar with many digital multimeters, but note
|
|
that you'll probably need to run the clock continuously for several
|
|
seconds before it decides what clock rate to show. Adjust the
|
|
toggling time up or down until the measured clock rate is a good
|
|
match with the rate you specified in the @command{adapter speed} command;
|
|
be conservative.
|
|
@end quotation
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
|
|
@deffn {Config Command} {parport write_on_exit} (@option{on}|@option{off})
|
|
This will configure the parallel driver to write a known
|
|
cable-specific value to the parallel interface on exiting OpenOCD.
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
|
|
For example, the interface configuration file for a
|
|
classic ``Wiggler'' cable on LPT2 might look something like this:
|
|
|
|
@example
|
|
adapter driver parport
|
|
parport port 0x278
|
|
parport cable wiggler
|
|
@end example
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
|
|
@deffn {Interface Driver} {presto}
|
|
ASIX PRESTO USB JTAG programmer.
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
|
|
@deffn {Interface Driver} {rlink}
|
|
Raisonance RLink USB adapter
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
|
|
@deffn {Interface Driver} {usbprog}
|
|
usbprog is a freely programmable USB adapter.
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
|
|
@deffn {Interface Driver} {vsllink}
|
|
vsllink is part of Versaloon which is a versatile USB programmer.
|
|
|
|
@quotation Note
|
|
This defines quite a few driver-specific commands,
|
|
which are not currently documented here.
|
|
@end quotation
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
|
|
@anchor{hla_interface}
|
|
@deffn {Interface Driver} {hla}
|
|
This is a driver that supports multiple High Level Adapters.
|
|
This type of adapter does not expose some of the lower level api's
|
|
that OpenOCD would normally use to access the target.
|
|
|
|
Currently supported adapters include the STMicroelectronics ST-LINK, TI ICDI
|
|
and Nuvoton Nu-Link.
|
|
ST-LINK firmware version >= V2.J21.S4 recommended due to issues with earlier
|
|
versions of firmware where serial number is reset after first use. Suggest
|
|
using ST firmware update utility to upgrade ST-LINK firmware even if current
|
|
version reported is V2.J21.S4.
|
|
|
|
@deffn {Config Command} {hla_device_desc} description
|
|
Currently Not Supported.
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
|
|
@deffn {Config Command} {hla_layout} (@option{stlink}|@option{icdi}|@option{nulink})
|
|
Specifies the adapter layout to use.
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
|
|
@deffn {Config Command} {hla_vid_pid} [vid pid]+
|
|
Pairs of vendor IDs and product IDs of the device.
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
|
|
@deffn {Config Command} {hla_stlink_backend} (usb | tcp [port])
|
|
@emph{ST-Link only:} Choose between 'exclusive' USB communication (the default backend) or
|
|
'shared' mode using ST-Link TCP server (the default port is 7184).
|
|
|
|
@emph{Note:} ST-Link TCP server is a binary application provided by ST
|
|
available from @url{https://www.st.com/en/development-tools/st-link-server.html,
|
|
ST-LINK server software module}.
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
|
|
@deffn {Command} {hla_command} command
|
|
Execute a custom adapter-specific command. The @var{command} string is
|
|
passed as is to the underlying adapter layout handler.
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
|
|
@anchor{st_link_dap_interface}
|
|
@deffn {Interface Driver} {st-link}
|
|
This is a driver that supports STMicroelectronics adapters ST-LINK/V2
|
|
(from firmware V2J24) and STLINK-V3, thanks to a new API that provides
|
|
directly access the arm ADIv5 DAP.
|
|
|
|
The new API provide access to multiple AP on the same DAP, but the
|
|
maximum number of the AP port is limited by the specific firmware version
|
|
(e.g. firmware V2J29 has 3 as maximum AP number, while V2J32 has 8).
|
|
An error is returned for any AP number above the maximum allowed value.
|
|
|
|
@emph{Note:} Either these same adapters and their older versions are
|
|
also supported by @ref{hla_interface, the hla interface driver}.
|
|
|
|
@deffn {Config Command} {st-link backend} (usb | tcp [port])
|
|
Choose between 'exclusive' USB communication (the default backend) or
|
|
'shared' mode using ST-Link TCP server (the default port is 7184).
|
|
|
|
@emph{Note:} ST-Link TCP server is a binary application provided by ST
|
|
available from @url{https://www.st.com/en/development-tools/st-link-server.html,
|
|
ST-LINK server software module}.
|
|
|
|
@emph{Note:} ST-Link TCP server does not support the SWIM transport.
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
|
|
@deffn {Config Command} {st-link vid_pid} [vid pid]+
|
|
Pairs of vendor IDs and product IDs of the device.
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
|
|
@deffn {Command} {st-link cmd} rx_n (tx_byte)+
|
|
Sends an arbitrary command composed by the sequence of bytes @var{tx_byte}
|
|
and receives @var{rx_n} bytes.
|
|
|
|
For example, the command to read the target's supply voltage is one byte 0xf7 followed
|
|
by 15 bytes zero. It returns 8 bytes, where the first 4 bytes represent the ADC sampling
|
|
of the reference voltage 1.2V and the last 4 bytes represent the ADC sampling of half
|
|
the target's supply voltage.
|
|
@example
|
|
> st-link cmd 8 0xf7 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0
|
|
0xf1 0x05 0x00 0x00 0x0b 0x08 0x00 0x00
|
|
@end example
|
|
The result can be converted to Volts (ignoring the most significant bytes, always zero)
|
|
@example
|
|
> set a [st-link cmd 8 0xf7 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0]
|
|
> set n [expr @{[lindex $a 4] + 256 * [lindex $a 5]@}]
|
|
> set d [expr @{[lindex $a 0] + 256 * [lindex $a 1]@}]
|
|
> echo [expr @{2 * 1.2 * $n / $d@}]
|
|
3.24891518738
|
|
@end example
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
|
|
@deffn {Interface Driver} {opendous}
|
|
opendous-jtag is a freely programmable USB adapter.
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
|
|
@deffn {Interface Driver} {ulink}
|
|
This is the Keil ULINK v1 JTAG debugger.
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
|
|
@deffn {Interface Driver} {xds110}
|
|
The XDS110 is included as the embedded debug probe on many Texas Instruments
|
|
LaunchPad evaluation boards. The XDS110 is also available as a stand-alone USB
|
|
debug probe with the added capability to supply power to the target board. The
|
|
following commands are supported by the XDS110 driver:
|
|
|
|
@deffn {Config Command} {xds110 supply} voltage_in_millivolts
|
|
Available only on the XDS110 stand-alone probe. Sets the voltage level of the
|
|
XDS110 power supply. A value of 0 leaves the supply off. Otherwise, the supply
|
|
can be set to any value in the range 1800 to 3600 millivolts.
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
|
|
@deffn {Command} {xds110 info}
|
|
Displays information about the connected XDS110 debug probe (e.g. firmware
|
|
version).
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
|
|
@deffn {Interface Driver} {xlnx_pcie_xvc}
|
|
This driver supports the Xilinx Virtual Cable (XVC) over PCI Express.
|
|
It is commonly found in Xilinx based PCI Express designs. It allows debugging
|
|
fabric based JTAG/SWD devices such as Cortex-M1/M3 microcontrollers. Access to this is
|
|
exposed via extended capability registers in the PCI Express configuration space.
|
|
|
|
For more information see Xilinx PG245 (Section on From_PCIE_to_JTAG mode).
|
|
|
|
@deffn {Config Command} {xlnx_pcie_xvc config} device
|
|
Specifies the PCI Express device via parameter @var{device} to use.
|
|
|
|
The correct value for @var{device} can be obtained by looking at the output
|
|
of lscpi -D (first column) for the corresponding device.
|
|
|
|
The string will be of the format "DDDD:BB:SS.F" such as "0000:65:00.1".
|
|
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
|
|
@deffn {Interface Driver} {bcm2835gpio}
|
|
This SoC is present in Raspberry Pi which is a cheap single-board computer
|
|
exposing some GPIOs on its expansion header.
|
|
|
|
The driver accesses memory-mapped GPIO peripheral registers directly
|
|
for maximum performance, but the only possible race condition is for
|
|
the pins' modes/muxing (which is highly unlikely), so it should be
|
|
able to coexist nicely with both sysfs bitbanging and various
|
|
peripherals' kernel drivers. The driver restores the previous
|
|
configuration on exit.
|
|
|
|
GPIO numbers >= 32 can't be used for performance reasons. GPIO configuration is
|
|
handled by the generic command @ref{adapter gpio, @command{adapter gpio}}.
|
|
|
|
See @file{interface/raspberrypi-native.cfg} for a sample config and
|
|
pinout.
|
|
|
|
@deffn {Config Command} {bcm2835gpio speed_coeffs} @var{speed_coeff} @var{speed_offset}
|
|
Set SPEED_COEFF and SPEED_OFFSET for delay calculations. If unspecified,
|
|
speed_coeff defaults to 113714, and speed_offset defaults to 28.
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
|
|
@deffn {Config Command} {bcm2835gpio peripheral_base} @var{base}
|
|
Set the peripheral base register address to access GPIOs. For the RPi1, use
|
|
0x20000000. For RPi2 and RPi3, use 0x3F000000. For RPi4, use 0xFE000000. A full
|
|
list can be found in the
|
|
@uref{https://www.raspberrypi.org/documentation/hardware/raspberrypi/peripheral_addresses.md, official guide}.
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
|
|
@deffn {Interface Driver} {imx_gpio}
|
|
i.MX SoC is present in many community boards. Wandboard is an example
|
|
of the one which is most popular.
|
|
|
|
This driver is mostly the same as bcm2835gpio.
|
|
|
|
See @file{interface/imx-native.cfg} for a sample config and
|
|
pinout.
|
|
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
|
|
|
|
@deffn {Interface Driver} {am335xgpio} The AM335x SoC is present in BeagleBone
|
|
Black and BeagleBone Green single-board computers which expose some of the GPIOs
|
|
on the two expansion headers.
|
|
|
|
For maximum performance the driver accesses memory-mapped GPIO peripheral
|
|
registers directly. The memory mapping requires read and write permission to
|
|
kernel memory; if /dev/gpiomem exists it will be used, otherwise /dev/mem will
|
|
be used. The driver restores the GPIO state on exit.
|
|
|
|
All four GPIO ports are available. GPIO configuration is handled by the generic
|
|
command @ref{adapter gpio, @command{adapter gpio}}.
|
|
|
|
@deffn {Config Command} {am335xgpio speed_coeffs} @var{speed_coeff} @var{speed_offset}
|
|
Set SPEED_COEFF and SPEED_OFFSET for delay calculations. If unspecified
|
|
speed_coeff defaults to 600000 and speed_offset defaults to 575.
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
|
|
See @file{interface/beaglebone-swd-native.cfg} for a sample configuration file.
|
|
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
|
|
|
|
@deffn {Interface Driver} {linuxgpiod}
|
|
Linux provides userspace access to GPIO through libgpiod since Linux kernel
|
|
version v4.6. The driver emulates either JTAG or SWD transport through
|
|
bitbanging. There are no driver-specific commands, all GPIO configuration is
|
|
handled by the generic command @ref{adapter gpio, @command{adapter gpio}}. This
|
|
driver supports the resistor pull options provided by the @command{adapter gpio}
|
|
command but the underlying hardware may not be able to support them.
|
|
|
|
See @file{interface/dln-2-gpiod.cfg} for a sample configuration file.
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
|
|
|
|
@deffn {Interface Driver} {sysfsgpio}
|
|
Linux legacy userspace access to GPIO through sysfs is deprecated from Linux kernel version v5.3.
|
|
Prefer using @b{linuxgpiod}, instead.
|
|
|
|
See @file{interface/sysfsgpio-raspberrypi.cfg} for a sample config.
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
|
|
|
|
@deffn {Interface Driver} {openjtag}
|
|
OpenJTAG compatible USB adapter.
|
|
This defines some driver-specific commands:
|
|
|
|
@deffn {Config Command} {openjtag variant} variant
|
|
Specifies the variant of the OpenJTAG adapter (see @uref{http://www.openjtag.org/}).
|
|
Currently valid @var{variant} values include:
|
|
|
|
@itemize @minus
|
|
@item @b{standard} Standard variant (default).
|
|
@item @b{cy7c65215} Cypress CY7C65215 Dual Channel USB-Serial Bridge Controller
|
|
(see @uref{http://www.cypress.com/?rID=82870}).
|
|
@end itemize
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
|
|
@deffn {Config Command} {openjtag device_desc} string
|
|
The USB device description string of the adapter.
|
|
This value is only used with the standard variant.
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
|
|
|
|
@deffn {Interface Driver} {vdebug}
|
|
Cadence Virtual Debug Interface driver.
|
|
|
|
@deffn {Config Command} {vdebug server} host:port
|
|
Specifies the host and TCP port number where the vdebug server runs.
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
|
|
@deffn {Config Command} {vdebug batching} value
|
|
Specifies the batching method for the vdebug request. Possible values are
|
|
0 for no batching
|
|
1 or wr to batch write transactions together (default)
|
|
2 or rw to batch both read and write transactions
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
|
|
@deffn {Config Command} {vdebug polling} min max
|
|
Takes two values, representing the polling interval in ms. Lower values mean faster
|
|
debugger responsiveness, but lower emulation performance. The minimum should be
|
|
around 10, maximum should not exceed 1000, which is the default gdb and keepalive
|
|
timeout value.
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
|
|
@deffn {Config Command} {vdebug bfm_path} path clk_period
|
|
Specifies the hierarchical path and input clk period of the vdebug BFM in the design.
|
|
The hierarchical path uses Verilog notation top.inst.inst
|
|
The clock period must include the unit, for instance 40ns.
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
|
|
@deffn {Config Command} {vdebug mem_path} path base size
|
|
Specifies the hierarchical path to the design memory instance for backdoor access.
|
|
Up to 4 memories can be specified. The hierarchical path uses Verilog notation.
|
|
The base specifies start address in the design address space, size its size in bytes.
|
|
Both values can use hexadecimal notation with prefix 0x.
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
|
|
@deffn {Interface Driver} {jtag_dpi}
|
|
SystemVerilog Direct Programming Interface (DPI) compatible driver for
|
|
JTAG devices in emulation. The driver acts as a client for the SystemVerilog
|
|
DPI server interface.
|
|
|
|
@deffn {Config Command} {jtag_dpi set_port} port
|
|
Specifies the TCP/IP port number of the SystemVerilog DPI server interface.
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
|
|
@deffn {Config Command} {jtag_dpi set_address} address
|
|
Specifies the TCP/IP address of the SystemVerilog DPI server interface.
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
|
|
|
|
@deffn {Interface Driver} {buspirate}
|
|
|
|
This driver is for the Bus Pirate (see @url{http://dangerousprototypes.com/docs/Bus_Pirate}) and compatible devices.
|
|
It uses a simple data protocol over a serial port connection.
|
|
|
|
Most hardware development boards have a UART, a real serial port, or a virtual USB serial device, so this driver
|
|
allows you to start building your own JTAG adapter without the complexity of a custom USB connection.
|
|
|
|
@deffn {Config Command} {buspirate port} serial_port
|
|
Specify the serial port's filename. For example:
|
|
@example
|
|
buspirate port /dev/ttyUSB0
|
|
@end example
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
|
|
@deffn {Config Command} {buspirate speed} (normal|fast)
|
|
Set the communication speed to 115k (normal) or 1M (fast). For example:
|
|
@example
|
|
buspirate speed normal
|
|
@end example
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
|
|
@deffn {Config Command} {buspirate mode} (normal|open-drain)
|
|
Set the Bus Pirate output mode.
|
|
@itemize @minus
|
|
@item In normal mode (push/pull), do not enable the pull-ups, and do not connect I/O header pin VPU to JTAG VREF.
|
|
@item In open drain mode, you will then need to enable the pull-ups.
|
|
@end itemize
|
|
For example:
|
|
@example
|
|
buspirate mode normal
|
|
@end example
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
|
|
@deffn {Config Command} {buspirate pullup} (0|1)
|
|
Whether to connect (1) or not (0) the I/O header pin VPU (JTAG VREF)
|
|
to the pull-up/pull-down resistors on MOSI (JTAG TDI), CLK (JTAG TCK), MISO (JTAG TDO) and CS (JTAG TMS).
|
|
For example:
|
|
@example
|
|
buspirate pullup 0
|
|
@end example
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
|
|
@deffn {Config Command} {buspirate vreg} (0|1)
|
|
Whether to enable (1) or disable (0) the built-in voltage regulator,
|
|
which can be used to supply power to a test circuit through
|
|
I/O header pins +3V3 and +5V. For example:
|
|
@example
|
|
buspirate vreg 0
|
|
@end example
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
|
|
@deffn {Command} {buspirate led} (0|1)
|
|
Turns the Bus Pirate's LED on (1) or off (0). For example:
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
@example
|
|
buspirate led 1
|
|
@end example
|
|
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
|
|
@deffn {Interface Driver} {esp_usb_jtag}
|
|
Espressif JTAG driver to communicate with ESP32-C3, ESP32-S3 chips and ESP USB Bridge board using OpenOCD.
|
|
These chips have built-in JTAG circuitry and can be debugged without any additional hardware.
|
|
Only an USB cable connected to the D+/D- pins is necessary.
|
|
|
|
@deffn {Command} {espusbjtag tdo}
|
|
Returns the current state of the TDO line
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
|
|
@deffn {Command} {espusbjtag setio} setio
|
|
Manually set the status of the output lines with the order of (tdi tms tck trst srst)
|
|
@example
|
|
espusbjtag setio 0 1 0 1 0
|
|
@end example
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
|
|
@deffn {Config Command} {espusbjtag vid_pid} vid_pid
|
|
Set vendor ID and product ID for the ESP usb jtag driver
|
|
@example
|
|
espusbjtag vid_pid 0x303a 0x1001
|
|
@end example
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
|
|
@deffn {Config Command} {espusbjtag caps_descriptor} caps_descriptor
|
|
Set the jtag descriptor to read capabilities of ESP usb jtag driver
|
|
@example
|
|
espusbjtag caps_descriptor 0x2000
|
|
@end example
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
|
|
@deffn {Config Command} {espusbjtag chip_id} chip_id
|
|
Set chip id to transfer to the ESP USB bridge board
|
|
@example
|
|
espusbjtag chip_id 1
|
|
@end example
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
|
|
@section Transport Configuration
|
|
@cindex Transport
|
|
As noted earlier, depending on the version of OpenOCD you use,
|
|
and the debug adapter you are using,
|
|
several transports may be available to
|
|
communicate with debug targets (or perhaps to program flash memory).
|
|
@deffn {Command} {transport list}
|
|
displays the names of the transports supported by this
|
|
version of OpenOCD.
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
|
|
@deffn {Command} {transport select} @option{transport_name}
|
|
Select which of the supported transports to use in this OpenOCD session.
|
|
|
|
When invoked with @option{transport_name}, attempts to select the named
|
|
transport. The transport must be supported by the debug adapter
|
|
hardware and by the version of OpenOCD you are using (including the
|
|
adapter's driver).
|
|
|
|
If no transport has been selected and no @option{transport_name} is
|
|
provided, @command{transport select} auto-selects the first transport
|
|
supported by the debug adapter.
|
|
|
|
@command{transport select} always returns the name of the session's selected
|
|
transport, if any.
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
|
|
@subsection JTAG Transport
|
|
@cindex JTAG
|
|
JTAG is the original transport supported by OpenOCD, and most
|
|
of the OpenOCD commands support it.
|
|
JTAG transports expose a chain of one or more Test Access Points (TAPs),
|
|
each of which must be explicitly declared.
|
|
JTAG supports both debugging and boundary scan testing.
|
|
Flash programming support is built on top of debug support.
|
|
|
|
JTAG transport is selected with the command @command{transport select
|
|
jtag}. Unless your adapter uses either @ref{hla_interface,the hla interface
|
|
driver} (in which case the command is @command{transport select hla_jtag})
|
|
or @ref{st_link_dap_interface,the st-link interface driver} (in which case
|
|
the command is @command{transport select dapdirect_jtag}).
|
|
|
|
@subsection SWD Transport
|
|
@cindex SWD
|
|
@cindex Serial Wire Debug
|
|
SWD (Serial Wire Debug) is an ARM-specific transport which exposes one
|
|
Debug Access Point (DAP, which must be explicitly declared.
|
|
(SWD uses fewer signal wires than JTAG.)
|
|
SWD is debug-oriented, and does not support boundary scan testing.
|
|
Flash programming support is built on top of debug support.
|
|
(Some processors support both JTAG and SWD.)
|
|
|
|
SWD transport is selected with the command @command{transport select
|
|
swd}. Unless your adapter uses either @ref{hla_interface,the hla interface
|
|
driver} (in which case the command is @command{transport select hla_swd})
|
|
or @ref{st_link_dap_interface,the st-link interface driver} (in which case
|
|
the command is @command{transport select dapdirect_swd}).
|
|
|
|
@deffn {Config Command} {swd newdap} ...
|
|
Declares a single DAP which uses SWD transport.
|
|
Parameters are currently the same as "jtag newtap" but this is
|
|
expected to change.
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
|
|
@cindex SWD multi-drop
|
|
The newer SWD devices (SW-DP v2 or SWJ-DP v2) support the multi-drop extension
|
|
of SWD protocol: two or more devices can be connected to one SWD adapter.
|
|
SWD transport works in multi-drop mode if @ref{dap_create,DAP} is configured
|
|
with both @code{-dp-id} and @code{-instance-id} parameters regardless how many
|
|
DAPs are created.
|
|
|
|
Not all adapters and adapter drivers support SWD multi-drop. Only the following
|
|
adapter drivers are SWD multi-drop capable:
|
|
cmsis_dap (use an adapter with CMSIS-DAP version 2.0), ftdi, all bitbang based.
|
|
|
|
@subsection SPI Transport
|
|
@cindex SPI
|
|
@cindex Serial Peripheral Interface
|
|
The Serial Peripheral Interface (SPI) is a general purpose transport
|
|
which uses four wire signaling. Some processors use it as part of a
|
|
solution for flash programming.
|
|
|
|
@anchor{swimtransport}
|
|
@subsection SWIM Transport
|
|
@cindex SWIM
|
|
@cindex Single Wire Interface Module
|
|
The Single Wire Interface Module (SWIM) is a low-pin-count debug protocol used
|
|
by the STMicroelectronics MCU family STM8 and documented in the
|
|
@uref{https://www.st.com/resource/en/user_manual/cd00173911.pdf, User Manual UM470}.
|
|
|
|
SWIM does not support boundary scan testing nor multiple cores.
|
|
|
|
The SWIM transport is selected with the command @command{transport select swim}.
|
|
|
|
The concept of TAPs does not fit in the protocol since SWIM does not implement
|
|
a scan chain. Nevertheless, the current SW model of OpenOCD requires defining a
|
|
virtual SWIM TAP through the command @command{swim newtap basename tap_type}.
|
|
The TAP definition must precede the target definition command
|
|
@command{target create target_name stm8 -chain-position basename.tap_type}.
|
|
|
|
@anchor{jtagspeed}
|
|
@section JTAG Speed
|
|
JTAG clock setup is part of system setup.
|
|
It @emph{does not belong with interface setup} since any interface
|
|
only knows a few of the constraints for the JTAG clock speed.
|
|
Sometimes the JTAG speed is
|
|
changed during the target initialization process: (1) slow at
|
|
reset, (2) program the CPU clocks, (3) run fast.
|
|
Both the "slow" and "fast" clock rates are functions of the
|
|
oscillators used, the chip, the board design, and sometimes
|
|
power management software that may be active.
|
|
|
|
The speed used during reset, and the scan chain verification which
|
|
follows reset, can be adjusted using a @code{reset-start}
|
|
target event handler.
|
|
It can then be reconfigured to a faster speed by a
|
|
@code{reset-init} target event handler after it reprograms those
|
|
CPU clocks, or manually (if something else, such as a boot loader,
|
|
sets up those clocks).
|
|
@xref{targetevents,,Target Events}.
|
|
When the initial low JTAG speed is a chip characteristic, perhaps
|
|
because of a required oscillator speed, provide such a handler
|
|
in the target config file.
|
|
When that speed is a function of a board-specific characteristic
|
|
such as which speed oscillator is used, it belongs in the board
|
|
config file instead.
|
|
In both cases it's safest to also set the initial JTAG clock rate
|
|
to that same slow speed, so that OpenOCD never starts up using a
|
|
clock speed that's faster than the scan chain can support.
|
|
|
|
@example
|
|
jtag_rclk 3000
|
|
$_TARGET.cpu configure -event reset-start @{ jtag_rclk 3000 @}
|
|
@end example
|
|
|
|
If your system supports adaptive clocking (RTCK), configuring
|
|
JTAG to use that is probably the most robust approach.
|
|
However, it introduces delays to synchronize clocks; so it
|
|
may not be the fastest solution.
|
|
|
|
@b{NOTE:} Script writers should consider using @command{jtag_rclk}
|
|
instead of @command{adapter speed}, but only for (ARM) cores and boards
|
|
which support adaptive clocking.
|
|
|
|
@deffn {Command} {adapter speed} max_speed_kHz
|
|
A non-zero speed is in KHZ. Hence: 3000 is 3mhz.
|
|
JTAG interfaces usually support a limited number of
|
|
speeds. The speed actually used won't be faster
|
|
than the speed specified.
|
|
|
|
Chip data sheets generally include a top JTAG clock rate.
|
|
The actual rate is often a function of a CPU core clock,
|
|
and is normally less than that peak rate.
|
|
For example, most ARM cores accept at most one sixth of the CPU clock.
|
|
|
|
Speed 0 (khz) selects RTCK method.
|
|
@xref{faqrtck,,FAQ RTCK}.
|
|
If your system uses RTCK, you won't need to change the
|
|
JTAG clocking after setup.
|
|
Not all interfaces, boards, or targets support ``rtck''.
|
|
If the interface device can not
|
|
support it, an error is returned when you try to use RTCK.
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
|
|
@defun jtag_rclk fallback_speed_kHz
|
|
@cindex adaptive clocking
|
|
@cindex RTCK
|
|
This Tcl proc (defined in @file{startup.tcl}) attempts to enable RTCK/RCLK.
|
|
If that fails (maybe the interface, board, or target doesn't
|
|
support it), falls back to the specified frequency.
|
|
@example
|
|
# Fall back to 3mhz if RTCK is not supported
|
|
jtag_rclk 3000
|
|
@end example
|
|
@end defun
|
|
|
|
@node Reset Configuration
|
|
@chapter Reset Configuration
|
|
@cindex Reset Configuration
|
|
|
|
Every system configuration may require a different reset
|
|
configuration. This can also be quite confusing.
|
|
Resets also interact with @var{reset-init} event handlers,
|
|
which do things like setting up clocks and DRAM, and
|
|
JTAG clock rates. (@xref{jtagspeed,,JTAG Speed}.)
|
|
They can also interact with JTAG routers.
|
|
Please see the various board files for examples.
|
|
|
|
@quotation Note
|
|
To maintainers and integrators:
|
|
Reset configuration touches several things at once.
|
|
Normally the board configuration file
|
|
should define it and assume that the JTAG adapter supports
|
|
everything that's wired up to the board's JTAG connector.
|
|
|
|
However, the target configuration file could also make note
|
|
of something the silicon vendor has done inside the chip,
|
|
which will be true for most (or all) boards using that chip.
|
|
And when the JTAG adapter doesn't support everything, the
|
|
user configuration file will need to override parts of
|
|
the reset configuration provided by other files.
|
|
@end quotation
|
|
|
|
@section Types of Reset
|
|
|
|
There are many kinds of reset possible through JTAG, but
|
|
they may not all work with a given board and adapter.
|
|
That's part of why reset configuration can be error prone.
|
|
|
|
@itemize @bullet
|
|
@item
|
|
@emph{System Reset} ... the @emph{SRST} hardware signal
|
|
resets all chips connected to the JTAG adapter, such as processors,
|
|
power management chips, and I/O controllers. Normally resets triggered
|
|
with this signal behave exactly like pressing a RESET button.
|
|
@item
|
|
@emph{JTAG TAP Reset} ... the @emph{TRST} hardware signal resets
|
|
just the TAP controllers connected to the JTAG adapter.
|
|
Such resets should not be visible to the rest of the system; resetting a
|
|
device's TAP controller just puts that controller into a known state.
|
|
@item
|
|
@emph{Emulation Reset} ... many devices can be reset through JTAG
|
|
commands. These resets are often distinguishable from system
|
|
resets, either explicitly (a "reset reason" register says so)
|
|
or implicitly (not all parts of the chip get reset).
|
|
@item
|
|
@emph{Other Resets} ... system-on-chip devices often support
|
|
several other types of reset.
|
|
You may need to arrange that a watchdog timer stops
|
|
while debugging, preventing a watchdog reset.
|
|
There may be individual module resets.
|
|
@end itemize
|
|
|
|
In the best case, OpenOCD can hold SRST, then reset
|
|
the TAPs via TRST and send commands through JTAG to halt the
|
|
CPU at the reset vector before the 1st instruction is executed.
|
|
Then when it finally releases the SRST signal, the system is
|
|
halted under debugger control before any code has executed.
|
|
This is the behavior required to support the @command{reset halt}
|
|
and @command{reset init} commands; after @command{reset init} a
|
|
board-specific script might do things like setting up DRAM.
|
|
(@xref{resetcommand,,Reset Command}.)
|
|
|
|
@anchor{srstandtrstissues}
|
|
@section SRST and TRST Issues
|
|
|
|
Because SRST and TRST are hardware signals, they can have a
|
|
variety of system-specific constraints. Some of the most
|
|
common issues are:
|
|
|
|
@itemize @bullet
|
|
|
|
@item @emph{Signal not available} ... Some boards don't wire
|
|
SRST or TRST to the JTAG connector. Some JTAG adapters don't
|
|
support such signals even if they are wired up.
|
|
Use the @command{reset_config} @var{signals} options to say
|
|
when either of those signals is not connected.
|
|
When SRST is not available, your code might not be able to rely
|
|
on controllers having been fully reset during code startup.
|
|
Missing TRST is not a problem, since JTAG-level resets can
|
|
be triggered using with TMS signaling.
|
|
|
|
@item @emph{Signals shorted} ... Sometimes a chip, board, or
|
|
adapter will connect SRST to TRST, instead of keeping them separate.
|
|
Use the @command{reset_config} @var{combination} options to say
|
|
when those signals aren't properly independent.
|
|
|
|
@item @emph{Timing} ... Reset circuitry like a resistor/capacitor
|
|
delay circuit, reset supervisor, or on-chip features can extend
|
|
the effect of a JTAG adapter's reset for some time after the adapter
|
|
stops issuing the reset. For example, there may be chip or board
|
|
requirements that all reset pulses last for at least a
|
|
certain amount of time; and reset buttons commonly have
|
|
hardware debouncing.
|
|
Use the @command{adapter srst delay} and @command{jtag_ntrst_delay}
|
|
commands to say when extra delays are needed.
|
|
|
|
@item @emph{Drive type} ... Reset lines often have a pullup
|
|
resistor, letting the JTAG interface treat them as open-drain
|
|
signals. But that's not a requirement, so the adapter may need
|
|
to use push/pull output drivers.
|
|
Also, with weak pullups it may be advisable to drive
|
|
signals to both levels (push/pull) to minimize rise times.
|
|
Use the @command{reset_config} @var{trst_type} and
|
|
@var{srst_type} parameters to say how to drive reset signals.
|
|
|
|
@item @emph{Special initialization} ... Targets sometimes need
|
|
special JTAG initialization sequences to handle chip-specific
|
|
issues (not limited to errata).
|
|
For example, certain JTAG commands might need to be issued while
|
|
the system as a whole is in a reset state (SRST active)
|
|
but the JTAG scan chain is usable (TRST inactive).
|
|
Many systems treat combined assertion of SRST and TRST as a
|
|
trigger for a harder reset than SRST alone.
|
|
Such custom reset handling is discussed later in this chapter.
|
|
@end itemize
|
|
|
|
There can also be other issues.
|
|
Some devices don't fully conform to the JTAG specifications.
|
|
Trivial system-specific differences are common, such as
|
|
SRST and TRST using slightly different names.
|
|
There are also vendors who distribute key JTAG documentation for
|
|
their chips only to developers who have signed a Non-Disclosure
|
|
Agreement (NDA).
|
|
|
|
Sometimes there are chip-specific extensions like a requirement to use
|
|
the normally-optional TRST signal (precluding use of JTAG adapters which
|
|
don't pass TRST through), or needing extra steps to complete a TAP reset.
|
|
|
|
In short, SRST and especially TRST handling may be very finicky,
|
|
needing to cope with both architecture and board specific constraints.
|
|
|
|
@section Commands for Handling Resets
|
|
|
|
@deffn {Command} {adapter srst pulse_width} milliseconds
|
|
Minimum amount of time (in milliseconds) OpenOCD should wait
|
|
after asserting nSRST (active-low system reset) before
|
|
allowing it to be deasserted.
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
|
|
@deffn {Command} {adapter srst delay} milliseconds
|
|
How long (in milliseconds) OpenOCD should wait after deasserting
|
|
nSRST (active-low system reset) before starting new JTAG operations.
|
|
When a board has a reset button connected to SRST line it will
|
|
probably have hardware debouncing, implying you should use this.
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
|
|
@deffn {Command} {jtag_ntrst_assert_width} milliseconds
|
|
Minimum amount of time (in milliseconds) OpenOCD should wait
|
|
after asserting nTRST (active-low JTAG TAP reset) before
|
|
allowing it to be deasserted.
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
|
|
@deffn {Command} {jtag_ntrst_delay} milliseconds
|
|
How long (in milliseconds) OpenOCD should wait after deasserting
|
|
nTRST (active-low JTAG TAP reset) before starting new JTAG operations.
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
|
|
@anchor{reset_config}
|
|
@deffn {Command} {reset_config} mode_flag ...
|
|
This command displays or modifies the reset configuration
|
|
of your combination of JTAG board and target in target
|
|
configuration scripts.
|
|
|
|
Information earlier in this section describes the kind of problems
|
|
the command is intended to address (@pxref{srstandtrstissues,,SRST and TRST Issues}).
|
|
As a rule this command belongs only in board config files,
|
|
describing issues like @emph{board doesn't connect TRST};
|
|
or in user config files, addressing limitations derived
|
|
from a particular combination of interface and board.
|
|
(An unlikely example would be using a TRST-only adapter
|
|
with a board that only wires up SRST.)
|
|
|
|
The @var{mode_flag} options can be specified in any order, but only one
|
|
of each type -- @var{signals}, @var{combination}, @var{gates},
|
|
@var{trst_type}, @var{srst_type} and @var{connect_type}
|
|
-- may be specified at a time.
|
|
If you don't provide a new value for a given type, its previous
|
|
value (perhaps the default) is unchanged.
|
|
For example, this means that you don't need to say anything at all about
|
|
TRST just to declare that if the JTAG adapter should want to drive SRST,
|
|
it must explicitly be driven high (@option{srst_push_pull}).
|
|
|
|
@itemize
|
|
@item
|
|
@var{signals} can specify which of the reset signals are connected.
|
|
For example, If the JTAG interface provides SRST, but the board doesn't
|
|
connect that signal properly, then OpenOCD can't use it.
|
|
Possible values are @option{none} (the default), @option{trst_only},
|
|
@option{srst_only} and @option{trst_and_srst}.
|
|
|
|
@quotation Tip
|
|
If your board provides SRST and/or TRST through the JTAG connector,
|
|
you must declare that so those signals can be used.
|
|
@end quotation
|
|
|
|
@item
|
|
The @var{combination} is an optional value specifying broken reset
|
|
signal implementations.
|
|
The default behaviour if no option given is @option{separate},
|
|
indicating everything behaves normally.
|
|
@option{srst_pulls_trst} states that the
|
|
test logic is reset together with the reset of the system (e.g. NXP
|
|
LPC2000, "broken" board layout), @option{trst_pulls_srst} says that
|
|
the system is reset together with the test logic (only hypothetical, I
|
|
haven't seen hardware with such a bug, and can be worked around).
|
|
@option{combined} implies both @option{srst_pulls_trst} and
|
|
@option{trst_pulls_srst}.
|
|
|
|
@item
|
|
The @var{gates} tokens control flags that describe some cases where
|
|
JTAG may be unavailable during reset.
|
|
@option{srst_gates_jtag} (default)
|
|
indicates that asserting SRST gates the
|
|
JTAG clock. This means that no communication can happen on JTAG
|
|
while SRST is asserted.
|
|
Its converse is @option{srst_nogate}, indicating that JTAG commands
|
|
can safely be issued while SRST is active.
|
|
|
|
@item
|
|
The @var{connect_type} tokens control flags that describe some cases where
|
|
SRST is asserted while connecting to the target. @option{srst_nogate}
|
|
is required to use this option.
|
|
@option{connect_deassert_srst} (default)
|
|
indicates that SRST will not be asserted while connecting to the target.
|
|
Its converse is @option{connect_assert_srst}, indicating that SRST will
|
|
be asserted before any target connection.
|
|
Only some targets support this feature, STM32 and STR9 are examples.
|
|
This feature is useful if you are unable to connect to your target due
|
|
to incorrect options byte config or illegal program execution.
|
|
@end itemize
|
|
|
|
The optional @var{trst_type} and @var{srst_type} parameters allow the
|
|
driver mode of each reset line to be specified. These values only affect
|
|
JTAG interfaces with support for different driver modes, like the Amontec
|
|
JTAGkey and JTAG Accelerator. Also, they are necessarily ignored if the
|
|
relevant signal (TRST or SRST) is not connected.
|
|
|
|
@itemize
|
|
@item
|
|
Possible @var{trst_type} driver modes for the test reset signal (TRST)
|
|
are the default @option{trst_push_pull}, and @option{trst_open_drain}.
|
|
Most boards connect this signal to a pulldown, so the JTAG TAPs
|
|
never leave reset unless they are hooked up to a JTAG adapter.
|
|
|
|
@item
|
|
Possible @var{srst_type} driver modes for the system reset signal (SRST)
|
|
are the default @option{srst_open_drain}, and @option{srst_push_pull}.
|
|
Most boards connect this signal to a pullup, and allow the
|
|
signal to be pulled low by various events including system
|
|
power-up and pressing a reset button.
|
|
@end itemize
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
|
|
@section Custom Reset Handling
|
|
@cindex events
|
|
|
|
OpenOCD has several ways to help support the various reset
|
|
mechanisms provided by chip and board vendors.
|
|
The commands shown in the previous section give standard parameters.
|
|
There are also @emph{event handlers} associated with TAPs or Targets.
|
|
Those handlers are Tcl procedures you can provide, which are invoked
|
|
at particular points in the reset sequence.
|
|
|
|
@emph{When SRST is not an option} you must set
|
|
up a @code{reset-assert} event handler for your target.
|
|
For example, some JTAG adapters don't include the SRST signal;
|
|
and some boards have multiple targets, and you won't always
|
|
want to reset everything at once.
|
|
|
|
After configuring those mechanisms, you might still
|
|
find your board doesn't start up or reset correctly.
|
|
For example, maybe it needs a slightly different sequence
|
|
of SRST and/or TRST manipulations, because of quirks that
|
|
the @command{reset_config} mechanism doesn't address;
|
|
or asserting both might trigger a stronger reset, which
|
|
needs special attention.
|
|
|
|
Experiment with lower level operations, such as
|
|
@command{adapter assert}, @command{adapter deassert}
|
|
and the @command{jtag arp_*} operations shown here,
|
|
to find a sequence of operations that works.
|
|
@xref{JTAG Commands}.
|
|
When you find a working sequence, it can be used to override
|
|
@command{jtag_init}, which fires during OpenOCD startup
|
|
(@pxref{configurationstage,,Configuration Stage});
|
|
or @command{init_reset}, which fires during reset processing.
|
|
|
|
You might also want to provide some project-specific reset
|
|
schemes. For example, on a multi-target board the standard
|
|
@command{reset} command would reset all targets, but you
|
|
may need the ability to reset only one target at time and
|
|
thus want to avoid using the board-wide SRST signal.
|
|
|
|
@deffn {Overridable Procedure} {init_reset} mode
|
|
This is invoked near the beginning of the @command{reset} command,
|
|
usually to provide as much of a cold (power-up) reset as practical.
|
|
By default it is also invoked from @command{jtag_init} if
|
|
the scan chain does not respond to pure JTAG operations.
|
|
The @var{mode} parameter is the parameter given to the
|
|
low level reset command (@option{halt},
|
|
@option{init}, or @option{run}), @option{setup},
|
|
or potentially some other value.
|
|
|
|
The default implementation just invokes @command{jtag arp_init-reset}.
|
|
Replacements will normally build on low level JTAG
|
|
operations such as @command{adapter assert} and @command{adapter deassert}.
|
|
Operations here must not address individual TAPs
|
|
(or their associated targets)
|
|
until the JTAG scan chain has first been verified to work.
|
|
|
|
Implementations must have verified the JTAG scan chain before
|
|
they return.
|
|
This is done by calling @command{jtag arp_init}
|
|
(or @command{jtag arp_init-reset}).
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
|
|
@deffn {Command} {jtag arp_init}
|
|
This validates the scan chain using just the four
|
|
standard JTAG signals (TMS, TCK, TDI, TDO).
|
|
It starts by issuing a JTAG-only reset.
|
|
Then it performs checks to verify that the scan chain configuration
|
|
matches the TAPs it can observe.
|
|
Those checks include checking IDCODE values for each active TAP,
|
|
and verifying the length of their instruction registers using
|
|
TAP @code{-ircapture} and @code{-irmask} values.
|
|
If these tests all pass, TAP @code{setup} events are
|
|
issued to all TAPs with handlers for that event.
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
|
|
@deffn {Command} {jtag arp_init-reset}
|
|
This uses TRST and SRST to try resetting
|
|
everything on the JTAG scan chain
|
|
(and anything else connected to SRST).
|
|
It then invokes the logic of @command{jtag arp_init}.
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
|
|
|
|
@node TAP Declaration
|
|
@chapter TAP Declaration
|
|
@cindex TAP declaration
|
|
@cindex TAP configuration
|
|
|
|
@emph{Test Access Ports} (TAPs) are the core of JTAG.
|
|
TAPs serve many roles, including:
|
|
|
|
@itemize @bullet
|
|
@item @b{Debug Target} A CPU TAP can be used as a GDB debug target.
|
|
@item @b{Flash Programming} Some chips program the flash directly via JTAG.
|
|
Others do it indirectly, making a CPU do it.
|
|
@item @b{Program Download} Using the same CPU support GDB uses,
|
|
you can initialize a DRAM controller, download code to DRAM, and then
|
|
start running that code.
|
|
@item @b{Boundary Scan} Most chips support boundary scan, which
|
|
helps test for board assembly problems like solder bridges
|
|
and missing connections.
|
|
@end itemize
|
|
|
|
OpenOCD must know about the active TAPs on your board(s).
|
|
Setting up the TAPs is the core task of your configuration files.
|
|
Once those TAPs are set up, you can pass their names to code
|
|
which sets up CPUs and exports them as GDB targets,
|
|
probes flash memory, performs low-level JTAG operations, and more.
|
|
|
|
@section Scan Chains
|
|
@cindex scan chain
|
|
|
|
TAPs are part of a hardware @dfn{scan chain},
|
|
which is a daisy chain of TAPs.
|
|
They also need to be added to
|
|
OpenOCD's software mirror of that hardware list,
|
|
giving each member a name and associating other data with it.
|
|
Simple scan chains, with a single TAP, are common in
|
|
systems with a single microcontroller or microprocessor.
|
|
More complex chips may have several TAPs internally.
|
|
Very complex scan chains might have a dozen or more TAPs:
|
|
several in one chip, more in the next, and connecting
|
|
to other boards with their own chips and TAPs.
|
|
|
|
You can display the list with the @command{scan_chain} command.
|
|
(Don't confuse this with the list displayed by the @command{targets}
|
|
command, presented in the next chapter.
|
|
That only displays TAPs for CPUs which are configured as
|
|
debugging targets.)
|
|
Here's what the scan chain might look like for a chip more than one TAP:
|
|
|
|
@verbatim
|
|
TapName Enabled IdCode Expected IrLen IrCap IrMask
|
|
-- ------------------ ------- ---------- ---------- ----- ----- ------
|
|
0 omap5912.dsp Y 0x03df1d81 0x03df1d81 38 0x01 0x03
|
|
1 omap5912.arm Y 0x0692602f 0x0692602f 4 0x01 0x0f
|
|
2 omap5912.unknown Y 0x00000000 0x00000000 8 0x01 0x03
|
|
@end verbatim
|
|
|
|
OpenOCD can detect some of that information, but not all
|
|
of it. @xref{autoprobing,,Autoprobing}.
|
|
Unfortunately, those TAPs can't always be autoconfigured,
|
|
because not all devices provide good support for that.
|
|
JTAG doesn't require supporting IDCODE instructions, and
|
|
chips with JTAG routers may not link TAPs into the chain
|
|
until they are told to do so.
|
|
|
|
The configuration mechanism currently supported by OpenOCD
|
|
requires explicit configuration of all TAP devices using
|
|
@command{jtag newtap} commands, as detailed later in this chapter.
|
|
A command like this would declare one tap and name it @code{chip1.cpu}:
|
|
|
|
@example
|
|
jtag newtap chip1 cpu -irlen 4 -expected-id 0x3ba00477
|
|
@end example
|
|
|
|
Each target configuration file lists the TAPs provided
|
|
by a given chip.
|
|
Board configuration files combine all the targets on a board,
|
|
and so forth.
|
|
Note that @emph{the order in which TAPs are declared is very important.}
|
|
That declaration order must match the order in the JTAG scan chain,
|
|
both inside a single chip and between them.
|
|
@xref{faqtaporder,,FAQ TAP Order}.
|
|
|
|
For example, the STMicroelectronics STR912 chip has
|
|
three separate TAPs@footnote{See the ST
|
|
document titled: @emph{STR91xFAxxx, Section 3.15 Jtag Interface, Page:
|
|
28/102, Figure 3: JTAG chaining inside the STR91xFA}.
|
|
@url{http://eu.st.com/stonline/products/literature/ds/13495.pdf}}.
|
|
To configure those taps, @file{target/str912.cfg}
|
|
includes commands something like this:
|
|
|
|
@example
|
|
jtag newtap str912 flash ... params ...
|
|
jtag newtap str912 cpu ... params ...
|
|
jtag newtap str912 bs ... params ...
|
|
@end example
|
|
|
|
Actual config files typically use a variable such as @code{$_CHIPNAME}
|
|
instead of literals like @option{str912}, to support more than one chip
|
|
of each type. @xref{Config File Guidelines}.
|
|
|
|
@deffn {Command} {jtag names}
|
|
Returns the names of all current TAPs in the scan chain.
|
|
Use @command{jtag cget} or @command{jtag tapisenabled}
|
|
to examine attributes and state of each TAP.
|
|
@example
|
|
foreach t [jtag names] @{
|
|
puts [format "TAP: %s\n" $t]
|
|
@}
|
|
@end example
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
|
|
@deffn {Command} {scan_chain}
|
|
Displays the TAPs in the scan chain configuration,
|
|
and their status.
|
|
The set of TAPs listed by this command is fixed by
|
|
exiting the OpenOCD configuration stage,
|
|
but systems with a JTAG router can
|
|
enable or disable TAPs dynamically.
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
|
|
@c FIXME! "jtag cget" should be able to return all TAP
|
|
@c attributes, like "$target_name cget" does for targets.
|
|
|
|
@c Probably want "jtag eventlist", and a "tap-reset" event
|
|
@c (on entry to RESET state).
|
|
|
|
@section TAP Names
|
|
@cindex dotted name
|
|
|
|
When TAP objects are declared with @command{jtag newtap},
|
|
a @dfn{dotted.name} is created for the TAP, combining the
|
|
name of a module (usually a chip) and a label for the TAP.
|
|
For example: @code{xilinx.tap}, @code{str912.flash},
|
|
@code{omap3530.jrc}, @code{dm6446.dsp}, or @code{stm32.cpu}.
|
|
Many other commands use that dotted.name to manipulate or
|
|
refer to the TAP. For example, CPU configuration uses the
|
|
name, as does declaration of NAND or NOR flash banks.
|
|
|
|
The components of a dotted name should follow ``C'' symbol
|
|
name rules: start with an alphabetic character, then numbers
|
|
and underscores are OK; while others (including dots!) are not.
|
|
|
|
@section TAP Declaration Commands
|
|
|
|
@deffn {Config Command} {jtag newtap} chipname tapname configparams...
|
|
Declares a new TAP with the dotted name @var{chipname}.@var{tapname},
|
|
and configured according to the various @var{configparams}.
|
|
|
|
The @var{chipname} is a symbolic name for the chip.
|
|
Conventionally target config files use @code{$_CHIPNAME},
|
|
defaulting to the model name given by the chip vendor but
|
|
overridable.
|
|
|
|
@cindex TAP naming convention
|
|
The @var{tapname} reflects the role of that TAP,
|
|
and should follow this convention:
|
|
|
|
@itemize @bullet
|
|
@item @code{bs} -- For boundary scan if this is a separate TAP;
|
|
@item @code{cpu} -- The main CPU of the chip, alternatively
|
|
@code{arm} and @code{dsp} on chips with both ARM and DSP CPUs,
|
|
@code{arm1} and @code{arm2} on chips with two ARMs, and so forth;
|
|
@item @code{etb} -- For an embedded trace buffer (example: an ARM ETB11);
|
|
@item @code{flash} -- If the chip has a flash TAP, like the str912;
|
|
@item @code{jrc} -- For JTAG route controller (example: the ICEPick modules
|
|
on many Texas Instruments chips, like the OMAP3530 on Beagleboards);
|
|
@item @code{tap} -- Should be used only for FPGA- or CPLD-like devices
|
|
with a single TAP;
|
|
@item @code{unknownN} -- If you have no idea what the TAP is for (N is a number);
|
|
@item @emph{when in doubt} -- Use the chip maker's name in their data sheet.
|
|
For example, the Freescale i.MX31 has a SDMA (Smart DMA) with
|
|
a JTAG TAP; that TAP should be named @code{sdma}.
|
|
@end itemize
|
|
|
|
Every TAP requires at least the following @var{configparams}:
|
|
|
|
@itemize @bullet
|
|
@item @code{-irlen} @var{NUMBER}
|
|
@*The length in bits of the
|
|
instruction register, such as 4 or 5 bits.
|
|
@end itemize
|
|
|
|
A TAP may also provide optional @var{configparams}:
|
|
|
|
@itemize @bullet
|
|
@item @code{-disable} (or @code{-enable})
|
|
@*Use the @code{-disable} parameter to flag a TAP which is not
|
|
linked into the scan chain after a reset using either TRST
|
|
or the JTAG state machine's @sc{reset} state.
|
|
You may use @code{-enable} to highlight the default state
|
|
(the TAP is linked in).
|
|
@xref{enablinganddisablingtaps,,Enabling and Disabling TAPs}.
|
|
@item @code{-expected-id} @var{NUMBER}
|
|
@*A non-zero @var{number} represents a 32-bit IDCODE
|
|
which you expect to find when the scan chain is examined.
|
|
These codes are not required by all JTAG devices.
|
|
@emph{Repeat the option} as many times as required if more than one
|
|
ID code could appear (for example, multiple versions).
|
|
Specify @var{number} as zero to suppress warnings about IDCODE
|
|
values that were found but not included in the list.
|
|
|
|
Provide this value if at all possible, since it lets OpenOCD
|
|
tell when the scan chain it sees isn't right. These values
|
|
are provided in vendors' chip documentation, usually a technical
|
|
reference manual. Sometimes you may need to probe the JTAG
|
|
hardware to find these values.
|
|
@xref{autoprobing,,Autoprobing}.
|
|
@item @code{-ignore-version}
|
|
@*Specify this to ignore the JTAG version field in the @code{-expected-id}
|
|
option. When vendors put out multiple versions of a chip, or use the same
|
|
JTAG-level ID for several largely-compatible chips, it may be more practical
|
|
to ignore the version field than to update config files to handle all of
|
|
the various chip IDs. The version field is defined as bit 28-31 of the IDCODE.
|
|
@item @code{-ignore-bypass}
|
|
@*Specify this to ignore the 'bypass' bit of the idcode. Some vendor put
|
|
an invalid idcode regarding this bit. Specify this to ignore this bit and
|
|
to not consider this tap in bypass mode.
|
|
@item @code{-ircapture} @var{NUMBER}
|
|
@*The bit pattern loaded by the TAP into the JTAG shift register
|
|
on entry to the @sc{ircapture} state, such as 0x01.
|
|
JTAG requires the two LSBs of this value to be 01.
|
|
By default, @code{-ircapture} and @code{-irmask} are set
|
|
up to verify that two-bit value. You may provide
|
|
additional bits if you know them, or indicate that
|
|
a TAP doesn't conform to the JTAG specification.
|
|
@item @code{-irmask} @var{NUMBER}
|
|
@*A mask used with @code{-ircapture}
|
|
to verify that instruction scans work correctly.
|
|
Such scans are not used by OpenOCD except to verify that
|
|
there seems to be no problems with JTAG scan chain operations.
|
|
@item @code{-ignore-syspwrupack}
|
|
@*Specify this to ignore the CSYSPWRUPACK bit in the ARM DAP DP CTRL/STAT
|
|
register during initial examination and when checking the sticky error bit.
|
|
This bit is normally checked after setting the CSYSPWRUPREQ bit, but some
|
|
devices do not set the ack bit until sometime later.
|
|
@end itemize
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
|
|
@section Other TAP commands
|
|
|
|
@deffn {Command} {jtag cget} dotted.name @option{-idcode}
|
|
Get the value of the IDCODE found in hardware.
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
|
|
@deffn {Command} {jtag cget} dotted.name @option{-event} event_name
|
|
@deffnx {Command} {jtag configure} dotted.name @option{-event} event_name handler
|
|
At this writing this TAP attribute
|
|
mechanism is limited and used mostly for event handling.
|
|
(It is not a direct analogue of the @code{cget}/@code{configure}
|
|
mechanism for debugger targets.)
|
|
See the next section for information about the available events.
|
|
|
|
The @code{configure} subcommand assigns an event handler,
|
|
a TCL string which is evaluated when the event is triggered.
|
|
The @code{cget} subcommand returns that handler.
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
|
|
@section TAP Events
|
|
@cindex events
|
|
@cindex TAP events
|
|
|
|
OpenOCD includes two event mechanisms.
|
|
The one presented here applies to all JTAG TAPs.
|
|
The other applies to debugger targets,
|
|
which are associated with certain TAPs.
|
|
|
|
The TAP events currently defined are:
|
|
|
|
@itemize @bullet
|
|
@item @b{post-reset}
|
|
@* The TAP has just completed a JTAG reset.
|
|
The tap may still be in the JTAG @sc{reset} state.
|
|
Handlers for these events might perform initialization sequences
|
|
such as issuing TCK cycles, TMS sequences to ensure
|
|
exit from the ARM SWD mode, and more.
|
|
|
|
Because the scan chain has not yet been verified, handlers for these events
|
|
@emph{should not issue commands which scan the JTAG IR or DR registers}
|
|
of any particular target.
|
|
@b{NOTE:} As this is written (September 2009), nothing prevents such access.
|
|
@item @b{setup}
|
|
@* The scan chain has been reset and verified.
|
|
This handler may enable TAPs as needed.
|
|
@item @b{tap-disable}
|
|
@* The TAP needs to be disabled. This handler should
|
|
implement @command{jtag tapdisable}
|
|
by issuing the relevant JTAG commands.
|
|
@item @b{tap-enable}
|
|
@* The TAP needs to be enabled. This handler should
|
|
implement @command{jtag tapenable}
|
|
by issuing the relevant JTAG commands.
|
|
@end itemize
|
|
|
|
If you need some action after each JTAG reset which isn't actually
|
|
specific to any TAP (since you can't yet trust the scan chain's
|
|
contents to be accurate), you might:
|
|
|
|
@example
|
|
jtag configure CHIP.jrc -event post-reset @{
|
|
echo "JTAG Reset done"
|
|
... non-scan jtag operations to be done after reset
|
|
@}
|
|
@end example
|
|
|
|
|
|
@anchor{enablinganddisablingtaps}
|
|
@section Enabling and Disabling TAPs
|
|
@cindex JTAG Route Controller
|
|
@cindex jrc
|
|
|
|
In some systems, a @dfn{JTAG Route Controller} (JRC)
|
|
is used to enable and/or disable specific JTAG TAPs.
|
|
Many ARM-based chips from Texas Instruments include
|
|
an ``ICEPick'' module, which is a JRC.
|
|
Such chips include DaVinci and OMAP3 processors.
|
|
|
|
A given TAP may not be visible until the JRC has been
|
|
told to link it into the scan chain; and if the JRC
|
|
has been told to unlink that TAP, it will no longer
|
|
be visible.
|
|
Such routers address problems that JTAG ``bypass mode''
|
|
ignores, such as:
|
|
|
|
@itemize
|
|
@item The scan chain can only go as fast as its slowest TAP.
|
|
@item Having many TAPs slows instruction scans, since all
|
|
TAPs receive new instructions.
|
|
@item TAPs in the scan chain must be powered up, which wastes
|
|
power and prevents debugging some power management mechanisms.
|
|
@end itemize
|
|
|
|
The IEEE 1149.1 JTAG standard has no concept of a ``disabled'' tap,
|
|
as implied by the existence of JTAG routers.
|
|
However, the upcoming IEEE 1149.7 framework (layered on top of JTAG)
|
|
does include a kind of JTAG router functionality.
|
|
|
|
@c (a) currently the event handlers don't seem to be able to
|
|
@c fail in a way that could lead to no-change-of-state.
|
|
|
|
In OpenOCD, tap enabling/disabling is invoked by the Tcl commands
|
|
shown below, and is implemented using TAP event handlers.
|
|
So for example, when defining a TAP for a CPU connected to
|
|
a JTAG router, your @file{target.cfg} file
|
|
should define TAP event handlers using
|
|
code that looks something like this:
|
|
|
|
@example
|
|
jtag configure CHIP.cpu -event tap-enable @{
|
|
... jtag operations using CHIP.jrc
|
|
@}
|
|
jtag configure CHIP.cpu -event tap-disable @{
|
|
... jtag operations using CHIP.jrc
|
|
@}
|
|
@end example
|
|
|
|
Then you might want that CPU's TAP enabled almost all the time:
|
|
|
|
@example
|
|
jtag configure $CHIP.jrc -event setup "jtag tapenable $CHIP.cpu"
|
|
@end example
|
|
|
|
Note how that particular setup event handler declaration
|
|
uses quotes to evaluate @code{$CHIP} when the event is configured.
|
|
Using brackets @{ @} would cause it to be evaluated later,
|
|
at runtime, when it might have a different value.
|
|
|
|
@deffn {Command} {jtag tapdisable} dotted.name
|
|
If necessary, disables the tap
|
|
by sending it a @option{tap-disable} event.
|
|
Returns the string "1" if the tap
|
|
specified by @var{dotted.name} is enabled,
|
|
and "0" if it is disabled.
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
|
|
@deffn {Command} {jtag tapenable} dotted.name
|
|
If necessary, enables the tap
|
|
by sending it a @option{tap-enable} event.
|
|
Returns the string "1" if the tap
|
|
specified by @var{dotted.name} is enabled,
|
|
and "0" if it is disabled.
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
|
|
@deffn {Command} {jtag tapisenabled} dotted.name
|
|
Returns the string "1" if the tap
|
|
specified by @var{dotted.name} is enabled,
|
|
and "0" if it is disabled.
|
|
|
|
@quotation Note
|
|
Humans will find the @command{scan_chain} command more helpful
|
|
for querying the state of the JTAG taps.
|
|
@end quotation
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
|
|
@anchor{autoprobing}
|
|
@section Autoprobing
|
|
@cindex autoprobe
|
|
@cindex JTAG autoprobe
|
|
|
|
TAP configuration is the first thing that needs to be done
|
|
after interface and reset configuration. Sometimes it's
|
|
hard finding out what TAPs exist, or how they are identified.
|
|
Vendor documentation is not always easy to find and use.
|
|
|
|
To help you get past such problems, OpenOCD has a limited
|
|
@emph{autoprobing} ability to look at the scan chain, doing
|
|
a @dfn{blind interrogation} and then reporting the TAPs it finds.
|
|
To use this mechanism, start the OpenOCD server with only data
|
|
that configures your JTAG interface, and arranges to come up
|
|
with a slow clock (many devices don't support fast JTAG clocks
|
|
right when they come out of reset).
|
|
|
|
For example, your @file{openocd.cfg} file might have:
|
|
|
|
@example
|
|
source [find interface/olimex-arm-usb-tiny-h.cfg]
|
|
reset_config trst_and_srst
|
|
jtag_rclk 8
|
|
@end example
|
|
|
|
When you start the server without any TAPs configured, it will
|
|
attempt to autoconfigure the TAPs. There are two parts to this:
|
|
|
|
@enumerate
|
|
@item @emph{TAP discovery} ...
|
|
After a JTAG reset (sometimes a system reset may be needed too),
|
|
each TAP's data registers will hold the contents of either the
|
|
IDCODE or BYPASS register.
|
|
If JTAG communication is working, OpenOCD will see each TAP,
|
|
and report what @option{-expected-id} to use with it.
|
|
@item @emph{IR Length discovery} ...
|
|
Unfortunately JTAG does not provide a reliable way to find out
|
|
the value of the @option{-irlen} parameter to use with a TAP
|
|
that is discovered.
|
|
If OpenOCD can discover the length of a TAP's instruction
|
|
register, it will report it.
|
|
Otherwise you may need to consult vendor documentation, such
|
|
as chip data sheets or BSDL files.
|
|
@end enumerate
|
|
|
|
In many cases your board will have a simple scan chain with just
|
|
a single device. Here's what OpenOCD reported with one board
|
|
that's a bit more complex:
|
|
|
|
@example
|
|
clock speed 8 kHz
|
|
There are no enabled taps. AUTO PROBING MIGHT NOT WORK!!
|
|
AUTO auto0.tap - use "jtag newtap auto0 tap -expected-id 0x2b900f0f ..."
|
|
AUTO auto1.tap - use "jtag newtap auto1 tap -expected-id 0x07926001 ..."
|
|
AUTO auto2.tap - use "jtag newtap auto2 tap -expected-id 0x0b73b02f ..."
|
|
AUTO auto0.tap - use "... -irlen 4"
|
|
AUTO auto1.tap - use "... -irlen 4"
|
|
AUTO auto2.tap - use "... -irlen 6"
|
|
no gdb ports allocated as no target has been specified
|
|
@end example
|
|
|
|
Given that information, you should be able to either find some existing
|
|
config files to use, or create your own. If you create your own, you
|
|
would configure from the bottom up: first a @file{target.cfg} file
|
|
with these TAPs, any targets associated with them, and any on-chip
|
|
resources; then a @file{board.cfg} with off-chip resources, clocking,
|
|
and so forth.
|
|
|
|
@anchor{dapdeclaration}
|
|
@section DAP declaration (ARMv6-M, ARMv7 and ARMv8 targets)
|
|
@cindex DAP declaration
|
|
|
|
Since OpenOCD version 0.11.0, the Debug Access Port (DAP) is
|
|
no longer implicitly created together with the target. It must be
|
|
explicitly declared using the @command{dap create} command. For all ARMv6-M, ARMv7
|
|
and ARMv8 targets, the option "@option{-dap} @var{dap_name}" has to be used
|
|
instead of "@option{-chain-position} @var{dotted.name}" when the target is created.
|
|
|
|
The @command{dap} command group supports the following sub-commands:
|
|
|
|
@anchor{dap_create}
|
|
@deffn {Command} {dap create} dap_name @option{-chain-position} dotted.name configparams...
|
|
Declare a DAP instance named @var{dap_name} linked to the JTAG tap
|
|
@var{dotted.name}. This also creates a new command (@command{dap_name})
|
|
which is used for various purposes including additional configuration.
|
|
There can only be one DAP for each JTAG tap in the system.
|
|
|
|
A DAP may also provide optional @var{configparams}:
|
|
|
|
@itemize @bullet
|
|
@item @code{-adiv5}
|
|
Specify that it's an ADIv5 DAP. This is the default if not specified.
|
|
@item @code{-adiv6}
|
|
Specify that it's an ADIv6 DAP.
|
|
@item @code{-ignore-syspwrupack}
|
|
Specify this to ignore the CSYSPWRUPACK bit in the ARM DAP DP CTRL/STAT
|
|
register during initial examination and when checking the sticky error bit.
|
|
This bit is normally checked after setting the CSYSPWRUPREQ bit, but some
|
|
devices do not set the ack bit until sometime later.
|
|
|
|
@item @code{-dp-id} @var{number}
|
|
@*Debug port identification number for SWD DPv2 multidrop.
|
|
The @var{number} is written to bits 0..27 of DP TARGETSEL during DP selection.
|
|
To find the id number of a single connected device read DP TARGETID:
|
|
@code{device.dap dpreg 0x24}
|
|
Use bits 0..27 of TARGETID.
|
|
|
|
@item @code{-instance-id} @var{number}
|
|
@*Instance identification number for SWD DPv2 multidrop.
|
|
The @var{number} is written to bits 28..31 of DP TARGETSEL during DP selection.
|
|
To find the instance number of a single connected device read DP DLPIDR:
|
|
@code{device.dap dpreg 0x34}
|
|
The instance number is in bits 28..31 of DLPIDR value.
|
|
@end itemize
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
|
|
@deffn {Command} {dap names}
|
|
This command returns a list of all registered DAP objects. It it useful mainly
|
|
for TCL scripting.
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
|
|
@deffn {Command} {dap info} [@var{num}|@option{root}]
|
|
Displays the ROM table for MEM-AP @var{num},
|
|
defaulting to the currently selected AP of the currently selected target.
|
|
On ADIv5 DAP @var{num} is the numeric index of the AP.
|
|
On ADIv6 DAP @var{num} is the base address of the AP.
|
|
With ADIv6 only, @option{root} specifies the root ROM table.
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
|
|
@deffn {Command} {dap init}
|
|
Initialize all registered DAPs. This command is used internally
|
|
during initialization. It can be issued at any time after the
|
|
initialization, too.
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
|
|
The following commands exist as subcommands of DAP instances:
|
|
|
|
@deffn {Command} {$dap_name info} [@var{num}|@option{root}]
|
|
Displays the ROM table for MEM-AP @var{num},
|
|
defaulting to the currently selected AP.
|
|
On ADIv5 DAP @var{num} is the numeric index of the AP.
|
|
On ADIv6 DAP @var{num} is the base address of the AP.
|
|
With ADIv6 only, @option{root} specifies the root ROM table.
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
|
|
@deffn {Command} {$dap_name apid} [num]
|
|
Displays ID register from AP @var{num}, defaulting to the currently selected AP.
|
|
On ADIv5 DAP @var{num} is the numeric index of the AP.
|
|
On ADIv6 DAP @var{num} is the base address of the AP.
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
|
|
@anchor{DAP subcommand apreg}
|
|
@deffn {Command} {$dap_name apreg} ap_num reg [value]
|
|
Displays content of a register @var{reg} from AP @var{ap_num}
|
|
or set a new value @var{value}.
|
|
On ADIv5 DAP @var{ap_num} is the numeric index of the AP.
|
|
On ADIv6 DAP @var{ap_num} is the base address of the AP.
|
|
@var{reg} is byte address of a word register, 0, 4, 8 ... 0xfc.
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
|
|
@deffn {Command} {$dap_name apsel} [num]
|
|
Select AP @var{num}, defaulting to 0.
|
|
On ADIv5 DAP @var{num} is the numeric index of the AP.
|
|
On ADIv6 DAP @var{num} is the base address of the AP.
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
|
|
@deffn {Command} {$dap_name dpreg} reg [value]
|
|
Displays the content of DP register at address @var{reg}, or set it to a new
|
|
value @var{value}.
|
|
|
|
In case of SWD, @var{reg} is a value in packed format
|
|
@math{dpbanksel << 4 | addr} and assumes values 0, 4, 8 ... 0xfc.
|
|
In case of JTAG it only assumes values 0, 4, 8 and 0xc.
|
|
|
|
@emph{Note:} Consider using @command{poll off} to avoid any disturbing
|
|
background activity by OpenOCD while you are operating at such low-level.
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
|
|
@deffn {Command} {$dap_name baseaddr} [num]
|
|
Displays debug base address from MEM-AP @var{num},
|
|
defaulting to the currently selected AP.
|
|
On ADIv5 DAP @var{num} is the numeric index of the AP.
|
|
On ADIv6 DAP @var{num} is the base address of the AP.
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
|
|
@deffn {Command} {$dap_name memaccess} [value]
|
|
Displays the number of extra tck cycles in the JTAG idle to use for MEM-AP
|
|
memory bus access [0-255], giving additional time to respond to reads.
|
|
If @var{value} is defined, first assigns that.
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
|
|
@deffn {Command} {$dap_name apcsw} [value [mask]]
|
|
Displays or changes CSW bit pattern for MEM-AP transfers.
|
|
|
|
At the begin of each memory access the CSW pattern is extended (bitwise or-ed)
|
|
by @dfn{Size} and @dfn{AddrInc} bit-fields according to transfer requirements
|
|
and the result is written to the real CSW register. All bits except dynamically
|
|
updated fields @dfn{Size} and @dfn{AddrInc} can be changed by changing
|
|
the CSW pattern. Refer to ARM ADI v5 manual chapter 7.6.4 and appendix A
|
|
for details.
|
|
|
|
Use @var{value} only syntax if you want to set the new CSW pattern as a whole.
|
|
The example sets HPROT1 bit (required by Cortex-M) and clears the rest of
|
|
the pattern:
|
|
@example
|
|
kx.dap apcsw 0x2000000
|
|
@end example
|
|
|
|
If @var{mask} is also used, the CSW pattern is changed only on bit positions
|
|
where the mask bit is 1. The following example sets HPROT3 (cacheable)
|
|
and leaves the rest of the pattern intact. It configures memory access through
|
|
DCache on Cortex-M7.
|
|
@example
|
|
set CSW_HPROT3_CACHEABLE [expr @{1 << 27@}]
|
|
samv.dap apcsw $CSW_HPROT3_CACHEABLE $CSW_HPROT3_CACHEABLE
|
|
@end example
|
|
|
|
Another example clears SPROT bit and leaves the rest of pattern intact:
|
|
@example
|
|
set CSW_SPROT [expr @{1 << 30@}]
|
|
samv.dap apcsw 0 $CSW_SPROT
|
|
@end example
|
|
|
|
@emph{Note:} If you want to check the real value of CSW, not CSW pattern, use
|
|
@code{xxx.dap apreg 0}. @xref{DAP subcommand apreg,,}.
|
|
|
|
@emph{Warning:} Some of the CSW bits are vital for working memory transfer.
|
|
If you set a wrong CSW pattern and MEM-AP stopped working, use the following
|
|
example with a proper dap name:
|
|
@example
|
|
xxx.dap apcsw default
|
|
@end example
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
|
|
@deffn {Config Command} {$dap_name ti_be_32_quirks} [@option{enable}]
|
|
Set/get quirks mode for TI TMS450/TMS570 processors
|
|
Disabled by default
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
|
|
@deffn {Config Command} {$dap_name nu_npcx_quirks} [@option{enable}]
|
|
Set/get quirks mode for Nuvoton NPCX/NPCD MCU families
|
|
Disabled by default
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
|
|
@node CPU Configuration
|
|
@chapter CPU Configuration
|
|
@cindex GDB target
|
|
|
|
This chapter discusses how to set up GDB debug targets for CPUs.
|
|
You can also access these targets without GDB
|
|
(@pxref{Architecture and Core Commands},
|
|
and @ref{targetstatehandling,,Target State handling}) and
|
|
through various kinds of NAND and NOR flash commands.
|
|
If you have multiple CPUs you can have multiple such targets.
|
|
|
|
We'll start by looking at how to examine the targets you have,
|
|
then look at how to add one more target and how to configure it.
|
|
|
|
@section Target List
|
|
@cindex target, current
|
|
@cindex target, list
|
|
|
|
All targets that have been set up are part of a list,
|
|
where each member has a name.
|
|
That name should normally be the same as the TAP name.
|
|
You can display the list with the @command{targets}
|
|
(plural!) command.
|
|
This display often has only one CPU; here's what it might
|
|
look like with more than one:
|
|
@verbatim
|
|
TargetName Type Endian TapName State
|
|
-- ------------------ ---------- ------ ------------------ ------------
|
|
0* at91rm9200.cpu arm920t little at91rm9200.cpu running
|
|
1 MyTarget cortex_m little mychip.foo tap-disabled
|
|
@end verbatim
|
|
|
|
One member of that list is the @dfn{current target}, which
|
|
is implicitly referenced by many commands.
|
|
It's the one marked with a @code{*} near the target name.
|
|
In particular, memory addresses often refer to the address
|
|
space seen by that current target.
|
|
Commands like @command{mdw} (memory display words)
|
|
and @command{flash erase_address} (erase NOR flash blocks)
|
|
are examples; and there are many more.
|
|
|
|
Several commands let you examine the list of targets:
|
|
|
|
@deffn {Command} {target current}
|
|
Returns the name of the current target.
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
|
|
@deffn {Command} {target names}
|
|
Lists the names of all current targets in the list.
|
|
@example
|
|
foreach t [target names] @{
|
|
puts [format "Target: %s\n" $t]
|
|
@}
|
|
@end example
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
|
|
@c yep, "target list" would have been better.
|
|
@c plus maybe "target setdefault".
|
|
|
|
@deffn {Command} {targets} [name]
|
|
@emph{Note: the name of this command is plural. Other target
|
|
command names are singular.}
|
|
|
|
With no parameter, this command displays a table of all known
|
|
targets in a user friendly form.
|
|
|
|
With a parameter, this command sets the current target to
|
|
the given target with the given @var{name}; this is
|
|
only relevant on boards which have more than one target.
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
|
|
@section Target CPU Types
|
|
@cindex target type
|
|
@cindex CPU type
|
|
|
|
Each target has a @dfn{CPU type}, as shown in the output of
|
|
the @command{targets} command. You need to specify that type
|
|
when calling @command{target create}.
|
|
The CPU type indicates more than just the instruction set.
|
|
It also indicates how that instruction set is implemented,
|
|
what kind of debug support it integrates,
|
|
whether it has an MMU (and if so, what kind),
|
|
what core-specific commands may be available
|
|
(@pxref{Architecture and Core Commands}),
|
|
and more.
|
|
|
|
It's easy to see what target types are supported,
|
|
since there's a command to list them.
|
|
|
|
@anchor{targettypes}
|
|
@deffn {Command} {target types}
|
|
Lists all supported target types.
|
|
At this writing, the supported CPU types are:
|
|
|
|
@itemize @bullet
|
|
@item @code{aarch64} -- this is an ARMv8-A core with an MMU.
|
|
@item @code{arm11} -- this is a generation of ARMv6 cores.
|
|
@item @code{arm720t} -- this is an ARMv4 core with an MMU.
|
|
@item @code{arm7tdmi} -- this is an ARMv4 core.
|
|
@item @code{arm920t} -- this is an ARMv4 core with an MMU.
|
|
@item @code{arm926ejs} -- this is an ARMv5 core with an MMU.
|
|
@item @code{arm946e} -- this is an ARMv5 core with an MMU.
|
|
@item @code{arm966e} -- this is an ARMv5 core.
|
|
@item @code{arm9tdmi} -- this is an ARMv4 core.
|
|
@item @code{avr} -- implements Atmel's 8-bit AVR instruction set.
|
|
(Support for this is preliminary and incomplete.)
|
|
@item @code{avr32_ap7k} -- this an AVR32 core.
|
|
@item @code{cortex_a} -- this is an ARMv7-A core with an MMU.
|
|
@item @code{cortex_m} -- this is an ARMv7-M core, supporting only the
|
|
compact Thumb2 instruction set. Supports also ARMv6-M and ARMv8-M cores
|
|
@item @code{cortex_r4} -- this is an ARMv7-R core.
|
|
@item @code{dragonite} -- resembles arm966e.
|
|
@item @code{dsp563xx} -- implements Freescale's 24-bit DSP.
|
|
(Support for this is still incomplete.)
|
|
@item @code{dsp5680xx} -- implements Freescale's 5680x DSP.
|
|
@item @code{esirisc} -- this is an EnSilica eSi-RISC core.
|
|
The current implementation supports eSi-32xx cores.
|
|
@item @code{esp32} -- this is an Espressif SoC with dual Xtensa cores.
|
|
@item @code{esp32s2} -- this is an Espressif SoC with single Xtensa core.
|
|
@item @code{esp32s3} -- this is an Espressif SoC with dual Xtensa cores.
|
|
@item @code{fa526} -- resembles arm920 (w/o Thumb).
|
|
@item @code{feroceon} -- resembles arm926.
|
|
@item @code{hla_target} -- a Cortex-M alternative to work with HL adapters like ST-Link.
|
|
@item @code{ls1_sap} -- this is the SAP on NXP LS102x CPUs,
|
|
allowing access to physical memory addresses independently of CPU cores.
|
|
@item @code{mem_ap} -- this is an ARM debug infrastructure Access Port without
|
|
a CPU, through which bus read and write cycles can be generated; it may be
|
|
useful for working with non-CPU hardware behind an AP or during development of
|
|
support for new CPUs.
|
|
It's possible to connect a GDB client to this target (the GDB port has to be
|
|
specified, @xref{gdbportoverride,,option -gdb-port}.), and a fake ARM core will
|
|
be emulated to comply to GDB remote protocol.
|
|
@item @code{mips_m4k} -- a MIPS core.
|
|
@item @code{mips_mips64} -- a MIPS64 core.
|
|
@item @code{or1k} -- this is an OpenRISC 1000 core.
|
|
The current implementation supports three JTAG TAP cores:
|
|
@itemize @minus
|
|
@item @code{OpenCores TAP} (See: @url{http://opencores.org/project@comma{}jtag})
|
|
@item @code{Altera Virtual JTAG TAP} (See: @url{http://www.altera.com/literature/ug/ug_virtualjtag.pdf})
|
|
@item @code{Xilinx BSCAN_* virtual JTAG interface} (See: @url{http://www.xilinx.com/support/documentation/sw_manuals/xilinx14_2/spartan6_hdl.pdf})
|
|
@end itemize
|
|
And two debug interfaces cores:
|
|
@itemize @minus
|
|
@item @code{Advanced debug interface}
|
|
@*(See: @url{http://opencores.org/project@comma{}adv_debug_sys})
|
|
@item @code{SoC Debug Interface}
|
|
@*(See: @url{http://opencores.org/project@comma{}dbg_interface})
|
|
@end itemize
|
|
@item @code{quark_d20xx} -- an Intel Quark D20xx core.
|
|
@item @code{quark_x10xx} -- an Intel Quark X10xx core.
|
|
@item @code{riscv} -- a RISC-V core.
|
|
@item @code{stm8} -- implements an STM8 core.
|
|
@item @code{testee} -- a dummy target for cases without a real CPU, e.g. CPLD.
|
|
@item @code{xscale} -- this is actually an architecture,
|
|
not a CPU type. It is based on the ARMv5 architecture.
|
|
@item @code{xtensa} -- this is a generic Cadence/Tensilica Xtensa core.
|
|
@end itemize
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
|
|
To avoid being confused by the variety of ARM based cores, remember
|
|
this key point: @emph{ARM is a technology licencing company}.
|
|
(See: @url{http://www.arm.com}.)
|
|
The CPU name used by OpenOCD will reflect the CPU design that was
|
|
licensed, not a vendor brand which incorporates that design.
|
|
Name prefixes like arm7, arm9, arm11, and cortex
|
|
reflect design generations;
|
|
while names like ARMv4, ARMv5, ARMv6, ARMv7 and ARMv8
|
|
reflect an architecture version implemented by a CPU design.
|
|
|
|
@anchor{targetconfiguration}
|
|
@section Target Configuration
|
|
|
|
Before creating a ``target'', you must have added its TAP to the scan chain.
|
|
When you've added that TAP, you will have a @code{dotted.name}
|
|
which is used to set up the CPU support.
|
|
The chip-specific configuration file will normally configure its CPU(s)
|
|
right after it adds all of the chip's TAPs to the scan chain.
|
|
|
|
Although you can set up a target in one step, it's often clearer if you
|
|
use shorter commands and do it in two steps: create it, then configure
|
|
optional parts.
|
|
All operations on the target after it's created will use a new
|
|
command, created as part of target creation.
|
|
|
|
The two main things to configure after target creation are
|
|
a work area, which usually has target-specific defaults even
|
|
if the board setup code overrides them later;
|
|
and event handlers (@pxref{targetevents,,Target Events}), which tend
|
|
to be much more board-specific.
|
|
The key steps you use might look something like this
|
|
|
|
@example
|
|
dap create mychip.dap -chain-position mychip.cpu
|
|
target create MyTarget cortex_m -dap mychip.dap
|
|
MyTarget configure -work-area-phys 0x08000 -work-area-size 8096
|
|
MyTarget configure -event reset-deassert-pre @{ jtag_rclk 5 @}
|
|
MyTarget configure -event reset-init @{ myboard_reinit @}
|
|
@end example
|
|
|
|
You should specify a working area if you can; typically it uses some
|
|
on-chip SRAM.
|
|
Such a working area can speed up many things, including bulk
|
|
writes to target memory;
|
|
flash operations like checking to see if memory needs to be erased;
|
|
GDB memory checksumming;
|
|
and more.
|
|
|
|
@quotation Warning
|
|
On more complex chips, the work area can become
|
|
inaccessible when application code
|
|
(such as an operating system)
|
|
enables or disables the MMU.
|
|
For example, the particular MMU context used to access the virtual
|
|
address will probably matter ... and that context might not have
|
|
easy access to other addresses needed.
|
|
At this writing, OpenOCD doesn't have much MMU intelligence.
|
|
@end quotation
|
|
|
|
It's often very useful to define a @code{reset-init} event handler.
|
|
For systems that are normally used with a boot loader,
|
|
common tasks include updating clocks and initializing memory
|
|
controllers.
|
|
That may be needed to let you write the boot loader into flash,
|
|
in order to ``de-brick'' your board; or to load programs into
|
|
external DDR memory without having run the boot loader.
|
|
|
|
@deffn {Config Command} {target create} target_name type configparams...
|
|
This command creates a GDB debug target that refers to a specific JTAG tap.
|
|
It enters that target into a list, and creates a new
|
|
command (@command{@var{target_name}}) which is used for various
|
|
purposes including additional configuration.
|
|
|
|
@itemize @bullet
|
|
@item @var{target_name} ... is the name of the debug target.
|
|
By convention this should be the same as the @emph{dotted.name}
|
|
of the TAP associated with this target, which must be specified here
|
|
using the @code{-chain-position @var{dotted.name}} configparam.
|
|
|
|
This name is also used to create the target object command,
|
|
referred to here as @command{$target_name},
|
|
and in other places the target needs to be identified.
|
|
@item @var{type} ... specifies the target type. @xref{targettypes,,target types}.
|
|
@item @var{configparams} ... all parameters accepted by
|
|
@command{$target_name configure} are permitted.
|
|
If the target is big-endian, set it here with @code{-endian big}.
|
|
|
|
You @emph{must} set the @code{-chain-position @var{dotted.name}} or
|
|
@code{-dap @var{dap_name}} here.
|
|
@end itemize
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
|
|
@deffn {Command} {$target_name configure} configparams...
|
|
The options accepted by this command may also be
|
|
specified as parameters to @command{target create}.
|
|
Their values can later be queried one at a time by
|
|
using the @command{$target_name cget} command.
|
|
|
|
@emph{Warning:} changing some of these after setup is dangerous.
|
|
For example, moving a target from one TAP to another;
|
|
and changing its endianness.
|
|
|
|
@itemize @bullet
|
|
|
|
@item @code{-chain-position} @var{dotted.name} -- names the TAP
|
|
used to access this target.
|
|
|
|
@item @code{-dap} @var{dap_name} -- names the DAP used to access
|
|
this target. @xref{dapdeclaration,,DAP declaration}, on how to
|
|
create and manage DAP instances.
|
|
|
|
@item @code{-endian} (@option{big}|@option{little}) -- specifies
|
|
whether the CPU uses big or little endian conventions
|
|
|
|
@item @code{-event} @var{event_name} @var{event_body} --
|
|
@xref{targetevents,,Target Events}.
|
|
Note that this updates a list of named event handlers.
|
|
Calling this twice with two different event names assigns
|
|
two different handlers, but calling it twice with the
|
|
same event name assigns only one handler.
|
|
|
|
Current target is temporarily overridden to the event issuing target
|
|
before handler code starts and switched back after handler is done.
|
|
|
|
@item @code{-work-area-backup} (@option{0}|@option{1}) -- says
|
|
whether the work area gets backed up; by default,
|
|
@emph{it is not backed up.}
|
|
When possible, use a working_area that doesn't need to be backed up,
|
|
since performing a backup slows down operations.
|
|
For example, the beginning of an SRAM block is likely to
|
|
be used by most build systems, but the end is often unused.
|
|
|
|
@item @code{-work-area-size} @var{size} -- specify work are size,
|
|
in bytes. The same size applies regardless of whether its physical
|
|
or virtual address is being used.
|
|
|
|
@item @code{-work-area-phys} @var{address} -- set the work area
|
|
base @var{address} to be used when no MMU is active.
|
|
|
|
@item @code{-work-area-virt} @var{address} -- set the work area
|
|
base @var{address} to be used when an MMU is active.
|
|
@emph{Do not specify a value for this except on targets with an MMU.}
|
|
The value should normally correspond to a static mapping for the
|
|
@code{-work-area-phys} address, set up by the current operating system.
|
|
|
|
@anchor{rtostype}
|
|
@item @code{-rtos} @var{rtos_type} -- enable rtos support for target,
|
|
@var{rtos_type} can be one of @option{auto}, @option{none}, @option{eCos},
|
|
@option{ThreadX}, @option{FreeRTOS}, @option{linux}, @option{ChibiOS},
|
|
@option{embKernel}, @option{mqx}, @option{uCOS-III}, @option{nuttx},
|
|
@option{RIOT}, @option{Zephyr}, @option{rtkernel}
|
|
@xref{gdbrtossupport,,RTOS Support}.
|
|
|
|
@item @code{-defer-examine} -- skip target examination at initial JTAG chain
|
|
scan and after a reset. A manual call to arp_examine is required to
|
|
access the target for debugging.
|
|
|
|
@item @code{-ap-num} @var{ap_number} -- set DAP access port for target.
|
|
On ADIv5 DAP @var{ap_number} is the numeric index of the DAP AP the target is connected to.
|
|
On ADIv6 DAP @var{ap_number} is the base address of the DAP AP the target is connected to.
|
|
Use this option with systems where multiple, independent cores are connected
|
|
to separate access ports of the same DAP.
|
|
|
|
@item @code{-cti} @var{cti_name} -- set Cross-Trigger Interface (CTI) connected
|
|
to the target. Currently, only the @code{aarch64} target makes use of this option,
|
|
where it is a mandatory configuration for the target run control.
|
|
@xref{armcrosstrigger,,ARM Cross-Trigger Interface},
|
|
for instruction on how to declare and control a CTI instance.
|
|
|
|
@anchor{gdbportoverride}
|
|
@item @code{-gdb-port} @var{number} -- see command @command{gdb_port} for the
|
|
possible values of the parameter @var{number}, which are not only numeric values.
|
|
Use this option to override, for this target only, the global parameter set with
|
|
command @command{gdb_port}.
|
|
@xref{gdb_port,,command gdb_port}.
|
|
|
|
@item @code{-gdb-max-connections} @var{number} -- EXPERIMENTAL: set the maximum
|
|
number of GDB connections that are allowed for the target. Default is 1.
|
|
A negative value for @var{number} means unlimited connections.
|
|
See @xref{gdbmeminspect,,Using GDB as a non-intrusive memory inspector}.
|
|
@end itemize
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
|
|
@section Other $target_name Commands
|
|
@cindex object command
|
|
|
|
The Tcl/Tk language has the concept of object commands,
|
|
and OpenOCD adopts that same model for targets.
|
|
|
|
A good Tk example is a on screen button.
|
|
Once a button is created a button
|
|
has a name (a path in Tk terms) and that name is useable as a first
|
|
class command. For example in Tk, one can create a button and later
|
|
configure it like this:
|
|
|
|
@example
|
|
# Create
|
|
button .foobar -background red -command @{ foo @}
|
|
# Modify
|
|
.foobar configure -foreground blue
|
|
# Query
|
|
set x [.foobar cget -background]
|
|
# Report
|
|
puts [format "The button is %s" $x]
|
|
@end example
|
|
|
|
In OpenOCD's terms, the ``target'' is an object just like a Tcl/Tk
|
|
button, and its object commands are invoked the same way.
|
|
|
|
@example
|
|
str912.cpu mww 0x1234 0x42
|
|
omap3530.cpu mww 0x5555 123
|
|
@end example
|
|
|
|
The commands supported by OpenOCD target objects are:
|
|
|
|
@deffn {Command} {$target_name arp_examine} @option{allow-defer}
|
|
@deffnx {Command} {$target_name arp_halt}
|
|
@deffnx {Command} {$target_name arp_poll}
|
|
@deffnx {Command} {$target_name arp_reset}
|
|
@deffnx {Command} {$target_name arp_waitstate}
|
|
Internal OpenOCD scripts (most notably @file{startup.tcl})
|
|
use these to deal with specific reset cases.
|
|
They are not otherwise documented here.
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
|
|
@deffn {Command} {$target_name set_reg} dict
|
|
Set register values of the target.
|
|
|
|
@itemize
|
|
@item @var{dict} ... Tcl dictionary with pairs of register names and values.
|
|
@end itemize
|
|
|
|
For example, the following command sets the value 0 to the program counter (pc)
|
|
register and 0x1000 to the stack pointer (sp) register:
|
|
|
|
@example
|
|
set_reg @{pc 0 sp 0x1000@}
|
|
@end example
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
|
|
@deffn {Command} {$target_name get_reg} [-force] list
|
|
Get register values from the target and return them as Tcl dictionary with pairs
|
|
of register names and values.
|
|
If option "-force" is set, the register values are read directly from the
|
|
target, bypassing any caching.
|
|
|
|
@itemize
|
|
@item @var{list} ... List of register names
|
|
@end itemize
|
|
|
|
For example, the following command retrieves the values from the program
|
|
counter (pc) and stack pointer (sp) register:
|
|
|
|
@example
|
|
get_reg @{pc sp@}
|
|
@end example
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
|
|
@deffn {Command} {$target_name write_memory} address width data ['phys']
|
|
This function provides an efficient way to write to the target memory from a Tcl
|
|
script.
|
|
|
|
@itemize
|
|
@item @var{address} ... target memory address
|
|
@item @var{width} ... memory access bit size, can be 8, 16, 32 or 64
|
|
@item @var{data} ... Tcl list with the elements to write
|
|
@item ['phys'] ... treat the memory address as physical instead of virtual address
|
|
@end itemize
|
|
|
|
For example, the following command writes two 32 bit words into the target
|
|
memory at address 0x20000000:
|
|
|
|
@example
|
|
write_memory 0x20000000 32 @{0xdeadbeef 0x00230500@}
|
|
@end example
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
|
|
@deffn {Command} {$target_name read_memory} address width count ['phys']
|
|
This function provides an efficient way to read the target memory from a Tcl
|
|
script.
|
|
A Tcl list containing the requested memory elements is returned by this function.
|
|
|
|
@itemize
|
|
@item @var{address} ... target memory address
|
|
@item @var{width} ... memory access bit size, can be 8, 16, 32 or 64
|
|
@item @var{count} ... number of elements to read
|
|
@item ['phys'] ... treat the memory address as physical instead of virtual address
|
|
@end itemize
|
|
|
|
For example, the following command reads two 32 bit words from the target
|
|
memory at address 0x20000000:
|
|
|
|
@example
|
|
read_memory 0x20000000 32 2
|
|
@end example
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
|
|
@deffn {Command} {$target_name cget} queryparm
|
|
Each configuration parameter accepted by
|
|
@command{$target_name configure}
|
|
can be individually queried, to return its current value.
|
|
The @var{queryparm} is a parameter name
|
|
accepted by that command, such as @code{-work-area-phys}.
|
|
There are a few special cases:
|
|
|
|
@itemize @bullet
|
|
@item @code{-event} @var{event_name} -- returns the handler for the
|
|
event named @var{event_name}.
|
|
This is a special case because setting a handler requires
|
|
two parameters.
|
|
@item @code{-type} -- returns the target type.
|
|
This is a special case because this is set using
|
|
@command{target create} and can't be changed
|
|
using @command{$target_name configure}.
|
|
@end itemize
|
|
|
|
For example, if you wanted to summarize information about
|
|
all the targets you might use something like this:
|
|
|
|
@example
|
|
foreach name [target names] @{
|
|
set y [$name cget -endian]
|
|
set z [$name cget -type]
|
|
puts [format "Chip %d is %s, Endian: %s, type: %s" \
|
|
$x $name $y $z]
|
|
@}
|
|
@end example
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
|
|
@anchor{targetcurstate}
|
|
@deffn {Command} {$target_name curstate}
|
|
Displays the current target state:
|
|
@code{debug-running},
|
|
@code{halted},
|
|
@code{reset},
|
|
@code{running}, or @code{unknown}.
|
|
(Also, @pxref{eventpolling,,Event Polling}.)
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
|
|
@deffn {Command} {$target_name eventlist}
|
|
Displays a table listing all event handlers
|
|
currently associated with this target.
|
|
@xref{targetevents,,Target Events}.
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
|
|
@deffn {Command} {$target_name invoke-event} event_name
|
|
Invokes the handler for the event named @var{event_name}.
|
|
(This is primarily intended for use by OpenOCD framework
|
|
code, for example by the reset code in @file{startup.tcl}.)
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
|
|
@deffn {Command} {$target_name mdd} [phys] addr [count]
|
|
@deffnx {Command} {$target_name mdw} [phys] addr [count]
|
|
@deffnx {Command} {$target_name mdh} [phys] addr [count]
|
|
@deffnx {Command} {$target_name mdb} [phys] addr [count]
|
|
Display contents of address @var{addr}, as
|
|
64-bit doublewords (@command{mdd}),
|
|
32-bit words (@command{mdw}), 16-bit halfwords (@command{mdh}),
|
|
or 8-bit bytes (@command{mdb}).
|
|
When the current target has an MMU which is present and active,
|
|
@var{addr} is interpreted as a virtual address.
|
|
Otherwise, or if the optional @var{phys} flag is specified,
|
|
@var{addr} is interpreted as a physical address.
|
|
If @var{count} is specified, displays that many units.
|
|
(If you want to process the data instead of displaying it,
|
|
see the @code{read_memory} primitives.)
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
|
|
@deffn {Command} {$target_name mwd} [phys] addr doubleword [count]
|
|
@deffnx {Command} {$target_name mww} [phys] addr word [count]
|
|
@deffnx {Command} {$target_name mwh} [phys] addr halfword [count]
|
|
@deffnx {Command} {$target_name mwb} [phys] addr byte [count]
|
|
Writes the specified @var{doubleword} (64 bits), @var{word} (32 bits),
|
|
@var{halfword} (16 bits), or @var{byte} (8-bit) value,
|
|
at the specified address @var{addr}.
|
|
When the current target has an MMU which is present and active,
|
|
@var{addr} is interpreted as a virtual address.
|
|
Otherwise, or if the optional @var{phys} flag is specified,
|
|
@var{addr} is interpreted as a physical address.
|
|
If @var{count} is specified, fills that many units of consecutive address.
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
|
|
@anchor{targetevents}
|
|
@section Target Events
|
|
@cindex target events
|
|
@cindex events
|
|
At various times, certain things can happen, or you want them to happen.
|
|
For example:
|
|
@itemize @bullet
|
|
@item What should happen when GDB connects? Should your target reset?
|
|
@item When GDB tries to flash the target, do you need to enable the flash via a special command?
|
|
@item Is using SRST appropriate (and possible) on your system?
|
|
Or instead of that, do you need to issue JTAG commands to trigger reset?
|
|
SRST usually resets everything on the scan chain, which can be inappropriate.
|
|
@item During reset, do you need to write to certain memory locations
|
|
to set up system clocks or
|
|
to reconfigure the SDRAM?
|
|
How about configuring the watchdog timer, or other peripherals,
|
|
to stop running while you hold the core stopped for debugging?
|
|
@end itemize
|
|
|
|
All of the above items can be addressed by target event handlers.
|
|
These are set up by @command{$target_name configure -event} or
|
|
@command{target create ... -event}.
|
|
|
|
The programmer's model matches the @code{-command} option used in Tcl/Tk
|
|
buttons and events. The two examples below act the same, but one creates
|
|
and invokes a small procedure while the other inlines it.
|
|
|
|
@example
|
|
proc my_init_proc @{ @} @{
|
|
echo "Disabling watchdog..."
|
|
mww 0xfffffd44 0x00008000
|
|
@}
|
|
mychip.cpu configure -event reset-init my_init_proc
|
|
mychip.cpu configure -event reset-init @{
|
|
echo "Disabling watchdog..."
|
|
mww 0xfffffd44 0x00008000
|
|
@}
|
|
@end example
|
|
|
|
The following target events are defined:
|
|
|
|
@itemize @bullet
|
|
@item @b{debug-halted}
|
|
@* The target has halted for debug reasons (i.e.: breakpoint)
|
|
@item @b{debug-resumed}
|
|
@* The target has resumed (i.e.: GDB said run)
|
|
@item @b{early-halted}
|
|
@* Occurs early in the halt process
|
|
@item @b{examine-start}
|
|
@* Before target examine is called.
|
|
@item @b{examine-end}
|
|
@* After target examine is called with no errors.
|
|
@item @b{examine-fail}
|
|
@* After target examine fails.
|
|
@item @b{gdb-attach}
|
|
@* When GDB connects. Issued before any GDB communication with the target
|
|
starts. GDB expects the target is halted during attachment.
|
|
@xref{gdbmeminspect,,GDB as a non-intrusive memory inspector}, how to
|
|
connect GDB to running target.
|
|
The event can be also used to set up the target so it is possible to probe flash.
|
|
Probing flash is necessary during GDB connect if you want to use
|
|
@pxref{programmingusinggdb,,programming using GDB}.
|
|
Another use of the flash memory map is for GDB to automatically choose
|
|
hardware or software breakpoints depending on whether the breakpoint
|
|
is in RAM or read only memory.
|
|
Default is @code{halt}
|
|
@item @b{gdb-detach}
|
|
@* When GDB disconnects
|
|
@item @b{gdb-end}
|
|
@* When the target has halted and GDB is not doing anything (see early halt)
|
|
@item @b{gdb-flash-erase-start}
|
|
@* Before the GDB flash process tries to erase the flash (default is
|
|
@code{reset init})
|
|
@item @b{gdb-flash-erase-end}
|
|
@* After the GDB flash process has finished erasing the flash
|
|
@item @b{gdb-flash-write-start}
|
|
@* Before GDB writes to the flash
|
|
@item @b{gdb-flash-write-end}
|
|
@* After GDB writes to the flash (default is @code{reset halt})
|
|
@item @b{gdb-start}
|
|
@* Before the target steps, GDB is trying to start/resume the target
|
|
@item @b{halted}
|
|
@* The target has halted
|
|
@item @b{reset-assert-pre}
|
|
@* Issued as part of @command{reset} processing
|
|
after @command{reset-start} was triggered
|
|
but before either SRST alone is asserted on the scan chain,
|
|
or @code{reset-assert} is triggered.
|
|
@item @b{reset-assert}
|
|
@* Issued as part of @command{reset} processing
|
|
after @command{reset-assert-pre} was triggered.
|
|
When such a handler is present, cores which support this event will use
|
|
it instead of asserting SRST.
|
|
This support is essential for debugging with JTAG interfaces which
|
|
don't include an SRST line (JTAG doesn't require SRST), and for
|
|
selective reset on scan chains that have multiple targets.
|
|
@item @b{reset-assert-post}
|
|
@* Issued as part of @command{reset} processing
|
|
after @code{reset-assert} has been triggered.
|
|
or the target asserted SRST on the entire scan chain.
|
|
@item @b{reset-deassert-pre}
|
|
@* Issued as part of @command{reset} processing
|
|
after @code{reset-assert-post} has been triggered.
|
|
@item @b{reset-deassert-post}
|
|
@* Issued as part of @command{reset} processing
|
|
after @code{reset-deassert-pre} has been triggered
|
|
and (if the target is using it) after SRST has been
|
|
released on the scan chain.
|
|
@item @b{reset-end}
|
|
@* Issued as the final step in @command{reset} processing.
|
|
@item @b{reset-init}
|
|
@* Used by @b{reset init} command for board-specific initialization.
|
|
This event fires after @emph{reset-deassert-post}.
|
|
|
|
This is where you would configure PLLs and clocking, set up DRAM so
|
|
you can download programs that don't fit in on-chip SRAM, set up pin
|
|
multiplexing, and so on.
|
|
(You may be able to switch to a fast JTAG clock rate here, after
|
|
the target clocks are fully set up.)
|
|
@item @b{reset-start}
|
|
@* Issued as the first step in @command{reset} processing
|
|
before @command{reset-assert-pre} is called.
|
|
|
|
This is the most robust place to use @command{jtag_rclk}
|
|
or @command{adapter speed} to switch to a low JTAG clock rate,
|
|
when reset disables PLLs needed to use a fast clock.
|
|
@item @b{resume-start}
|
|
@* Before any target is resumed
|
|
@item @b{resume-end}
|
|
@* After all targets have resumed
|
|
@item @b{resumed}
|
|
@* Target has resumed
|
|
@item @b{step-start}
|
|
@* Before a target is single-stepped
|
|
@item @b{step-end}
|
|
@* After single-step has completed
|
|
@item @b{trace-config}
|
|
@* After target hardware trace configuration was changed
|
|
@item @b{semihosting-user-cmd-0x100}
|
|
@* The target made a semihosting call with user-defined operation number 0x100
|
|
@item @b{semihosting-user-cmd-0x101}
|
|
@* The target made a semihosting call with user-defined operation number 0x101
|
|
@item @b{semihosting-user-cmd-0x102}
|
|
@* The target made a semihosting call with user-defined operation number 0x102
|
|
@item @b{semihosting-user-cmd-0x103}
|
|
@* The target made a semihosting call with user-defined operation number 0x103
|
|
@item @b{semihosting-user-cmd-0x104}
|
|
@* The target made a semihosting call with user-defined operation number 0x104
|
|
@item @b{semihosting-user-cmd-0x105}
|
|
@* The target made a semihosting call with user-defined operation number 0x105
|
|
@item @b{semihosting-user-cmd-0x106}
|
|
@* The target made a semihosting call with user-defined operation number 0x106
|
|
@item @b{semihosting-user-cmd-0x107}
|
|
@* The target made a semihosting call with user-defined operation number 0x107
|
|
@end itemize
|
|
|
|
@quotation Note
|
|
OpenOCD events are not supposed to be preempt by another event, but this
|
|
is not enforced in current code. Only the target event @b{resumed} is
|
|
executed with polling disabled; this avoids polling to trigger the event
|
|
@b{halted}, reversing the logical order of execution of their handlers.
|
|
Future versions of OpenOCD will prevent the event preemption and will
|
|
disable the schedule of polling during the event execution. Do not rely
|
|
on polling in any event handler; this means, don't expect the status of
|
|
a core to change during the execution of the handler. The event handler
|
|
will have to enable polling or use @command{$target_name arp_poll} to
|
|
check if the core has changed status.
|
|
@end quotation
|
|
|
|
@node Flash Commands
|
|
@chapter Flash Commands
|
|
|
|
OpenOCD has different commands for NOR and NAND flash;
|
|
the ``flash'' command works with NOR flash, while
|
|
the ``nand'' command works with NAND flash.
|
|
This partially reflects different hardware technologies:
|
|
NOR flash usually supports direct CPU instruction and data bus access,
|
|
while data from a NAND flash must be copied to memory before it can be
|
|
used. (SPI flash must also be copied to memory before use.)
|
|
However, the documentation also uses ``flash'' as a generic term;
|
|
for example, ``Put flash configuration in board-specific files''.
|
|
|
|
Flash Steps:
|
|
@enumerate
|
|
@item Configure via the command @command{flash bank}
|
|
@* Do this in a board-specific configuration file,
|
|
passing parameters as needed by the driver.
|
|
@item Operate on the flash via @command{flash subcommand}
|
|
@* Often commands to manipulate the flash are typed by a human, or run
|
|
via a script in some automated way. Common tasks include writing a
|
|
boot loader, operating system, or other data.
|
|
@item GDB Flashing
|
|
@* Flashing via GDB requires the flash be configured via ``flash
|
|
bank'', and the GDB flash features be enabled.
|
|
@xref{gdbconfiguration,,GDB Configuration}.
|
|
@end enumerate
|
|
|
|
Many CPUs have the ability to ``boot'' from the first flash bank.
|
|
This means that misprogramming that bank can ``brick'' a system,
|
|
so that it can't boot.
|
|
JTAG tools, like OpenOCD, are often then used to ``de-brick'' the
|
|
board by (re)installing working boot firmware.
|
|
|
|
@anchor{norconfiguration}
|
|
@section Flash Configuration Commands
|
|
@cindex flash configuration
|
|
|
|
@deffn {Config Command} {flash bank} name driver base size chip_width bus_width target [driver_options]
|
|
Configures a flash bank which provides persistent storage
|
|
for addresses from @math{base} to @math{base + size - 1}.
|
|
These banks will often be visible to GDB through the target's memory map.
|
|
In some cases, configuring a flash bank will activate extra commands;
|
|
see the driver-specific documentation.
|
|
|
|
@itemize @bullet
|
|
@item @var{name} ... may be used to reference the flash bank
|
|
in other flash commands. A number is also available.
|
|
@item @var{driver} ... identifies the controller driver
|
|
associated with the flash bank being declared.
|
|
This is usually @code{cfi} for external flash, or else
|
|
the name of a microcontroller with embedded flash memory.
|
|
@xref{flashdriverlist,,Flash Driver List}.
|
|
@item @var{base} ... Base address of the flash chip.
|
|
@item @var{size} ... Size of the chip, in bytes.
|
|
For some drivers, this value is detected from the hardware.
|
|
@item @var{chip_width} ... Width of the flash chip, in bytes;
|
|
ignored for most microcontroller drivers.
|
|
@item @var{bus_width} ... Width of the data bus used to access the
|
|
chip, in bytes; ignored for most microcontroller drivers.
|
|
@item @var{target} ... Names the target used to issue
|
|
commands to the flash controller.
|
|
@comment Actually, it's currently a controller-specific parameter...
|
|
@item @var{driver_options} ... drivers may support, or require,
|
|
additional parameters. See the driver-specific documentation
|
|
for more information.
|
|
@end itemize
|
|
@quotation Note
|
|
This command is not available after OpenOCD initialization has completed.
|
|
Use it in board specific configuration files, not interactively.
|
|
@end quotation
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
|
|
@comment less confusing would be: "flash list" (like "nand list")
|
|
@deffn {Command} {flash banks}
|
|
Prints a one-line summary of each device that was
|
|
declared using @command{flash bank}, numbered from zero.
|
|
Note that this is the @emph{plural} form;
|
|
the @emph{singular} form is a very different command.
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
|
|
@deffn {Command} {flash list}
|
|
Retrieves a list of associative arrays for each device that was
|
|
declared using @command{flash bank}, numbered from zero.
|
|
This returned list can be manipulated easily from within scripts.
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
|
|
@deffn {Command} {flash probe} num
|
|
Identify the flash, or validate the parameters of the configured flash. Operation
|
|
depends on the flash type.
|
|
The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
|
|
Most flash commands will implicitly @emph{autoprobe} the bank;
|
|
flash drivers can distinguish between probing and autoprobing,
|
|
but most don't bother.
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
|
|
@section Preparing a Target before Flash Programming
|
|
|
|
The target device should be in well defined state before the flash programming
|
|
begins.
|
|
|
|
@emph{Always issue} @command{reset init} before @ref{flashprogrammingcommands,,Flash Programming Commands}.
|
|
Do not issue another @command{reset} or @command{reset halt} or @command{resume}
|
|
until the programming session is finished.
|
|
|
|
If you use @ref{programmingusinggdb,,Programming using GDB},
|
|
the target is prepared automatically in the event gdb-flash-erase-start
|
|
|
|
The jimtcl script @command{program} calls @command{reset init} explicitly.
|
|
|
|
@section Erasing, Reading, Writing to Flash
|
|
@cindex flash erasing
|
|
@cindex flash reading
|
|
@cindex flash writing
|
|
@cindex flash programming
|
|
@anchor{flashprogrammingcommands}
|
|
|
|
One feature distinguishing NOR flash from NAND or serial flash technologies
|
|
is that for read access, it acts exactly like any other addressable memory.
|
|
This means you can use normal memory read commands like @command{mdw} or
|
|
@command{dump_image} with it, with no special @command{flash} subcommands.
|
|
@xref{memoryaccess,,Memory access}, and @ref{imageaccess,,Image access}.
|
|
|
|
Write access works differently. Flash memory normally needs to be erased
|
|
before it's written. Erasing a sector turns all of its bits to ones, and
|
|
writing can turn ones into zeroes. This is why there are special commands
|
|
for interactive erasing and writing, and why GDB needs to know which parts
|
|
of the address space hold NOR flash memory.
|
|
|
|
@quotation Note
|
|
Most of these erase and write commands leverage the fact that NOR flash
|
|
chips consume target address space. They implicitly refer to the current
|
|
JTAG target, and map from an address in that target's address space
|
|
back to a flash bank.
|
|
@comment In May 2009, those mappings may fail if any bank associated
|
|
@comment with that target doesn't successfully autoprobe ... bug worth fixing?
|
|
A few commands use abstract addressing based on bank and sector numbers,
|
|
and don't depend on searching the current target and its address space.
|
|
Avoid confusing the two command models.
|
|
@end quotation
|
|
|
|
Some flash chips implement software protection against accidental writes,
|
|
since such buggy writes could in some cases ``brick'' a system.
|
|
For such systems, erasing and writing may require sector protection to be
|
|
disabled first.
|
|
Examples include CFI flash such as ``Intel Advanced Bootblock flash'',
|
|
and AT91SAM7 on-chip flash.
|
|
@xref{flashprotect,,flash protect}.
|
|
|
|
@deffn {Command} {flash erase_sector} num first last
|
|
Erase sectors in bank @var{num}, starting at sector @var{first}
|
|
up to and including @var{last}.
|
|
Sector numbering starts at 0.
|
|
Providing a @var{last} sector of @option{last}
|
|
specifies "to the end of the flash bank".
|
|
The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
|
|
@deffn {Command} {flash erase_address} [@option{pad}] [@option{unlock}] address length
|
|
Erase sectors starting at @var{address} for @var{length} bytes.
|
|
Unless @option{pad} is specified, @math{address} must begin a
|
|
flash sector, and @math{address + length - 1} must end a sector.
|
|
Specifying @option{pad} erases extra data at the beginning and/or
|
|
end of the specified region, as needed to erase only full sectors.
|
|
The flash bank to use is inferred from the @var{address}, and
|
|
the specified length must stay within that bank.
|
|
As a special case, when @var{length} is zero and @var{address} is
|
|
the start of the bank, the whole flash is erased.
|
|
If @option{unlock} is specified, then the flash is unprotected
|
|
before erase starts.
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
|
|
@deffn {Command} {flash filld} address double-word length
|
|
@deffnx {Command} {flash fillw} address word length
|
|
@deffnx {Command} {flash fillh} address halfword length
|
|
@deffnx {Command} {flash fillb} address byte length
|
|
Fills flash memory with the specified @var{double-word} (64 bits), @var{word} (32 bits),
|
|
@var{halfword} (16 bits), or @var{byte} (8-bit) pattern,
|
|
starting at @var{address} and continuing
|
|
for @var{length} units (word/halfword/byte).
|
|
No erasure is done before writing; when needed, that must be done
|
|
before issuing this command.
|
|
Writes are done in blocks of up to 1024 bytes, and each write is
|
|
verified by reading back the data and comparing it to what was written.
|
|
The flash bank to use is inferred from the @var{address} of
|
|
each block, and the specified length must stay within that bank.
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
@comment no current checks for errors if fill blocks touch multiple banks!
|
|
|
|
@deffn {Command} {flash mdw} addr [count]
|
|
@deffnx {Command} {flash mdh} addr [count]
|
|
@deffnx {Command} {flash mdb} addr [count]
|
|
Display contents of address @var{addr}, as
|
|
32-bit words (@command{mdw}), 16-bit halfwords (@command{mdh}),
|
|
or 8-bit bytes (@command{mdb}).
|
|
If @var{count} is specified, displays that many units.
|
|
Reads from flash using the flash driver, therefore it enables reading
|
|
from a bank not mapped in target address space.
|
|
The flash bank to use is inferred from the @var{address} of
|
|
each block, and the specified length must stay within that bank.
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
|
|
@deffn {Command} {flash write_bank} num filename [offset]
|
|
Write the binary @file{filename} to flash bank @var{num},
|
|
starting at @var{offset} bytes from the beginning of the bank. If @var{offset}
|
|
is omitted, start at the beginning of the flash bank.
|
|
The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
|
|
@deffn {Command} {flash read_bank} num filename [offset [length]]
|
|
Read @var{length} bytes from the flash bank @var{num} starting at @var{offset}
|
|
and write the contents to the binary @file{filename}. If @var{offset} is
|
|
omitted, start at the beginning of the flash bank. If @var{length} is omitted,
|
|
read the remaining bytes from the flash bank.
|
|
The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
|
|
@deffn {Command} {flash verify_bank} num filename [offset]
|
|
Compare the contents of the binary file @var{filename} with the contents of the
|
|
flash bank @var{num} starting at @var{offset}. If @var{offset} is omitted,
|
|
start at the beginning of the flash bank. Fail if the contents do not match.
|
|
The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
|
|
@deffn {Command} {flash write_image} [erase] [unlock] filename [offset] [type]
|
|
Write the image @file{filename} to the current target's flash bank(s).
|
|
Only loadable sections from the image are written.
|
|
A relocation @var{offset} may be specified, in which case it is added
|
|
to the base address for each section in the image.
|
|
The file [@var{type}] can be specified
|
|
explicitly as @option{bin} (binary), @option{ihex} (Intel hex),
|
|
@option{elf} (ELF file), @option{s19} (Motorola s19).
|
|
@option{mem}, or @option{builder}.
|
|
The relevant flash sectors will be erased prior to programming
|
|
if the @option{erase} parameter is given. If @option{unlock} is
|
|
provided, then the flash banks are unlocked before erase and
|
|
program. The flash bank to use is inferred from the address of
|
|
each image section.
|
|
|
|
@quotation Warning
|
|
Be careful using the @option{erase} flag when the flash is holding
|
|
data you want to preserve.
|
|
Portions of the flash outside those described in the image's
|
|
sections might be erased with no notice.
|
|
@itemize
|
|
@item
|
|
When a section of the image being written does not fill out all the
|
|
sectors it uses, the unwritten parts of those sectors are necessarily
|
|
also erased, because sectors can't be partially erased.
|
|
@item
|
|
Data stored in sector "holes" between image sections are also affected.
|
|
For example, "@command{flash write_image erase ...}" of an image with
|
|
one byte at the beginning of a flash bank and one byte at the end
|
|
erases the entire bank -- not just the two sectors being written.
|
|
@end itemize
|
|
Also, when flash protection is important, you must re-apply it after
|
|
it has been removed by the @option{unlock} flag.
|
|
@end quotation
|
|
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
|
|
@deffn {Command} {flash verify_image} filename [offset] [type]
|
|
Verify the image @file{filename} to the current target's flash bank(s).
|
|
Parameters follow the description of 'flash write_image'.
|
|
In contrast to the 'verify_image' command, for banks with specific
|
|
verify method, that one is used instead of the usual target's read
|
|
memory methods. This is necessary for flash banks not readable by
|
|
ordinary memory reads.
|
|
This command gives only an overall good/bad result for each bank, not
|
|
addresses of individual failed bytes as it's intended only as quick
|
|
check for successful programming.
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
|
|
@section Other Flash commands
|
|
@cindex flash protection
|
|
|
|
@deffn {Command} {flash erase_check} num
|
|
Check erase state of sectors in flash bank @var{num},
|
|
and display that status.
|
|
The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
|
|
@deffn {Command} {flash info} num [sectors]
|
|
Print info about flash bank @var{num}, a list of protection blocks
|
|
and their status. Use @option{sectors} to show a list of sectors instead.
|
|
|
|
The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
|
|
This command will first query the hardware, it does not print cached
|
|
and possibly stale information.
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
|
|
@anchor{flashprotect}
|
|
@deffn {Command} {flash protect} num first last (@option{on}|@option{off})
|
|
Enable (@option{on}) or disable (@option{off}) protection of flash blocks
|
|
in flash bank @var{num}, starting at protection block @var{first}
|
|
and continuing up to and including @var{last}.
|
|
Providing a @var{last} block of @option{last}
|
|
specifies "to the end of the flash bank".
|
|
The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
|
|
The protection block is usually identical to a flash sector.
|
|
Some devices may utilize a protection block distinct from flash sector.
|
|
See @command{flash info} for a list of protection blocks.
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
|
|
@deffn {Command} {flash padded_value} num value
|
|
Sets the default value used for padding any image sections, This should
|
|
normally match the flash bank erased value. If not specified by this
|
|
command or the flash driver then it defaults to 0xff.
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
|
|
@anchor{program}
|
|
@deffn {Command} {program} filename [preverify] [verify] [reset] [exit] [offset]
|
|
This is a helper script that simplifies using OpenOCD as a standalone
|
|
programmer. The only required parameter is @option{filename}, the others are optional.
|
|
@xref{Flash Programming}.
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
|
|
@anchor{flashdriverlist}
|
|
@section Flash Driver List
|
|
As noted above, the @command{flash bank} command requires a driver name,
|
|
and allows driver-specific options and behaviors.
|
|
Some drivers also activate driver-specific commands.
|
|
|
|
@deffn {Flash Driver} {virtual}
|
|
This is a special driver that maps a previously defined bank to another
|
|
address. All bank settings will be copied from the master physical bank.
|
|
|
|
The @var{virtual} driver defines one mandatory parameters,
|
|
|
|
@itemize
|
|
@item @var{master_bank} The bank that this virtual address refers to.
|
|
@end itemize
|
|
|
|
So in the following example addresses 0xbfc00000 and 0x9fc00000 refer to
|
|
the flash bank defined at address 0x1fc00000. Any command executed on
|
|
the virtual banks is actually performed on the physical banks.
|
|
@example
|
|
flash bank $_FLASHNAME pic32mx 0x1fc00000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
|
|
flash bank vbank0 virtual 0xbfc00000 0 0 0 \
|
|
$_TARGETNAME $_FLASHNAME
|
|
flash bank vbank1 virtual 0x9fc00000 0 0 0 \
|
|
$_TARGETNAME $_FLASHNAME
|
|
@end example
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
|
|
@subsection External Flash
|
|
|
|
@deffn {Flash Driver} {cfi}
|
|
@cindex Common Flash Interface
|
|
@cindex CFI
|
|
The ``Common Flash Interface'' (CFI) is the main standard for
|
|
external NOR flash chips, each of which connects to a
|
|
specific external chip select on the CPU.
|
|
Frequently the first such chip is used to boot the system.
|
|
Your board's @code{reset-init} handler might need to
|
|
configure additional chip selects using other commands (like: @command{mww} to
|
|
configure a bus and its timings), or
|
|
perhaps configure a GPIO pin that controls the ``write protect'' pin
|
|
on the flash chip.
|
|
The CFI driver can use a target-specific working area to significantly
|
|
speed up operation.
|
|
|
|
The CFI driver can accept the following optional parameters, in any order:
|
|
|
|
@itemize
|
|
@item @var{jedec_probe} ... is used to detect certain non-CFI flash ROMs,
|
|
like AM29LV010 and similar types.
|
|
@item @var{x16_as_x8} ... when a 16-bit flash is hooked up to an 8-bit bus.
|
|
@item @var{bus_swap} ... when data bytes in a 16-bit flash needs to be swapped.
|
|
@item @var{data_swap} ... when data bytes in a 16-bit flash needs to be
|
|
swapped when writing data values (i.e. not CFI commands).
|
|
@end itemize
|
|
|
|
To configure two adjacent banks of 16 MBytes each, both sixteen bits (two bytes)
|
|
wide on a sixteen bit bus:
|
|
|
|
@example
|
|
flash bank $_FLASHNAME cfi 0x00000000 0x01000000 2 2 $_TARGETNAME
|
|
flash bank $_FLASHNAME cfi 0x01000000 0x01000000 2 2 $_TARGETNAME
|
|
@end example
|
|
|
|
To configure one bank of 32 MBytes
|
|
built from two sixteen bit (two byte) wide parts wired in parallel
|
|
to create a thirty-two bit (four byte) bus with doubled throughput:
|
|
|
|
@example
|
|
flash bank $_FLASHNAME cfi 0x00000000 0x02000000 2 4 $_TARGETNAME
|
|
@end example
|
|
|
|
@c "cfi part_id" disabled
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
|
|
@deffn {Flash Driver} {jtagspi}
|
|
@cindex Generic JTAG2SPI driver
|
|
@cindex SPI
|
|
@cindex jtagspi
|
|
@cindex bscan_spi
|
|
Several FPGAs and CPLDs can retrieve their configuration (bitstream) from a
|
|
SPI flash connected to them. To access this flash from the host, the device
|
|
is first programmed with a special proxy bitstream that
|
|
exposes the SPI flash on the device's JTAG interface. The flash can then be
|
|
accessed through JTAG.
|
|
|
|
Since signaling between JTAG and SPI is compatible, all that is required for
|
|
a proxy bitstream is to connect TDI-MOSI, TDO-MISO, TCK-CLK and activate
|
|
the flash chip select when the JTAG state machine is in SHIFT-DR. Such
|
|
a bitstream for several Xilinx FPGAs can be found in
|
|
@file{contrib/loaders/flash/fpga/xilinx_bscan_spi.py}. It requires
|
|
@uref{https://github.com/m-labs/migen, migen} and a Xilinx toolchain to build.
|
|
|
|
This flash bank driver requires a target on a JTAG tap and will access that
|
|
tap directly. Since no support from the target is needed, the target can be a
|
|
"testee" dummy. Since the target does not expose the flash memory
|
|
mapping, target commands that would otherwise be expected to access the flash
|
|
will not work. These include all @command{*_image} and
|
|
@command{$target_name m*} commands as well as @command{program}. Equivalent
|
|
functionality is available through the @command{flash write_bank},
|
|
@command{flash read_bank}, and @command{flash verify_bank} commands.
|
|
|
|
According to device size, 1- to 4-byte addresses are sent. However, some
|
|
flash chips additionally have to be switched to 4-byte addresses by an extra
|
|
command, see below.
|
|
|
|
@itemize
|
|
@item @var{ir} ... is loaded into the JTAG IR to map the flash as the JTAG DR.
|
|
For the bitstreams generated from @file{xilinx_bscan_spi.py} this is the
|
|
@var{USER1} instruction.
|
|
@end itemize
|
|
|
|
@example
|
|
target create $_TARGETNAME testee -chain-position $_CHIPNAME.fpga
|
|
set _XILINX_USER1 0x02
|
|
flash bank $_FLASHNAME spi 0x0 0 0 0 \
|
|
$_TARGETNAME $_XILINX_USER1
|
|
@end example
|
|
|
|
@deffn Command {jtagspi set} bank_id name total_size page_size read_cmd unused pprg_cmd mass_erase_cmd sector_size sector_erase_cmd
|
|
Sets flash parameters: @var{name} human readable string, @var{total_size}
|
|
size in bytes, @var{page_size} is write page size. @var{read_cmd} and @var{pprg_cmd}
|
|
are commands for read and page program, respectively. @var{mass_erase_cmd},
|
|
@var{sector_size} and @var{sector_erase_cmd} are optional.
|
|
@example
|
|
jtagspi set 0 w25q128 0x1000000 0x100 0x03 0 0x02 0xC7 0x10000 0xD8
|
|
@end example
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
|
|
@deffn Command {jtagspi cmd} bank_id resp_num cmd_byte ...
|
|
Sends command @var{cmd_byte} and at most 20 following bytes and reads
|
|
@var{resp_num} bytes afterwards. E.g. for 'Enter 4-byte address mode'
|
|
@example
|
|
jtagspi cmd 0 0 0xB7
|
|
@end example
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
|
|
@deffn Command {jtagspi always_4byte} bank_id [ on | off ]
|
|
Some devices use 4-byte addresses for all commands except the legacy 0x03 read
|
|
regardless of device size. This command controls the corresponding hack.
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
|
|
@deffn {Flash Driver} {xcf}
|
|
@cindex Xilinx Platform flash driver
|
|
@cindex xcf
|
|
Xilinx FPGAs can be configured from specialized flash ICs named Platform Flash.
|
|
It is (almost) regular NOR flash with erase sectors, program pages, etc. The
|
|
only difference is special registers controlling its FPGA specific behavior.
|
|
They must be properly configured for successful FPGA loading using
|
|
additional @var{xcf} driver command:
|
|
|
|
@deffn {Command} {xcf ccb} <bank_id>
|
|
command accepts additional parameters:
|
|
@itemize
|
|
@item @var{external|internal} ... selects clock source.
|
|
@item @var{serial|parallel} ... selects serial or parallel data bus mode.
|
|
@item @var{slave|master} ... selects slave of master mode for flash device.
|
|
@item @var{40|20} ... selects clock frequency in MHz for internal clock
|
|
in master mode.
|
|
@end itemize
|
|
@example
|
|
xcf ccb 0 external parallel slave 40
|
|
@end example
|
|
All of them must be specified even if clock frequency is pointless
|
|
in slave mode. If only bank id specified than command prints current
|
|
CCB register value. Note: there is no need to write this register
|
|
every time you erase/program data sectors because it stores in
|
|
dedicated sector.
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
|
|
@deffn {Command} {xcf configure} <bank_id>
|
|
Initiates FPGA loading procedure. Useful if your board has no "configure"
|
|
button.
|
|
@example
|
|
xcf configure 0
|
|
@end example
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
|
|
Additional driver notes:
|
|
@itemize
|
|
@item Only single revision supported.
|
|
@item Driver automatically detects need of bit reverse, but
|
|
only "bin" (raw binary, do not confuse it with "bit") and "mcs"
|
|
(Intel hex) file types supported.
|
|
@item For additional info check xapp972.pdf and ug380.pdf.
|
|
@end itemize
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
|
|
@deffn {Flash Driver} {lpcspifi}
|
|
@cindex NXP SPI Flash Interface
|
|
@cindex SPIFI
|
|
@cindex lpcspifi
|
|
NXP's LPC43xx and LPC18xx families include a proprietary SPI
|
|
Flash Interface (SPIFI) peripheral that can drive and provide
|
|
memory mapped access to external SPI flash devices.
|
|
|
|
The lpcspifi driver initializes this interface and provides
|
|
program and erase functionality for these serial flash devices.
|
|
Use of this driver @b{requires} a working area of at least 1kB
|
|
to be configured on the target device; more than this will
|
|
significantly reduce flash programming times.
|
|
|
|
The setup command only requires the @var{base} parameter. All
|
|
other parameters are ignored, and the flash size and layout
|
|
are configured by the driver.
|
|
|
|
@example
|
|
flash bank $_FLASHNAME lpcspifi 0x14000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
|
|
@end example
|
|
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
|
|
@deffn {Flash Driver} {stmsmi}
|
|
@cindex STMicroelectronics Serial Memory Interface
|
|
@cindex SMI
|
|
@cindex stmsmi
|
|
Some devices from STMicroelectronics (e.g. STR75x MCU family,
|
|
SPEAr MPU family) include a proprietary
|
|
``Serial Memory Interface'' (SMI) controller able to drive external
|
|
SPI flash devices.
|
|
Depending on specific device and board configuration, up to 4 external
|
|
flash devices can be connected.
|
|
|
|
SMI makes the flash content directly accessible in the CPU address
|
|
space; each external device is mapped in a memory bank.
|
|
CPU can directly read data, execute code and boot from SMI banks.
|
|
Normal OpenOCD commands like @command{mdw} can be used to display
|
|
the flash content.
|
|
|
|
The setup command only requires the @var{base} parameter in order
|
|
to identify the memory bank.
|
|
All other parameters are ignored. Additional information, like
|
|
flash size, are detected automatically.
|
|
|
|
@example
|
|
flash bank $_FLASHNAME stmsmi 0xf8000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
|
|
@end example
|
|
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
|
|
@deffn {Flash Driver} {stmqspi}
|
|
@cindex STMicroelectronics QuadSPI/OctoSPI Interface
|
|
@cindex QuadSPI
|
|
@cindex OctoSPI
|
|
@cindex stmqspi
|
|
Some devices from STMicroelectronics include a proprietary ``QuadSPI Interface''
|
|
(e.g. STM32F4, STM32F7, STM32L4) or ``OctoSPI Interface'' (e.g. STM32L4+)
|
|
controller able to drive one or even two (dual mode) external SPI flash devices.
|
|
The OctoSPI is a superset of QuadSPI, its presence is detected automatically.
|
|
Currently only the regular command mode is supported, whereas the HyperFlash
|
|
mode is not.
|
|
|
|
QuadSPI/OctoSPI makes the flash contents directly accessible in the CPU address
|
|
space; in case of dual mode both devices must be of the same type and are
|
|
mapped in the same memory bank (even and odd addresses interleaved).
|
|
CPU can directly read data, execute code (but not boot) from QuadSPI bank.
|
|
|
|
The 'flash bank' command only requires the @var{base} parameter and the extra
|
|
parameter @var{io_base} in order to identify the memory bank. Both are fixed
|
|
by hardware, see datasheet or RM. All other parameters are ignored.
|
|
|
|
The controller must be initialized after each reset and properly configured
|
|
for memory-mapped read operation for the particular flash chip(s), for the full
|
|
list of available register settings cf. the controller's RM. This setup is quite
|
|
board specific (that's why booting from this memory is not possible). The
|
|
flash driver infers all parameters from current controller register values when
|
|
'flash probe @var{bank_id}' is executed.
|
|
|
|
Normal OpenOCD commands like @command{mdw} can be used to display the flash content,
|
|
but only after proper controller initialization as described above. However,
|
|
due to a silicon bug in some devices, attempting to access the very last word
|
|
should be avoided.
|
|
|
|
It is possible to use two (even different) flash chips alternatingly, if individual
|
|
bank chip selects are available. For some package variants, this is not the case
|
|
due to limited pin count. To switch from one to another, adjust FSEL bit accordingly
|
|
and re-issue 'flash probe bank_id'. Note that the bank base address will @emph{not}
|
|
change, so the address spaces of both devices will overlap. In dual flash mode
|
|
both chips must be identical regarding size and most other properties.
|
|
|
|
Block or sector protection internal to the flash chip is not handled by this
|
|
driver at all, but can be dealt with manually by the 'cmd' command, see below.
|
|
The sector protection via 'flash protect' command etc. is completely internal to
|
|
openocd, intended only to prevent accidental erase or overwrite and it does not
|
|
persist across openocd invocations.
|
|
|
|
OpenOCD contains a hardcoded list of flash devices with their properties,
|
|
these are auto-detected. If a device is not included in this list, SFDP discovery
|
|
is attempted. If this fails or gives inappropriate results, manual setting is
|
|
required (see 'set' command).
|
|
|
|
@example
|
|
flash bank $_FLASHNAME stmqspi 0x90000000 0 0 0 \
|
|
$_TARGETNAME 0xA0001000
|
|
flash bank $_FLASHNAME stmqspi 0x70000000 0 0 0 \
|
|
$_TARGETNAME 0xA0001400
|
|
@end example
|
|
|
|
There are three specific commands
|
|
@deffn {Command} {stmqspi mass_erase} bank_id
|
|
Clears sector protections and performs a mass erase. Works only if there is no
|
|
chip specific write protection engaged.
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
|
|
@deffn {Command} {stmqspi set} bank_id name total_size page_size read_cmd fread_cmd pprg_cmd mass_erase_cmd sector_size sector_erase_cmd
|
|
Set flash parameters: @var{name} human readable string, @var{total_size} size
|
|
in bytes, @var{page_size} is write page size. @var{read_cmd}, @var{fread_cmd} and @var{pprg_cmd}
|
|
are commands for reading and page programming. @var{fread_cmd} is used in DPI and QPI modes,
|
|
@var{read_cmd} in normal SPI (single line) mode. @var{mass_erase_cmd}, @var{sector_size}
|
|
and @var{sector_erase_cmd} are optional.
|
|
|
|
This command is required if chip id is not hardcoded yet and e.g. for EEPROMs or FRAMs
|
|
which don't support an id command.
|
|
|
|
In dual mode parameters of both chips are set identically. The parameters refer to
|
|
a single chip, so the whole bank gets twice the specified capacity etc.
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
|
|
@deffn {Command} {stmqspi cmd} bank_id resp_num cmd_byte ...
|
|
If @var{resp_num} is zero, sends command @var{cmd_byte} and following data
|
|
bytes. In dual mode command byte is sent to @emph{both} chips but data bytes are
|
|
sent @emph{alternatingly} to chip 1 and 2, first to flash 1, second to flash 2, etc.,
|
|
i.e. the total number of bytes (including cmd_byte) must be odd.
|
|
|
|
If @var{resp_num} is not zero, cmd and at most four following data bytes are
|
|
sent, in dual mode @emph{simultaneously} to both chips. Then @var{resp_num} bytes
|
|
are read interleaved from both chips starting with chip 1. In this case
|
|
@var{resp_num} must be even.
|
|
|
|
Note the hardware dictated subtle difference of those two cases in dual-flash mode.
|
|
|
|
To check basic communication settings, issue
|
|
@example
|
|
stmqspi cmd bank_id 0 0x04; stmqspi cmd bank_id 1 0x05
|
|
stmqspi cmd bank_id 0 0x06; stmqspi cmd bank_id 1 0x05
|
|
@end example
|
|
for single flash mode or
|
|
@example
|
|
stmqspi cmd bank_id 0 0x04; stmqspi cmd bank_id 2 0x05
|
|
stmqspi cmd bank_id 0 0x06; stmqspi cmd bank_id 2 0x05
|
|
@end example
|
|
for dual flash mode. This should return the status register contents.
|
|
|
|
In 8-line mode, @var{cmd_byte} is sent twice - first time as given, second time
|
|
complemented. Additionally, in 8-line mode only, some commands (e.g. Read Status)
|
|
need a dummy address, e.g.
|
|
@example
|
|
stmqspi cmd bank_id 1 0x05 0x00 0x00 0x00 0x00
|
|
@end example
|
|
should return the status register contents.
|
|
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
|
|
@deffn {Flash Driver} {mrvlqspi}
|
|
This driver supports QSPI flash controller of Marvell's Wireless
|
|
Microcontroller platform.
|
|
|
|
The flash size is autodetected based on the table of known JEDEC IDs
|
|
hardcoded in the OpenOCD sources.
|
|
|
|
@example
|
|
flash bank $_FLASHNAME mrvlqspi 0x0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME 0x46010000
|
|
@end example
|
|
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
|
|
@deffn {Flash Driver} {ath79}
|
|
@cindex Atheros ath79 SPI driver
|
|
@cindex ath79
|
|
Members of ATH79 SoC family from Atheros include a SPI interface with 3
|
|
chip selects.
|
|
On reset a SPI flash connected to the first chip select (CS0) is made
|
|
directly read-accessible in the CPU address space (up to 16MBytes)
|
|
and is usually used to store the bootloader and operating system.
|
|
Normal OpenOCD commands like @command{mdw} can be used to display
|
|
the flash content while it is in memory-mapped mode (only the first
|
|
4MBytes are accessible without additional configuration on reset).
|
|
|
|
The setup command only requires the @var{base} parameter in order
|
|
to identify the memory bank. The actual value for the base address
|
|
is not otherwise used by the driver. However the mapping is passed
|
|
to gdb. Thus for the memory mapped flash (chipselect CS0) the base
|
|
address should be the actual memory mapped base address. For unmapped
|
|
chipselects (CS1 and CS2) care should be taken to use a base address
|
|
that does not overlap with real memory regions.
|
|
Additional information, like flash size, are detected automatically.
|
|
An optional additional parameter sets the chipselect for the bank,
|
|
with the default CS0.
|
|
CS1 and CS2 require additional GPIO setup before they can be used
|
|
since the alternate function must be enabled on the GPIO pin
|
|
CS1/CS2 is routed to on the given SoC.
|
|
|
|
@example
|
|
flash bank $_FLASHNAME ath79 0xbf000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
|
|
|
|
# When using multiple chipselects the base should be different
|
|
# for each, otherwise the write_image command is not able to
|
|
# distinguish the banks.
|
|
flash bank flash0 ath79 0xbf000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME cs0
|
|
flash bank flash1 ath79 0x10000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME cs1
|
|
flash bank flash2 ath79 0x20000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME cs2
|
|
@end example
|
|
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
|
|
@deffn {Flash Driver} {fespi}
|
|
@cindex Freedom E SPI
|
|
@cindex fespi
|
|
|
|
SiFive's Freedom E SPI controller, used in HiFive and other boards.
|
|
|
|
@example
|
|
flash bank $_FLASHNAME fespi 0x20000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
|
|
@end example
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
|
|
@subsection Internal Flash (Microcontrollers)
|
|
|
|
@deffn {Flash Driver} {aduc702x}
|
|
The ADUC702x analog microcontrollers from Analog Devices
|
|
include internal flash and use ARM7TDMI cores.
|
|
The aduc702x flash driver works with models ADUC7019 through ADUC7028.
|
|
The setup command only requires the @var{target} argument
|
|
since all devices in this family have the same memory layout.
|
|
|
|
@example
|
|
flash bank $_FLASHNAME aduc702x 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
|
|
@end example
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
|
|
@deffn {Flash Driver} {ambiqmicro}
|
|
@cindex ambiqmicro
|
|
@cindex apollo
|
|
All members of the Apollo microcontroller family from
|
|
Ambiq Micro include internal flash and use ARM's Cortex-M4 core.
|
|
The host connects over USB to an FTDI interface that communicates
|
|
with the target using SWD.
|
|
|
|
The @var{ambiqmicro} driver reads the Chip Information Register detect
|
|
the device class of the MCU.
|
|
The Flash and SRAM sizes directly follow device class, and are used
|
|
to set up the flash banks.
|
|
If this fails, the driver will use default values set to the minimum
|
|
sizes of an Apollo chip.
|
|
|
|
All Apollo chips have two flash banks of the same size.
|
|
In all cases the first flash bank starts at location 0,
|
|
and the second bank starts after the first.
|
|
|
|
@example
|
|
# Flash bank 0
|
|
flash bank $_FLASHNAME ambiqmicro 0 0x00040000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
|
|
# Flash bank 1 - same size as bank0, starts after bank 0.
|
|
flash bank $_FLASHNAME ambiqmicro 0x00040000 0x00040000 0 0 \
|
|
$_TARGETNAME
|
|
@end example
|
|
|
|
Flash is programmed using custom entry points into the bootloader.
|
|
This is the only way to program the flash as no flash control registers
|
|
are available to the user.
|
|
|
|
The @var{ambiqmicro} driver adds some additional commands:
|
|
|
|
@deffn {Command} {ambiqmicro mass_erase} <bank>
|
|
Erase entire bank.
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
@deffn {Command} {ambiqmicro page_erase} <bank> <first> <last>
|
|
Erase device pages.
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
@deffn {Command} {ambiqmicro program_otp} <bank> <offset> <count>
|
|
Program OTP is a one time operation to create write protected flash.
|
|
The user writes sectors to SRAM starting at 0x10000010.
|
|
Program OTP will write these sectors from SRAM to flash, and write protect
|
|
the flash.
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
|
|
@deffn {Flash Driver} {at91samd}
|
|
@cindex at91samd
|
|
All members of the ATSAM D2x, D1x, D0x, ATSAMR, ATSAML and ATSAMC microcontroller
|
|
families from Atmel include internal flash and use ARM's Cortex-M0+ core.
|
|
|
|
Do not use for ATSAM D51 and E5x: use @xref{atsame5}.
|
|
|
|
The devices have one flash bank:
|
|
|
|
@example
|
|
flash bank $_FLASHNAME at91samd 0x00000000 0 1 1 $_TARGETNAME
|
|
@end example
|
|
|
|
@deffn {Command} {at91samd chip-erase}
|
|
Issues a complete Flash erase via the Device Service Unit (DSU). This can be
|
|
used to erase a chip back to its factory state and does not require the
|
|
processor to be halted.
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
|
|
@deffn {Command} {at91samd set-security}
|
|
Secures the Flash via the Set Security Bit (SSB) command. This prevents access
|
|
to the Flash and can only be undone by using the chip-erase command which
|
|
erases the Flash contents and turns off the security bit. Warning: at this
|
|
time, openocd will not be able to communicate with a secured chip and it is
|
|
therefore not possible to chip-erase it without using another tool.
|
|
|
|
@example
|
|
at91samd set-security enable
|
|
@end example
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
|
|
@deffn {Command} {at91samd eeprom}
|
|
Shows or sets the EEPROM emulation size configuration, stored in the User Row
|
|
of the Flash. When setting, the EEPROM size must be specified in bytes and it
|
|
must be one of the permitted sizes according to the datasheet. Settings are
|
|
written immediately but only take effect on MCU reset. EEPROM emulation
|
|
requires additional firmware support and the minimum EEPROM size may not be
|
|
the same as the minimum that the hardware supports. Set the EEPROM size to 0
|
|
in order to disable this feature.
|
|
|
|
@example
|
|
at91samd eeprom
|
|
at91samd eeprom 1024
|
|
@end example
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
|
|
@deffn {Command} {at91samd bootloader}
|
|
Shows or sets the bootloader size configuration, stored in the User Row of the
|
|
Flash. This is called the BOOTPROT region. When setting, the bootloader size
|
|
must be specified in bytes and it must be one of the permitted sizes according
|
|
to the datasheet. Settings are written immediately but only take effect on
|
|
MCU reset. Setting the bootloader size to 0 disables bootloader protection.
|
|
|
|
@example
|
|
at91samd bootloader
|
|
at91samd bootloader 16384
|
|
@end example
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
|
|
@deffn {Command} {at91samd dsu_reset_deassert}
|
|
This command releases internal reset held by DSU
|
|
and prepares reset vector catch in case of reset halt.
|
|
Command is used internally in event reset-deassert-post.
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
|
|
@deffn {Command} {at91samd nvmuserrow}
|
|
Writes or reads the entire 64 bit wide NVM user row register which is located at
|
|
0x804000. This register includes various fuses lock-bits and factory calibration
|
|
data. Reading the register is done by invoking this command without any
|
|
arguments. Writing is possible by giving 1 or 2 hex values. The first argument
|
|
is the register value to be written and the second one is an optional changemask.
|
|
Every bit which value in changemask is 0 will stay unchanged. The lock- and
|
|
reserved-bits are masked out and cannot be changed.
|
|
|
|
@example
|
|
# Read user row
|
|
>at91samd nvmuserrow
|
|
NVMUSERROW: 0xFFFFFC5DD8E0C788
|
|
# Write 0xFFFFFC5DD8E0C788 to user row
|
|
>at91samd nvmuserrow 0xFFFFFC5DD8E0C788
|
|
# Write 0x12300 to user row but leave other bits and low
|
|
# byte unchanged
|
|
>at91samd nvmuserrow 0x12345 0xFFF00
|
|
@end example
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
|
|
@anchor{at91sam3}
|
|
@deffn {Flash Driver} {at91sam3}
|
|
@cindex at91sam3
|
|
All members of the AT91SAM3 microcontroller family from
|
|
Atmel include internal flash and use ARM's Cortex-M3 core. The driver
|
|
currently (6/22/09) recognizes the AT91SAM3U[1/2/4][C/E] chips. Note
|
|
that the driver was orginaly developed and tested using the
|
|
AT91SAM3U4E, using a SAM3U-EK eval board. Support for other chips in
|
|
the family was cribbed from the data sheet. @emph{Note to future
|
|
readers/updaters: Please remove this worrisome comment after other
|
|
chips are confirmed.}
|
|
|
|
The AT91SAM3U4[E/C] (256K) chips have two flash banks; most other chips
|
|
have one flash bank. In all cases the flash banks are at
|
|
the following fixed locations:
|
|
|
|
@example
|
|
# Flash bank 0 - all chips
|
|
flash bank $_FLASHNAME at91sam3 0x00080000 0 1 1 $_TARGETNAME
|
|
# Flash bank 1 - only 256K chips
|
|
flash bank $_FLASHNAME at91sam3 0x00100000 0 1 1 $_TARGETNAME
|
|
@end example
|
|
|
|
Internally, the AT91SAM3 flash memory is organized as follows.
|
|
Unlike the AT91SAM7 chips, these are not used as parameters
|
|
to the @command{flash bank} command:
|
|
|
|
@itemize
|
|
@item @emph{N-Banks:} 256K chips have 2 banks, others have 1 bank.
|
|
@item @emph{Bank Size:} 128K/64K Per flash bank
|
|
@item @emph{Sectors:} 16 or 8 per bank
|
|
@item @emph{SectorSize:} 8K Per Sector
|
|
@item @emph{PageSize:} 256 bytes per page. Note that OpenOCD operates on 'sector' sizes, not page sizes.
|
|
@end itemize
|
|
|
|
The AT91SAM3 driver adds some additional commands:
|
|
|
|
@deffn {Command} {at91sam3 gpnvm}
|
|
@deffnx {Command} {at91sam3 gpnvm clear} number
|
|
@deffnx {Command} {at91sam3 gpnvm set} number
|
|
@deffnx {Command} {at91sam3 gpnvm show} [@option{all}|number]
|
|
With no parameters, @command{show} or @command{show all},
|
|
shows the status of all GPNVM bits.
|
|
With @command{show} @var{number}, displays that bit.
|
|
|
|
With @command{set} @var{number} or @command{clear} @var{number},
|
|
modifies that GPNVM bit.
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
|
|
@deffn {Command} {at91sam3 info}
|
|
This command attempts to display information about the AT91SAM3
|
|
chip. @emph{First} it read the @code{CHIPID_CIDR} [address 0x400e0740, see
|
|
Section 28.2.1, page 505 of the AT91SAM3U 29/may/2009 datasheet,
|
|
document id: doc6430A] and decodes the values. @emph{Second} it reads the
|
|
various clock configuration registers and attempts to display how it
|
|
believes the chip is configured. By default, the SLOWCLK is assumed to
|
|
be 32768 Hz, see the command @command{at91sam3 slowclk}.
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
|
|
@deffn {Command} {at91sam3 slowclk} [value]
|
|
This command shows/sets the slow clock frequency used in the
|
|
@command{at91sam3 info} command calculations above.
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
|
|
@deffn {Flash Driver} {at91sam4}
|
|
@cindex at91sam4
|
|
All members of the AT91SAM4 microcontroller family from
|
|
Atmel include internal flash and use ARM's Cortex-M4 core.
|
|
This driver uses the same command names/syntax as @xref{at91sam3}.
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
|
|
@deffn {Flash Driver} {at91sam4l}
|
|
@cindex at91sam4l
|
|
All members of the AT91SAM4L microcontroller family from
|
|
Atmel include internal flash and use ARM's Cortex-M4 core.
|
|
This driver uses the same command names/syntax as @xref{at91sam3}.
|
|
|
|
The AT91SAM4L driver adds some additional commands:
|
|
@deffn {Command} {at91sam4l smap_reset_deassert}
|
|
This command releases internal reset held by SMAP
|
|
and prepares reset vector catch in case of reset halt.
|
|
Command is used internally in event reset-deassert-post.
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
|
|
@anchor{atsame5}
|
|
@deffn {Flash Driver} {atsame5}
|
|
@cindex atsame5
|
|
All members of the SAM E54, E53, E51 and D51 microcontroller
|
|
families from Microchip (former Atmel) include internal flash
|
|
and use ARM's Cortex-M4 core.
|
|
|
|
The devices have two ECC flash banks with a swapping feature.
|
|
This driver handles both banks together as it were one.
|
|
Bank swapping is not supported yet.
|
|
|
|
@example
|
|
flash bank $_FLASHNAME atsame5 0x00000000 0 1 1 $_TARGETNAME
|
|
@end example
|
|
|
|
@deffn {Command} {atsame5 bootloader}
|
|
Shows or sets the bootloader size configuration, stored in the User Page of the
|
|
Flash. This is called the BOOTPROT region. When setting, the bootloader size
|
|
must be specified in bytes. The nearest bigger protection size is used.
|
|
Settings are written immediately but only take effect on MCU reset.
|
|
Setting the bootloader size to 0 disables bootloader protection.
|
|
|
|
@example
|
|
atsame5 bootloader
|
|
atsame5 bootloader 16384
|
|
@end example
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
|
|
@deffn {Command} {atsame5 chip-erase}
|
|
Issues a complete Flash erase via the Device Service Unit (DSU). This can be
|
|
used to erase a chip back to its factory state and does not require the
|
|
processor to be halted.
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
|
|
@deffn {Command} {atsame5 dsu_reset_deassert}
|
|
This command releases internal reset held by DSU
|
|
and prepares reset vector catch in case of reset halt.
|
|
Command is used internally in event reset-deassert-post.
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
|
|
@deffn {Command} {atsame5 userpage}
|
|
Writes or reads the first 64 bits of NVM User Page which is located at
|
|
0x804000. This field includes various fuses.
|
|
Reading is done by invoking this command without any arguments.
|
|
Writing is possible by giving 1 or 2 hex values. The first argument
|
|
is the value to be written and the second one is an optional bit mask
|
|
(a zero bit in the mask means the bit stays unchanged).
|
|
The reserved fields are always masked out and cannot be changed.
|
|
|
|
@example
|
|
# Read
|
|
>atsame5 userpage
|
|
USER PAGE: 0xAEECFF80FE9A9239
|
|
# Write
|
|
>atsame5 userpage 0xAEECFF80FE9A9239
|
|
# Write 2 to SEESBLK and 4 to SEEPSZ fields but leave other
|
|
# bits unchanged (setup SmartEEPROM of virtual size 8192
|
|
# bytes)
|
|
>atsame5 userpage 0x4200000000 0x7f00000000
|
|
@end example
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
|
|
@deffn {Flash Driver} {atsamv}
|
|
@cindex atsamv
|
|
All members of the ATSAMV7x, ATSAMS70, and ATSAME70 families from
|
|
Atmel include internal flash and use ARM's Cortex-M7 core.
|
|
This driver uses the same command names/syntax as @xref{at91sam3}.
|
|
|
|
@example
|
|
flash bank $_FLASHNAME atsamv 0x00400000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
|
|
@end example
|
|
|
|
@deffn {Command} {atsamv gpnvm} [@option{show} [@option{all}|number]]
|
|
@deffnx {Command} {atsamv gpnvm} (@option{clr}|@option{set}) number
|
|
With no parameters, @option{show} or @option{show all},
|
|
shows the status of all GPNVM bits.
|
|
With @option{show} @var{number}, displays that bit.
|
|
|
|
With @option{set} @var{number} or @option{clear} @var{number},
|
|
modifies that GPNVM bit.
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
|
|
@deffn {Flash Driver} {at91sam7}
|
|
All members of the AT91SAM7 microcontroller family from Atmel include
|
|
internal flash and use ARM7TDMI cores. The driver automatically
|
|
recognizes a number of these chips using the chip identification
|
|
register, and autoconfigures itself.
|
|
|
|
@example
|
|
flash bank $_FLASHNAME at91sam7 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
|
|
@end example
|
|
|
|
For chips which are not recognized by the controller driver, you must
|
|
provide additional parameters in the following order:
|
|
|
|
@itemize
|
|
@item @var{chip_model} ... label used with @command{flash info}
|
|
@item @var{banks}
|
|
@item @var{sectors_per_bank}
|
|
@item @var{pages_per_sector}
|
|
@item @var{pages_size}
|
|
@item @var{num_nvm_bits}
|
|
@item @var{freq_khz} ... required if an external clock is provided,
|
|
optional (but recommended) when the oscillator frequency is known
|
|
@end itemize
|
|
|
|
It is recommended that you provide zeroes for all of those values
|
|
except the clock frequency, so that everything except that frequency
|
|
will be autoconfigured.
|
|
Knowing the frequency helps ensure correct timings for flash access.
|
|
|
|
The flash controller handles erases automatically on a page (128/256 byte)
|
|
basis, so explicit erase commands are not necessary for flash programming.
|
|
However, there is an ``EraseAll`` command that can erase an entire flash
|
|
plane (of up to 256KB), and it will be used automatically when you issue
|
|
@command{flash erase_sector} or @command{flash erase_address} commands.
|
|
|
|
@deffn {Command} {at91sam7 gpnvm} bitnum (@option{set}|@option{clear})
|
|
Set or clear a ``General Purpose Non-Volatile Memory'' (GPNVM)
|
|
bit for the processor. Each processor has a number of such bits,
|
|
used for controlling features such as brownout detection (so they
|
|
are not truly general purpose).
|
|
@quotation Note
|
|
This assumes that the first flash bank (number 0) is associated with
|
|
the appropriate at91sam7 target.
|
|
@end quotation
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
|
|
@deffn {Flash Driver} {avr}
|
|
The AVR 8-bit microcontrollers from Atmel integrate flash memory.
|
|
@emph{The current implementation is incomplete.}
|
|
@comment - defines mass_erase ... pointless given flash_erase_address
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
|
|
@deffn {Flash Driver} {bluenrg-x}
|
|
STMicroelectronics BlueNRG-1, BlueNRG-2 and BlueNRG-LP/LPS Bluetooth low energy wireless system-on-chip. They include ARM Cortex-M0/M0+ core and internal flash memory.
|
|
The driver automatically recognizes these chips using
|
|
the chip identification registers, and autoconfigures itself.
|
|
|
|
@example
|
|
flash bank $_FLASHNAME bluenrg-x 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
|
|
@end example
|
|
|
|
Note that when users ask to erase all the sectors of the flash, a mass erase command is used which is faster than erasing
|
|
each single sector one by one.
|
|
|
|
@example
|
|
flash erase_sector 0 0 last # It will perform a mass erase
|
|
@end example
|
|
|
|
Triggering a mass erase is also useful when users want to disable readout protection.
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
|
|
@deffn {Flash Driver} {cc26xx}
|
|
All versions of the SimpleLink CC13xx and CC26xx microcontrollers from Texas
|
|
Instruments include internal flash. The cc26xx flash driver supports both the
|
|
CC13xx and CC26xx family of devices. The driver automatically recognizes the
|
|
specific version's flash parameters and autoconfigures itself. The flash bank
|
|
starts at address 0.
|
|
|
|
@example
|
|
flash bank $_FLASHNAME cc26xx 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
|
|
@end example
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
|
|
@deffn {Flash Driver} {cc3220sf}
|
|
The CC3220SF version of the SimpleLink CC32xx microcontrollers from Texas
|
|
Instruments includes 1MB of internal flash. The cc3220sf flash driver only
|
|
supports the internal flash. The serial flash on SimpleLink boards is
|
|
programmed via the bootloader over a UART connection. Security features of
|
|
the CC3220SF may erase the internal flash during power on reset. Refer to
|
|
documentation at @url{www.ti.com/cc3220sf} for details on security features
|
|
and programming the serial flash.
|
|
|
|
@example
|
|
flash bank $_FLASHNAME cc3220sf 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
|
|
@end example
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
|
|
@deffn {Flash Driver} {efm32}
|
|
All members of the EFM32/EFR32 microcontroller family from Energy Micro (now Silicon Labs)
|
|
include internal flash and use Arm Cortex-M3 or Cortex-M4 cores. The driver automatically
|
|
recognizes a number of these chips using the chip identification register, and
|
|
autoconfigures itself.
|
|
@example
|
|
flash bank $_FLASHNAME efm32 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
|
|
@end example
|
|
It supports writing to the user data page, as well as the portion of the lockbits page
|
|
past 512 bytes on chips with larger page sizes. The latter is used by the SiLabs
|
|
bootloader/AppLoader system for encryption keys. Setting protection on these pages is
|
|
currently not supported.
|
|
@example
|
|
flash bank userdata.flash efm32 0x0FE00000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
|
|
flash bank lockbits.flash efm32 0x0FE04000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
|
|
@end example
|
|
|
|
A special feature of efm32 controllers is that it is possible to completely disable the
|
|
debug interface by writing the correct values to the 'Debug Lock Word'. OpenOCD supports
|
|
this via the following command:
|
|
@example
|
|
efm32 debuglock num
|
|
@end example
|
|
The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
|
|
Note that in order for this command to take effect, the target needs to be reset.
|
|
@emph{The current implementation is incomplete. Unprotecting flash pages is not
|
|
supported.}
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
|
|
@deffn {Flash Driver} {esirisc}
|
|
Members of the eSi-RISC family may optionally include internal flash programmed
|
|
via the eSi-TSMC Flash interface. Additional parameters are required to
|
|
configure the driver: @option{cfg_address} is the base address of the
|
|
configuration register interface, @option{clock_hz} is the expected clock
|
|
frequency, and @option{wait_states} is the number of configured read wait states.
|
|
|
|
@example
|
|
flash bank $_FLASHNAME esirisc base_address size_bytes 0 0 \
|
|
$_TARGETNAME cfg_address clock_hz wait_states
|
|
@end example
|
|
|
|
@deffn {Command} {esirisc flash mass_erase} bank_id
|
|
Erase all pages in data memory for the bank identified by @option{bank_id}.
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
|
|
@deffn {Command} {esirisc flash ref_erase} bank_id
|
|
Erase the reference cell for the bank identified by @option{bank_id}. @emph{This
|
|
is an uncommon operation.}
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
|
|
@deffn {Flash Driver} {fm3}
|
|
All members of the FM3 microcontroller family from Fujitsu
|
|
include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M3 cores.
|
|
The @var{fm3} driver uses the @var{target} parameter to select the
|
|
correct bank config, it can currently be one of the following:
|
|
@code{mb9bfxx1.cpu}, @code{mb9bfxx2.cpu}, @code{mb9bfxx3.cpu},
|
|
@code{mb9bfxx4.cpu}, @code{mb9bfxx5.cpu} or @code{mb9bfxx6.cpu}.
|
|
|
|
@example
|
|
flash bank $_FLASHNAME fm3 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
|
|
@end example
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
|
|
@deffn {Flash Driver} {fm4}
|
|
All members of the FM4 microcontroller family from Spansion (formerly Fujitsu)
|
|
include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M4 cores.
|
|
The @var{fm4} driver uses a @var{family} parameter to select the
|
|
correct bank config, it can currently be one of the following:
|
|
@code{MB9BFx64}, @code{MB9BFx65}, @code{MB9BFx66}, @code{MB9BFx67}, @code{MB9BFx68},
|
|
@code{S6E2Cx8}, @code{S6E2Cx9}, @code{S6E2CxA} or @code{S6E2Dx},
|
|
with @code{x} treated as wildcard and otherwise case (and any trailing
|
|
characters) ignored.
|
|
|
|
@example
|
|
flash bank $@{_FLASHNAME@}0 fm4 0x00000000 0 0 0 \
|
|
$_TARGETNAME S6E2CCAJ0A
|
|
flash bank $@{_FLASHNAME@}1 fm4 0x00100000 0 0 0 \
|
|
$_TARGETNAME S6E2CCAJ0A
|
|
@end example
|
|
@emph{The current implementation is incomplete. Protection is not supported,
|
|
nor is Chip Erase (only Sector Erase is implemented).}
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
|
|
@deffn {Flash Driver} {kinetis}
|
|
@cindex kinetis
|
|
Kx, KLx, KVx and KE1x members of the Kinetis microcontroller family
|
|
from NXP (former Freescale) include
|
|
internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M0+ or M4 cores. The driver automatically
|
|
recognizes flash size and a number of flash banks (1-4) using the chip
|
|
identification register, and autoconfigures itself.
|
|
Use kinetis_ke driver for KE0x and KEAx devices.
|
|
|
|
The @var{kinetis} driver defines option:
|
|
@itemize
|
|
@item -sim-base @var{addr} ... base of System Integration Module where chip identification resides. Driver tries two known locations if option is omitted.
|
|
@end itemize
|
|
|
|
@example
|
|
flash bank $_FLASHNAME kinetis 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
|
|
@end example
|
|
|
|
@deffn {Config Command} {kinetis create_banks}
|
|
Configuration command enables automatic creation of additional flash banks
|
|
based on real flash layout of device. Banks are created during device probe.
|
|
Use 'flash probe 0' to force probe.
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
|
|
@deffn {Command} {kinetis fcf_source} [protection|write]
|
|
Select what source is used when writing to a Flash Configuration Field.
|
|
@option{protection} mode builds FCF content from protection bits previously
|
|
set by 'flash protect' command.
|
|
This mode is default. MCU is protected from unwanted locking by immediate
|
|
writing FCF after erase of relevant sector.
|
|
@option{write} mode enables direct write to FCF.
|
|
Protection cannot be set by 'flash protect' command. FCF is written along
|
|
with the rest of a flash image.
|
|
@emph{BEWARE: Incorrect flash configuration may permanently lock the device!}
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
|
|
@deffn {Command} {kinetis fopt} [num]
|
|
Set value to write to FOPT byte of Flash Configuration Field.
|
|
Used in kinetis 'fcf_source protection' mode only.
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
|
|
@deffn {Command} {kinetis mdm check_security}
|
|
Checks status of device security lock. Used internally in examine-end
|
|
and examine-fail event.
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
|
|
@deffn {Command} {kinetis mdm halt}
|
|
Issues a halt via the MDM-AP. This command can be used to break a watchdog reset
|
|
loop when connecting to an unsecured target.
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
|
|
@deffn {Command} {kinetis mdm mass_erase}
|
|
Issues a complete flash erase via the MDM-AP. This can be used to erase a chip
|
|
back to its factory state, removing security. It does not require the processor
|
|
to be halted, however the target will remain in a halted state after this
|
|
command completes.
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
|
|
@deffn {Command} {kinetis nvm_partition}
|
|
For FlexNVM devices only (KxxDX and KxxFX).
|
|
Command shows or sets data flash or EEPROM backup size in kilobytes,
|
|
sets two EEPROM blocks sizes in bytes and enables/disables loading
|
|
of EEPROM contents to FlexRAM during reset.
|
|
|
|
For details see device reference manual, Flash Memory Module,
|
|
Program Partition command.
|
|
|
|
Setting is possible only once after mass_erase.
|
|
Reset the device after partition setting.
|
|
|
|
Show partition size:
|
|
@example
|
|
kinetis nvm_partition info
|
|
@end example
|
|
|
|
Set 32 KB data flash, rest of FlexNVM is EEPROM backup. EEPROM has two blocks
|
|
of 512 and 1536 bytes and its contents is loaded to FlexRAM during reset:
|
|
@example
|
|
kinetis nvm_partition dataflash 32 512 1536 on
|
|
@end example
|
|
|
|
Set 16 KB EEPROM backup, rest of FlexNVM is a data flash. EEPROM has two blocks
|
|
of 1024 bytes and its contents is not loaded to FlexRAM during reset:
|
|
@example
|
|
kinetis nvm_partition eebkp 16 1024 1024 off
|
|
@end example
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
|
|
@deffn {Command} {kinetis mdm reset}
|
|
Issues a reset via the MDM-AP. This causes the MCU to output a low pulse on the
|
|
RESET pin, which can be used to reset other hardware on board.
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
|
|
@deffn {Command} {kinetis disable_wdog}
|
|
For Kx devices only (KLx has different COP watchdog, it is not supported).
|
|
Command disables watchdog timer.
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
|
|
@deffn {Flash Driver} {kinetis_ke}
|
|
@cindex kinetis_ke
|
|
KE0x and KEAx members of the Kinetis microcontroller family from NXP include
|
|
internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M0+. The driver automatically recognizes
|
|
the KE0x sub-family using the chip identification register, and
|
|
autoconfigures itself.
|
|
Use kinetis (not kinetis_ke) driver for KE1x devices.
|
|
|
|
@example
|
|
flash bank $_FLASHNAME kinetis_ke 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
|
|
@end example
|
|
|
|
@deffn {Command} {kinetis_ke mdm check_security}
|
|
Checks status of device security lock. Used internally in examine-end event.
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
|
|
@deffn {Command} {kinetis_ke mdm mass_erase}
|
|
Issues a complete Flash erase via the MDM-AP.
|
|
This can be used to erase a chip back to its factory state.
|
|
Command removes security lock from a device (use of SRST highly recommended).
|
|
It does not require the processor to be halted.
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
|
|
@deffn {Command} {kinetis_ke disable_wdog}
|
|
Command disables watchdog timer.
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
|
|
@deffn {Flash Driver} {lpc2000}
|
|
This is the driver to support internal flash of all members of the
|
|
LPC11(x)00 and LPC1300 microcontroller families and most members of
|
|
the LPC800, LPC1500, LPC1700, LPC1800, LPC2000, LPC4000, LPC54100,
|
|
LPC8Nxx and NHS31xx microcontroller families from NXP.
|
|
|
|
@quotation Note
|
|
There are LPC2000 devices which are not supported by the @var{lpc2000}
|
|
driver:
|
|
The LPC2888 is supported by the @var{lpc288x} driver.
|
|
The LPC29xx family is supported by the @var{lpc2900} driver.
|
|
@end quotation
|
|
|
|
The @var{lpc2000} driver defines two mandatory and two optional parameters,
|
|
which must appear in the following order:
|
|
|
|
@itemize
|
|
@item @var{variant} ... required, may be
|
|
@option{lpc2000_v1} (older LPC21xx and LPC22xx)
|
|
@option{lpc2000_v2} (LPC213x, LPC214x, LPC210[123], LPC23xx and LPC24xx)
|
|
@option{lpc1700} (LPC175x and LPC176x and LPC177x/8x)
|
|
@option{lpc4300} - available also as @option{lpc1800} alias (LPC18x[2357] and
|
|
LPC43x[2357])
|
|
@option{lpc800} (LPC8xx)
|
|
@option{lpc1100} (LPC11(x)xx and LPC13xx)
|
|
@option{lpc1500} (LPC15xx)
|
|
@option{lpc54100} (LPC541xx)
|
|
@option{lpc4000} (LPC40xx)
|
|
or @option{auto} - automatically detects flash variant and size for LPC11(x)00,
|
|
LPC8xx, LPC13xx, LPC17xx, LPC40xx, LPC8Nxx and NHS31xx
|
|
@item @var{clock_kHz} ... the frequency, in kiloHertz,
|
|
at which the core is running
|
|
@item @option{calc_checksum} ... optional (but you probably want to provide this!),
|
|
telling the driver to calculate a valid checksum for the exception vector table.
|
|
@quotation Note
|
|
If you don't provide @option{calc_checksum} when you're writing the vector
|
|
table, the boot ROM will almost certainly ignore your flash image.
|
|
However, if you do provide it,
|
|
with most tool chains @command{verify_image} will fail.
|
|
@end quotation
|
|
@item @option{iap_entry} ... optional telling the driver to use a different
|
|
ROM IAP entry point.
|
|
@end itemize
|
|
|
|
LPC flashes don't require the chip and bus width to be specified.
|
|
|
|
@example
|
|
flash bank $_FLASHNAME lpc2000 0x0 0x7d000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME \
|
|
lpc2000_v2 14765 calc_checksum
|
|
@end example
|
|
|
|
@deffn {Command} {lpc2000 part_id} bank
|
|
Displays the four byte part identifier associated with
|
|
the specified flash @var{bank}.
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
|
|
@deffn {Flash Driver} {lpc288x}
|
|
The LPC2888 microcontroller from NXP needs slightly different flash
|
|
support from its lpc2000 siblings.
|
|
The @var{lpc288x} driver defines one mandatory parameter,
|
|
the programming clock rate in Hz.
|
|
LPC flashes don't require the chip and bus width to be specified.
|
|
|
|
@example
|
|
flash bank $_FLASHNAME lpc288x 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME 12000000
|
|
@end example
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
|
|
@deffn {Flash Driver} {lpc2900}
|
|
This driver supports the LPC29xx ARM968E based microcontroller family
|
|
from NXP.
|
|
|
|
The predefined parameters @var{base}, @var{size}, @var{chip_width} and
|
|
@var{bus_width} of the @code{flash bank} command are ignored. Flash size and
|
|
sector layout are auto-configured by the driver.
|
|
The driver has one additional mandatory parameter: The CPU clock rate
|
|
(in kHz) at the time the flash operations will take place. Most of the time this
|
|
will not be the crystal frequency, but a higher PLL frequency. The
|
|
@code{reset-init} event handler in the board script is usually the place where
|
|
you start the PLL.
|
|
|
|
The driver rejects flashless devices (currently the LPC2930).
|
|
|
|
The EEPROM in LPC2900 devices is not mapped directly into the address space.
|
|
It must be handled much more like NAND flash memory, and will therefore be
|
|
handled by a separate @code{lpc2900_eeprom} driver (not yet available).
|
|
|
|
Sector protection in terms of the LPC2900 is handled transparently. Every time a
|
|
sector needs to be erased or programmed, it is automatically unprotected.
|
|
What is shown as protection status in the @code{flash info} command, is
|
|
actually the LPC2900 @emph{sector security}. This is a mechanism to prevent a
|
|
sector from ever being erased or programmed again. As this is an irreversible
|
|
mechanism, it is handled by a special command (@code{lpc2900 secure_sector}),
|
|
and not by the standard @code{flash protect} command.
|
|
|
|
Example for a 125 MHz clock frequency:
|
|
@example
|
|
flash bank $_FLASHNAME lpc2900 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME 125000
|
|
@end example
|
|
|
|
Some @code{lpc2900}-specific commands are defined. In the following command list,
|
|
the @var{bank} parameter is the bank number as obtained by the
|
|
@code{flash banks} command.
|
|
|
|
@deffn {Command} {lpc2900 signature} bank
|
|
Calculates a 128-bit hash value, the @emph{signature}, from the whole flash
|
|
content. This is a hardware feature of the flash block, hence the calculation is
|
|
very fast. You may use this to verify the content of a programmed device against
|
|
a known signature.
|
|
Example:
|
|
@example
|
|
lpc2900 signature 0
|
|
signature: 0x5f40cdc8:0xc64e592e:0x10490f89:0x32a0f317
|
|
@end example
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
|
|
@deffn {Command} {lpc2900 read_custom} bank filename
|
|
Reads the 912 bytes of customer information from the flash index sector, and
|
|
saves it to a file in binary format.
|
|
Example:
|
|
@example
|
|
lpc2900 read_custom 0 /path_to/customer_info.bin
|
|
@end example
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
|
|
The index sector of the flash is a @emph{write-only} sector. It cannot be
|
|
erased! In order to guard against unintentional write access, all following
|
|
commands need to be preceded by a successful call to the @code{password}
|
|
command:
|
|
|
|
@deffn {Command} {lpc2900 password} bank password
|
|
You need to use this command right before each of the following commands:
|
|
@code{lpc2900 write_custom}, @code{lpc2900 secure_sector},
|
|
@code{lpc2900 secure_jtag}.
|
|
|
|
The password string is fixed to "I_know_what_I_am_doing".
|
|
Example:
|
|
@example
|
|
lpc2900 password 0 I_know_what_I_am_doing
|
|
Potentially dangerous operation allowed in next command!
|
|
@end example
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
|
|
@deffn {Command} {lpc2900 write_custom} bank filename type
|
|
Writes the content of the file into the customer info space of the flash index
|
|
sector. The filetype can be specified with the @var{type} field. Possible values
|
|
for @var{type} are: @var{bin} (binary), @var{ihex} (Intel hex format),
|
|
@var{elf} (ELF binary) or @var{s19} (Motorola S-records). The file must
|
|
contain a single section, and the contained data length must be exactly
|
|
912 bytes.
|
|
@quotation Attention
|
|
This cannot be reverted! Be careful!
|
|
@end quotation
|
|
Example:
|
|
@example
|
|
lpc2900 write_custom 0 /path_to/customer_info.bin bin
|
|
@end example
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
|
|
@deffn {Command} {lpc2900 secure_sector} bank first last
|
|
Secures the sector range from @var{first} to @var{last} (including) against
|
|
further program and erase operations. The sector security will be effective
|
|
after the next power cycle.
|
|
@quotation Attention
|
|
This cannot be reverted! Be careful!
|
|
@end quotation
|
|
Secured sectors appear as @emph{protected} in the @code{flash info} command.
|
|
Example:
|
|
@example
|
|
lpc2900 secure_sector 0 1 1
|
|
flash info 0
|
|
#0 : lpc2900 at 0x20000000, size 0x000c0000, (...)
|
|
# 0: 0x00000000 (0x2000 8kB) not protected
|
|
# 1: 0x00002000 (0x2000 8kB) protected
|
|
# 2: 0x00004000 (0x2000 8kB) not protected
|
|
@end example
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
|
|
@deffn {Command} {lpc2900 secure_jtag} bank
|
|
Irreversibly disable the JTAG port. The new JTAG security setting will be
|
|
effective after the next power cycle.
|
|
@quotation Attention
|
|
This cannot be reverted! Be careful!
|
|
@end quotation
|
|
Examples:
|
|
@example
|
|
lpc2900 secure_jtag 0
|
|
@end example
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
|
|
@deffn {Flash Driver} {mdr}
|
|
This drivers handles the integrated NOR flash on Milandr Cortex-M
|
|
based controllers. A known limitation is that the Info memory can't be
|
|
read or verified as it's not memory mapped.
|
|
|
|
@example
|
|
flash bank <name> mdr <base> <size> \
|
|
0 0 <target#> @var{type} @var{page_count} @var{sec_count}
|
|
@end example
|
|
|
|
@itemize @bullet
|
|
@item @var{type} - 0 for main memory, 1 for info memory
|
|
@item @var{page_count} - total number of pages
|
|
@item @var{sec_count} - number of sector per page count
|
|
@end itemize
|
|
|
|
Example usage:
|
|
@example
|
|
if @{ [info exists IMEMORY] && [string equal $IMEMORY true] @} @{
|
|
flash bank $@{_CHIPNAME@}_info.flash mdr 0x00000000 0x01000 \
|
|
0 0 $_TARGETNAME 1 1 4
|
|
@} else @{
|
|
flash bank $_CHIPNAME.flash mdr 0x00000000 0x20000 \
|
|
0 0 $_TARGETNAME 0 32 4
|
|
@}
|
|
@end example
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
|
|
@deffn {Flash Driver} {msp432}
|
|
All versions of the SimpleLink MSP432 microcontrollers from Texas
|
|
Instruments include internal flash. The msp432 flash driver automatically
|
|
recognizes the specific version's flash parameters and autoconfigures itself.
|
|
Main program flash starts at address 0. The information flash region on
|
|
MSP432P4 versions starts at address 0x200000.
|
|
|
|
@example
|
|
flash bank $_FLASHNAME msp432 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
|
|
@end example
|
|
|
|
@deffn {Command} {msp432 mass_erase} bank_id [main|all]
|
|
Performs a complete erase of flash. By default, @command{mass_erase} will erase
|
|
only the main program flash.
|
|
|
|
On MSP432P4 versions, using @command{mass_erase all} will erase both the
|
|
main program and information flash regions. To also erase the BSL in information
|
|
flash, the user must first use the @command{bsl} command.
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
|
|
@deffn {Command} {msp432 bsl} bank_id [unlock|lock]
|
|
On MSP432P4 versions, @command{bsl} unlocks and locks the bootstrap loader (BSL)
|
|
region in information flash so that flash commands can erase or write the BSL.
|
|
Leave the BSL locked to prevent accidentally corrupting the bootstrap loader.
|
|
|
|
To erase and program the BSL:
|
|
@example
|
|
msp432 bsl unlock
|
|
flash erase_address 0x202000 0x2000
|
|
flash write_image bsl.bin 0x202000
|
|
msp432 bsl lock
|
|
@end example
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
|
|
@deffn {Flash Driver} {niietcm4}
|
|
This drivers handles the integrated NOR flash on NIIET Cortex-M4
|
|
based controllers. Flash size and sector layout are auto-configured by the driver.
|
|
Main flash memory is called "Bootflash" and has main region and info region.
|
|
Info region is NOT memory mapped by default,
|
|
but it can replace first part of main region if needed.
|
|
Full erase, single and block writes are supported for both main and info regions.
|
|
There is additional not memory mapped flash called "Userflash", which
|
|
also have division into regions: main and info.
|
|
Purpose of userflash - to store system and user settings.
|
|
Driver has special commands to perform operations with this memory.
|
|
|
|
@example
|
|
flash bank $_FLASHNAME niietcm4 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
|
|
@end example
|
|
|
|
Some niietcm4-specific commands are defined:
|
|
|
|
@deffn {Command} {niietcm4 uflash_read_byte} bank ('main'|'info') address
|
|
Read byte from main or info userflash region.
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
|
|
@deffn {Command} {niietcm4 uflash_write_byte} bank ('main'|'info') address value
|
|
Write byte to main or info userflash region.
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
|
|
@deffn {Command} {niietcm4 uflash_full_erase} bank
|
|
Erase all userflash including info region.
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
|
|
@deffn {Command} {niietcm4 uflash_erase} bank ('main'|'info') first_sector last_sector
|
|
Erase sectors of main or info userflash region, starting at sector first up to and including last.
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
|
|
@deffn {Command} {niietcm4 uflash_protect_check} bank ('main'|'info')
|
|
Check sectors protect.
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
|
|
@deffn {Command} {niietcm4 uflash_protect} bank ('main'|'info') first_sector last_sector ('on'|'off')
|
|
Protect sectors of main or info userflash region, starting at sector first up to and including last.
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
|
|
@deffn {Command} {niietcm4 bflash_info_remap} bank ('on'|'off')
|
|
Enable remapping bootflash info region to 0x00000000 (or 0x40000000 if external memory boot used).
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
|
|
@deffn {Command} {niietcm4 extmem_cfg} bank ('gpioa'|'gpiob'|'gpioc'|'gpiod'|'gpioe'|'gpiof'|'gpiog'|'gpioh') pin_num ('func1'|'func3')
|
|
Configure external memory interface for boot.
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
|
|
@deffn {Command} {niietcm4 service_mode_erase} bank
|
|
Perform emergency erase of all flash (bootflash and userflash).
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
|
|
@deffn {Command} {niietcm4 driver_info} bank
|
|
Show information about flash driver.
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
|
|
@deffn {Flash Driver} {npcx}
|
|
All versions of the NPCX microcontroller families from Nuvoton include internal
|
|
flash. The NPCX flash driver supports the NPCX family of devices. The driver
|
|
automatically recognizes the specific version's flash parameters and
|
|
autoconfigures itself. The flash bank starts at address 0x64000000.
|
|
|
|
@example
|
|
flash bank $_FLASHNAME npcx 0x64000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
|
|
@end example
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
|
|
@deffn {Flash Driver} {nrf5}
|
|
All members of the nRF51 microcontroller families from Nordic Semiconductor
|
|
include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M0 core. nRF52 family powered
|
|
by ARM Cortex-M4 or M4F core is supported too. nRF52832 is fully supported
|
|
including BPROT flash protection scheme. nRF52833 and nRF52840 devices are
|
|
supported with the exception of security extensions (flash access control list
|
|
- ACL).
|
|
|
|
@example
|
|
flash bank $_FLASHNAME nrf5 0 0x00000000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
|
|
@end example
|
|
|
|
Some nrf5-specific commands are defined:
|
|
|
|
@deffn {Command} {nrf5 mass_erase}
|
|
Erases the contents of the code memory and user information
|
|
configuration registers as well. It must be noted that this command
|
|
works only for chips that do not have factory pre-programmed region 0
|
|
code.
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
|
|
@deffn {Command} {nrf5 info}
|
|
Decodes and shows information from FICR and UICR registers.
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
|
|
@deffn {Flash Driver} {ocl}
|
|
This driver is an implementation of the ``on chip flash loader''
|
|
protocol proposed by Pavel Chromy.
|
|
|
|
It is a minimalistic command-response protocol intended to be used
|
|
over a DCC when communicating with an internal or external flash
|
|
loader running from RAM. An example implementation for AT91SAM7x is
|
|
available in @file{contrib/loaders/flash/at91sam7x/}.
|
|
|
|
@example
|
|
flash bank $_FLASHNAME ocl 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
|
|
@end example
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
|
|
@deffn {Flash Driver} {pic32mx}
|
|
The PIC32MX microcontrollers are based on the MIPS 4K cores,
|
|
and integrate flash memory.
|
|
|
|
@example
|
|
flash bank $_FLASHNAME pix32mx 0x1fc00000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
|
|
flash bank $_FLASHNAME pix32mx 0x1d000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
|
|
@end example
|
|
|
|
@comment numerous *disabled* commands are defined:
|
|
@comment - chip_erase ... pointless given flash_erase_address
|
|
@comment - lock, unlock ... pointless given protect on/off (yes?)
|
|
@comment - pgm_word ... shouldn't bank be deduced from address??
|
|
Some pic32mx-specific commands are defined:
|
|
@deffn {Command} {pic32mx pgm_word} address value bank
|
|
Programs the specified 32-bit @var{value} at the given @var{address}
|
|
in the specified chip @var{bank}.
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
@deffn {Command} {pic32mx unlock} bank
|
|
Unlock and erase specified chip @var{bank}.
|
|
This will remove any Code Protection.
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
|
|
@deffn {Flash Driver} {psoc4}
|
|
All members of the PSoC 41xx/42xx microcontroller family from Cypress
|
|
include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M0 cores.
|
|
The driver automatically recognizes a number of these chips using
|
|
the chip identification register, and autoconfigures itself.
|
|
|
|
Note: Erased internal flash reads as 00.
|
|
System ROM of PSoC 4 does not implement erase of a flash sector.
|
|
|
|
@example
|
|
flash bank $_FLASHNAME psoc4 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
|
|
@end example
|
|
|
|
psoc4-specific commands
|
|
@deffn {Command} {psoc4 flash_autoerase} num (on|off)
|
|
Enables or disables autoerase mode for a flash bank.
|
|
|
|
If flash_autoerase is off, use mass_erase before flash programming.
|
|
Flash erase command fails if region to erase is not whole flash memory.
|
|
|
|
If flash_autoerase is on, a sector is both erased and programmed in one
|
|
system ROM call. Flash erase command is ignored.
|
|
This mode is suitable for gdb load.
|
|
|
|
The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
|
|
@deffn {Command} {psoc4 mass_erase} num
|
|
Erases the contents of the flash memory, protection and security lock.
|
|
|
|
The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
|
|
@deffn {Flash Driver} {psoc5lp}
|
|
All members of the PSoC 5LP microcontroller family from Cypress
|
|
include internal program flash and use ARM Cortex-M3 cores.
|
|
The driver probes for a number of these chips and autoconfigures itself,
|
|
apart from the base address.
|
|
|
|
@example
|
|
flash bank $_FLASHNAME psoc5lp 0x00000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
|
|
@end example
|
|
|
|
@b{Note:} PSoC 5LP chips can be configured to have ECC enabled or disabled.
|
|
@quotation Attention
|
|
If flash operations are performed in ECC-disabled mode, they will also affect
|
|
the ECC flash region. Erasing a 16k flash sector in the 0x00000000 area will
|
|
then also erase the corresponding 2k data bytes in the 0x48000000 area.
|
|
Writing to the ECC data bytes in ECC-disabled mode is not implemented.
|
|
@end quotation
|
|
|
|
Commands defined in the @var{psoc5lp} driver:
|
|
|
|
@deffn {Command} {psoc5lp mass_erase}
|
|
Erases all flash data and ECC/configuration bytes, all flash protection rows,
|
|
and all row latches in all flash arrays on the device.
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
|
|
@deffn {Flash Driver} {psoc5lp_eeprom}
|
|
All members of the PSoC 5LP microcontroller family from Cypress
|
|
include internal EEPROM and use ARM Cortex-M3 cores.
|
|
The driver probes for a number of these chips and autoconfigures itself,
|
|
apart from the base address.
|
|
|
|
@example
|
|
flash bank $_CHIPNAME.eeprom psoc5lp_eeprom 0x40008000 0 0 0 \
|
|
$_TARGETNAME
|
|
@end example
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
|
|
@deffn {Flash Driver} {psoc5lp_nvl}
|
|
All members of the PSoC 5LP microcontroller family from Cypress
|
|
include internal Nonvolatile Latches and use ARM Cortex-M3 cores.
|
|
The driver probes for a number of these chips and autoconfigures itself.
|
|
|
|
@example
|
|
flash bank $_CHIPNAME.nvl psoc5lp_nvl 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
|
|
@end example
|
|
|
|
PSoC 5LP chips have multiple NV Latches:
|
|
|
|
@itemize
|
|
@item Device Configuration NV Latch - 4 bytes
|
|
@item Write Once (WO) NV Latch - 4 bytes
|
|
@end itemize
|
|
|
|
@b{Note:} This driver only implements the Device Configuration NVL.
|
|
|
|
The @var{psoc5lp} driver reads the ECC mode from Device Configuration NVL.
|
|
@quotation Attention
|
|
Switching ECC mode via write to Device Configuration NVL will require a reset
|
|
after successful write.
|
|
@end quotation
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
|
|
@deffn {Flash Driver} {psoc6}
|
|
Supports PSoC6 (CY8C6xxx) family of Cypress microcontrollers.
|
|
PSoC6 is a dual-core device with CM0+ and CM4 cores. Both cores share
|
|
the same Flash/RAM/MMIO address space.
|
|
|
|
Flash in PSoC6 is split into three regions:
|
|
@itemize @bullet
|
|
@item Main Flash - this is the main storage for user application.
|
|
Total size varies among devices, sector size: 256 kBytes, row size:
|
|
512 bytes. Supports erase operation on individual rows.
|
|
@item Work Flash - intended to be used as storage for user data
|
|
(e.g. EEPROM emulation). Total size: 32 KBytes, sector size: 32 KBytes,
|
|
row size: 512 bytes.
|
|
@item Supervisory Flash - special region which contains device-specific
|
|
service data. This region does not support erase operation. Only few rows can
|
|
be programmed by the user, most of the rows are read only. Programming
|
|
operation will erase row automatically.
|
|
@end itemize
|
|
|
|
All three flash regions are supported by the driver. Flash geometry is detected
|
|
automatically by parsing data in SPCIF_GEOMETRY register.
|
|
|
|
PSoC6 is equipped with NOR Flash so erased Flash reads as 0x00.
|
|
|
|
@example
|
|
flash bank main_flash_cm0 psoc6 0x10000000 0 0 0 \
|
|
$@{TARGET@}.cm0
|
|
flash bank work_flash_cm0 psoc6 0x14000000 0 0 0 \
|
|
$@{TARGET@}.cm0
|
|
flash bank super_flash_user_cm0 psoc6 0x16000800 0 0 0 \
|
|
$@{TARGET@}.cm0
|
|
flash bank super_flash_nar_cm0 psoc6 0x16001A00 0 0 0 \
|
|
$@{TARGET@}.cm0
|
|
flash bank super_flash_key_cm0 psoc6 0x16005A00 0 0 0 \
|
|
$@{TARGET@}.cm0
|
|
flash bank super_flash_toc2_cm0 psoc6 0x16007C00 0 0 0 \
|
|
$@{TARGET@}.cm0
|
|
|
|
flash bank main_flash_cm4 psoc6 0x10000000 0 0 0 \
|
|
$@{TARGET@}.cm4
|
|
flash bank work_flash_cm4 psoc6 0x14000000 0 0 0 \
|
|
$@{TARGET@}.cm4
|
|
flash bank super_flash_user_cm4 psoc6 0x16000800 0 0 0 \
|
|
$@{TARGET@}.cm4
|
|
flash bank super_flash_nar_cm4 psoc6 0x16001A00 0 0 0 \
|
|
$@{TARGET@}.cm4
|
|
flash bank super_flash_key_cm4 psoc6 0x16005A00 0 0 0 \
|
|
$@{TARGET@}.cm4
|
|
flash bank super_flash_toc2_cm4 psoc6 0x16007C00 0 0 0 \
|
|
$@{TARGET@}.cm4
|
|
@end example
|
|
|
|
psoc6-specific commands
|
|
@deffn {Command} {psoc6 reset_halt}
|
|
Command can be used to simulate broken Vector Catch from gdbinit or tcl scripts.
|
|
When invoked for CM0+ target, it will set break point at application entry point
|
|
and issue SYSRESETREQ. This will reset both cores and all peripherals. CM0+ will
|
|
reset CM4 during boot anyway so this is safe. On CM4 target, VECTRESET is used
|
|
instead of SYSRESETREQ to avoid unwanted reset of CM0+;
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
|
|
@deffn {Command} {psoc6 mass_erase} num
|
|
Erases the contents given flash bank. The @var{num} parameter is a value shown
|
|
by @command{flash banks}.
|
|
Note: only Main and Work flash regions support Erase operation.
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
|
|
@deffn {Flash Driver} {rp2040}
|
|
Supports RP2040 "Raspberry Pi Pico" microcontroller.
|
|
RP2040 is a dual-core device with two CM0+ cores. Both cores share the same
|
|
Flash/RAM/MMIO address space. Non-volatile storage is achieved with an
|
|
external QSPI flash; a Boot ROM provides helper functions.
|
|
|
|
@example
|
|
flash bank $_FLASHNAME rp2040_flash $_FLASHBASE $_FLASHSIZE 1 32 $_TARGETNAME
|
|
@end example
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
|
|
@deffn {Flash Driver} {rsl10}
|
|
Supports Onsemi RSL10 microcontroller flash memory. Uses functions
|
|
stored in ROM to control flash memory interface.
|
|
|
|
@example
|
|
flash bank $_FLASHNAME rsl10 $_FLASHBASE $_FLASHSIZE 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
|
|
@end example
|
|
|
|
@deffn {Command} {rsl10 lock} key1 key2 key3 key4
|
|
Writes @var{key1 key2 key3 key4} words to @var{0x81044 0x81048 0x8104c
|
|
0x8050}. Locks debug port by writing @var{0x4C6F634B} to @var{0x81040}.
|
|
|
|
To unlock use the @command{rsl10 unlock key1 key2 key3 key4} command.
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
|
|
@deffn {Command} {rsl10 unlock} key1 key2 key3 key4
|
|
Unlocks debug port, by writing @var{key1 key2 key3 key4} words to
|
|
registers through DAP, and clears @var{0x81040} address in flash to 0x1.
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
|
|
@deffn {Command} {rsl10 mass_erase}
|
|
Erases all unprotected flash sectors.
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
|
|
@deffn {Flash Driver} {sim3x}
|
|
All members of the SiM3 microcontroller family from Silicon Laboratories
|
|
include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M3 cores. It supports both JTAG
|
|
and SWD interface.
|
|
The @var{sim3x} driver tries to probe the device to auto detect the MCU.
|
|
If this fails, it will use the @var{size} parameter as the size of flash bank.
|
|
|
|
@example
|
|
flash bank $_FLASHNAME sim3x 0 $_CPUROMSIZE 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
|
|
@end example
|
|
|
|
There are 2 commands defined in the @var{sim3x} driver:
|
|
|
|
@deffn {Command} {sim3x mass_erase}
|
|
Erases the complete flash. This is used to unlock the flash.
|
|
And this command is only possible when using the SWD interface.
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
|
|
@deffn {Command} {sim3x lock}
|
|
Lock the flash. To unlock use the @command{sim3x mass_erase} command.
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
|
|
@deffn {Flash Driver} {stellaris}
|
|
All members of the Stellaris LM3Sxxx, LM4x and Tiva C microcontroller
|
|
families from Texas Instruments include internal flash. The driver
|
|
automatically recognizes a number of these chips using the chip
|
|
identification register, and autoconfigures itself.
|
|
|
|
@example
|
|
flash bank $_FLASHNAME stellaris 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
|
|
@end example
|
|
|
|
@deffn {Command} {stellaris recover}
|
|
Performs the @emph{Recovering a "Locked" Device} procedure to restore
|
|
the flash and its associated nonvolatile registers to their factory
|
|
default values (erased). This is the only way to remove flash
|
|
protection or re-enable debugging if that capability has been
|
|
disabled.
|
|
|
|
Note that the final "power cycle the chip" step in this procedure
|
|
must be performed by hand, since OpenOCD can't do it.
|
|
@quotation Warning
|
|
if more than one Stellaris chip is connected, the procedure is
|
|
applied to all of them.
|
|
@end quotation
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
|
|
@deffn {Flash Driver} {stm32f1x}
|
|
All members of the STM32F0, STM32F1 and STM32F3 microcontroller families
|
|
from STMicroelectronics and all members of the GD32F1x0, GD32F3x0 and GD32E23x microcontroller
|
|
families from GigaDevice include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M0/M3/M4/M23 cores.
|
|
The driver also works with GD32VF103 powered by RISC-V core.
|
|
The driver automatically recognizes a number of these chips using
|
|
the chip identification register, and autoconfigures itself.
|
|
|
|
@example
|
|
flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32f1x 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
|
|
@end example
|
|
|
|
Note that some devices have been found that have a flash size register that contains
|
|
an invalid value, to workaround this issue you can override the probed value used by
|
|
the flash driver.
|
|
|
|
@example
|
|
flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32f1x 0 0x20000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
|
|
@end example
|
|
|
|
If you have a target with dual flash banks then define the second bank
|
|
as per the following example.
|
|
@example
|
|
flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32f1x 0x08080000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
|
|
@end example
|
|
|
|
Some stm32f1x-specific commands are defined:
|
|
|
|
@deffn {Command} {stm32f1x lock} num
|
|
Locks the entire stm32 device against reading.
|
|
The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
|
|
@deffn {Command} {stm32f1x unlock} num
|
|
Unlocks the entire stm32 device for reading. This command will cause
|
|
a mass erase of the entire stm32 device if previously locked.
|
|
The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
|
|
@deffn {Command} {stm32f1x mass_erase} num
|
|
Mass erases the entire stm32 device.
|
|
The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
|
|
@deffn {Command} {stm32f1x options_read} num
|
|
Reads and displays active stm32 option bytes loaded during POR
|
|
or upon executing the @command{stm32f1x options_load} command.
|
|
The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
|
|
@deffn {Command} {stm32f1x options_write} num (@option{SWWDG}|@option{HWWDG}) (@option{RSTSTNDBY}|@option{NORSTSTNDBY}) (@option{RSTSTOP}|@option{NORSTSTOP}) (@option{USEROPT} user_data)
|
|
Writes the stm32 option byte with the specified values.
|
|
The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
|
|
The @var{user_data} parameter is content of higher 16 bits of the option byte register (Data0 and Data1 as one 16bit number).
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
|
|
@deffn {Command} {stm32f1x options_load} num
|
|
Generates a special kind of reset to re-load the stm32 option bytes written
|
|
by the @command{stm32f1x options_write} or @command{flash protect} commands
|
|
without having to power cycle the target. Not applicable to stm32f1x devices.
|
|
The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
|
|
@deffn {Flash Driver} {stm32f2x}
|
|
All members of the STM32F2, STM32F4 and STM32F7 microcontroller families from STMicroelectronics
|
|
include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M3/M4/M7 cores.
|
|
The driver automatically recognizes a number of these chips using
|
|
the chip identification register, and autoconfigures itself.
|
|
|
|
@example
|
|
flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32f2x 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
|
|
@end example
|
|
|
|
If you use OTP (One-Time Programmable) memory define it as a second bank
|
|
as per the following example.
|
|
@example
|
|
flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32f2x 0x1FFF7800 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
|
|
@end example
|
|
|
|
@deffn {Command} {stm32f2x otp} num (@option{enable}|@option{disable}|@option{show})
|
|
Enables or disables OTP write commands for bank @var{num}.
|
|
The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
|
|
Note that some devices have been found that have a flash size register that contains
|
|
an invalid value, to workaround this issue you can override the probed value used by
|
|
the flash driver.
|
|
|
|
@example
|
|
flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32f2x 0 0x20000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
|
|
@end example
|
|
|
|
Some stm32f2x-specific commands are defined:
|
|
|
|
@deffn {Command} {stm32f2x lock} num
|
|
Locks the entire stm32 device.
|
|
The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
|
|
@deffn {Command} {stm32f2x unlock} num
|
|
Unlocks the entire stm32 device.
|
|
The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
|
|
@deffn {Command} {stm32f2x mass_erase} num
|
|
Mass erases the entire stm32f2x device.
|
|
The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
|
|
@deffn {Command} {stm32f2x options_read} num
|
|
Reads and displays user options and (where implemented) boot_addr0, boot_addr1, optcr2.
|
|
The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
|
|
@deffn {Command} {stm32f2x options_write} num user_options boot_addr0 boot_addr1
|
|
Writes user options and (where implemented) boot_addr0 and boot_addr1 in raw format.
|
|
Warning: The meaning of the various bits depends on the device, always check datasheet!
|
|
The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}, @var{user_options} a
|
|
12 bit value, consisting of bits 31-28 and 7-0 of FLASH_OPTCR, @var{boot_addr0} and
|
|
@var{boot_addr1} two halfwords (of FLASH_OPTCR1).
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
|
|
@deffn {Command} {stm32f2x optcr2_write} num optcr2
|
|
Writes FLASH_OPTCR2 options. Warning: Clearing PCROPi bits requires a full mass erase!
|
|
The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}, @var{optcr2} a 32-bit word.
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
|
|
@deffn {Flash Driver} {stm32h7x}
|
|
All members of the STM32H7 microcontroller families from STMicroelectronics
|
|
include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M7 core.
|
|
The driver automatically recognizes a number of these chips using
|
|
the chip identification register, and autoconfigures itself.
|
|
|
|
@example
|
|
flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32h7x 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
|
|
@end example
|
|
|
|
Note that some devices have been found that have a flash size register that contains
|
|
an invalid value, to workaround this issue you can override the probed value used by
|
|
the flash driver.
|
|
|
|
@example
|
|
flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32h7x 0 0x20000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
|
|
@end example
|
|
|
|
Some stm32h7x-specific commands are defined:
|
|
|
|
@deffn {Command} {stm32h7x lock} num
|
|
Locks the entire stm32 device.
|
|
The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
|
|
@deffn {Command} {stm32h7x unlock} num
|
|
Unlocks the entire stm32 device.
|
|
The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
|
|
@deffn {Command} {stm32h7x mass_erase} num
|
|
Mass erases the entire stm32h7x device.
|
|
The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
|
|
@deffn {Command} {stm32h7x option_read} num reg_offset
|
|
Reads an option byte register from the stm32h7x device.
|
|
The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}, @var{reg_offset}
|
|
is the register offset of the option byte to read from the used bank registers' base.
|
|
For example: in STM32H74x/H75x the bank 1 registers' base is 0x52002000 and 0x52002100 for bank 2.
|
|
|
|
Example usage:
|
|
@example
|
|
# read OPTSR_CUR
|
|
stm32h7x option_read 0 0x1c
|
|
# read WPSN_CUR1R
|
|
stm32h7x option_read 0 0x38
|
|
# read WPSN_CUR2R
|
|
stm32h7x option_read 1 0x38
|
|
@end example
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
|
|
@deffn {Command} {stm32h7x option_write} num reg_offset value [reg_mask]
|
|
Writes an option byte register of the stm32h7x device.
|
|
The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}, @var{reg_offset}
|
|
is the register offset of the option byte to write from the used bank register base,
|
|
and @var{reg_mask} is the mask to apply when writing the register (only bits with a '1'
|
|
will be touched).
|
|
|
|
Example usage:
|
|
@example
|
|
# swap bank 1 and bank 2 in dual bank devices
|
|
# by setting SWAP_BANK_OPT bit in OPTSR_PRG
|
|
stm32h7x option_write 0 0x20 0x8000000 0x8000000
|
|
@end example
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
|
|
@deffn {Flash Driver} {stm32lx}
|
|
All members of the STM32L0 and STM32L1 microcontroller families from STMicroelectronics
|
|
include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M3 and Cortex-M0+ cores.
|
|
The driver automatically recognizes a number of these chips using
|
|
the chip identification register, and autoconfigures itself.
|
|
|
|
@example
|
|
flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32lx 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
|
|
@end example
|
|
|
|
Note that some devices have been found that have a flash size register that contains
|
|
an invalid value, to workaround this issue you can override the probed value used by
|
|
the flash driver. If you use 0 as the bank base address, it tells the
|
|
driver to autodetect the bank location assuming you're configuring the
|
|
second bank.
|
|
|
|
@example
|
|
flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32lx 0x08000000 0x20000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
|
|
@end example
|
|
|
|
Some stm32lx-specific commands are defined:
|
|
|
|
@deffn {Command} {stm32lx lock} num
|
|
Locks the entire stm32 device.
|
|
The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
|
|
@deffn {Command} {stm32lx unlock} num
|
|
Unlocks the entire stm32 device.
|
|
The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
|
|
@deffn {Command} {stm32lx mass_erase} num
|
|
Mass erases the entire stm32lx device (all flash banks and EEPROM
|
|
data). This is the only way to unlock a protected flash (unless RDP
|
|
Level is 2 which can't be unlocked at all).
|
|
The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
|
|
@deffn {Flash Driver} {stm32l4x}
|
|
All members of the STM32 G0, G4, L4, L4+, L5, U5, WB and WL
|
|
microcontroller families from STMicroelectronics include internal flash
|
|
and use ARM Cortex-M0+, M4 and M33 cores.
|
|
The driver automatically recognizes a number of these chips using
|
|
the chip identification register, and autoconfigures itself.
|
|
|
|
@example
|
|
flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32l4x 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
|
|
@end example
|
|
|
|
If you use OTP (One-Time Programmable) memory define it as a second bank
|
|
as per the following example.
|
|
@example
|
|
flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32l4x 0x1FFF7000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
|
|
@end example
|
|
|
|
@deffn {Command} {stm32l4x otp} num (@option{enable}|@option{disable}|@option{show})
|
|
Enables or disables OTP write commands for bank @var{num}.
|
|
The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
|
|
Note that some devices have been found that have a flash size register that contains
|
|
an invalid value, to workaround this issue you can override the probed value used by
|
|
the flash driver. However, specifying a wrong value might lead to a completely
|
|
wrong flash layout, so this feature must be used carefully.
|
|
|
|
@example
|
|
flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32l4x 0x08000000 0x40000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
|
|
@end example
|
|
|
|
Some stm32l4x-specific commands are defined:
|
|
|
|
@deffn {Command} {stm32l4x lock} num
|
|
Locks the entire stm32 device.
|
|
The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
|
|
|
|
@emph{Note:} To apply the protection change immediately, use @command{stm32l4x option_load}.
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
|
|
@deffn {Command} {stm32l4x unlock} num
|
|
Unlocks the entire stm32 device.
|
|
The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
|
|
|
|
@emph{Note:} To apply the protection change immediately, use @command{stm32l4x option_load}.
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
|
|
@deffn {Command} {stm32l4x mass_erase} num
|
|
Mass erases the entire stm32l4x device.
|
|
The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
|
|
@deffn {Command} {stm32l4x option_read} num reg_offset
|
|
Reads an option byte register from the stm32l4x device.
|
|
The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}, @var{reg_offset}
|
|
is the register offset of the Option byte to read.
|
|
|
|
For example to read the FLASH_OPTR register:
|
|
@example
|
|
stm32l4x option_read 0 0x20
|
|
# Option Register (for STM32L4x): <0x40022020> = 0xffeff8aa
|
|
# Option Register (for STM32WBx): <0x58004020> = ...
|
|
# The correct flash base address will be used automatically
|
|
@end example
|
|
|
|
The above example will read out the FLASH_OPTR register which contains the RDP
|
|
option byte, Watchdog configuration, BOR level etc.
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
|
|
@deffn {Command} {stm32l4x option_write} num reg_offset reg_mask
|
|
Write an option byte register of the stm32l4x device.
|
|
The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}, @var{reg_offset}
|
|
is the register offset of the Option byte to write, and @var{reg_mask} is the mask
|
|
to apply when writing the register (only bits with a '1' will be touched).
|
|
|
|
@emph{Note:} To apply the option bytes change immediately, use @command{stm32l4x option_load}.
|
|
|
|
For example to write the WRP1AR option bytes:
|
|
@example
|
|
stm32l4x option_write 0 0x28 0x00FF0000 0x00FF00FF
|
|
@end example
|
|
|
|
The above example will write the WRP1AR option register configuring the Write protection
|
|
Area A for bank 1. The above example set WRP1AR_END=255, WRP1AR_START=0.
|
|
This will effectively write protect all sectors in flash bank 1.
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
|
|
@deffn {Command} {stm32l4x wrp_info} num [device_bank]
|
|
List the protected areas using WRP.
|
|
The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
|
|
@var{device_bank} parameter is optional, possible values 'bank1' or 'bank2',
|
|
if not specified, the command will display the whole flash protected areas.
|
|
|
|
@b{Note:} @var{device_bank} is different from banks created using @code{flash bank}.
|
|
Devices supported in this flash driver, can have main flash memory organized
|
|
in single or dual-banks mode.
|
|
Thus the usage of @var{device_bank} is meaningful only in dual-bank mode, to get
|
|
write protected areas in a specific @var{device_bank}
|
|
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
|
|
@deffn {Command} {stm32l4x option_load} num
|
|
Forces a re-load of the option byte registers. Will cause a system reset of the device.
|
|
The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
|
|
@deffn Command {stm32l4x trustzone} num [@option{enable} | @option{disable}]
|
|
Enables or disables Global TrustZone Security, using the TZEN option bit.
|
|
If neither @option{enabled} nor @option{disable} are specified, the command will display
|
|
the TrustZone status.
|
|
@emph{Note:} This command works only with devices with TrustZone, eg. STM32L5.
|
|
@emph{Note:} This command will perform an OBL_Launch after modifying the TZEN.
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
|
|
@deffn {Flash Driver} {str7x}
|
|
All members of the STR7 microcontroller family from STMicroelectronics
|
|
include internal flash and use ARM7TDMI cores.
|
|
The @var{str7x} driver defines one mandatory parameter, @var{variant},
|
|
which is either @code{STR71x}, @code{STR73x} or @code{STR75x}.
|
|
|
|
@example
|
|
flash bank $_FLASHNAME str7x \
|
|
0x40000000 0x00040000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME STR71x
|
|
@end example
|
|
|
|
@deffn {Command} {str7x disable_jtag} bank
|
|
Activate the Debug/Readout protection mechanism
|
|
for the specified flash bank.
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
|
|
@deffn {Flash Driver} {str9x}
|
|
Most members of the STR9 microcontroller family from STMicroelectronics
|
|
include internal flash and use ARM966E cores.
|
|
The str9 needs the flash controller to be configured using
|
|
the @command{str9x flash_config} command prior to Flash programming.
|
|
|
|
@example
|
|
flash bank $_FLASHNAME str9x 0x40000000 0x00040000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
|
|
str9x flash_config 0 4 2 0 0x80000
|
|
@end example
|
|
|
|
@deffn {Command} {str9x flash_config} num bbsr nbbsr bbadr nbbadr
|
|
Configures the str9 flash controller.
|
|
The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
|
|
|
|
@itemize @bullet
|
|
@item @var{bbsr} - Boot Bank Size register
|
|
@item @var{nbbsr} - Non Boot Bank Size register
|
|
@item @var{bbadr} - Boot Bank Start Address register
|
|
@item @var{nbbadr} - Boot Bank Start Address register
|
|
@end itemize
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
|
|
@deffn {Flash Driver} {str9xpec}
|
|
@cindex str9xpec
|
|
|
|
Only use this driver for locking/unlocking the device or configuring the option bytes.
|
|
Use the standard str9 driver for programming.
|
|
Before using the flash commands the turbo mode must be enabled using the
|
|
@command{str9xpec enable_turbo} command.
|
|
|
|
Here is some background info to help
|
|
you better understand how this driver works. OpenOCD has two flash drivers for
|
|
the str9:
|
|
@enumerate
|
|
@item
|
|
Standard driver @option{str9x} programmed via the str9 core. Normally used for
|
|
flash programming as it is faster than the @option{str9xpec} driver.
|
|
@item
|
|
Direct programming @option{str9xpec} using the flash controller. This is an
|
|
ISC compliant (IEEE 1532) tap connected in series with the str9 core. The str9
|
|
core does not need to be running to program using this flash driver. Typical use
|
|
for this driver is locking/unlocking the target and programming the option bytes.
|
|
@end enumerate
|
|
|
|
Before we run any commands using the @option{str9xpec} driver we must first disable
|
|
the str9 core. This example assumes the @option{str9xpec} driver has been
|
|
configured for flash bank 0.
|
|
@example
|
|
# assert srst, we do not want core running
|
|
# while accessing str9xpec flash driver
|
|
adapter assert srst
|
|
# turn off target polling
|
|
poll off
|
|
# disable str9 core
|
|
str9xpec enable_turbo 0
|
|
# read option bytes
|
|
str9xpec options_read 0
|
|
# re-enable str9 core
|
|
str9xpec disable_turbo 0
|
|
poll on
|
|
reset halt
|
|
@end example
|
|
The above example will read the str9 option bytes.
|
|
When performing a unlock remember that you will not be able to halt the str9 - it
|
|
has been locked. Halting the core is not required for the @option{str9xpec} driver
|
|
as mentioned above, just issue the commands above manually or from a telnet prompt.
|
|
|
|
Several str9xpec-specific commands are defined:
|
|
|
|
@deffn {Command} {str9xpec disable_turbo} num
|
|
Restore the str9 into JTAG chain.
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
|
|
@deffn {Command} {str9xpec enable_turbo} num
|
|
Enable turbo mode, will simply remove the str9 from the chain and talk
|
|
directly to the embedded flash controller.
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
|
|
@deffn {Command} {str9xpec lock} num
|
|
Lock str9 device. The str9 will only respond to an unlock command that will
|
|
erase the device.
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
|
|
@deffn {Command} {str9xpec part_id} num
|
|
Prints the part identifier for bank @var{num}.
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
|
|
@deffn {Command} {str9xpec options_cmap} num (@option{bank0}|@option{bank1})
|
|
Configure str9 boot bank.
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
|
|
@deffn {Command} {str9xpec options_lvdsel} num (@option{vdd}|@option{vdd_vddq})
|
|
Configure str9 lvd source.
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
|
|
@deffn {Command} {str9xpec options_lvdthd} num (@option{2.4v}|@option{2.7v})
|
|
Configure str9 lvd threshold.
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
|
|
@deffn {Command} {str9xpec options_lvdwarn} bank (@option{vdd}|@option{vdd_vddq})
|
|
Configure str9 lvd reset warning source.
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
|
|
@deffn {Command} {str9xpec options_read} num
|
|
Read str9 option bytes.
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
|
|
@deffn {Command} {str9xpec options_write} num
|
|
Write str9 option bytes.
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
|
|
@deffn {Command} {str9xpec unlock} num
|
|
unlock str9 device.
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
|
|
@deffn {Flash Driver} {swm050}
|
|
@cindex swm050
|
|
All members of the swm050 microcontroller family from Foshan Synwit Tech.
|
|
|
|
@example
|
|
flash bank $_FLASHNAME swm050 0x0 0x2000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
|
|
@end example
|
|
|
|
One swm050-specific command is defined:
|
|
|
|
@deffn {Command} {swm050 mass_erase} bank_id
|
|
Erases the entire flash bank.
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
|
|
|
|
@deffn {Flash Driver} {tms470}
|
|
Most members of the TMS470 microcontroller family from Texas Instruments
|
|
include internal flash and use ARM7TDMI cores.
|
|
This driver doesn't require the chip and bus width to be specified.
|
|
|
|
Some tms470-specific commands are defined:
|
|
|
|
@deffn {Command} {tms470 flash_keyset} key0 key1 key2 key3
|
|
Saves programming keys in a register, to enable flash erase and write commands.
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
|
|
@deffn {Command} {tms470 osc_megahertz} clock_mhz
|
|
Reports the clock speed, which is used to calculate timings.
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
|
|
@deffn {Command} {tms470 plldis} (0|1)
|
|
Disables (@var{1}) or enables (@var{0}) use of the PLL to speed up
|
|
the flash clock.
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
|
|
@deffn {Flash Driver} {w600}
|
|
W60x series Wi-Fi SoC from WinnerMicro
|
|
are designed with ARM Cortex-M3 and have 1M Byte QFLASH inside.
|
|
The @var{w600} driver uses the @var{target} parameter to select the
|
|
correct bank config.
|
|
|
|
@example
|
|
flash bank $_FLASHNAME w600 0x08000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAMEs
|
|
@end example
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
|
|
@deffn {Flash Driver} {xmc1xxx}
|
|
All members of the XMC1xxx microcontroller family from Infineon.
|
|
This driver does not require the chip and bus width to be specified.
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
|
|
@deffn {Flash Driver} {xmc4xxx}
|
|
All members of the XMC4xxx microcontroller family from Infineon.
|
|
This driver does not require the chip and bus width to be specified.
|
|
|
|
Some xmc4xxx-specific commands are defined:
|
|
|
|
@deffn {Command} {xmc4xxx flash_password} bank_id passwd1 passwd2
|
|
Saves flash protection passwords which are used to lock the user flash
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
|
|
@deffn {Command} {xmc4xxx flash_unprotect} bank_id user_level[0-1]
|
|
Removes Flash write protection from the selected user bank
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
|
|
@section NAND Flash Commands
|
|
@cindex NAND
|
|
|
|
Compared to NOR or SPI flash, NAND devices are inexpensive
|
|
and high density. Today's NAND chips, and multi-chip modules,
|
|
commonly hold multiple GigaBytes of data.
|
|
|
|
NAND chips consist of a number of ``erase blocks'' of a given
|
|
size (such as 128 KBytes), each of which is divided into a
|
|
number of pages (of perhaps 512 or 2048 bytes each). Each
|
|
page of a NAND flash has an ``out of band'' (OOB) area to hold
|
|
Error Correcting Code (ECC) and other metadata, usually 16 bytes
|
|
of OOB for every 512 bytes of page data.
|
|
|
|
One key characteristic of NAND flash is that its error rate
|
|
is higher than that of NOR flash. In normal operation, that
|
|
ECC is used to correct and detect errors. However, NAND
|
|
blocks can also wear out and become unusable; those blocks
|
|
are then marked "bad". NAND chips are even shipped from the
|
|
manufacturer with a few bad blocks. The highest density chips
|
|
use a technology (MLC) that wears out more quickly, so ECC
|
|
support is increasingly important as a way to detect blocks
|
|
that have begun to fail, and help to preserve data integrity
|
|
with techniques such as wear leveling.
|
|
|
|
Software is used to manage the ECC. Some controllers don't
|
|
support ECC directly; in those cases, software ECC is used.
|
|
Other controllers speed up the ECC calculations with hardware.
|
|
Single-bit error correction hardware is routine. Controllers
|
|
geared for newer MLC chips may correct 4 or more errors for
|
|
every 512 bytes of data.
|
|
|
|
You will need to make sure that any data you write using
|
|
OpenOCD includes the appropriate kind of ECC. For example,
|
|
that may mean passing the @code{oob_softecc} flag when
|
|
writing NAND data, or ensuring that the correct hardware
|
|
ECC mode is used.
|
|
|
|
The basic steps for using NAND devices include:
|
|
@enumerate
|
|
@item Declare via the command @command{nand device}
|
|
@* Do this in a board-specific configuration file,
|
|
passing parameters as needed by the controller.
|
|
@item Configure each device using @command{nand probe}.
|
|
@* Do this only after the associated target is set up,
|
|
such as in its reset-init script or in procures defined
|
|
to access that device.
|
|
@item Operate on the flash via @command{nand subcommand}
|
|
@* Often commands to manipulate the flash are typed by a human, or run
|
|
via a script in some automated way. Common task include writing a
|
|
boot loader, operating system, or other data needed to initialize or
|
|
de-brick a board.
|
|
@end enumerate
|
|
|
|
@b{NOTE:} At the time this text was written, the largest NAND
|
|
flash fully supported by OpenOCD is 2 GiBytes (16 GiBits).
|
|
This is because the variables used to hold offsets and lengths
|
|
are only 32 bits wide.
|
|
(Larger chips may work in some cases, unless an offset or length
|
|
is larger than 0xffffffff, the largest 32-bit unsigned integer.)
|
|
Some larger devices will work, since they are actually multi-chip
|
|
modules with two smaller chips and individual chipselect lines.
|
|
|
|
@anchor{nandconfiguration}
|
|
@subsection NAND Configuration Commands
|
|
@cindex NAND configuration
|
|
|
|
NAND chips must be declared in configuration scripts,
|
|
plus some additional configuration that's done after
|
|
OpenOCD has initialized.
|
|
|
|
@deffn {Config Command} {nand device} name driver target [configparams...]
|
|
Declares a NAND device, which can be read and written to
|
|
after it has been configured through @command{nand probe}.
|
|
In OpenOCD, devices are single chips; this is unlike some
|
|
operating systems, which may manage multiple chips as if
|
|
they were a single (larger) device.
|
|
In some cases, configuring a device will activate extra
|
|
commands; see the controller-specific documentation.
|
|
|
|
@b{NOTE:} This command is not available after OpenOCD
|
|
initialization has completed. Use it in board specific
|
|
configuration files, not interactively.
|
|
|
|
@itemize @bullet
|
|
@item @var{name} ... may be used to reference the NAND bank
|
|
in most other NAND commands. A number is also available.
|
|
@item @var{driver} ... identifies the NAND controller driver
|
|
associated with the NAND device being declared.
|
|
@xref{nanddriverlist,,NAND Driver List}.
|
|
@item @var{target} ... names the target used when issuing
|
|
commands to the NAND controller.
|
|
@comment Actually, it's currently a controller-specific parameter...
|
|
@item @var{configparams} ... controllers may support, or require,
|
|
additional parameters. See the controller-specific documentation
|
|
for more information.
|
|
@end itemize
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
|
|
@deffn {Command} {nand list}
|
|
Prints a summary of each device declared
|
|
using @command{nand device}, numbered from zero.
|
|
Note that un-probed devices show no details.
|
|
@example
|
|
> nand list
|
|
#0: NAND 1GiB 3,3V 8-bit (Micron) pagesize: 2048, buswidth: 8,
|
|
blocksize: 131072, blocks: 8192
|
|
#1: NAND 1GiB 3,3V 8-bit (Micron) pagesize: 2048, buswidth: 8,
|
|
blocksize: 131072, blocks: 8192
|
|
>
|
|
@end example
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
|
|
@deffn {Command} {nand probe} num
|
|
Probes the specified device to determine key characteristics
|
|
like its page and block sizes, and how many blocks it has.
|
|
The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
|
|
You must (successfully) probe a device before you can use
|
|
it with most other NAND commands.
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
|
|
@subsection Erasing, Reading, Writing to NAND Flash
|
|
|
|
@deffn {Command} {nand dump} num filename offset length [oob_option]
|
|
@cindex NAND reading
|
|
Reads binary data from the NAND device and writes it to the file,
|
|
starting at the specified offset.
|
|
The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
|
|
|
|
Use a complete path name for @var{filename}, so you don't depend
|
|
on the directory used to start the OpenOCD server.
|
|
|
|
The @var{offset} and @var{length} must be exact multiples of the
|
|
device's page size. They describe a data region; the OOB data
|
|
associated with each such page may also be accessed.
|
|
|
|
@b{NOTE:} At the time this text was written, no error correction
|
|
was done on the data that's read, unless raw access was disabled
|
|
and the underlying NAND controller driver had a @code{read_page}
|
|
method which handled that error correction.
|
|
|
|
By default, only page data is saved to the specified file.
|
|
Use an @var{oob_option} parameter to save OOB data:
|
|
@itemize @bullet
|
|
@item no oob_* parameter
|
|
@*Output file holds only page data; OOB is discarded.
|
|
@item @code{oob_raw}
|
|
@*Output file interleaves page data and OOB data;
|
|
the file will be longer than "length" by the size of the
|
|
spare areas associated with each data page.
|
|
Note that this kind of "raw" access is different from
|
|
what's implied by @command{nand raw_access}, which just
|
|
controls whether a hardware-aware access method is used.
|
|
@item @code{oob_only}
|
|
@*Output file has only raw OOB data, and will
|
|
be smaller than "length" since it will contain only the
|
|
spare areas associated with each data page.
|
|
@end itemize
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
|
|
@deffn {Command} {nand erase} num [offset length]
|
|
@cindex NAND erasing
|
|
@cindex NAND programming
|
|
Erases blocks on the specified NAND device, starting at the
|
|
specified @var{offset} and continuing for @var{length} bytes.
|
|
Both of those values must be exact multiples of the device's
|
|
block size, and the region they specify must fit entirely in the chip.
|
|
If those parameters are not specified,
|
|
the whole NAND chip will be erased.
|
|
The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
|
|
|
|
@b{NOTE:} This command will try to erase bad blocks, when told
|
|
to do so, which will probably invalidate the manufacturer's bad
|
|
block marker.
|
|
For the remainder of the current server session, @command{nand info}
|
|
will still report that the block ``is'' bad.
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
|
|
@deffn {Command} {nand write} num filename offset [option...]
|
|
@cindex NAND writing
|
|
@cindex NAND programming
|
|
Writes binary data from the file into the specified NAND device,
|
|
starting at the specified offset. Those pages should already
|
|
have been erased; you can't change zero bits to one bits.
|
|
The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
|
|
|
|
Use a complete path name for @var{filename}, so you don't depend
|
|
on the directory used to start the OpenOCD server.
|
|
|
|
The @var{offset} must be an exact multiple of the device's page size.
|
|
All data in the file will be written, assuming it doesn't run
|
|
past the end of the device.
|
|
Only full pages are written, and any extra space in the last
|
|
page will be filled with 0xff bytes. (That includes OOB data,
|
|
if that's being written.)
|
|
|
|
@b{NOTE:} At the time this text was written, bad blocks are
|
|
ignored. That is, this routine will not skip bad blocks,
|
|
but will instead try to write them. This can cause problems.
|
|
|
|
Provide at most one @var{option} parameter. With some
|
|
NAND drivers, the meanings of these parameters may change
|
|
if @command{nand raw_access} was used to disable hardware ECC.
|
|
@itemize @bullet
|
|
@item no oob_* parameter
|
|
@*File has only page data, which is written.
|
|
If raw access is in use, the OOB area will not be written.
|
|
Otherwise, if the underlying NAND controller driver has
|
|
a @code{write_page} routine, that routine may write the OOB
|
|
with hardware-computed ECC data.
|
|
@item @code{oob_only}
|
|
@*File has only raw OOB data, which is written to the OOB area.
|
|
Each page's data area stays untouched. @i{This can be a dangerous
|
|
option}, since it can invalidate the ECC data.
|
|
You may need to force raw access to use this mode.
|
|
@item @code{oob_raw}
|
|
@*File interleaves data and OOB data, both of which are written
|
|
If raw access is enabled, the data is written first, then the
|
|
un-altered OOB.
|
|
Otherwise, if the underlying NAND controller driver has
|
|
a @code{write_page} routine, that routine may modify the OOB
|
|
before it's written, to include hardware-computed ECC data.
|
|
@item @code{oob_softecc}
|
|
@*File has only page data, which is written.
|
|
The OOB area is filled with 0xff, except for a standard 1-bit
|
|
software ECC code stored in conventional locations.
|
|
You might need to force raw access to use this mode, to prevent
|
|
the underlying driver from applying hardware ECC.
|
|
@item @code{oob_softecc_kw}
|
|
@*File has only page data, which is written.
|
|
The OOB area is filled with 0xff, except for a 4-bit software ECC
|
|
specific to the boot ROM in Marvell Kirkwood SoCs.
|
|
You might need to force raw access to use this mode, to prevent
|
|
the underlying driver from applying hardware ECC.
|
|
@end itemize
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
|
|
@deffn {Command} {nand verify} num filename offset [option...]
|
|
@cindex NAND verification
|
|
@cindex NAND programming
|
|
Verify the binary data in the file has been programmed to the
|
|
specified NAND device, starting at the specified offset.
|
|
The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
|
|
|
|
Use a complete path name for @var{filename}, so you don't depend
|
|
on the directory used to start the OpenOCD server.
|
|
|
|
The @var{offset} must be an exact multiple of the device's page size.
|
|
All data in the file will be read and compared to the contents of the
|
|
flash, assuming it doesn't run past the end of the device.
|
|
As with @command{nand write}, only full pages are verified, so any extra
|
|
space in the last page will be filled with 0xff bytes.
|
|
|
|
The same @var{options} accepted by @command{nand write},
|
|
and the file will be processed similarly to produce the buffers that
|
|
can be compared against the contents produced from @command{nand dump}.
|
|
|
|
@b{NOTE:} This will not work when the underlying NAND controller
|
|
driver's @code{write_page} routine must update the OOB with a
|
|
hardware-computed ECC before the data is written. This limitation may
|
|
be removed in a future release.
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
|
|
@subsection Other NAND commands
|
|
@cindex NAND other commands
|
|
|
|
@deffn {Command} {nand check_bad_blocks} num [offset length]
|
|
Checks for manufacturer bad block markers on the specified NAND
|
|
device. If no parameters are provided, checks the whole
|
|
device; otherwise, starts at the specified @var{offset} and
|
|
continues for @var{length} bytes.
|
|
Both of those values must be exact multiples of the device's
|
|
block size, and the region they specify must fit entirely in the chip.
|
|
The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
|
|
|
|
@b{NOTE:} Before using this command you should force raw access
|
|
with @command{nand raw_access enable} to ensure that the underlying
|
|
driver will not try to apply hardware ECC.
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
|
|
@deffn {Command} {nand info} num
|
|
The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
|
|
This prints the one-line summary from "nand list", plus for
|
|
devices which have been probed this also prints any known
|
|
status for each block.
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
|
|
@deffn {Command} {nand raw_access} num (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
|
|
Sets or clears an flag affecting how page I/O is done.
|
|
The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
|
|
|
|
This flag is cleared (disabled) by default, but changing that
|
|
value won't affect all NAND devices. The key factor is whether
|
|
the underlying driver provides @code{read_page} or @code{write_page}
|
|
methods. If it doesn't provide those methods, the setting of
|
|
this flag is irrelevant; all access is effectively ``raw''.
|
|
|
|
When those methods exist, they are normally used when reading
|
|
data (@command{nand dump} or reading bad block markers) or
|
|
writing it (@command{nand write}). However, enabling
|
|
raw access (setting the flag) prevents use of those methods,
|
|
bypassing hardware ECC logic.
|
|
@i{This can be a dangerous option}, since writing blocks
|
|
with the wrong ECC data can cause them to be marked as bad.
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
|
|
@anchor{nanddriverlist}
|
|
@subsection NAND Driver List
|
|
As noted above, the @command{nand device} command allows
|
|
driver-specific options and behaviors.
|
|
Some controllers also activate controller-specific commands.
|
|
|
|
@deffn {NAND Driver} {at91sam9}
|
|
This driver handles the NAND controllers found on AT91SAM9 family chips from
|
|
Atmel. It takes two extra parameters: address of the NAND chip;
|
|
address of the ECC controller.
|
|
@example
|
|
nand device $NANDFLASH at91sam9 $CHIPNAME 0x40000000 0xfffffe800
|
|
@end example
|
|
AT91SAM9 chips support single-bit ECC hardware. The @code{write_page} and
|
|
@code{read_page} methods are used to utilize the ECC hardware unless they are
|
|
disabled by using the @command{nand raw_access} command. There are four
|
|
additional commands that are needed to fully configure the AT91SAM9 NAND
|
|
controller. Two are optional; most boards use the same wiring for ALE/CLE:
|
|
@deffn {Config Command} {at91sam9 cle} num addr_line
|
|
Configure the address line used for latching commands. The @var{num}
|
|
parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
@deffn {Config Command} {at91sam9 ale} num addr_line
|
|
Configure the address line used for latching addresses. The @var{num}
|
|
parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
|
|
For the next two commands, it is assumed that the pins have already been
|
|
properly configured for input or output.
|
|
@deffn {Config Command} {at91sam9 rdy_busy} num pio_base_addr pin
|
|
Configure the RDY/nBUSY input from the NAND device. The @var{num}
|
|
parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}. @var{pio_base_addr}
|
|
is the base address of the PIO controller and @var{pin} is the pin number.
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
@deffn {Config Command} {at91sam9 ce} num pio_base_addr pin
|
|
Configure the chip enable input to the NAND device. The @var{num}
|
|
parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}. @var{pio_base_addr}
|
|
is the base address of the PIO controller and @var{pin} is the pin number.
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
|
|
@deffn {NAND Driver} {davinci}
|
|
This driver handles the NAND controllers found on DaVinci family
|
|
chips from Texas Instruments.
|
|
It takes three extra parameters:
|
|
address of the NAND chip;
|
|
hardware ECC mode to use (@option{hwecc1},
|
|
@option{hwecc4}, @option{hwecc4_infix});
|
|
address of the AEMIF controller on this processor.
|
|
@example
|
|
nand device davinci dm355.arm 0x02000000 hwecc4 0x01e10000
|
|
@end example
|
|
All DaVinci processors support the single-bit ECC hardware,
|
|
and newer ones also support the four-bit ECC hardware.
|
|
The @code{write_page} and @code{read_page} methods are used
|
|
to implement those ECC modes, unless they are disabled using
|
|
the @command{nand raw_access} command.
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
|
|
@deffn {NAND Driver} {lpc3180}
|
|
These controllers require an extra @command{nand device}
|
|
parameter: the clock rate used by the controller.
|
|
@deffn {Command} {lpc3180 select} num [mlc|slc]
|
|
Configures use of the MLC or SLC controller mode.
|
|
MLC implies use of hardware ECC.
|
|
The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
|
|
At this writing, this driver includes @code{write_page}
|
|
and @code{read_page} methods. Using @command{nand raw_access}
|
|
to disable those methods will prevent use of hardware ECC
|
|
in the MLC controller mode, but won't change SLC behavior.
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
@comment current lpc3180 code won't issue 5-byte address cycles
|
|
|
|
@deffn {NAND Driver} {mx3}
|
|
This driver handles the NAND controller in i.MX31. The mxc driver
|
|
should work for this chip as well.
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
|
|
@deffn {NAND Driver} {mxc}
|
|
This driver handles the NAND controller found in Freescale i.MX
|
|
chips. It has support for v1 (i.MX27 and i.MX31) and v2 (i.MX35).
|
|
The driver takes 3 extra arguments, chip (@option{mx27},
|
|
@option{mx31}, @option{mx35}), ecc (@option{noecc}, @option{hwecc})
|
|
and optionally if bad block information should be swapped between
|
|
main area and spare area (@option{biswap}), defaults to off.
|
|
@example
|
|
nand device mx35.nand mxc imx35.cpu mx35 hwecc biswap
|
|
@end example
|
|
@deffn {Command} {mxc biswap} bank_num [enable|disable]
|
|
Turns on/off bad block information swapping from main area,
|
|
without parameter query status.
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
|
|
@deffn {NAND Driver} {orion}
|
|
These controllers require an extra @command{nand device}
|
|
parameter: the address of the controller.
|
|
@example
|
|
nand device orion 0xd8000000
|
|
@end example
|
|
These controllers don't define any specialized commands.
|
|
At this writing, their drivers don't include @code{write_page}
|
|
or @code{read_page} methods, so @command{nand raw_access} won't
|
|
change any behavior.
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
|
|
@deffn {NAND Driver} {s3c2410}
|
|
@deffnx {NAND Driver} {s3c2412}
|
|
@deffnx {NAND Driver} {s3c2440}
|
|
@deffnx {NAND Driver} {s3c2443}
|
|
@deffnx {NAND Driver} {s3c6400}
|
|
These S3C family controllers don't have any special
|
|
@command{nand device} options, and don't define any
|
|
specialized commands.
|
|
At this writing, their drivers don't include @code{write_page}
|
|
or @code{read_page} methods, so @command{nand raw_access} won't
|
|
change any behavior.
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
|
|
@node Flash Programming
|
|
@chapter Flash Programming
|
|
|
|
OpenOCD implements numerous ways to program the target flash, whether internal or external.
|
|
Programming can be achieved by either using @ref{programmingusinggdb,,Programming using GDB},
|
|
or using the commands given in @ref{flashprogrammingcommands,,Flash Programming Commands}.
|
|
|
|
@*To simplify using the flash commands directly a jimtcl script is available that handles the programming and verify stage.
|
|
OpenOCD will program/verify/reset the target and optionally shutdown.
|
|
|
|
The script is executed as follows and by default the following actions will be performed.
|
|
@enumerate
|
|
@item 'init' is executed.
|
|
@item 'reset init' is called to reset and halt the target, any 'reset init' scripts are executed.
|
|
@item @code{flash write_image} is called to erase and write any flash using the filename given.
|
|
@item If the @option{preverify} parameter is given, the target is "verified" first and only flashed if this fails.
|
|
@item @code{verify_image} is called if @option{verify} parameter is given.
|
|
@item @code{reset run} is called if @option{reset} parameter is given.
|
|
@item OpenOCD is shutdown if @option{exit} parameter is given.
|
|
@end enumerate
|
|
|
|
An example of usage is given below. @xref{program}.
|
|
|
|
@example
|
|
# program and verify using elf/hex/s19. verify and reset
|
|
# are optional parameters
|
|
openocd -f board/stm32f3discovery.cfg \
|
|
-c "program filename.elf verify reset exit"
|
|
|
|
# binary files need the flash address passing
|
|
openocd -f board/stm32f3discovery.cfg \
|
|
-c "program filename.bin exit 0x08000000"
|
|
@end example
|
|
|
|
@node PLD/FPGA Commands
|
|
@chapter PLD/FPGA Commands
|
|
@cindex PLD
|
|
@cindex FPGA
|
|
|
|
Programmable Logic Devices (PLDs) and the more flexible
|
|
Field Programmable Gate Arrays (FPGAs) are both types of programmable hardware.
|
|
OpenOCD can support programming them.
|
|
Although PLDs are generally restrictive (cells are less functional, and
|
|
there are no special purpose cells for memory or computational tasks),
|
|
they share the same OpenOCD infrastructure.
|
|
Accordingly, both are called PLDs here.
|
|
|
|
@section PLD/FPGA Configuration and Commands
|
|
|
|
As it does for JTAG TAPs, debug targets, and flash chips (both NOR and NAND),
|
|
OpenOCD maintains a list of PLDs available for use in various commands.
|
|
Also, each such PLD requires a driver.
|
|
|
|
They are referenced by the number shown by the @command{pld devices} command,
|
|
and new PLDs are defined by @command{pld device driver_name}.
|
|
|
|
@deffn {Config Command} {pld device} driver_name tap_name [driver_options]
|
|
Defines a new PLD device, supported by driver @var{driver_name},
|
|
using the TAP named @var{tap_name}.
|
|
The driver may make use of any @var{driver_options} to configure its
|
|
behavior.
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
|
|
@deffn {Command} {pld devices}
|
|
Lists the PLDs and their numbers.
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
|
|
@deffn {Command} {pld load} num filename
|
|
Loads the file @file{filename} into the PLD identified by @var{num}.
|
|
The file format must be inferred by the driver.
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
|
|
@section PLD/FPGA Drivers, Options, and Commands
|
|
|
|
Drivers may support PLD-specific options to the @command{pld device}
|
|
definition command, and may also define commands usable only with
|
|
that particular type of PLD.
|
|
|
|
@deffn {FPGA Driver} {virtex2} [no_jstart]
|
|
Virtex-II is a family of FPGAs sold by Xilinx.
|
|
This driver can also be used to load Series3, Series6, Series7 and Zynq 7000 devices.
|
|
It supports the IEEE 1532 standard for In-System Configuration (ISC).
|
|
|
|
If @var{no_jstart} is non-zero, the JSTART instruction is not used after
|
|
loading the bitstream. While required for Series2, Series3, and Series6, it
|
|
breaks bitstream loading on Series7.
|
|
|
|
@example
|
|
openocd -f board/digilent_zedboard.cfg -c "init" \
|
|
-c "pld load 0 zedboard_bitstream.bit"
|
|
@end example
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@deffn {Command} {virtex2 read_stat} num
|
|
Reads and displays the Virtex-II status register (STAT)
|
|
for FPGA @var{num}.
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
|
|
@node General Commands
|
|
@chapter General Commands
|
|
@cindex commands
|
|
|
|
The commands documented in this chapter here are common commands that
|
|
you, as a human, may want to type and see the output of. Configuration type
|
|
commands are documented elsewhere.
|
|
|
|
Intent:
|
|
@itemize @bullet
|
|
@item @b{Source Of Commands}
|
|
@* OpenOCD commands can occur in a configuration script (discussed
|
|
elsewhere) or typed manually by a human or supplied programmatically,
|
|
or via one of several TCP/IP Ports.
|
|
|
|
@item @b{From the human}
|
|
@* A human should interact with the telnet interface (default port: 4444)
|
|
or via GDB (default port 3333).
|
|
|
|
To issue commands from within a GDB session, use the @option{monitor}
|
|
command, e.g. use @option{monitor poll} to issue the @option{poll}
|
|
command. All output is relayed through the GDB session.
|
|
|
|
@item @b{Machine Interface}
|
|
The Tcl interface's intent is to be a machine interface. The default Tcl
|
|
port is 6666.
|
|
@end itemize
|
|
|
|
|
|
@section Server Commands
|
|
|
|
@deffn {Command} {exit}
|
|
Exits the current telnet session.
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
|
|
@deffn {Command} {help} [string]
|
|
With no parameters, prints help text for all commands.
|
|
Otherwise, prints each helptext containing @var{string}.
|
|
Not every command provides helptext.
|
|
|
|
Configuration commands, and commands valid at any time, are
|
|
explicitly noted in parenthesis.
|
|
In most cases, no such restriction is listed; this indicates commands
|
|
which are only available after the configuration stage has completed.
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
|
|
@deffn {Command} {usage} [string]
|
|
With no parameters, prints usage text for all commands. Otherwise,
|
|
prints all usage text of which command, help text, and usage text
|
|
containing @var{string}.
|
|
Not every command provides helptext.
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
|
|
@deffn {Command} {sleep} msec [@option{busy}]
|
|
Wait for at least @var{msec} milliseconds before resuming.
|
|
If @option{busy} is passed, busy-wait instead of sleeping.
|
|
(This option is strongly discouraged.)
|
|
Useful in connection with script files
|
|
(@command{script} command and @command{target_name} configuration).
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
|
|
@deffn {Command} {shutdown} [@option{error}]
|
|
Close the OpenOCD server, disconnecting all clients (GDB, telnet,
|
|
other). If option @option{error} is used, OpenOCD will return a
|
|
non-zero exit code to the parent process.
|
|
|
|
If user types CTRL-C or kills OpenOCD, the command @command{shutdown}
|
|
will be automatically executed to cause OpenOCD to exit.
|
|
|
|
It is possible to specify, in the TCL list @var{pre_shutdown_commands} , a
|
|
set of commands to be automatically executed before @command{shutdown} , e.g.:
|
|
@example
|
|
lappend pre_shutdown_commands @{echo "Goodbye, my friend ..."@}
|
|
lappend pre_shutdown_commands @{echo "see you soon !"@}
|
|
@end example
|
|
The commands in the list will be executed (in the same order they occupy
|
|
in the list) before OpenOCD exits. If one of the commands in the list
|
|
fails, then the remaining commands are not executed anymore while OpenOCD
|
|
will proceed to quit.
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
|
|
@anchor{debuglevel}
|
|
@deffn {Command} {debug_level} [n]
|
|
@cindex message level
|
|
Display debug level.
|
|
If @var{n} (from 0..4) is provided, then set it to that level.
|
|
This affects the kind of messages sent to the server log.
|
|
Level 0 is error messages only;
|
|
level 1 adds warnings;
|
|
level 2 adds informational messages;
|
|
level 3 adds debugging messages;
|
|
and level 4 adds verbose low-level debug messages.
|
|
The default is level 2, but that can be overridden on
|
|
the command line along with the location of that log
|
|
file (which is normally the server's standard output).
|
|
@xref{Running}.
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
|
|
@deffn {Command} {echo} [-n] message
|
|
Logs a message at "user" priority.
|
|
Option "-n" suppresses trailing newline.
|
|
@example
|
|
echo "Downloading kernel -- please wait"
|
|
@end example
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
|
|
@deffn {Command} {log_output} [filename | "default"]
|
|
Redirect logging to @var{filename} or set it back to default output;
|
|
the default log output channel is stderr.
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
|
|
@deffn {Command} {add_script_search_dir} [directory]
|
|
Add @var{directory} to the file/script search path.
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
|
|
@deffn {Config Command} {bindto} [@var{name}]
|
|
Specify hostname or IPv4 address on which to listen for incoming
|
|
TCP/IP connections. By default, OpenOCD will listen on the loopback
|
|
interface only. If your network environment is safe, @code{bindto
|
|
0.0.0.0} can be used to cover all available interfaces.
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
|
|
@anchor{targetstatehandling}
|
|
@section Target State handling
|
|
@cindex reset
|
|
@cindex halt
|
|
@cindex target initialization
|
|
|
|
In this section ``target'' refers to a CPU configured as
|
|
shown earlier (@pxref{CPU Configuration}).
|
|
These commands, like many, implicitly refer to
|
|
a current target which is used to perform the
|
|
various operations. The current target may be changed
|
|
by using @command{targets} command with the name of the
|
|
target which should become current.
|
|
|
|
@deffn {Command} {reg} [(number|name) [(value|'force')]]
|
|
Access a single register by @var{number} or by its @var{name}.
|
|
The target must generally be halted before access to CPU core
|
|
registers is allowed. Depending on the hardware, some other
|
|
registers may be accessible while the target is running.
|
|
|
|
@emph{With no arguments}:
|
|
list all available registers for the current target,
|
|
showing number, name, size, value, and cache status.
|
|
For valid entries, a value is shown; valid entries
|
|
which are also dirty (and will be written back later)
|
|
are flagged as such.
|
|
|
|
@emph{With number/name}: display that register's value.
|
|
Use @var{force} argument to read directly from the target,
|
|
bypassing any internal cache.
|
|
|
|
@emph{With both number/name and value}: set register's value.
|
|
Writes may be held in a writeback cache internal to OpenOCD,
|
|
so that setting the value marks the register as dirty instead
|
|
of immediately flushing that value. Resuming CPU execution
|
|
(including by single stepping) or otherwise activating the
|
|
relevant module will flush such values.
|
|
|
|
Cores may have surprisingly many registers in their
|
|
Debug and trace infrastructure:
|
|
|
|
@example
|
|
> reg
|
|
===== ARM registers
|
|
(0) r0 (/32): 0x0000D3C2 (dirty)
|
|
(1) r1 (/32): 0xFD61F31C
|
|
(2) r2 (/32)
|
|
...
|
|
(164) ETM_contextid_comparator_mask (/32)
|
|
>
|
|
@end example
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
|
|
@deffn {Command} {set_reg} dict
|
|
Set register values of the target.
|
|
|
|
@itemize
|
|
@item @var{dict} ... Tcl dictionary with pairs of register names and values.
|
|
@end itemize
|
|
|
|
For example, the following command sets the value 0 to the program counter (pc)
|
|
register and 0x1000 to the stack pointer (sp) register:
|
|
|
|
@example
|
|
set_reg @{pc 0 sp 0x1000@}
|
|
@end example
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
|
|
@deffn {Command} {get_reg} [-force] list
|
|
Get register values from the target and return them as Tcl dictionary with pairs
|
|
of register names and values.
|
|
If option "-force" is set, the register values are read directly from the
|
|
target, bypassing any caching.
|
|
|
|
@itemize
|
|
@item @var{list} ... List of register names
|
|
@end itemize
|
|
|
|
For example, the following command retrieves the values from the program
|
|
counter (pc) and stack pointer (sp) register:
|
|
|
|
@example
|
|
get_reg @{pc sp@}
|
|
@end example
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
|
|
@deffn {Command} {write_memory} address width data ['phys']
|
|
This function provides an efficient way to write to the target memory from a Tcl
|
|
script.
|
|
|
|
@itemize
|
|
@item @var{address} ... target memory address
|
|
@item @var{width} ... memory access bit size, can be 8, 16, 32 or 64
|
|
@item @var{data} ... Tcl list with the elements to write
|
|
@item ['phys'] ... treat the memory address as physical instead of virtual address
|
|
@end itemize
|
|
|
|
For example, the following command writes two 32 bit words into the target
|
|
memory at address 0x20000000:
|
|
|
|
@example
|
|
write_memory 0x20000000 32 @{0xdeadbeef 0x00230500@}
|
|
@end example
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
|
|
@deffn {Command} {read_memory} address width count ['phys']
|
|
This function provides an efficient way to read the target memory from a Tcl
|
|
script.
|
|
A Tcl list containing the requested memory elements is returned by this function.
|
|
|
|
@itemize
|
|
@item @var{address} ... target memory address
|
|
@item @var{width} ... memory access bit size, can be 8, 16, 32 or 64
|
|
@item @var{count} ... number of elements to read
|
|
@item ['phys'] ... treat the memory address as physical instead of virtual address
|
|
@end itemize
|
|
|
|
For example, the following command reads two 32 bit words from the target
|
|
memory at address 0x20000000:
|
|
|
|
@example
|
|
read_memory 0x20000000 32 2
|
|
@end example
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
|
|
@deffn {Command} {halt} [ms]
|
|
@deffnx {Command} {wait_halt} [ms]
|
|
The @command{halt} command first sends a halt request to the target,
|
|
which @command{wait_halt} doesn't.
|
|
Otherwise these behave the same: wait up to @var{ms} milliseconds,
|
|
or 5 seconds if there is no parameter, for the target to halt
|
|
(and enter debug mode).
|
|
Using 0 as the @var{ms} parameter prevents OpenOCD from waiting.
|
|
|
|
@quotation Warning
|
|
On ARM cores, software using the @emph{wait for interrupt} operation
|
|
often blocks the JTAG access needed by a @command{halt} command.
|
|
This is because that operation also puts the core into a low
|
|
power mode by gating the core clock;
|
|
but the core clock is needed to detect JTAG clock transitions.
|
|
|
|
One partial workaround uses adaptive clocking: when the core is
|
|
interrupted the operation completes, then JTAG clocks are accepted
|
|
at least until the interrupt handler completes.
|
|
However, this workaround is often unusable since the processor, board,
|
|
and JTAG adapter must all support adaptive JTAG clocking.
|
|
Also, it can't work until an interrupt is issued.
|
|
|
|
A more complete workaround is to not use that operation while you
|
|
work with a JTAG debugger.
|
|
Tasking environments generally have idle loops where the body is the
|
|
@emph{wait for interrupt} operation.
|
|
(On older cores, it is a coprocessor action;
|
|
newer cores have a @option{wfi} instruction.)
|
|
Such loops can just remove that operation, at the cost of higher
|
|
power consumption (because the CPU is needlessly clocked).
|
|
@end quotation
|
|
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
|
|
@deffn {Command} {resume} [address]
|
|
Resume the target at its current code position,
|
|
or the optional @var{address} if it is provided.
|
|
OpenOCD will wait 5 seconds for the target to resume.
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
|
|
@deffn {Command} {step} [address]
|
|
Single-step the target at its current code position,
|
|
or the optional @var{address} if it is provided.
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
|
|
@anchor{resetcommand}
|
|
@deffn {Command} {reset}
|
|
@deffnx {Command} {reset run}
|
|
@deffnx {Command} {reset halt}
|
|
@deffnx {Command} {reset init}
|
|
Perform as hard a reset as possible, using SRST if possible.
|
|
@emph{All defined targets will be reset, and target
|
|
events will fire during the reset sequence.}
|
|
|
|
The optional parameter specifies what should
|
|
happen after the reset.
|
|
If there is no parameter, a @command{reset run} is executed.
|
|
The other options will not work on all systems.
|
|
@xref{Reset Configuration}.
|
|
|
|
@itemize @minus
|
|
@item @b{run} Let the target run
|
|
@item @b{halt} Immediately halt the target
|
|
@item @b{init} Immediately halt the target, and execute the reset-init script
|
|
@end itemize
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
|
|
@deffn {Command} {soft_reset_halt}
|
|
Requesting target halt and executing a soft reset. This is often used
|
|
when a target cannot be reset and halted. The target, after reset is
|
|
released begins to execute code. OpenOCD attempts to stop the CPU and
|
|
then sets the program counter back to the reset vector. Unfortunately
|
|
the code that was executed may have left the hardware in an unknown
|
|
state.
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
|
|
@deffn {Command} {adapter assert} [signal [assert|deassert signal]]
|
|
@deffnx {Command} {adapter deassert} [signal [assert|deassert signal]]
|
|
Set values of reset signals.
|
|
Without parameters returns current status of the signals.
|
|
The @var{signal} parameter values may be
|
|
@option{srst}, indicating that srst signal is to be asserted or deasserted,
|
|
@option{trst}, indicating that trst signal is to be asserted or deasserted.
|
|
|
|
The @command{reset_config} command should already have been used
|
|
to configure how the board and the adapter treat these two
|
|
signals, and to say if either signal is even present.
|
|
@xref{Reset Configuration}.
|
|
Trying to assert a signal that is not present triggers an error.
|
|
If a signal is present on the adapter and not specified in the command,
|
|
the signal will not be modified.
|
|
|
|
@quotation Note
|
|
TRST is specially handled.
|
|
It actually signifies JTAG's @sc{reset} state.
|
|
So if the board doesn't support the optional TRST signal,
|
|
or it doesn't support it along with the specified SRST value,
|
|
JTAG reset is triggered with TMS and TCK signals
|
|
instead of the TRST signal.
|
|
And no matter how that JTAG reset is triggered, once
|
|
the scan chain enters @sc{reset} with TRST inactive,
|
|
TAP @code{post-reset} events are delivered to all TAPs
|
|
with handlers for that event.
|
|
@end quotation
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
|
|
@anchor{memoryaccess}
|
|
@section Memory access commands
|
|
@cindex memory access
|
|
|
|
These commands allow accesses of a specific size to the memory
|
|
system. Often these are used to configure the current target in some
|
|
special way. For example - one may need to write certain values to the
|
|
SDRAM controller to enable SDRAM.
|
|
|
|
@enumerate
|
|
@item Use the @command{targets} (plural) command
|
|
to change the current target.
|
|
@item In system level scripts these commands are deprecated.
|
|
Please use their TARGET object siblings to avoid making assumptions
|
|
about what TAP is the current target, or about MMU configuration.
|
|
@end enumerate
|
|
|
|
@deffn {Command} {mdd} [phys] addr [count]
|
|
@deffnx {Command} {mdw} [phys] addr [count]
|
|
@deffnx {Command} {mdh} [phys] addr [count]
|
|
@deffnx {Command} {mdb} [phys] addr [count]
|
|
Display contents of address @var{addr}, as
|
|
64-bit doublewords (@command{mdd}),
|
|
32-bit words (@command{mdw}), 16-bit halfwords (@command{mdh}),
|
|
or 8-bit bytes (@command{mdb}).
|
|
When the current target has an MMU which is present and active,
|
|
@var{addr} is interpreted as a virtual address.
|
|
Otherwise, or if the optional @var{phys} flag is specified,
|
|
@var{addr} is interpreted as a physical address.
|
|
If @var{count} is specified, displays that many units.
|
|
(If you want to process the data instead of displaying it,
|
|
see the @code{read_memory} primitives.)
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
|
|
@deffn {Command} {mwd} [phys] addr doubleword [count]
|
|
@deffnx {Command} {mww} [phys] addr word [count]
|
|
@deffnx {Command} {mwh} [phys] addr halfword [count]
|
|
@deffnx {Command} {mwb} [phys] addr byte [count]
|
|
Writes the specified @var{doubleword} (64 bits), @var{word} (32 bits),
|
|
@var{halfword} (16 bits), or @var{byte} (8-bit) value,
|
|
at the specified address @var{addr}.
|
|
When the current target has an MMU which is present and active,
|
|
@var{addr} is interpreted as a virtual address.
|
|
Otherwise, or if the optional @var{phys} flag is specified,
|
|
@var{addr} is interpreted as a physical address.
|
|
If @var{count} is specified, fills that many units of consecutive address.
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
|
|
@anchor{imageaccess}
|
|
@section Image loading commands
|
|
@cindex image loading
|
|
@cindex image dumping
|
|
|
|
@deffn {Command} {dump_image} filename address size
|
|
Dump @var{size} bytes of target memory starting at @var{address} to the
|
|
binary file named @var{filename}.
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
|
|
@deffn {Command} {fast_load}
|
|
Loads an image stored in memory by @command{fast_load_image} to the
|
|
current target. Must be preceded by fast_load_image.
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
|
|
@deffn {Command} {fast_load_image} filename address [@option{bin}|@option{ihex}|@option{elf}|@option{s19}]
|
|
Normally you should be using @command{load_image} or GDB load. However, for
|
|
testing purposes or when I/O overhead is significant(OpenOCD running on an embedded
|
|
host), storing the image in memory and uploading the image to the target
|
|
can be a way to upload e.g. multiple debug sessions when the binary does not change.
|
|
Arguments are the same as @command{load_image}, but the image is stored in OpenOCD host
|
|
memory, i.e. does not affect target. This approach is also useful when profiling
|
|
target programming performance as I/O and target programming can easily be profiled
|
|
separately.
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
|
|
@deffn {Command} {load_image} filename address [[@option{bin}|@option{ihex}|@option{elf}|@option{s19}] @option{min_addr} @option{max_length}]
|
|
Load image from file @var{filename} to target memory offset by @var{address} from its load address.
|
|
The file format may optionally be specified
|
|
(@option{bin}, @option{ihex}, @option{elf}, or @option{s19}).
|
|
In addition the following arguments may be specified:
|
|
@var{min_addr} - ignore data below @var{min_addr} (this is w.r.t. to the target's load address + @var{address})
|
|
@var{max_length} - maximum number of bytes to load.
|
|
@example
|
|
proc load_image_bin @{fname foffset address length @} @{
|
|
# Load data from fname filename at foffset offset to
|
|
# target at address. Load at most length bytes.
|
|
load_image $fname [expr @{$address - $foffset@}] bin \
|
|
$address $length
|
|
@}
|
|
@end example
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
|
|
@deffn {Command} {test_image} filename [address [@option{bin}|@option{ihex}|@option{elf}]]
|
|
Displays image section sizes and addresses
|
|
as if @var{filename} were loaded into target memory
|
|
starting at @var{address} (defaults to zero).
|
|
The file format may optionally be specified
|
|
(@option{bin}, @option{ihex}, or @option{elf})
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
|
|
@deffn {Command} {verify_image} filename address [@option{bin}|@option{ihex}|@option{elf}]
|
|
Verify @var{filename} against target memory starting at @var{address}.
|
|
The file format may optionally be specified
|
|
(@option{bin}, @option{ihex}, or @option{elf})
|
|
This will first attempt a comparison using a CRC checksum, if this fails it will try a binary compare.
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
|
|
@deffn {Command} {verify_image_checksum} filename address [@option{bin}|@option{ihex}|@option{elf}]
|
|
Verify @var{filename} against target memory starting at @var{address}.
|
|
The file format may optionally be specified
|
|
(@option{bin}, @option{ihex}, or @option{elf})
|
|
This perform a comparison using a CRC checksum only
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
|
|
|
|
@section Breakpoint and Watchpoint commands
|
|
@cindex breakpoint
|
|
@cindex watchpoint
|
|
|
|
CPUs often make debug modules accessible through JTAG, with
|
|
hardware support for a handful of code breakpoints and data
|
|
watchpoints.
|
|
In addition, CPUs almost always support software breakpoints.
|
|
|
|
@deffn {Command} {bp} [address len [@option{hw}]]
|
|
With no parameters, lists all active breakpoints.
|
|
Else sets a breakpoint on code execution starting
|
|
at @var{address} for @var{length} bytes.
|
|
This is a software breakpoint, unless @option{hw} is specified
|
|
in which case it will be a hardware breakpoint.
|
|
|
|
(@xref{arm9vectorcatch,,arm9 vector_catch}, or @pxref{xscalevectorcatch,,xscale vector_catch},
|
|
for similar mechanisms that do not consume hardware breakpoints.)
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
|
|
@deffn {Command} {rbp} @option{all} | address
|
|
Remove the breakpoint at @var{address} or all breakpoints.
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
|
|
@deffn {Command} {rwp} address
|
|
Remove data watchpoint on @var{address}
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
|
|
@deffn {Command} {wp} [address len [(@option{r}|@option{w}|@option{a}) [value [mask]]]]
|
|
With no parameters, lists all active watchpoints.
|
|
Else sets a data watchpoint on data from @var{address} for @var{length} bytes.
|
|
The watch point is an "access" watchpoint unless
|
|
the @option{r} or @option{w} parameter is provided,
|
|
defining it as respectively a read or write watchpoint.
|
|
If a @var{value} is provided, that value is used when determining if
|
|
the watchpoint should trigger. The value may be first be masked
|
|
using @var{mask} to mark ``don't care'' fields.
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
|
|
|
|
@section Real Time Transfer (RTT)
|
|
|
|
Real Time Transfer (RTT) is an interface specified by SEGGER based on basic
|
|
memory reads and writes to transfer data bidirectionally between target and host.
|
|
The specification is independent of the target architecture.
|
|
Every target that supports so called "background memory access", which means
|
|
that the target memory can be accessed by the debugger while the target is
|
|
running, can be used.
|
|
This interface is especially of interest for targets without
|
|
Serial Wire Output (SWO), such as ARM Cortex-M0, or where semihosting is not
|
|
applicable because of real-time constraints.
|
|
|
|
@quotation Note
|
|
The current implementation supports only single target devices.
|
|
@end quotation
|
|
|
|
The data transfer between host and target device is organized through
|
|
unidirectional up/down-channels for target-to-host and host-to-target
|
|
communication, respectively.
|
|
|
|
@quotation Note
|
|
The current implementation does not respect channel buffer flags.
|
|
They are used to determine what happens when writing to a full buffer, for
|
|
example.
|
|
@end quotation
|
|
|
|
Channels are exposed via raw TCP/IP connections. One or more RTT servers can be
|
|
assigned to each channel to make them accessible to an unlimited number
|
|
of TCP/IP connections.
|
|
|
|
@deffn {Command} {rtt setup} address size ID
|
|
Configure RTT for the currently selected target.
|
|
Once RTT is started, OpenOCD searches for a control block with the
|
|
identifier @var{ID} starting at the memory address @var{address} within the next
|
|
@var{size} bytes.
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
|
|
@deffn {Command} {rtt start}
|
|
Start RTT.
|
|
If the control block location is not known, OpenOCD starts searching for it.
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
|
|
@deffn {Command} {rtt stop}
|
|
Stop RTT.
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
|
|
@deffn {Command} {rtt polling_interval} [interval]
|
|
Display the polling interval.
|
|
If @var{interval} is provided, set the polling interval.
|
|
The polling interval determines (in milliseconds) how often the up-channels are
|
|
checked for new data.
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
|
|
@deffn {Command} {rtt channels}
|
|
Display a list of all channels and their properties.
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
|
|
@deffn {Command} {rtt channellist}
|
|
Return a list of all channels and their properties as Tcl list.
|
|
The list can be manipulated easily from within scripts.
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
|
|
@deffn {Command} {rtt server start} port channel
|
|
Start a TCP server on @var{port} for the channel @var{channel}.
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
|
|
@deffn {Command} {rtt server stop} port
|
|
Stop the TCP sever with port @var{port}.
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
|
|
The following example shows how to setup RTT using the SEGGER RTT implementation
|
|
on the target device.
|
|
|
|
@example
|
|
resume
|
|
|
|
rtt setup 0x20000000 2048 "SEGGER RTT"
|
|
rtt start
|
|
|
|
rtt server start 9090 0
|
|
@end example
|
|
|
|
In this example, OpenOCD searches the control block with the ID "SEGGER RTT"
|
|
starting at 0x20000000 for 2048 bytes. The RTT channel 0 is exposed through the
|
|
TCP/IP port 9090.
|
|
|
|
|
|
@section Misc Commands
|
|
|
|
@cindex profiling
|
|
@deffn {Command} {profile} seconds filename [start end]
|
|
Profiling samples the CPU's program counter as quickly as possible,
|
|
which is useful for non-intrusive stochastic profiling.
|
|
Saves up to 10000 samples in @file{filename} using ``gmon.out''
|
|
format. Optional @option{start} and @option{end} parameters allow to
|
|
limit the address range.
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
|
|
@deffn {Command} {version}
|
|
Displays a string identifying the version of this OpenOCD server.
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
|
|
@deffn {Command} {virt2phys} virtual_address
|
|
Requests the current target to map the specified @var{virtual_address}
|
|
to its corresponding physical address, and displays the result.
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
|
|
@deffn {Command} {add_help_text} 'command_name' 'help-string'
|
|
Add or replace help text on the given @var{command_name}.
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
|
|
@deffn {Command} {add_usage_text} 'command_name' 'help-string'
|
|
Add or replace usage text on the given @var{command_name}.
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
|
|
@node Architecture and Core Commands
|
|
@chapter Architecture and Core Commands
|
|
@cindex Architecture Specific Commands
|
|
@cindex Core Specific Commands
|
|
|
|
Most CPUs have specialized JTAG operations to support debugging.
|
|
OpenOCD packages most such operations in its standard command framework.
|
|
Some of those operations don't fit well in that framework, so they are
|
|
exposed here as architecture or implementation (core) specific commands.
|
|
|
|
@anchor{armhardwaretracing}
|
|
@section ARM Hardware Tracing
|
|
@cindex tracing
|
|
@cindex ETM
|
|
@cindex ETB
|
|
|
|
CPUs based on ARM cores may include standard tracing interfaces,
|
|
based on an ``Embedded Trace Module'' (ETM) which sends voluminous
|
|
address and data bus trace records to a ``Trace Port''.
|
|
|
|
@itemize
|
|
@item
|
|
Development-oriented boards will sometimes provide a high speed
|
|
trace connector for collecting that data, when the particular CPU
|
|
supports such an interface.
|
|
(The standard connector is a 38-pin Mictor, with both JTAG
|
|
and trace port support.)
|
|
Those trace connectors are supported by higher end JTAG adapters
|
|
and some logic analyzer modules; frequently those modules can
|
|
buffer several megabytes of trace data.
|
|
Configuring an ETM coupled to such an external trace port belongs
|
|
in the board-specific configuration file.
|
|
@item
|
|
If the CPU doesn't provide an external interface, it probably
|
|
has an ``Embedded Trace Buffer'' (ETB) on the chip, which is a
|
|
dedicated SRAM. 4KBytes is one common ETB size.
|
|
Configuring an ETM coupled only to an ETB belongs in the CPU-specific
|
|
(target) configuration file, since it works the same on all boards.
|
|
@end itemize
|
|
|
|
ETM support in OpenOCD doesn't seem to be widely used yet.
|
|
|
|
@quotation Issues
|
|
ETM support may be buggy, and at least some @command{etm config}
|
|
parameters should be detected by asking the ETM for them.
|
|
|
|
ETM trigger events could also implement a kind of complex
|
|
hardware breakpoint, much more powerful than the simple
|
|
watchpoint hardware exported by EmbeddedICE modules.
|
|
@emph{Such breakpoints can be triggered even when using the
|
|
dummy trace port driver}.
|
|
|
|
It seems like a GDB hookup should be possible,
|
|
as well as tracing only during specific states
|
|
(perhaps @emph{handling IRQ 23} or @emph{calls foo()}).
|
|
|
|
There should be GUI tools to manipulate saved trace data and help
|
|
analyse it in conjunction with the source code.
|
|
It's unclear how much of a common interface is shared
|
|
with the current XScale trace support, or should be
|
|
shared with eventual Nexus-style trace module support.
|
|
|
|
At this writing (November 2009) only ARM7, ARM9, and ARM11 support
|
|
for ETM modules is available. The code should be able to
|
|
work with some newer cores; but not all of them support
|
|
this original style of JTAG access.
|
|
@end quotation
|
|
|
|
@subsection ETM Configuration
|
|
ETM setup is coupled with the trace port driver configuration.
|
|
|
|
@deffn {Config Command} {etm config} target width mode clocking driver
|
|
Declares the ETM associated with @var{target}, and associates it
|
|
with a given trace port @var{driver}. @xref{traceportdrivers,,Trace Port Drivers}.
|
|
|
|
Several of the parameters must reflect the trace port capabilities,
|
|
which are a function of silicon capabilities (exposed later
|
|
using @command{etm info}) and of what hardware is connected to
|
|
that port (such as an external pod, or ETB).
|
|
The @var{width} must be either 4, 8, or 16,
|
|
except with ETMv3.0 and newer modules which may also
|
|
support 1, 2, 24, 32, 48, and 64 bit widths.
|
|
(With those versions, @command{etm info} also shows whether
|
|
the selected port width and mode are supported.)
|
|
|
|
The @var{mode} must be @option{normal}, @option{multiplexed},
|
|
or @option{demultiplexed}.
|
|
The @var{clocking} must be @option{half} or @option{full}.
|
|
|
|
@quotation Warning
|
|
With ETMv3.0 and newer, the bits set with the @var{mode} and
|
|
@var{clocking} parameters both control the mode.
|
|
This modified mode does not map to the values supported by
|
|
previous ETM modules, so this syntax is subject to change.
|
|
@end quotation
|
|
|
|
@quotation Note
|
|
You can see the ETM registers using the @command{reg} command.
|
|
Not all possible registers are present in every ETM.
|
|
Most of the registers are write-only, and are used to configure
|
|
what CPU activities are traced.
|
|
@end quotation
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
|
|
@deffn {Command} {etm info}
|
|
Displays information about the current target's ETM.
|
|
This includes resource counts from the @code{ETM_CONFIG} register,
|
|
as well as silicon capabilities (except on rather old modules).
|
|
from the @code{ETM_SYS_CONFIG} register.
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
|
|
@deffn {Command} {etm status}
|
|
Displays status of the current target's ETM and trace port driver:
|
|
is the ETM idle, or is it collecting data?
|
|
Did trace data overflow?
|
|
Was it triggered?
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
|
|
@deffn {Command} {etm tracemode} [type context_id_bits cycle_accurate branch_output]
|
|
Displays what data that ETM will collect.
|
|
If arguments are provided, first configures that data.
|
|
When the configuration changes, tracing is stopped
|
|
and any buffered trace data is invalidated.
|
|
|
|
@itemize
|
|
@item @var{type} ... describing how data accesses are traced,
|
|
when they pass any ViewData filtering that was set up.
|
|
The value is one of
|
|
@option{none} (save nothing),
|
|
@option{data} (save data),
|
|
@option{address} (save addresses),
|
|
@option{all} (save data and addresses)
|
|
@item @var{context_id_bits} ... 0, 8, 16, or 32
|
|
@item @var{cycle_accurate} ... @option{enable} or @option{disable}
|
|
cycle-accurate instruction tracing.
|
|
Before ETMv3, enabling this causes much extra data to be recorded.
|
|
@item @var{branch_output} ... @option{enable} or @option{disable}.
|
|
Disable this unless you need to try reconstructing the instruction
|
|
trace stream without an image of the code.
|
|
@end itemize
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
|
|
@deffn {Command} {etm trigger_debug} (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
|
|
Displays whether ETM triggering debug entry (like a breakpoint) is
|
|
enabled or disabled, after optionally modifying that configuration.
|
|
The default behaviour is @option{disable}.
|
|
Any change takes effect after the next @command{etm start}.
|
|
|
|
By using script commands to configure ETM registers, you can make the
|
|
processor enter debug state automatically when certain conditions,
|
|
more complex than supported by the breakpoint hardware, happen.
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
|
|
@subsection ETM Trace Operation
|
|
|
|
After setting up the ETM, you can use it to collect data.
|
|
That data can be exported to files for later analysis.
|
|
It can also be parsed with OpenOCD, for basic sanity checking.
|
|
|
|
To configure what is being traced, you will need to write
|
|
various trace registers using @command{reg ETM_*} commands.
|
|
For the definitions of these registers, read ARM publication
|
|
@emph{IHI 0014, ``Embedded Trace Macrocell, Architecture Specification''}.
|
|
Be aware that most of the relevant registers are write-only,
|
|
and that ETM resources are limited. There are only a handful
|
|
of address comparators, data comparators, counters, and so on.
|
|
|
|
Examples of scenarios you might arrange to trace include:
|
|
|
|
@itemize
|
|
@item Code flow within a function, @emph{excluding} subroutines
|
|
it calls. Use address range comparators to enable tracing
|
|
for instruction access within that function's body.
|
|
@item Code flow within a function, @emph{including} subroutines
|
|
it calls. Use the sequencer and address comparators to activate
|
|
tracing on an ``entered function'' state, then deactivate it by
|
|
exiting that state when the function's exit code is invoked.
|
|
@item Code flow starting at the fifth invocation of a function,
|
|
combining one of the above models with a counter.
|
|
@item CPU data accesses to the registers for a particular device,
|
|
using address range comparators and the ViewData logic.
|
|
@item Such data accesses only during IRQ handling, combining the above
|
|
model with sequencer triggers which on entry and exit to the IRQ handler.
|
|
@item @emph{... more}
|
|
@end itemize
|
|
|
|
At this writing, September 2009, there are no Tcl utility
|
|
procedures to help set up any common tracing scenarios.
|
|
|
|
@deffn {Command} {etm analyze}
|
|
Reads trace data into memory, if it wasn't already present.
|
|
Decodes and prints the data that was collected.
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
|
|
@deffn {Command} {etm dump} filename
|
|
Stores the captured trace data in @file{filename}.
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
|
|
@deffn {Command} {etm image} filename [base_address] [type]
|
|
Opens an image file.
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
|
|
@deffn {Command} {etm load} filename
|
|
Loads captured trace data from @file{filename}.
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
|
|
@deffn {Command} {etm start}
|
|
Starts trace data collection.
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
|
|
@deffn {Command} {etm stop}
|
|
Stops trace data collection.
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
|
|
@anchor{traceportdrivers}
|
|
@subsection Trace Port Drivers
|
|
|
|
To use an ETM trace port it must be associated with a driver.
|
|
|
|
@deffn {Trace Port Driver} {dummy}
|
|
Use the @option{dummy} driver if you are configuring an ETM that's
|
|
not connected to anything (on-chip ETB or off-chip trace connector).
|
|
@emph{This driver lets OpenOCD talk to the ETM, but it does not expose
|
|
any trace data collection.}
|
|
@deffn {Config Command} {etm_dummy config} target
|
|
Associates the ETM for @var{target} with a dummy driver.
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
|
|
@deffn {Trace Port Driver} {etb}
|
|
Use the @option{etb} driver if you are configuring an ETM
|
|
to use on-chip ETB memory.
|
|
@deffn {Config Command} {etb config} target etb_tap
|
|
Associates the ETM for @var{target} with the ETB at @var{etb_tap}.
|
|
You can see the ETB registers using the @command{reg} command.
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
@deffn {Command} {etb trigger_percent} [percent]
|
|
This displays, or optionally changes, ETB behavior after the
|
|
ETM's configured @emph{trigger} event fires.
|
|
It controls how much more trace data is saved after the (single)
|
|
trace trigger becomes active.
|
|
|
|
@itemize
|
|
@item The default corresponds to @emph{trace around} usage,
|
|
recording 50 percent data before the event and the rest
|
|
afterwards.
|
|
@item The minimum value of @var{percent} is 2 percent,
|
|
recording almost exclusively data before the trigger.
|
|
Such extreme @emph{trace before} usage can help figure out
|
|
what caused that event to happen.
|
|
@item The maximum value of @var{percent} is 100 percent,
|
|
recording data almost exclusively after the event.
|
|
This extreme @emph{trace after} usage might help sort out
|
|
how the event caused trouble.
|
|
@end itemize
|
|
@c REVISIT allow "break" too -- enter debug mode.
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
|
|
@anchor{armcrosstrigger}
|
|
@section ARM Cross-Trigger Interface
|
|
@cindex CTI
|
|
|
|
The ARM Cross-Trigger Interface (CTI) is a generic CoreSight component
|
|
that connects event sources like tracing components or CPU cores with each
|
|
other through a common trigger matrix (CTM). For ARMv8 architecture, a
|
|
CTI is mandatory for core run control and each core has an individual
|
|
CTI instance attached to it. OpenOCD has limited support for CTI using
|
|
the @emph{cti} group of commands.
|
|
|
|
@deffn {Command} {cti create} cti_name @option{-dap} dap_name @option{-ap-num} apn @option{-baseaddr} base_address
|
|
Creates a CTI instance @var{cti_name} on the DAP instance @var{dap_name} on MEM-AP
|
|
@var{apn}.
|
|
On ADIv5 DAP @var{apn} is the numeric index of the DAP AP the CTI is connected to.
|
|
On ADIv6 DAP @var{apn} is the base address of the DAP AP the CTI is connected to.
|
|
The @var{base_address} must match the base address of the CTI
|
|
on the respective MEM-AP. All arguments are mandatory. This creates a
|
|
new command @command{$cti_name} which is used for various purposes
|
|
including additional configuration.
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
|
|
@deffn {Command} {$cti_name enable} @option{on|off}
|
|
Enable (@option{on}) or disable (@option{off}) the CTI.
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
|
|
@deffn {Command} {$cti_name dump}
|
|
Displays a register dump of the CTI.
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
|
|
@deffn {Command} {$cti_name write} @var{reg_name} @var{value}
|
|
Write @var{value} to the CTI register with the symbolic name @var{reg_name}.
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
|
|
@deffn {Command} {$cti_name read} @var{reg_name}
|
|
Print the value read from the CTI register with the symbolic name @var{reg_name}.
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
|
|
@deffn {Command} {$cti_name ack} @var{event}
|
|
Acknowledge a CTI @var{event}.
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
|
|
@deffn {Command} {$cti_name channel} @var{channel_number} @var{operation}
|
|
Perform a specific channel operation, the possible operations are:
|
|
gate, ungate, set, clear and pulse
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
|
|
@deffn {Command} {$cti_name testmode} @option{on|off}
|
|
Enable (@option{on}) or disable (@option{off}) the integration test mode
|
|
of the CTI.
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
|
|
@deffn {Command} {cti names}
|
|
Prints a list of names of all CTI objects created. This command is mainly
|
|
useful in TCL scripting.
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
|
|
@section Generic ARM
|
|
@cindex ARM
|
|
|
|
These commands should be available on all ARM processors.
|
|
They are available in addition to other core-specific
|
|
commands that may be available.
|
|
|
|
@deffn {Command} {arm core_state} [@option{arm}|@option{thumb}]
|
|
Displays the core_state, optionally changing it to process
|
|
either @option{arm} or @option{thumb} instructions.
|
|
The target may later be resumed in the currently set core_state.
|
|
(Processors may also support the Jazelle state, but
|
|
that is not currently supported in OpenOCD.)
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
|
|
@deffn {Command} {arm disassemble} address [count [@option{thumb}]]
|
|
@cindex disassemble
|
|
Disassembles @var{count} instructions starting at @var{address}.
|
|
If @var{count} is not specified, a single instruction is disassembled.
|
|
If @option{thumb} is specified, or the low bit of the address is set,
|
|
Thumb2 (mixed 16/32-bit) instructions are used;
|
|
else ARM (32-bit) instructions are used.
|
|
(Processors may also support the Jazelle state, but
|
|
those instructions are not currently understood by OpenOCD.)
|
|
|
|
Note that all Thumb instructions are Thumb2 instructions,
|
|
so older processors (without Thumb2 support) will still
|
|
see correct disassembly of Thumb code.
|
|
Also, ThumbEE opcodes are the same as Thumb2,
|
|
with a handful of exceptions.
|
|
ThumbEE disassembly currently has no explicit support.
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
|
|
@deffn {Command} {arm mcr} pX op1 CRn CRm op2 value
|
|
Write @var{value} to a coprocessor @var{pX} register
|
|
passing parameters @var{CRn},
|
|
@var{CRm}, opcodes @var{opc1} and @var{opc2},
|
|
and using the MCR instruction.
|
|
(Parameter sequence matches the ARM instruction, but omits
|
|
an ARM register.)
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
|
|
@deffn {Command} {arm mrc} pX coproc op1 CRn CRm op2
|
|
Read a coprocessor @var{pX} register passing parameters @var{CRn},
|
|
@var{CRm}, opcodes @var{opc1} and @var{opc2},
|
|
and the MRC instruction.
|
|
Returns the result so it can be manipulated by Jim scripts.
|
|
(Parameter sequence matches the ARM instruction, but omits
|
|
an ARM register.)
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
|
|
@deffn {Command} {arm reg}
|
|
Display a table of all banked core registers, fetching the current value from every
|
|
core mode if necessary.
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
|
|
@deffn {Command} {arm semihosting} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
|
|
@cindex ARM semihosting
|
|
Display status of semihosting, after optionally changing that status.
|
|
|
|
Semihosting allows for code executing on an ARM target to use the
|
|
I/O facilities on the host computer i.e. the system where OpenOCD
|
|
is running. The target application must be linked against a library
|
|
implementing the ARM semihosting convention that forwards operation
|
|
requests by using a special SVC instruction that is trapped at the
|
|
Supervisor Call vector by OpenOCD.
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
|
|
@deffn {Command} {arm semihosting_redirect} (@option{disable} | @option{tcp} <port> [@option{debug}|@option{stdio}|@option{all}])
|
|
@cindex ARM semihosting
|
|
Redirect semihosting messages to a specified TCP port.
|
|
|
|
This command redirects debug (READC, WRITEC and WRITE0) and stdio (READ, WRITE)
|
|
semihosting operations to the specified TCP port.
|
|
The command allows to select which type of operations to redirect (debug, stdio, all (default)).
|
|
|
|
Note: for stdio operations, only I/O from/to ':tt' file descriptors are redirected.
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
|
|
@deffn {Command} {arm semihosting_cmdline} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
|
|
@cindex ARM semihosting
|
|
Set the command line to be passed to the debugger.
|
|
|
|
@example
|
|
arm semihosting_cmdline argv0 argv1 argv2 ...
|
|
@end example
|
|
|
|
This option lets one set the command line arguments to be passed to
|
|
the program. The first argument (argv0) is the program name in a
|
|
standard C environment (argv[0]). Depending on the program (not much
|
|
programs look at argv[0]), argv0 is ignored and can be any string.
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
|
|
@deffn {Command} {arm semihosting_fileio} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
|
|
@cindex ARM semihosting
|
|
Display status of semihosting fileio, after optionally changing that
|
|
status.
|
|
|
|
Enabling this option forwards semihosting I/O to GDB process using the
|
|
File-I/O remote protocol extension. This is especially useful for
|
|
interacting with remote files or displaying console messages in the
|
|
debugger.
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
|
|
@deffn {Command} {arm semihosting_resexit} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
|
|
@cindex ARM semihosting
|
|
Enable resumable SEMIHOSTING_SYS_EXIT.
|
|
|
|
When SEMIHOSTING_SYS_EXIT is called outside a debug session,
|
|
things are simple, the openocd process calls exit() and passes
|
|
the value returned by the target.
|
|
|
|
When SEMIHOSTING_SYS_EXIT is called during a debug session,
|
|
by default execution returns to the debugger, leaving the
|
|
debugger in a HALT state, similar to the state entered when
|
|
encountering a break.
|
|
|
|
In some use cases, it is useful to have SEMIHOSTING_SYS_EXIT
|
|
return normally, as any semihosting call, and do not break
|
|
to the debugger.
|
|
The standard allows this to happen, but the condition
|
|
to trigger it is a bit obscure ("by performing an RDI_Execute
|
|
request or equivalent").
|
|
|
|
To make the SEMIHOSTING_SYS_EXIT call return normally, enable
|
|
this option (default: disabled).
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
|
|
@deffn {Command} {arm semihosting_read_user_param}
|
|
@cindex ARM semihosting
|
|
Read parameter of the semihosting call from the target. Usable in
|
|
semihosting-user-cmd-0x10* event handlers, returning a string.
|
|
|
|
When the target makes semihosting call with operation number from range 0x100-
|
|
0x107, an optional string parameter can be passed to the server. This parameter
|
|
is valid during the run of the event handlers and is accessible with this
|
|
command.
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
|
|
@deffn {Command} {arm semihosting_basedir} [dir]
|
|
@cindex ARM semihosting
|
|
Set the base directory for semihosting I/O, either an absolute path or a path relative to OpenOCD working directory.
|
|
Use "." for the current directory.
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
|
|
@section ARMv4 and ARMv5 Architecture
|
|
@cindex ARMv4
|
|
@cindex ARMv5
|
|
|
|
The ARMv4 and ARMv5 architectures are widely used in embedded systems,
|
|
and introduced core parts of the instruction set in use today.
|
|
That includes the Thumb instruction set, introduced in the ARMv4T
|
|
variant.
|
|
|
|
@subsection ARM7 and ARM9 specific commands
|
|
@cindex ARM7
|
|
@cindex ARM9
|
|
|
|
These commands are specific to ARM7 and ARM9 cores, like ARM7TDMI, ARM720T,
|
|
ARM9TDMI, ARM920T or ARM926EJ-S.
|
|
They are available in addition to the ARM commands,
|
|
and any other core-specific commands that may be available.
|
|
|
|
@deffn {Command} {arm7_9 dbgrq} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
|
|
Displays the value of the flag controlling use of the
|
|
EmbeddedIce DBGRQ signal to force entry into debug mode,
|
|
instead of breakpoints.
|
|
If a boolean parameter is provided, first assigns that flag.
|
|
|
|
This should be
|
|
safe for all but ARM7TDMI-S cores (like NXP LPC).
|
|
This feature is enabled by default on most ARM9 cores,
|
|
including ARM9TDMI, ARM920T, and ARM926EJ-S.
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
|
|
@deffn {Command} {arm7_9 dcc_downloads} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
|
|
@cindex DCC
|
|
Displays the value of the flag controlling use of the debug communications
|
|
channel (DCC) to write larger (>128 byte) amounts of memory.
|
|
If a boolean parameter is provided, first assigns that flag.
|
|
|
|
DCC downloads offer a huge speed increase, but might be
|
|
unsafe, especially with targets running at very low speeds. This command was introduced
|
|
with OpenOCD rev. 60, and requires a few bytes of working area.
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
|
|
@deffn {Command} {arm7_9 fast_memory_access} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
|
|
Displays the value of the flag controlling use of memory writes and reads
|
|
that don't check completion of the operation.
|
|
If a boolean parameter is provided, first assigns that flag.
|
|
|
|
This provides a huge speed increase, especially with USB JTAG
|
|
cables (FT2232), but might be unsafe if used with targets running at very low
|
|
speeds, like the 32kHz startup clock of an AT91RM9200.
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
|
|
@subsection ARM9 specific commands
|
|
@cindex ARM9
|
|
|
|
ARM9-family cores are built around ARM9TDMI or ARM9E (including ARM9EJS)
|
|
integer processors.
|
|
Such cores include the ARM920T, ARM926EJ-S, and ARM966.
|
|
|
|
@c 9-june-2009: tried this on arm920t, it didn't work.
|
|
@c no-params always lists nothing caught, and that's how it acts.
|
|
@c 23-oct-2009: doesn't work _consistently_ ... as if the ICE
|
|
@c versions have different rules about when they commit writes.
|
|
|
|
@anchor{arm9vectorcatch}
|
|
@deffn {Command} {arm9 vector_catch} [@option{all}|@option{none}|list]
|
|
@cindex vector_catch
|
|
Vector Catch hardware provides a sort of dedicated breakpoint
|
|
for hardware events such as reset, interrupt, and abort.
|
|
You can use this to conserve normal breakpoint resources,
|
|
so long as you're not concerned with code that branches directly
|
|
to those hardware vectors.
|
|
|
|
This always finishes by listing the current configuration.
|
|
If parameters are provided, it first reconfigures the
|
|
vector catch hardware to intercept
|
|
@option{all} of the hardware vectors,
|
|
@option{none} of them,
|
|
or a list with one or more of the following:
|
|
@option{reset} @option{undef} @option{swi} @option{pabt} @option{dabt}
|
|
@option{irq} @option{fiq}.
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
|
|
@subsection ARM920T specific commands
|
|
@cindex ARM920T
|
|
|
|
These commands are available to ARM920T based CPUs,
|
|
which are implementations of the ARMv4T architecture
|
|
built using the ARM9TDMI integer core.
|
|
They are available in addition to the ARM, ARM7/ARM9,
|
|
and ARM9 commands.
|
|
|
|
@deffn {Command} {arm920t cache_info}
|
|
Print information about the caches found. This allows to see whether your target
|
|
is an ARM920T (2x16kByte cache) or ARM922T (2x8kByte cache).
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
|
|
@deffn {Command} {arm920t cp15} regnum [value]
|
|
Display cp15 register @var{regnum};
|
|
else if a @var{value} is provided, that value is written to that register.
|
|
This uses "physical access" and the register number is as
|
|
shown in bits 38..33 of table 9-9 in the ARM920T TRM.
|
|
(Not all registers can be written.)
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
|
|
@deffn {Command} {arm920t read_cache} filename
|
|
Dump the content of ICache and DCache to a file named @file{filename}.
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
|
|
@deffn {Command} {arm920t read_mmu} filename
|
|
Dump the content of the ITLB and DTLB to a file named @file{filename}.
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
|
|
@subsection ARM926ej-s specific commands
|
|
@cindex ARM926ej-s
|
|
|
|
These commands are available to ARM926ej-s based CPUs,
|
|
which are implementations of the ARMv5TEJ architecture
|
|
based on the ARM9EJ-S integer core.
|
|
They are available in addition to the ARM, ARM7/ARM9,
|
|
and ARM9 commands.
|
|
|
|
The Feroceon cores also support these commands, although
|
|
they are not built from ARM926ej-s designs.
|
|
|
|
@deffn {Command} {arm926ejs cache_info}
|
|
Print information about the caches found.
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
|
|
@subsection ARM966E specific commands
|
|
@cindex ARM966E
|
|
|
|
These commands are available to ARM966 based CPUs,
|
|
which are implementations of the ARMv5TE architecture.
|
|
They are available in addition to the ARM, ARM7/ARM9,
|
|
and ARM9 commands.
|
|
|
|
@deffn {Command} {arm966e cp15} regnum [value]
|
|
Display cp15 register @var{regnum};
|
|
else if a @var{value} is provided, that value is written to that register.
|
|
The six bit @var{regnum} values are bits 37..32 from table 7-2 of the
|
|
ARM966E-S TRM.
|
|
There is no current control over bits 31..30 from that table,
|
|
as required for BIST support.
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
|
|
@subsection XScale specific commands
|
|
@cindex XScale
|
|
|
|
Some notes about the debug implementation on the XScale CPUs:
|
|
|
|
The XScale CPU provides a special debug-only mini-instruction cache
|
|
(mini-IC) in which exception vectors and target-resident debug handler
|
|
code are placed by OpenOCD. In order to get access to the CPU, OpenOCD
|
|
must point vector 0 (the reset vector) to the entry of the debug
|
|
handler. However, this means that the complete first cacheline in the
|
|
mini-IC is marked valid, which makes the CPU fetch all exception
|
|
handlers from the mini-IC, ignoring the code in RAM.
|
|
|
|
To address this situation, OpenOCD provides the @code{xscale
|
|
vector_table} command, which allows the user to explicitly write
|
|
individual entries to either the high or low vector table stored in
|
|
the mini-IC.
|
|
|
|
It is recommended to place a pc-relative indirect branch in the vector
|
|
table, and put the branch destination somewhere in memory. Doing so
|
|
makes sure the code in the vector table stays constant regardless of
|
|
code layout in memory:
|
|
@example
|
|
_vectors:
|
|
ldr pc,[pc,#0x100-8]
|
|
ldr pc,[pc,#0x100-8]
|
|
ldr pc,[pc,#0x100-8]
|
|
ldr pc,[pc,#0x100-8]
|
|
ldr pc,[pc,#0x100-8]
|
|
ldr pc,[pc,#0x100-8]
|
|
ldr pc,[pc,#0x100-8]
|
|
ldr pc,[pc,#0x100-8]
|
|
.org 0x100
|
|
.long real_reset_vector
|
|
.long real_ui_handler
|
|
.long real_swi_handler
|
|
.long real_pf_abort
|
|
.long real_data_abort
|
|
.long 0 /* unused */
|
|
.long real_irq_handler
|
|
.long real_fiq_handler
|
|
@end example
|
|
|
|
Alternatively, you may choose to keep some or all of the mini-IC
|
|
vector table entries synced with those written to memory by your
|
|
system software. The mini-IC can not be modified while the processor
|
|
is executing, but for each vector table entry not previously defined
|
|
using the @code{xscale vector_table} command, OpenOCD will copy the
|
|
value from memory to the mini-IC every time execution resumes from a
|
|
halt. This is done for both high and low vector tables (although the
|
|
table not in use may not be mapped to valid memory, and in this case
|
|
that copy operation will silently fail). This means that you will
|
|
need to briefly halt execution at some strategic point during system
|
|
start-up; e.g., after the software has initialized the vector table,
|
|
but before exceptions are enabled. A breakpoint can be used to
|
|
accomplish this once the appropriate location in the start-up code has
|
|
been identified. A watchpoint over the vector table region is helpful
|
|
in finding the location if you're not sure. Note that the same
|
|
situation exists any time the vector table is modified by the system
|
|
software.
|
|
|
|
The debug handler must be placed somewhere in the address space using
|
|
the @code{xscale debug_handler} command. The allowed locations for the
|
|
debug handler are either (0x800 - 0x1fef800) or (0xfe000800 -
|
|
0xfffff800). The default value is 0xfe000800.
|
|
|
|
XScale has resources to support two hardware breakpoints and two
|
|
watchpoints. However, the following restrictions on watchpoint
|
|
functionality apply: (1) the value and mask arguments to the @code{wp}
|
|
command are not supported, (2) the watchpoint length must be a
|
|
power of two and not less than four, and can not be greater than the
|
|
watchpoint address, and (3) a watchpoint with a length greater than
|
|
four consumes all the watchpoint hardware resources. This means that
|
|
at any one time, you can have enabled either two watchpoints with a
|
|
length of four, or one watchpoint with a length greater than four.
|
|
|
|
These commands are available to XScale based CPUs,
|
|
which are implementations of the ARMv5TE architecture.
|
|
|
|
@deffn {Command} {xscale analyze_trace}
|
|
Displays the contents of the trace buffer.
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
|
|
@deffn {Command} {xscale cache_clean_address} address
|
|
Changes the address used when cleaning the data cache.
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
|
|
@deffn {Command} {xscale cache_info}
|
|
Displays information about the CPU caches.
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
|
|
@deffn {Command} {xscale cp15} regnum [value]
|
|
Display cp15 register @var{regnum};
|
|
else if a @var{value} is provided, that value is written to that register.
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
|
|
@deffn {Command} {xscale debug_handler} target address
|
|
Changes the address used for the specified target's debug handler.
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
|
|
@deffn {Command} {xscale dcache} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
|
|
Enables or disable the CPU's data cache.
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
|
|
@deffn {Command} {xscale dump_trace} filename
|
|
Dumps the raw contents of the trace buffer to @file{filename}.
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
|
|
@deffn {Command} {xscale icache} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
|
|
Enables or disable the CPU's instruction cache.
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
|
|
@deffn {Command} {xscale mmu} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
|
|
Enables or disable the CPU's memory management unit.
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
|
|
@deffn {Command} {xscale trace_buffer} [@option{enable}|@option{disable} [@option{fill} [n] | @option{wrap}]]
|
|
Displays the trace buffer status, after optionally
|
|
enabling or disabling the trace buffer
|
|
and modifying how it is emptied.
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
|
|
@deffn {Command} {xscale trace_image} filename [offset [type]]
|
|
Opens a trace image from @file{filename}, optionally rebasing
|
|
its segment addresses by @var{offset}.
|
|
The image @var{type} may be one of
|
|
@option{bin} (binary), @option{ihex} (Intel hex),
|
|
@option{elf} (ELF file), @option{s19} (Motorola s19),
|
|
@option{mem}, or @option{builder}.
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
|
|
@anchor{xscalevectorcatch}
|
|
@deffn {Command} {xscale vector_catch} [mask]
|
|
@cindex vector_catch
|
|
Display a bitmask showing the hardware vectors to catch.
|
|
If the optional parameter is provided, first set the bitmask to that value.
|
|
|
|
The mask bits correspond with bit 16..23 in the DCSR:
|
|
@example
|
|
0x01 Trap Reset
|
|
0x02 Trap Undefined Instructions
|
|
0x04 Trap Software Interrupt
|
|
0x08 Trap Prefetch Abort
|
|
0x10 Trap Data Abort
|
|
0x20 reserved
|
|
0x40 Trap IRQ
|
|
0x80 Trap FIQ
|
|
@end example
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
|
|
@deffn {Command} {xscale vector_table} [(@option{low}|@option{high}) index value]
|
|
@cindex vector_table
|
|
|
|
Set an entry in the mini-IC vector table. There are two tables: one for
|
|
low vectors (at 0x00000000), and one for high vectors (0xFFFF0000), each
|
|
holding the 8 exception vectors. @var{index} can be 1-7, because vector 0
|
|
points to the debug handler entry and can not be overwritten.
|
|
@var{value} holds the 32-bit opcode that is placed in the mini-IC.
|
|
|
|
Without arguments, the current settings are displayed.
|
|
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
|
|
@section ARMv6 Architecture
|
|
@cindex ARMv6
|
|
|
|
@subsection ARM11 specific commands
|
|
@cindex ARM11
|
|
|
|
@deffn {Command} {arm11 memwrite burst} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
|
|
Displays the value of the memwrite burst-enable flag,
|
|
which is enabled by default.
|
|
If a boolean parameter is provided, first assigns that flag.
|
|
Burst writes are only used for memory writes larger than 1 word.
|
|
They improve performance by assuming that the CPU has read each data
|
|
word over JTAG and completed its write before the next word arrives,
|
|
instead of polling for a status flag to verify that completion.
|
|
This is usually safe, because JTAG runs much slower than the CPU.
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
|
|
@deffn {Command} {arm11 memwrite error_fatal} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
|
|
Displays the value of the memwrite error_fatal flag,
|
|
which is enabled by default.
|
|
If a boolean parameter is provided, first assigns that flag.
|
|
When set, certain memory write errors cause earlier transfer termination.
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
|
|
@deffn {Command} {arm11 step_irq_enable} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
|
|
Displays the value of the flag controlling whether
|
|
IRQs are enabled during single stepping;
|
|
they are disabled by default.
|
|
If a boolean parameter is provided, first assigns that.
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
|
|
@deffn {Command} {arm11 vcr} [value]
|
|
@cindex vector_catch
|
|
Displays the value of the @emph{Vector Catch Register (VCR)},
|
|
coprocessor 14 register 7.
|
|
If @var{value} is defined, first assigns that.
|
|
|
|
Vector Catch hardware provides dedicated breakpoints
|
|
for certain hardware events.
|
|
The specific bit values are core-specific (as in fact is using
|
|
coprocessor 14 register 7 itself) but all current ARM11
|
|
cores @emph{except the ARM1176} use the same six bits.
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
|
|
@section ARMv7 and ARMv8 Architecture
|
|
@cindex ARMv7
|
|
@cindex ARMv8
|
|
|
|
@subsection ARMv7-A specific commands
|
|
@cindex Cortex-A
|
|
|
|
@deffn {Command} {cortex_a cache_info}
|
|
display information about target caches
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
|
|
@deffn {Command} {cortex_a dacrfixup} [@option{on}|@option{off}]
|
|
Work around issues with software breakpoints when the program text is
|
|
mapped read-only by the operating system. This option sets the CP15 DACR
|
|
to "all-manager" to bypass MMU permission checks on memory access.
|
|
Defaults to 'off'.
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
|
|
@deffn {Command} {cortex_a dbginit}
|
|
Initialize core debug
|
|
Enables debug by unlocking the Software Lock and clearing sticky powerdown indications
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
|
|
@deffn {Command} {cortex_a smp} [on|off]
|
|
Display/set the current SMP mode
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
|
|
@deffn {Command} {cortex_a smp_gdb} [core_id]
|
|
Display/set the current core displayed in GDB
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
|
|
@deffn {Command} {cortex_a maskisr} [@option{on}|@option{off}]
|
|
Selects whether interrupts will be processed when single stepping
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
|
|
@deffn {Command} {cache_config l2x} [base way]
|
|
configure l2x cache
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
|
|
@deffn {Command} {cortex_a mmu dump} [@option{0}|@option{1}|@option{addr} address [@option{num_entries}]]
|
|
Dump the MMU translation table from TTB0 or TTB1 register, or from physical
|
|
memory location @var{address}. When dumping the table from @var{address}, print at most
|
|
@var{num_entries} page table entries. @var{num_entries} is optional, if omitted, the maximum
|
|
possible (4096) entries are printed.
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
|
|
@subsection ARMv7-R specific commands
|
|
@cindex Cortex-R
|
|
|
|
@deffn {Command} {cortex_r4 dbginit}
|
|
Initialize core debug
|
|
Enables debug by unlocking the Software Lock and clearing sticky powerdown indications
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
|
|
@deffn {Command} {cortex_r4 maskisr} [@option{on}|@option{off}]
|
|
Selects whether interrupts will be processed when single stepping
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
|
|
|
|
@subsection ARM CoreSight TPIU and SWO specific commands
|
|
@cindex tracing
|
|
@cindex SWO
|
|
@cindex SWV
|
|
@cindex TPIU
|
|
|
|
ARM CoreSight provides several modules to generate debugging
|
|
information internally (ITM, DWT and ETM). Their output is directed
|
|
through TPIU or SWO modules to be captured externally either on an SWO pin (this
|
|
configuration is called SWV) or on a synchronous parallel trace port.
|
|
|
|
ARM CoreSight provides independent HW blocks named TPIU and SWO each with its
|
|
own functionality. Embedded in Cortex-M3 and M4, ARM provides an optional HW
|
|
block that includes both TPIU and SWO functionalities and is again named TPIU,
|
|
which causes quite some confusion.
|
|
The registers map of all the TPIU and SWO implementations allows using a single
|
|
driver that detects at runtime the features available.
|
|
|
|
The @command{tpiu} is used for either TPIU or SWO.
|
|
A convenient alias @command{swo} is available to help distinguish, in scripts,
|
|
the commands for SWO from the commands for TPIU.
|
|
|
|
@deffn {Command} {swo} ...
|
|
Alias of @command{tpiu ...}. Can be used in scripts to distinguish the commands
|
|
for SWO from the commands for TPIU.
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
|
|
@deffn {Command} {tpiu create} tpiu_name configparams...
|
|
Creates a TPIU or a SWO object. The two commands are equivalent.
|
|
Add the object in a list and add new commands (@command{@var{tpiu_name}})
|
|
which are used for various purposes including additional configuration.
|
|
|
|
@itemize @bullet
|
|
@item @var{tpiu_name} -- the name of the TPIU or SWO object.
|
|
This name is also used to create the object's command, referred to here
|
|
as @command{$tpiu_name}, and in other places where the TPIU or SWO needs to be identified.
|
|
@item @var{configparams} -- all parameters accepted by @command{$tpiu_name configure} are permitted.
|
|
|
|
You @emph{must} set here the AP and MEM_AP base_address through @code{-dap @var{dap_name}},
|
|
@code{-ap-num @var{ap_number}} and @code{-baseaddr @var{base_address}}.
|
|
@end itemize
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
|
|
@deffn {Command} {tpiu names}
|
|
Lists all the TPIU or SWO objects created so far. The two commands are equivalent.
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
|
|
@deffn {Command} {tpiu init}
|
|
Initialize all registered TPIU and SWO. The two commands are equivalent.
|
|
These commands are used internally during initialization. They can be issued
|
|
at any time after the initialization, too.
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
|
|
@deffn {Command} {$tpiu_name cget} queryparm
|
|
Each configuration parameter accepted by @command{$tpiu_name configure} can be
|
|
individually queried, to return its current value.
|
|
The @var{queryparm} is a parameter name accepted by that command, such as @code{-dap}.
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
|
|
@deffn {Command} {$tpiu_name configure} configparams...
|
|
The options accepted by this command may also be specified as parameters
|
|
to @command{tpiu create}. Their values can later be queried one at a time by
|
|
using the @command{$tpiu_name cget} command.
|
|
|
|
@itemize @bullet
|
|
@item @code{-dap} @var{dap_name} -- names the DAP used to access this
|
|
TPIU. @xref{dapdeclaration,,DAP declaration}, on how to create and manage DAP instances.
|
|
|
|
@item @code{-ap-num} @var{ap_number} -- sets DAP access port for TPIU.
|
|
On ADIv5 DAP @var{ap_number} is the numeric index of the DAP AP the TPIU is connected to.
|
|
On ADIv6 DAP @var{ap_number} is the base address of the DAP AP the TPIU is connected to.
|
|
|
|
@item @code{-baseaddr} @var{base_address} -- sets the TPIU @var{base_address} where
|
|
to access the TPIU in the DAP AP memory space.
|
|
|
|
@item @code{-protocol} (@option{sync}|@option{uart}|@option{manchester}) -- sets the
|
|
protocol used for trace data:
|
|
@itemize @minus
|
|
@item @option{sync} -- synchronous parallel trace output mode, using @var{port_width}
|
|
data bits (default);
|
|
@item @option{uart} -- use asynchronous SWO mode with NRZ (same as regular UART 8N1) coding;
|
|
@item @option{manchester} -- use asynchronous SWO mode with Manchester coding.
|
|
@end itemize
|
|
|
|
@item @code{-event} @var{event_name} @var{event_body} -- assigns an event handler,
|
|
a TCL string which is evaluated when the event is triggered. The events
|
|
@code{pre-enable}, @code{post-enable}, @code{pre-disable} and @code{post-disable}
|
|
are defined for TPIU/SWO.
|
|
A typical use case for the event @code{pre-enable} is to enable the trace clock
|
|
of the TPIU.
|
|
|
|
@item @code{-output} (@option{external}|@option{:}@var{port}|@var{filename}|@option{-}) -- specifies
|
|
the destination of the trace data:
|
|
@itemize @minus
|
|
@item @option{external} -- configure TPIU/SWO to let user capture trace
|
|
output externally, either with an additional UART or with a logic analyzer (default);
|
|
@item @option{-} -- configure TPIU/SWO and debug adapter to gather trace data
|
|
and forward it to @command{tcl_trace} command;
|
|
@item @option{:}@var{port} -- configure TPIU/SWO and debug adapter to gather
|
|
trace data, open a TCP server at port @var{port} and send the trace data to
|
|
each connected client;
|
|
@item @var{filename} -- configure TPIU/SWO and debug adapter to
|
|
gather trace data and append it to @var{filename}, which can be
|
|
either a regular file or a named pipe.
|
|
@end itemize
|
|
|
|
@item @code{-traceclk} @var{TRACECLKIN_freq} -- mandatory parameter.
|
|
Specifies the frequency in Hz of the trace clock. For the TPIU embedded in
|
|
Cortex-M3 or M4, this is usually the same frequency as HCLK. For protocol
|
|
@option{sync} this is twice the frequency of the pin data rate.
|
|
|
|
@item @code{-pin-freq} @var{trace_freq} -- specifies the expected data rate
|
|
in Hz of the SWO pin. Parameter used only on protocols @option{uart} and
|
|
@option{manchester}. Can be omitted to let the adapter driver select the
|
|
maximum supported rate automatically.
|
|
|
|
@item @code{-port-width} @var{port_width} -- sets to @var{port_width} the width
|
|
of the synchronous parallel port used for trace output. Parameter used only on
|
|
protocol @option{sync}. If not specified, default value is @var{1}.
|
|
|
|
@item @code{-formatter} (@option{0}|@option{1}) -- specifies if the formatter
|
|
should be enabled. Parameter used only on protocol @option{sync}. If not specified,
|
|
default value is @var{0}.
|
|
@end itemize
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
|
|
@deffn {Command} {$tpiu_name enable}
|
|
Uses the parameters specified by the previous @command{$tpiu_name configure}
|
|
to configure and enable the TPIU or the SWO.
|
|
If required, the adapter is also configured and enabled to receive the trace
|
|
data.
|
|
This command can be used before @command{init}, but it will take effect only
|
|
after the @command{init}.
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
|
|
@deffn {Command} {$tpiu_name disable}
|
|
Disable the TPIU or the SWO, terminating the receiving of the trace data.
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Example usage:
|
|
@enumerate
|
|
@item STM32L152 board is programmed with an application that configures
|
|
PLL to provide core clock with 24MHz frequency; to use ITM output it's
|
|
enough to:
|
|
@example
|
|
#include <libopencm3/cm3/itm.h>
|
|
...
|
|
ITM_STIM8(0) = c;
|
|
...
|
|
@end example
|
|
(the most obvious way is to use the first stimulus port for printf,
|
|
for that this ITM_STIM8 assignment can be used inside _write(); to make it
|
|
blocking to avoid data loss, add @code{while (!(ITM_STIM8(0) &
|
|
ITM_STIM_FIFOREADY));});
|
|
@item An FT2232H UART is connected to the SWO pin of the board;
|
|
@item Commands to configure UART for 12MHz baud rate:
|
|
@example
|
|
$ setserial /dev/ttyUSB1 spd_cust divisor 5
|
|
$ stty -F /dev/ttyUSB1 38400
|
|
@end example
|
|
(FT2232H's base frequency is 60MHz, spd_cust allows to alias 38400
|
|
baud with our custom divisor to get 12MHz)
|
|
@item @code{itmdump -f /dev/ttyUSB1 -d1}
|
|
@item OpenOCD invocation line:
|
|
@example
|
|
openocd -f interface/stlink.cfg \
|
|
-c "transport select hla_swd" \
|
|
-f target/stm32l1.cfg \
|
|
-c "stm32l1.tpiu configure -protocol uart" \
|
|
-c "stm32l1.tpiu configure -traceclk 24000000 -pin-freq 12000000" \
|
|
-c "stm32l1.tpiu enable"
|
|
@end example
|
|
@end enumerate
|
|
|
|
@subsection ARMv7-M specific commands
|
|
@cindex tracing
|
|
@cindex SWO
|
|
@cindex SWV
|
|
@cindex ITM
|
|
@cindex ETM
|
|
|
|
@deffn {Command} {itm port} @var{port} (@option{0}|@option{1}|@option{on}|@option{off})
|
|
Enable or disable trace output for ITM stimulus @var{port} (counting
|
|
from 0). Port 0 is enabled on target creation automatically.
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
|
|
@deffn {Command} {itm ports} (@option{0}|@option{1}|@option{on}|@option{off})
|
|
Enable or disable trace output for all ITM stimulus ports.
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
|
|
@subsection Cortex-M specific commands
|
|
@cindex Cortex-M
|
|
|
|
@deffn {Command} {cortex_m maskisr} (@option{auto}|@option{on}|@option{off}|@option{steponly})
|
|
Control masking (disabling) interrupts during target step/resume.
|
|
|
|
The @option{auto} option handles interrupts during stepping in a way that they
|
|
get served but don't disturb the program flow. The step command first allows
|
|
pending interrupt handlers to execute, then disables interrupts and steps over
|
|
the next instruction where the core was halted. After the step interrupts
|
|
are enabled again. If the interrupt handlers don't complete within 500ms,
|
|
the step command leaves with the core running.
|
|
|
|
The @option{steponly} option disables interrupts during single-stepping but
|
|
enables them during normal execution. This can be used as a partial workaround
|
|
for 702596 erratum in Cortex-M7 r0p1. See "Cortex-M7 (AT610) and Cortex-M7 with
|
|
FPU (AT611) Software Developer Errata Notice" from ARM for further details.
|
|
|
|
Note that a free hardware (FPB) breakpoint is required for the @option{auto}
|
|
option. If no breakpoint is available at the time of the step, then the step
|
|
is taken with interrupts enabled, i.e. the same way the @option{off} option
|
|
does.
|
|
|
|
Default is @option{auto}.
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
|
|
@deffn {Command} {cortex_m vector_catch} [@option{all}|@option{none}|list]
|
|
@cindex vector_catch
|
|
Vector Catch hardware provides dedicated breakpoints
|
|
for certain hardware events.
|
|
|
|
Parameters request interception of
|
|
@option{all} of these hardware event vectors,
|
|
@option{none} of them,
|
|
or one or more of the following:
|
|
@option{hard_err} for a HardFault exception;
|
|
@option{mm_err} for a MemManage exception;
|
|
@option{bus_err} for a BusFault exception;
|
|
@option{irq_err},
|
|
@option{state_err},
|
|
@option{chk_err}, or
|
|
@option{nocp_err} for various UsageFault exceptions; or
|
|
@option{reset}.
|
|
If NVIC setup code does not enable them,
|
|
MemManage, BusFault, and UsageFault exceptions
|
|
are mapped to HardFault.
|
|
UsageFault checks for
|
|
divide-by-zero and unaligned access
|
|
must also be explicitly enabled.
|
|
|
|
This finishes by listing the current vector catch configuration.
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
|
|
@deffn {Command} {cortex_m reset_config} (@option{sysresetreq}|@option{vectreset})
|
|
Control reset handling if hardware srst is not fitted
|
|
@xref{reset_config,,reset_config}.
|
|
|
|
@itemize @minus
|
|
@item @option{sysresetreq} use AIRCR SYSRESETREQ to reset system.
|
|
@item @option{vectreset} use AIRCR VECTRESET to reset system (default).
|
|
@end itemize
|
|
|
|
Using @option{vectreset} is a safe option for Cortex-M3, M4 and M7 cores.
|
|
This however has the disadvantage of only resetting the core, all peripherals
|
|
are unaffected. A solution would be to use a @code{reset-init} event handler
|
|
to manually reset the peripherals.
|
|
@xref{targetevents,,Target Events}.
|
|
|
|
Cortex-M0, M0+ and M1 do not support @option{vectreset}, use @option{sysresetreq}
|
|
instead.
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
|
|
@subsection ARMv8-A specific commands
|
|
@cindex ARMv8-A
|
|
@cindex aarch64
|
|
|
|
@deffn {Command} {aarch64 cache_info}
|
|
Display information about target caches
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
|
|
@deffn {Command} {aarch64 dbginit}
|
|
This command enables debugging by clearing the OS Lock and sticky power-down and reset
|
|
indications. It also establishes the expected, basic cross-trigger configuration the aarch64
|
|
target code relies on. In a configuration file, the command would typically be called from a
|
|
@code{reset-end} or @code{reset-deassert-post} handler, to re-enable debugging after a system reset.
|
|
However, normally it is not necessary to use the command at all.
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
|
|
@deffn {Command} {aarch64 disassemble} address [count]
|
|
@cindex disassemble
|
|
Disassembles @var{count} instructions starting at @var{address}.
|
|
If @var{count} is not specified, a single instruction is disassembled.
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
|
|
@deffn {Command} {aarch64 smp} [on|off]
|
|
Display, enable or disable SMP handling mode. The state of SMP handling influences the way targets in an SMP group
|
|
are handled by the run control. With SMP handling enabled, issuing halt or resume to one core will trigger
|
|
halting or resuming of all cores in the group. The command @code{target smp} defines which targets are in the SMP
|
|
group. With SMP handling disabled, all targets need to be treated individually.
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
|
|
@deffn {Command} {aarch64 maskisr} [@option{on}|@option{off}]
|
|
Selects whether interrupts will be processed when single stepping. The default configuration is
|
|
@option{on}.
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
|
|
@deffn {Command} {$target_name catch_exc} [@option{off}|@option{sec_el1}|@option{sec_el3}|@option{nsec_el1}|@option{nsec_el2}]+
|
|
Cause @command{$target_name} to halt when an exception is taken. Any combination of
|
|
Secure (sec) EL1/EL3 or Non-Secure (nsec) EL1/EL2 is valid. The target
|
|
@command{$target_name} will halt before taking the exception. In order to resume
|
|
the target, the exception catch must be disabled again with @command{$target_name catch_exc off}.
|
|
Issuing the command without options prints the current configuration.
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
|
|
@deffn {Command} {$target_name pauth} [@option{off}|@option{on}]
|
|
Enable or disable pointer authentication features.
|
|
When pointer authentication is used on ARM cores, GDB asks GDB servers for an 8-bytes mask to remove signature bits added by pointer authentication.
|
|
If this feature is enabled, OpenOCD provides GDB with an 8-bytes mask.
|
|
Pointer authentication feature is broken until gdb 12.1, going to be fixed.
|
|
Consider using a newer version of gdb if you want to enable pauth feature.
|
|
The default configuration is @option{off}.
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
|
|
|
|
@section EnSilica eSi-RISC Architecture
|
|
|
|
eSi-RISC is a highly configurable microprocessor architecture for embedded systems
|
|
provided by EnSilica. (See: @url{http://www.ensilica.com/risc-ip/}.)
|
|
|
|
@subsection eSi-RISC Configuration
|
|
|
|
@deffn {Command} {esirisc cache_arch} (@option{harvard}|@option{von_neumann})
|
|
Configure the caching architecture. Targets with the @code{UNIFIED_ADDRESS_SPACE}
|
|
option disabled employ a Harvard architecture. By default, @option{von_neumann} is assumed.
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
|
|
@deffn {Command} {esirisc hwdc} (@option{all}|@option{none}|mask ...)
|
|
Configure hardware debug control. The HWDC register controls which exceptions return
|
|
control back to the debugger. Possible masks are @option{all}, @option{none},
|
|
@option{reset}, @option{interrupt}, @option{syscall}, @option{error}, and @option{debug}.
|
|
By default, @option{reset}, @option{error}, and @option{debug} are enabled.
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
|
|
@subsection eSi-RISC Operation
|
|
|
|
@deffn {Command} {esirisc flush_caches}
|
|
Flush instruction and data caches. This command requires that the target is halted
|
|
when the command is issued and configured with an instruction or data cache.
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
|
|
@subsection eSi-Trace Configuration
|
|
|
|
eSi-RISC targets may be configured with support for instruction tracing. Trace
|
|
data may be written to an in-memory buffer or FIFO. If a FIFO is configured, DMA
|
|
is typically employed to move trace data off-device using a high-speed
|
|
peripheral (eg. SPI). Collected trace data is encoded in one of three different
|
|
formats. At a minimum, @command{esirisc trace buffer} or @command{esirisc trace
|
|
fifo} must be issued along with @command{esirisc trace format} before trace data
|
|
can be collected.
|
|
|
|
OpenOCD provides rudimentary analysis of collected trace data. If more detail is
|
|
needed, collected trace data can be dumped to a file and processed by external
|
|
tooling.
|
|
|
|
@quotation Issues
|
|
OpenOCD is unable to process trace data sent to a FIFO. A potential workaround
|
|
for this issue is to configure DMA to copy trace data to an in-memory buffer,
|
|
which can then be passed to the @command{esirisc trace analyze} and
|
|
@command{esirisc trace dump} commands.
|
|
|
|
It is possible to corrupt trace data when using a FIFO if the peripheral
|
|
responsible for draining data from the FIFO is not fast enough. This can be
|
|
managed by enabling flow control, however this can impact timing-sensitive
|
|
software operation on the CPU.
|
|
@end quotation
|
|
|
|
@deffn {Command} {esirisc trace buffer} address size [@option{wrap}]
|
|
Configure trace buffer using the provided address and size. If the @option{wrap}
|
|
option is specified, trace collection will continue once the end of the buffer
|
|
is reached. By default, wrap is disabled.
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
|
|
@deffn {Command} {esirisc trace fifo} address
|
|
Configure trace FIFO using the provided address.
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
|
|
@deffn {Command} {esirisc trace flow_control} (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
|
|
Enable or disable stalling the CPU to collect trace data. By default, flow
|
|
control is disabled.
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
|
|
@deffn {Command} {esirisc trace format} (@option{full}|@option{branch}|@option{icache}) pc_bits
|
|
Configure trace format and number of PC bits to be captured. @option{pc_bits}
|
|
must be within 1 and 31 as the LSB is not collected. If external tooling is used
|
|
to analyze collected trace data, these values must match.
|
|
|
|
Supported trace formats:
|
|
@itemize
|
|
@item @option{full} capture full trace data, allowing execution history and
|
|
timing to be determined.
|
|
@item @option{branch} capture taken branch instructions and branch target
|
|
addresses.
|
|
@item @option{icache} capture instruction cache misses.
|
|
@end itemize
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
|
|
@deffn {Command} {esirisc trace trigger start} (@option{condition}) [start_data start_mask]
|
|
Configure trigger start condition using the provided start data and mask. A
|
|
brief description of each condition is provided below; for more detail on how
|
|
these values are used, see the eSi-RISC Architecture Manual.
|
|
|
|
Supported conditions:
|
|
@itemize
|
|
@item @option{none} manual tracing (see @command{esirisc trace start}).
|
|
@item @option{pc} start tracing if the PC matches start data and mask.
|
|
@item @option{load} start tracing if the effective address of a load
|
|
instruction matches start data and mask.
|
|
@item @option{store} start tracing if the effective address of a store
|
|
instruction matches start data and mask.
|
|
@item @option{exception} start tracing if the EID of an exception matches start
|
|
data and mask.
|
|
@item @option{eret} start tracing when an @code{ERET} instruction is executed.
|
|
@item @option{wait} start tracing when a @code{WAIT} instruction is executed.
|
|
@item @option{stop} start tracing when a @code{STOP} instruction is executed.
|
|
@item @option{high} start tracing when an external signal is a logical high.
|
|
@item @option{low} start tracing when an external signal is a logical low.
|
|
@end itemize
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
|
|
@deffn {Command} {esirisc trace trigger stop} (@option{condition}) [stop_data stop_mask]
|
|
Configure trigger stop condition using the provided stop data and mask. A brief
|
|
description of each condition is provided below; for more detail on how these
|
|
values are used, see the eSi-RISC Architecture Manual.
|
|
|
|
Supported conditions:
|
|
@itemize
|
|
@item @option{none} manual tracing (see @command{esirisc trace stop}).
|
|
@item @option{pc} stop tracing if the PC matches stop data and mask.
|
|
@item @option{load} stop tracing if the effective address of a load
|
|
instruction matches stop data and mask.
|
|
@item @option{store} stop tracing if the effective address of a store
|
|
instruction matches stop data and mask.
|
|
@item @option{exception} stop tracing if the EID of an exception matches stop
|
|
data and mask.
|
|
@item @option{eret} stop tracing when an @code{ERET} instruction is executed.
|
|
@item @option{wait} stop tracing when a @code{WAIT} instruction is executed.
|
|
@item @option{stop} stop tracing when a @code{STOP} instruction is executed.
|
|
@end itemize
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
|
|
@deffn {Command} {esirisc trace trigger delay} (@option{trigger}) [cycles]
|
|
Configure trigger start/stop delay in clock cycles.
|
|
|
|
Supported triggers:
|
|
@itemize
|
|
@item @option{none} no delay to start or stop collection.
|
|
@item @option{start} delay @option{cycles} after trigger to start collection.
|
|
@item @option{stop} delay @option{cycles} after trigger to stop collection.
|
|
@item @option{both} delay @option{cycles} after both triggers to start or stop
|
|
collection.
|
|
@end itemize
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
|
|
@subsection eSi-Trace Operation
|
|
|
|
@deffn {Command} {esirisc trace init}
|
|
Initialize trace collection. This command must be called any time the
|
|
configuration changes. If a trace buffer has been configured, the contents will
|
|
be overwritten when trace collection starts.
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
|
|
@deffn {Command} {esirisc trace info}
|
|
Display trace configuration.
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
|
|
@deffn {Command} {esirisc trace status}
|
|
Display trace collection status.
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
|
|
@deffn {Command} {esirisc trace start}
|
|
Start manual trace collection.
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
|
|
@deffn {Command} {esirisc trace stop}
|
|
Stop manual trace collection.
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
|
|
@deffn {Command} {esirisc trace analyze} [address size]
|
|
Analyze collected trace data. This command may only be used if a trace buffer
|
|
has been configured. If a trace FIFO has been configured, trace data must be
|
|
copied to an in-memory buffer identified by the @option{address} and
|
|
@option{size} options using DMA.
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
|
|
@deffn {Command} {esirisc trace dump} [address size] @file{filename}
|
|
Dump collected trace data to file. This command may only be used if a trace
|
|
buffer has been configured. If a trace FIFO has been configured, trace data must
|
|
be copied to an in-memory buffer identified by the @option{address} and
|
|
@option{size} options using DMA.
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
|
|
@section Intel Architecture
|
|
|
|
Intel Quark X10xx is the first product in the Quark family of SoCs. It is an IA-32
|
|
(Pentium x86 ISA) compatible SoC. The core CPU in the X10xx is codenamed Lakemont.
|
|
Lakemont version 1 (LMT1) is used in X10xx. The CPU TAP (Lakemont TAP) is used for
|
|
software debug and the CLTAP is used for SoC level operations.
|
|
Useful docs are here: https://communities.intel.com/community/makers/documentation
|
|
@itemize
|
|
@item Intel Quark SoC X1000 OpenOCD/GDB/Eclipse App Note (web search for doc num 330015)
|
|
@item Intel Quark SoC X1000 Debug Operations User Guide (web search for doc num 329866)
|
|
@item Intel Quark SoC X1000 Datasheet (web search for doc num 329676)
|
|
@end itemize
|
|
|
|
@subsection x86 32-bit specific commands
|
|
The three main address spaces for x86 are memory, I/O and configuration space.
|
|
These commands allow a user to read and write to the 64Kbyte I/O address space.
|
|
|
|
@deffn {Command} {x86_32 idw} address
|
|
Display the contents of a 32-bit I/O port from address range 0x0000 - 0xffff.
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
|
|
@deffn {Command} {x86_32 idh} address
|
|
Display the contents of a 16-bit I/O port from address range 0x0000 - 0xffff.
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
|
|
@deffn {Command} {x86_32 idb} address
|
|
Display the contents of a 8-bit I/O port from address range 0x0000 - 0xffff.
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
|
|
@deffn {Command} {x86_32 iww} address
|
|
Write the contents of a 32-bit I/O port to address range 0x0000 - 0xffff.
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
|
|
@deffn {Command} {x86_32 iwh} address
|
|
Write the contents of a 16-bit I/O port to address range 0x0000 - 0xffff.
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
|
|
@deffn {Command} {x86_32 iwb} address
|
|
Write the contents of a 8-bit I/O port to address range 0x0000 - 0xffff.
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
|
|
@section OpenRISC Architecture
|
|
|
|
The OpenRISC CPU is a soft core. It is used in a programmable SoC which can be
|
|
configured with any of the TAP / Debug Unit available.
|
|
|
|
@subsection TAP and Debug Unit selection commands
|
|
@deffn {Command} {tap_select} (@option{vjtag}|@option{mohor}|@option{xilinx_bscan})
|
|
Select between the Altera Virtual JTAG , Xilinx Virtual JTAG and Mohor TAP.
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
@deffn {Command} {du_select} (@option{adv}|@option{mohor}) [option]
|
|
Select between the Advanced Debug Interface and the classic one.
|
|
|
|
An option can be passed as a second argument to the debug unit.
|
|
|
|
When using the Advanced Debug Interface, option = 1 means the RTL core is
|
|
configured with ADBG_USE_HISPEED = 1. This configuration skips status checking
|
|
between bytes while doing read or write bursts.
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
|
|
@subsection Registers commands
|
|
@deffn {Command} {addreg} [name] [address] [feature] [reg_group]
|
|
Add a new register in the cpu register list. This register will be
|
|
included in the generated target descriptor file.
|
|
|
|
@strong{[feature]} must be "org.gnu.gdb.or1k.group[0..10]".
|
|
|
|
@strong{[reg_group]} can be anything. The default register list defines "system",
|
|
"dmmu", "immu", "dcache", "icache", "mac", "debug", "perf", "power", "pic"
|
|
and "timer" groups.
|
|
|
|
@emph{example:}
|
|
@example
|
|
addreg rtest 0x1234 org.gnu.gdb.or1k.group0 system
|
|
@end example
|
|
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
|
|
@section RISC-V Architecture
|
|
|
|
@uref{http://riscv.org/, RISC-V} is a free and open ISA. OpenOCD supports JTAG
|
|
debug of RV32 and RV64 cores in heterogeneous multicore systems of up to 32
|
|
harts. (It's possible to increase this limit to 1024 by changing
|
|
RISCV_MAX_HARTS in riscv.h.) OpenOCD primarily supports 0.13 of the RISC-V
|
|
Debug Specification, but there is also support for legacy targets that
|
|
implement version 0.11.
|
|
|
|
@subsection RISC-V Terminology
|
|
|
|
A @emph{hart} is a hardware thread. A hart may share resources (eg. FPU) with
|
|
another hart, or may be a separate core. RISC-V treats those the same, and
|
|
OpenOCD exposes each hart as a separate core.
|
|
|
|
@subsection Vector Registers
|
|
|
|
For harts that implement the vector extension, OpenOCD provides access to the
|
|
relevant CSRs, as well as the vector registers (v0-v31). The size of each
|
|
vector register is dependent on the value of vlenb. RISC-V allows each vector
|
|
register to be divided into selected-width elements, and this division can be
|
|
changed at run-time. Because OpenOCD cannot update register definitions at
|
|
run-time, it exposes each vector register to gdb as a union of fields of
|
|
vectors so that users can easily access individual bytes, shorts, words,
|
|
longs, and quads inside each vector register. It is left to gdb or
|
|
higher-level debuggers to present this data in a more intuitive format.
|
|
|
|
In the XML register description, the vector registers (when vlenb=16) look as
|
|
follows:
|
|
|
|
@example
|
|
<feature name="org.gnu.gdb.riscv.vector">
|
|
<vector id="bytes" type="uint8" count="16"/>
|
|
<vector id="shorts" type="uint16" count="8"/>
|
|
<vector id="words" type="uint32" count="4"/>
|
|
<vector id="longs" type="uint64" count="2"/>
|
|
<vector id="quads" type="uint128" count="1"/>
|
|
<union id="riscv_vector">
|
|
<field name="b" type="bytes"/>
|
|
<field name="s" type="shorts"/>
|
|
<field name="w" type="words"/>
|
|
<field name="l" type="longs"/>
|
|
<field name="q" type="quads"/>
|
|
</union>
|
|
<reg name="v0" bitsize="128" regnum="4162" save-restore="no"
|
|
type="riscv_vector" group="vector"/>
|
|
...
|
|
<reg name="v31" bitsize="128" regnum="4193" save-restore="no"
|
|
type="riscv_vector" group="vector"/>
|
|
</feature>
|
|
@end example
|
|
|
|
@subsection RISC-V Debug Configuration Commands
|
|
|
|
@deffn {Config Command} {riscv expose_csrs} n[-m|=name] [...]
|
|
Configure which CSRs to expose in addition to the standard ones. The CSRs to expose
|
|
can be specified as individual register numbers or register ranges (inclusive). For the
|
|
individually listed CSRs, a human-readable name can optionally be set using the @code{n=name}
|
|
syntax, which will get @code{csr_} prepended to it. If no name is provided, the register will be
|
|
named @code{csr<n>}.
|
|
|
|
By default OpenOCD attempts to expose only CSRs that are mentioned in a spec,
|
|
and then only if the corresponding extension appears to be implemented. This
|
|
command can be used if OpenOCD gets this wrong, or if the target implements custom
|
|
CSRs.
|
|
|
|
@example
|
|
# Expose a single RISC-V CSR number 128 under the name "csr128":
|
|
$_TARGETNAME expose_csrs 128
|
|
|
|
# Expose multiple RISC-V CSRs 128..132 under names "csr128" through "csr132":
|
|
$_TARGETNAME expose_csrs 128-132
|
|
|
|
# Expose a single RISC-V CSR number 1996 under custom name "csr_myregister":
|
|
$_TARGETNAME expose_csrs 1996=myregister
|
|
@end example
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
|
|
@deffn {Config Command} {riscv expose_custom} n[-m|=name] [...]
|
|
The RISC-V Debug Specification allows targets to expose custom registers
|
|
through abstract commands. (See Section 3.5.1.1 in that document.) This command
|
|
configures individual registers or register ranges (inclusive) that shall be exposed.
|
|
Number 0 indicates the first custom register, whose abstract command number is 0xc000.
|
|
For individually listed registers, a human-readable name can be optionally provided
|
|
using the @code{n=name} syntax, which will get @code{custom_} prepended to it. If no
|
|
name is provided, the register will be named @code{custom<n>}.
|
|
|
|
@example
|
|
# Expose one RISC-V custom register with number 0xc010 (0xc000 + 16)
|
|
# under the name "custom16":
|
|
$_TARGETNAME expose_custom 16
|
|
|
|
# Expose a range of RISC-V custom registers with numbers 0xc010 .. 0xc018
|
|
# (0xc000+16 .. 0xc000+24) under the names "custom16" through "custom24":
|
|
$_TARGETNAME expose_custom 16-24
|
|
|
|
# Expose one RISC-V custom register with number 0xc020 (0xc000 + 32) under
|
|
# user-defined name "custom_myregister":
|
|
$_TARGETNAME expose_custom 32=myregister
|
|
@end example
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
|
|
@deffn {Command} {riscv info}
|
|
Displays some information OpenOCD detected about the target.
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
|
|
@deffn {Command} {riscv reset_delays} [wait]
|
|
OpenOCD learns how many Run-Test/Idle cycles are required between scans to avoid
|
|
encountering the target being busy. This command resets those learned values
|
|
after `wait` scans. It's only useful for testing OpenOCD itself.
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
|
|
@deffn {Command} {riscv set_command_timeout_sec} [seconds]
|
|
Set the wall-clock timeout (in seconds) for individual commands. The default
|
|
should work fine for all but the slowest targets (eg. simulators).
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
|
|
@deffn {Command} {riscv set_reset_timeout_sec} [seconds]
|
|
Set the maximum time to wait for a hart to come out of reset after reset is
|
|
deasserted.
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
|
|
@deffn {Command} {riscv set_mem_access} method1 [method2] [method3]
|
|
Specify which RISC-V memory access method(s) shall be used, and in which order
|
|
of priority. At least one method must be specified.
|
|
|
|
Available methods are:
|
|
@itemize
|
|
@item @code{progbuf} - Use RISC-V Debug Program Buffer to access memory.
|
|
@item @code{sysbus} - Access memory via RISC-V Debug System Bus interface.
|
|
@item @code{abstract} - Access memory via RISC-V Debug abstract commands.
|
|
@end itemize
|
|
|
|
By default, all memory access methods are enabled in the following order:
|
|
@code{progbuf sysbus abstract}.
|
|
|
|
This command can be used to change the memory access methods if the default
|
|
behavior is not suitable for a particular target.
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
|
|
@deffn {Command} {riscv set_enable_virtual} on|off
|
|
When on, memory accesses are performed on physical or virtual memory depending
|
|
on the current system configuration. When off (default), all memory accessses are performed
|
|
on physical memory.
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
|
|
@deffn {Command} {riscv set_enable_virt2phys} on|off
|
|
When on (default), memory accesses are performed on physical or virtual memory
|
|
depending on the current satp configuration. When off, all memory accessses are
|
|
performed on physical memory.
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
|
|
@deffn {Command} {riscv resume_order} normal|reversed
|
|
Some software assumes all harts are executing nearly continuously. Such
|
|
software may be sensitive to the order that harts are resumed in. On harts
|
|
that don't support hasel, this option allows the user to choose the order the
|
|
harts are resumed in. If you are using this option, it's probably masking a
|
|
race condition problem in your code.
|
|
|
|
Normal order is from lowest hart index to highest. This is the default
|
|
behavior. Reversed order is from highest hart index to lowest.
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
|
|
@deffn {Command} {riscv set_ir} (@option{idcode}|@option{dtmcs}|@option{dmi}) [value]
|
|
Set the IR value for the specified JTAG register. This is useful, for
|
|
example, when using the existing JTAG interface on a Xilinx FPGA by
|
|
way of BSCANE2 primitives that only permit a limited selection of IR
|
|
values.
|
|
|
|
When utilizing version 0.11 of the RISC-V Debug Specification,
|
|
@option{dtmcs} and @option{dmi} set the IR values for the DTMCONTROL
|
|
and DBUS registers, respectively.
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
|
|
@deffn {Command} {riscv use_bscan_tunnel} value
|
|
Enable or disable use of a BSCAN tunnel to reach DM. Supply the width of
|
|
the DM transport TAP's instruction register to enable. Supply a value of 0 to disable.
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
|
|
@deffn {Command} {riscv set_ebreakm} on|off
|
|
Control dcsr.ebreakm. When on (default), M-mode ebreak instructions trap to
|
|
OpenOCD. When off, they generate a breakpoint exception handled internally.
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
|
|
@deffn {Command} {riscv set_ebreaks} on|off
|
|
Control dcsr.ebreaks. When on (default), S-mode ebreak instructions trap to
|
|
OpenOCD. When off, they generate a breakpoint exception handled internally.
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
|
|
@deffn {Command} {riscv set_ebreaku} on|off
|
|
Control dcsr.ebreaku. When on (default), U-mode ebreak instructions trap to
|
|
OpenOCD. When off, they generate a breakpoint exception handled internally.
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
|
|
@subsection RISC-V Authentication Commands
|
|
|
|
The following commands can be used to authenticate to a RISC-V system. Eg. a
|
|
trivial challenge-response protocol could be implemented as follows in a
|
|
configuration file, immediately following @command{init}:
|
|
@example
|
|
set challenge [riscv authdata_read]
|
|
riscv authdata_write [expr @{$challenge + 1@}]
|
|
@end example
|
|
|
|
@deffn {Command} {riscv authdata_read}
|
|
Return the 32-bit value read from authdata.
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
|
|
@deffn {Command} {riscv authdata_write} value
|
|
Write the 32-bit value to authdata.
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
|
|
@subsection RISC-V DMI Commands
|
|
|
|
The following commands allow direct access to the Debug Module Interface, which
|
|
can be used to interact with custom debug features.
|
|
|
|
@deffn {Command} {riscv dmi_read} address
|
|
Perform a 32-bit DMI read at address, returning the value.
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
|
|
@deffn {Command} {riscv dmi_write} address value
|
|
Perform a 32-bit DMI write of value at address.
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
|
|
@section ARC Architecture
|
|
@cindex ARC
|
|
|
|
Synopsys DesignWare ARC Processors are a family of 32-bit CPUs that SoC
|
|
designers can optimize for a wide range of uses, from deeply embedded to
|
|
high-performance host applications in a variety of market segments. See more
|
|
at: @url{http://www.synopsys.com/IP/ProcessorIP/ARCProcessors/Pages/default.aspx}.
|
|
OpenOCD currently supports ARC EM processors.
|
|
There is a set ARC-specific OpenOCD commands that allow low-level
|
|
access to the core and provide necessary support for ARC extensibility and
|
|
configurability capabilities. ARC processors has much more configuration
|
|
capabilities than most of the other processors and in addition there is an
|
|
extension interface that allows SoC designers to add custom registers and
|
|
instructions. For the OpenOCD that mostly means that set of core and AUX
|
|
registers in target will vary and is not fixed for a particular processor
|
|
model. To enable extensibility several TCL commands are provided that allow to
|
|
describe those optional registers in OpenOCD configuration files. Moreover
|
|
those commands allow for a dynamic target features discovery.
|
|
|
|
|
|
@subsection General ARC commands
|
|
|
|
@deffn {Config Command} {arc add-reg} configparams
|
|
|
|
Add a new register to processor target. By default newly created register is
|
|
marked as not existing. @var{configparams} must have following required
|
|
arguments:
|
|
|
|
@itemize @bullet
|
|
|
|
@item @code{-name} name
|
|
@*Name of a register.
|
|
|
|
@item @code{-num} number
|
|
@*Architectural register number: core register number or AUX register number.
|
|
|
|
@item @code{-feature} XML_feature
|
|
@*Name of GDB XML target description feature.
|
|
|
|
@end itemize
|
|
|
|
@var{configparams} may have following optional arguments:
|
|
|
|
@itemize @bullet
|
|
|
|
@item @code{-gdbnum} number
|
|
@*GDB register number. It is recommended to not assign GDB register number
|
|
manually, because there would be a risk that two register will have same
|
|
number. When register GDB number is not set with this option, then register
|
|
will get a previous register number + 1. This option is required only for those
|
|
registers that must be at particular address expected by GDB.
|
|
|
|
@item @code{-core}
|
|
@*This option specifies that register is a core registers. If not - this is an
|
|
AUX register. AUX registers and core registers reside in different address
|
|
spaces.
|
|
|
|
@item @code{-bcr}
|
|
@*This options specifies that register is a BCR register. BCR means Build
|
|
Configuration Registers - this is a special type of AUX registers that are read
|
|
only and non-volatile, that is - they never change their value. Therefore OpenOCD
|
|
never invalidates values of those registers in internal caches. Because BCR is a
|
|
type of AUX registers, this option cannot be used with @code{-core}.
|
|
|
|
@item @code{-type} type_name
|
|
@*Name of type of this register. This can be either one of the basic GDB types,
|
|
or a custom types described with @command{arc add-reg-type-[flags|struct]}.
|
|
|
|
@item @code{-g}
|
|
@* If specified then this is a "general" register. General registers are always
|
|
read by OpenOCD on context save (when core has just been halted) and is always
|
|
transferred to GDB client in a response to g-packet. Contrary to this,
|
|
non-general registers are read and sent to GDB client on-demand. In general it
|
|
is not recommended to apply this option to custom registers.
|
|
|
|
@end itemize
|
|
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
|
|
@deffn {Config Command} {arc add-reg-type-flags} -name name flags...
|
|
Adds new register type of ``flags'' class. ``Flags'' types can contain only
|
|
one-bit fields. Each flag definition looks like @code{-flag name bit-position}.
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
|
|
@anchor{add-reg-type-struct}
|
|
@deffn {Config Command} {arc add-reg-type-struct} -name name structs...
|
|
Adds new register type of ``struct'' class. ``Struct'' types can contain either
|
|
bit-fields or fields of other types, however at the moment only bit fields are
|
|
supported. Structure bit field definition looks like @code{-bitfield name
|
|
startbit endbit}.
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
|
|
@deffn {Command} {arc get-reg-field} reg-name field-name
|
|
Returns value of bit-field in a register. Register must be ``struct'' register
|
|
type, @xref{add-reg-type-struct}. command definition.
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
|
|
@deffn {Command} {arc set-reg-exists} reg-names...
|
|
Specify that some register exists. Any amount of names can be passed
|
|
as an argument for a single command invocation.
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
|
|
@subsection ARC JTAG commands
|
|
|
|
@deffn {Command} {arc jtag set-aux-reg} regnum value
|
|
This command writes value to AUX register via its number. This command access
|
|
register in target directly via JTAG, bypassing any OpenOCD internal caches,
|
|
therefore it is unsafe to use if that register can be operated by other means.
|
|
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
|
|
@deffn {Command} {arc jtag set-core-reg} regnum value
|
|
This command is similar to @command{arc jtag set-aux-reg} but is for core
|
|
registers.
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
|
|
@deffn {Command} {arc jtag get-aux-reg} regnum
|
|
This command returns the value storded in AUX register via its number. This commands access
|
|
register in target directly via JTAG, bypassing any OpenOCD internal caches,
|
|
therefore it is unsafe to use if that register can be operated by other means.
|
|
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
|
|
@deffn {Command} {arc jtag get-core-reg} regnum
|
|
This command is similar to @command{arc jtag get-aux-reg} but is for core
|
|
registers.
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
|
|
@section STM8 Architecture
|
|
@uref{http://st.com/stm8/, STM8} is a 8-bit microcontroller platform from
|
|
STMicroelectronics, based on a proprietary 8-bit core architecture.
|
|
|
|
OpenOCD supports debugging STM8 through the STMicroelectronics debug
|
|
protocol SWIM, @pxref{swimtransport,,SWIM}.
|
|
|
|
@section Xtensa Architecture
|
|
|
|
Xtensa is a highly-customizable, user-extensible microprocessor and DSP
|
|
architecture for complex embedded systems provided by Cadence Design
|
|
Systems, Inc. See the
|
|
@uref{https://www.cadence.com/en_US/home/tools/ip/tensilica-ip.html, Tensilica IP}
|
|
website for additional information and documentation.
|
|
|
|
OpenOCD supports generic Xtensa processor implementations which can be customized by
|
|
providing a core-specific configuration file which describes every enabled
|
|
Xtensa architecture option, e.g. number of address registers, exceptions, reduced
|
|
size instructions support, memory banks configuration etc. OpenOCD also supports SMP
|
|
configurations for Xtensa processors with any number of cores and allows configuring
|
|
their debug interconnect (termed "break/stall networks"), which control how debug
|
|
signals are distributed among cores. Xtensa "break networks" are compatible with
|
|
ARM's Cross Trigger Interface (CTI). OpenOCD implements both generic Xtensa targets
|
|
as well as several Espressif Xtensa-based chips from the
|
|
@uref{https://www.espressif.com/en/products/socs, ESP32 family}.
|
|
|
|
OCD sessions for Xtensa processor and DSP targets are accessed via the Xtensa
|
|
Debug Module (XDM), which provides external connectivity either through a
|
|
traditional JTAG interface or an ARM DAP interface. If used, the DAP interface
|
|
can control Xtensa targets through JTAG or SWD probes.
|
|
|
|
@subsection Xtensa Core Configuration
|
|
|
|
Due to the high level of configurability in Xtensa cores, the Xtensa target
|
|
configuration comprises two categories:
|
|
|
|
@enumerate
|
|
@item Base Xtensa support common to all core configurations, and
|
|
@item Core-specific support as configured for individual cores.
|
|
@end enumerate
|
|
|
|
All common Xtensa support is built into the OpenOCD Xtensa target layer and
|
|
is enabled through a combination of TCL scripts: the target-specific
|
|
@file{target/xtensa.cfg} and a board-specific @file{board/xtensa-*.cfg},
|
|
similar to other target architectures.
|
|
|
|
Importantly, core-specific configuration information must be provided by
|
|
the user, and takes the form of an @file{xtensa-core-XXX.cfg} TCL script that
|
|
defines the core's configurable features through a series of Xtensa
|
|
configuration commands (detailed below).
|
|
|
|
This core-specific @file{xtensa-core-XXX.cfg} file is typically either:
|
|
|
|
@itemize @bullet
|
|
@item Located within the Xtensa core configuration build as
|
|
@file{src/config/xtensa-core-openocd.cfg}, or
|
|
@item Generated by running the command @code{xt-gdb --dump-oocd-config}
|
|
from the Xtensa processor tool-chain's command-line tools.
|
|
@end itemize
|
|
|
|
NOTE: @file{xtensa-core-XXX.cfg} must match the target Xtensa hardware
|
|
connected to OpenOCD.
|
|
|
|
Some example Xtensa configurations are bundled with OpenOCD for reference:
|
|
@itemize @bullet
|
|
@item Cadence Palladium VDebug emulation target. The user can combine their
|
|
@file{xtensa-core-XXX.cfg} with the provided
|
|
@file{board/xtensa-palladium-vdebug.cfg} to debug an emulated Xtensa RTL design.
|
|
@item NXP MIMXRT685-EVK evaluation kit. The relevant configuration files are
|
|
@file{board/xtensa-rt685-jlink.cfg} and @file{board/xtensa-core-nxp_rt600.cfg}.
|
|
Additional information is provided by
|
|
@uref{https://www.nxp.com/design/development-boards/i-mx-evaluation-and-development-boards/i-mx-rt600-evaluation-kit:MIMXRT685-EVK,
|
|
NXP}.
|
|
@end itemize
|
|
|
|
@subsection Xtensa Configuration Commands
|
|
|
|
@deffn {Config Command} {xtensa xtdef} (@option{LX}|@option{NX})
|
|
Configure the Xtensa target architecture. Currently, Xtensa support is limited
|
|
to LX6, LX7, and NX cores.
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
|
|
@deffn {Config Command} {xtensa xtopt} option value
|
|
Configure Xtensa target options that are relevant to the debug subsystem.
|
|
@var{option} is one of: @option{arnum}, @option{windowed},
|
|
@option{cpenable}, @option{exceptions}, @option{intnum}, @option{hipriints},
|
|
@option{excmlevel}, @option{intlevels}, @option{debuglevel},
|
|
@option{ibreaknum}, or @option{dbreaknum}. @var{value} is an integer with
|
|
the exact range determined by each particular option.
|
|
|
|
NOTE: Some options are specific to Xtensa LX or Xtensa NX architecture, while
|
|
others may be common to both but have different valid ranges.
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
|
|
@deffn {Config Command} {xtensa xtmem} (@option{iram}|@option{dram}|@option{sram}|@option{irom}|@option{drom}|@option{srom}) baseaddr bytes
|
|
Configure Xtensa target memory. Memory type determines access rights,
|
|
where RAMs are read/write while ROMs are read-only. @var{baseaddr} and
|
|
@var{bytes} are both integers, typically hexadecimal and decimal, respectively.
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
|
|
@deffn {Config Command} {xtensa xtmem} (@option{icache}|@option{dcache}) linebytes cachebytes ways [writeback]
|
|
Configure Xtensa processor cache. All parameters are required except for
|
|
the optional @option{writeback} parameter; all are integers.
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
|
|
@deffn {Config Command} {xtensa xtmpu} numfgseg minsegsz lockable execonly
|
|
Configure an Xtensa Memory Protection Unit (MPU). MPUs can restrict access
|
|
and/or control cacheability of specific address ranges, but are lighter-weight
|
|
than a full traditional MMU. All parameters are required; all are integers.
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
|
|
@deffn {Config Command} {xtensa xtmmu} numirefillentries numdrefillentries
|
|
(Xtensa-LX only) Configure an Xtensa Memory Management Unit (MMU). Both
|
|
parameters are required; both are integers.
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
|
|
@deffn {Config Command} {xtensa xtregs} numregs
|
|
Configure the total number of registers for the Xtensa core. Configuration
|
|
logic expects to subsequently process this number of @code{xtensa xtreg}
|
|
definitions. @var{numregs} is an integer.
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
|
|
@deffn {Config Command} {xtensa xtregfmt} (@option{sparse}|@option{contiguous}) [general]
|
|
Configure the type of register map used by GDB to access the Xtensa core.
|
|
Generic Xtensa tools (e.g. xt-gdb) require @option{sparse} mapping (default) while
|
|
Espressif tools expect @option{contiguous} mapping. Contiguous mapping takes an
|
|
additional, optional integer parameter @option{numgregs}, which specifies the number
|
|
of general registers used in handling g/G packets.
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
|
|
@deffn {Config Command} {xtensa xtreg} name offset
|
|
Configure an Xtensa core register. All core registers are 32 bits wide,
|
|
while TIE and user registers may have variable widths. @var{name} is a
|
|
character string identifier while @var{offset} is a hexadecimal integer.
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
|
|
@subsection Xtensa Operation Commands
|
|
|
|
@deffn {Command} {xtensa maskisr} (@option{on}|@option{off})
|
|
(Xtensa-LX only) Mask or unmask Xtensa interrupts during instruction step.
|
|
When masked, an interrupt that occurs during a step operation is handled and
|
|
its ISR is executed, with the user's debug session returning after potentially
|
|
executing many instructions. When unmasked, a triggered interrupt will result
|
|
in execution progressing the requested number of instructions into the relevant
|
|
vector/ISR code.
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
|
|
@deffn {Command} {xtensa set_permissive} (0|1)
|
|
By default accessing memory beyond defined regions is forbidden. This commnd controls memory access address check.
|
|
When set to (1), skips access controls and address range check before read/write memory.
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
|
|
@deffn {Command} {xtensa smpbreak} [none|breakinout|runstall] | [BreakIn] [BreakOut] [RunStallIn] [DebugModeOut]
|
|
Configures debug signals connection ("break network") for currently selected core.
|
|
@itemize @bullet
|
|
@item @code{none} - Core's "break/stall network" is disconnected. Core is not affected by any debug
|
|
signal from other cores.
|
|
@item @code{breakinout} - Core's "break network" is fully connected (break inputs and outputs are enabled).
|
|
Core will receive debug break signals from other cores and send such signals to them. For example when another core
|
|
is stopped due to breakpoint hit this core will be stopped too and vice versa.
|
|
@item @code{runstall} - Core's "stall network" is fully connected (stall inputs and outputs are enabled).
|
|
This feature is not well implemented and tested yet.
|
|
@item @code{BreakIn} - Core's "break-in" signal is enabled.
|
|
Core will receive debug break signals from other cores. For example when another core is
|
|
stopped due to breakpoint hit this core will be stopped too.
|
|
@item @code{BreakOut} - Core's "break-out" signal is enabled.
|
|
Core will send debug break signal to other cores. For example when this core is
|
|
stopped due to breakpoint hit other cores with enabled break-in signals will be stopped too.
|
|
@item @code{RunStallIn} - Core's "runstall-in" signal is enabled.
|
|
This feature is not well implemented and tested yet.
|
|
@item @code{DebugModeOut} - Core's "debugmode-out" signal is enabled.
|
|
This feature is not well implemented and tested yet.
|
|
@end itemize
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
|
|
@deffn {Command} {xtensa exe} <ascii-encoded hexadecimal instruction bytes>
|
|
Execute arbitrary instruction(s) provided as an ascii string. The string represents an integer
|
|
number of instruction bytes, thus its length must be even.
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
|
|
@subsection Xtensa Performance Monitor Configuration
|
|
|
|
@deffn {Command} {xtensa perfmon_enable} <counter_id> <select> [mask] [kernelcnt] [tracelevel]
|
|
Enable and start performance counter.
|
|
@itemize @bullet
|
|
@item @code{counter_id} - Counter ID (0-1).
|
|
@item @code{select} - Selects performance metric to be counted by the counter,
|
|
e.g. 0 - CPU cycles, 2 - retired instructions.
|
|
@item @code{mask} - Selects input subsets to be counted (counter will
|
|
increment only once even if more than one condition corresponding to a mask bit occurs).
|
|
@item @code{kernelcnt} - 0 - count events with "CINTLEVEL <= tracelevel",
|
|
1 - count events with "CINTLEVEL > tracelevel".
|
|
@item @code{tracelevel} - Compares this value to "CINTLEVEL" when deciding
|
|
whether to count.
|
|
@end itemize
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
|
|
@deffn {Command} {xtensa perfmon_dump} (counter_id)
|
|
Dump performance counter value. If no argument specified, dumps all counters.
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
|
|
@subsection Xtensa Trace Configuration
|
|
|
|
@deffn {Command} {xtensa tracestart} [pc <pcval>/[<maskbitcount>]] [after <n> [ins|words]]
|
|
Set up and start a HW trace. Optionally set PC address range to trigger tracing stop when reached during program execution.
|
|
This command also allows to specify the amount of data to capture after stop trigger activation.
|
|
@itemize @bullet
|
|
@item @code{pcval} - PC value which will trigger trace data collection stop.
|
|
@item @code{maskbitcount} - PC value mask.
|
|
@item @code{n} - Maximum number of instructions/words to capture after trace stop trigger.
|
|
@end itemize
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
|
|
@deffn {Command} {xtensa tracestop}
|
|
Stop current trace as started by the tracestart command.
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
|
|
@deffn {Command} {xtensa tracedump} <outfile>
|
|
Dump trace memory to a file.
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
|
|
@anchor{softwaredebugmessagesandtracing}
|
|
@section Software Debug Messages and Tracing
|
|
@cindex Linux-ARM DCC support
|
|
@cindex tracing
|
|
@cindex libdcc
|
|
@cindex DCC
|
|
OpenOCD can process certain requests from target software, when
|
|
the target uses appropriate libraries.
|
|
The most powerful mechanism is semihosting, but there is also
|
|
a lighter weight mechanism using only the DCC channel.
|
|
|
|
Currently @command{target_request debugmsgs}
|
|
is supported only for @option{arm7_9} and @option{cortex_m} cores.
|
|
These messages are received as part of target polling, so
|
|
you need to have @command{poll on} active to receive them.
|
|
They are intrusive in that they will affect program execution
|
|
times. If that is a problem, @pxref{armhardwaretracing,,ARM Hardware Tracing}.
|
|
|
|
See @file{libdcc} in the contrib dir for more details.
|
|
In addition to sending strings, characters, and
|
|
arrays of various size integers from the target,
|
|
@file{libdcc} also exports a software trace point mechanism.
|
|
The target being debugged may
|
|
issue trace messages which include a 24-bit @dfn{trace point} number.
|
|
Trace point support includes two distinct mechanisms,
|
|
each supported by a command:
|
|
|
|
@itemize
|
|
@item @emph{History} ... A circular buffer of trace points
|
|
can be set up, and then displayed at any time.
|
|
This tracks where code has been, which can be invaluable in
|
|
finding out how some fault was triggered.
|
|
|
|
The buffer may overflow, since it collects records continuously.
|
|
It may be useful to use some of the 24 bits to represent a
|
|
particular event, and other bits to hold data.
|
|
|
|
@item @emph{Counting} ... An array of counters can be set up,
|
|
and then displayed at any time.
|
|
This can help establish code coverage and identify hot spots.
|
|
|
|
The array of counters is directly indexed by the trace point
|
|
number, so trace points with higher numbers are not counted.
|
|
@end itemize
|
|
|
|
Linux-ARM kernels have a ``Kernel low-level debugging
|
|
via EmbeddedICE DCC channel'' option (CONFIG_DEBUG_ICEDCC,
|
|
depends on CONFIG_DEBUG_LL) which uses this mechanism to
|
|
deliver messages before a serial console can be activated.
|
|
This is not the same format used by @file{libdcc}.
|
|
Other software, such as the U-Boot boot loader, sometimes
|
|
does the same thing.
|
|
|
|
@deffn {Command} {target_request debugmsgs} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}|@option{charmsg}]
|
|
Displays current handling of target DCC message requests.
|
|
These messages may be sent to the debugger while the target is running.
|
|
The optional @option{enable} and @option{charmsg} parameters
|
|
both enable the messages, while @option{disable} disables them.
|
|
|
|
With @option{charmsg} the DCC words each contain one character,
|
|
as used by Linux with CONFIG_DEBUG_ICEDCC;
|
|
otherwise the libdcc format is used.
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
|
|
@deffn {Command} {trace history} [@option{clear}|count]
|
|
With no parameter, displays all the trace points that have triggered
|
|
in the order they triggered.
|
|
With the parameter @option{clear}, erases all current trace history records.
|
|
With a @var{count} parameter, allocates space for that many
|
|
history records.
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
|
|
@deffn {Command} {trace point} [@option{clear}|identifier]
|
|
With no parameter, displays all trace point identifiers and how many times
|
|
they have been triggered.
|
|
With the parameter @option{clear}, erases all current trace point counters.
|
|
With a numeric @var{identifier} parameter, creates a new a trace point counter
|
|
and associates it with that identifier.
|
|
|
|
@emph{Important:} The identifier and the trace point number
|
|
are not related except by this command.
|
|
These trace point numbers always start at zero (from server startup,
|
|
or after @command{trace point clear}) and count up from there.
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
|
|
|
|
@node JTAG Commands
|
|
@chapter JTAG Commands
|
|
@cindex JTAG Commands
|
|
Most general purpose JTAG commands have been presented earlier.
|
|
(@xref{jtagspeed,,JTAG Speed}, @ref{Reset Configuration}, and @ref{TAP Declaration}.)
|
|
Lower level JTAG commands, as presented here,
|
|
may be needed to work with targets which require special
|
|
attention during operations such as reset or initialization.
|
|
|
|
To use these commands you will need to understand some
|
|
of the basics of JTAG, including:
|
|
|
|
@itemize @bullet
|
|
@item A JTAG scan chain consists of a sequence of individual TAP
|
|
devices such as a CPUs.
|
|
@item Control operations involve moving each TAP through the same
|
|
standard state machine (in parallel)
|
|
using their shared TMS and clock signals.
|
|
@item Data transfer involves shifting data through the chain of
|
|
instruction or data registers of each TAP, writing new register values
|
|
while the reading previous ones.
|
|
@item Data register sizes are a function of the instruction active in
|
|
a given TAP, while instruction register sizes are fixed for each TAP.
|
|
All TAPs support a BYPASS instruction with a single bit data register.
|
|
@item The way OpenOCD differentiates between TAP devices is by
|
|
shifting different instructions into (and out of) their instruction
|
|
registers.
|
|
@end itemize
|
|
|
|
@section Low Level JTAG Commands
|
|
|
|
These commands are used by developers who need to access
|
|
JTAG instruction or data registers, possibly controlling
|
|
the order of TAP state transitions.
|
|
If you're not debugging OpenOCD internals, or bringing up a
|
|
new JTAG adapter or a new type of TAP device (like a CPU or
|
|
JTAG router), you probably won't need to use these commands.
|
|
In a debug session that doesn't use JTAG for its transport protocol,
|
|
these commands are not available.
|
|
|
|
@deffn {Command} {drscan} tap [numbits value]+ [@option{-endstate} tap_state]
|
|
Loads the data register of @var{tap} with a series of bit fields
|
|
that specify the entire register.
|
|
Each field is @var{numbits} bits long with
|
|
a numeric @var{value} (hexadecimal encouraged).
|
|
The return value holds the original value of each
|
|
of those fields.
|
|
|
|
For example, a 38 bit number might be specified as one
|
|
field of 32 bits then one of 6 bits.
|
|
@emph{For portability, never pass fields which are more
|
|
than 32 bits long. Many OpenOCD implementations do not
|
|
support 64-bit (or larger) integer values.}
|
|
|
|
All TAPs other than @var{tap} must be in BYPASS mode.
|
|
The single bit in their data registers does not matter.
|
|
|
|
When @var{tap_state} is specified, the JTAG state machine is left
|
|
in that state.
|
|
For example @sc{drpause} might be specified, so that more
|
|
instructions can be issued before re-entering the @sc{run/idle} state.
|
|
If the end state is not specified, the @sc{run/idle} state is entered.
|
|
|
|
@quotation Warning
|
|
OpenOCD does not record information about data register lengths,
|
|
so @emph{it is important that you get the bit field lengths right}.
|
|
Remember that different JTAG instructions refer to different
|
|
data registers, which may have different lengths.
|
|
Moreover, those lengths may not be fixed;
|
|
the SCAN_N instruction can change the length of
|
|
the register accessed by the INTEST instruction
|
|
(by connecting a different scan chain).
|
|
@end quotation
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
|
|
@deffn {Command} {flush_count}
|
|
Returns the number of times the JTAG queue has been flushed.
|
|
This may be used for performance tuning.
|
|
|
|
For example, flushing a queue over USB involves a
|
|
minimum latency, often several milliseconds, which does
|
|
not change with the amount of data which is written.
|
|
You may be able to identify performance problems by finding
|
|
tasks which waste bandwidth by flushing small transfers too often,
|
|
instead of batching them into larger operations.
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
|
|
@deffn {Command} {irscan} [tap instruction]+ [@option{-endstate} tap_state]
|
|
For each @var{tap} listed, loads the instruction register
|
|
with its associated numeric @var{instruction}.
|
|
(The number of bits in that instruction may be displayed
|
|
using the @command{scan_chain} command.)
|
|
For other TAPs, a BYPASS instruction is loaded.
|
|
|
|
When @var{tap_state} is specified, the JTAG state machine is left
|
|
in that state.
|
|
For example @sc{irpause} might be specified, so the data register
|
|
can be loaded before re-entering the @sc{run/idle} state.
|
|
If the end state is not specified, the @sc{run/idle} state is entered.
|
|
|
|
@quotation Note
|
|
OpenOCD currently supports only a single field for instruction
|
|
register values, unlike data register values.
|
|
For TAPs where the instruction register length is more than 32 bits,
|
|
portable scripts currently must issue only BYPASS instructions.
|
|
@end quotation
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
|
|
@deffn {Command} {pathmove} start_state [next_state ...]
|
|
Start by moving to @var{start_state}, which
|
|
must be one of the @emph{stable} states.
|
|
Unless it is the only state given, this will often be the
|
|
current state, so that no TCK transitions are needed.
|
|
Then, in a series of single state transitions
|
|
(conforming to the JTAG state machine) shift to
|
|
each @var{next_state} in sequence, one per TCK cycle.
|
|
The final state must also be stable.
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
|
|
@deffn {Command} {runtest} @var{num_cycles}
|
|
Move to the @sc{run/idle} state, and execute at least
|
|
@var{num_cycles} of the JTAG clock (TCK).
|
|
Instructions often need some time
|
|
to execute before they take effect.
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
|
|
@c tms_sequence (short|long)
|
|
@c ... temporary, debug-only, other than USBprog bug workaround...
|
|
|
|
@deffn {Command} {verify_ircapture} (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
|
|
Verify values captured during @sc{ircapture} and returned
|
|
during IR scans. Default is enabled, but this can be
|
|
overridden by @command{verify_jtag}.
|
|
This flag is ignored when validating JTAG chain configuration.
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
|
|
@deffn {Command} {verify_jtag} (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
|
|
Enables verification of DR and IR scans, to help detect
|
|
programming errors. For IR scans, @command{verify_ircapture}
|
|
must also be enabled.
|
|
Default is enabled.
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
|
|
@section TAP state names
|
|
@cindex TAP state names
|
|
|
|
The @var{tap_state} names used by OpenOCD in the @command{drscan},
|
|
@command{irscan}, and @command{pathmove} commands are the same
|
|
as those used in SVF boundary scan documents, except that
|
|
SVF uses @sc{idle} instead of @sc{run/idle}.
|
|
|
|
@itemize @bullet
|
|
@item @b{RESET} ... @emph{stable} (with TMS high);
|
|
acts as if TRST were pulsed
|
|
@item @b{RUN/IDLE} ... @emph{stable}; don't assume this always means IDLE
|
|
@item @b{DRSELECT}
|
|
@item @b{DRCAPTURE}
|
|
@item @b{DRSHIFT} ... @emph{stable}; TDI/TDO shifting
|
|
through the data register
|
|
@item @b{DREXIT1}
|
|
@item @b{DRPAUSE} ... @emph{stable}; data register ready
|
|
for update or more shifting
|
|
@item @b{DREXIT2}
|
|
@item @b{DRUPDATE}
|
|
@item @b{IRSELECT}
|
|
@item @b{IRCAPTURE}
|
|
@item @b{IRSHIFT} ... @emph{stable}; TDI/TDO shifting
|
|
through the instruction register
|
|
@item @b{IREXIT1}
|
|
@item @b{IRPAUSE} ... @emph{stable}; instruction register ready
|
|
for update or more shifting
|
|
@item @b{IREXIT2}
|
|
@item @b{IRUPDATE}
|
|
@end itemize
|
|
|
|
Note that only six of those states are fully ``stable'' in the
|
|
face of TMS fixed (low except for @sc{reset})
|
|
and a free-running JTAG clock. For all the
|
|
others, the next TCK transition changes to a new state.
|
|
|
|
@itemize @bullet
|
|
@item From @sc{drshift} and @sc{irshift}, clock transitions will
|
|
produce side effects by changing register contents. The values
|
|
to be latched in upcoming @sc{drupdate} or @sc{irupdate} states
|
|
may not be as expected.
|
|
@item @sc{run/idle}, @sc{drpause}, and @sc{irpause} are reasonable
|
|
choices after @command{drscan} or @command{irscan} commands,
|
|
since they are free of JTAG side effects.
|
|
@item @sc{run/idle} may have side effects that appear at non-JTAG
|
|
levels, such as advancing the ARM9E-S instruction pipeline.
|
|
Consult the documentation for the TAP(s) you are working with.
|
|
@end itemize
|
|
|
|
@node Boundary Scan Commands
|
|
@chapter Boundary Scan Commands
|
|
|
|
One of the original purposes of JTAG was to support
|
|
boundary scan based hardware testing.
|
|
Although its primary focus is to support On-Chip Debugging,
|
|
OpenOCD also includes some boundary scan commands.
|
|
|
|
@section SVF: Serial Vector Format
|
|
@cindex Serial Vector Format
|
|
@cindex SVF
|
|
|
|
The Serial Vector Format, better known as @dfn{SVF}, is a
|
|
way to represent JTAG test patterns in text files.
|
|
In a debug session using JTAG for its transport protocol,
|
|
OpenOCD supports running such test files.
|
|
|
|
@deffn {Command} {svf} @file{filename} [@option{-tap @var{tapname}}] [@option{[-]quiet}] @
|
|
[@option{[-]nil}] [@option{[-]progress}] [@option{[-]ignore_error}]
|
|
This issues a JTAG reset (Test-Logic-Reset) and then
|
|
runs the SVF script from @file{filename}.
|
|
|
|
Arguments can be specified in any order; the optional dash doesn't
|
|
affect their semantics.
|
|
|
|
Command options:
|
|
@itemize @minus
|
|
@item @option{-tap @var{tapname}} ignore IR and DR headers and footers
|
|
specified by the SVF file with HIR, TIR, HDR and TDR commands;
|
|
instead, calculate them automatically according to the current JTAG
|
|
chain configuration, targeting @var{tapname};
|
|
@item @option{[-]quiet} do not log every command before execution;
|
|
@item @option{[-]nil} ``dry run'', i.e., do not perform any operations
|
|
on the real interface;
|
|
@item @option{[-]progress} enable progress indication;
|
|
@item @option{[-]ignore_error} continue execution despite TDO check
|
|
errors.
|
|
@end itemize
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
|
|
@section XSVF: Xilinx Serial Vector Format
|
|
@cindex Xilinx Serial Vector Format
|
|
@cindex XSVF
|
|
|
|
The Xilinx Serial Vector Format, better known as @dfn{XSVF}, is a
|
|
binary representation of SVF which is optimized for use with
|
|
Xilinx devices.
|
|
In a debug session using JTAG for its transport protocol,
|
|
OpenOCD supports running such test files.
|
|
|
|
@quotation Important
|
|
Not all XSVF commands are supported.
|
|
@end quotation
|
|
|
|
@deffn {Command} {xsvf} (tapname|@option{plain}) filename [@option{virt2}] [@option{quiet}]
|
|
This issues a JTAG reset (Test-Logic-Reset) and then
|
|
runs the XSVF script from @file{filename}.
|
|
When a @var{tapname} is specified, the commands are directed at
|
|
that TAP.
|
|
When @option{virt2} is specified, the @sc{xruntest} command counts
|
|
are interpreted as TCK cycles instead of microseconds.
|
|
Unless the @option{quiet} option is specified,
|
|
messages are logged for comments and some retries.
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
|
|
The OpenOCD sources also include two utility scripts
|
|
for working with XSVF; they are not currently installed
|
|
after building the software.
|
|
You may find them useful:
|
|
|
|
@itemize
|
|
@item @emph{svf2xsvf} ... converts SVF files into the extended XSVF
|
|
syntax understood by the @command{xsvf} command; see notes below.
|
|
@item @emph{xsvfdump} ... converts XSVF files into a text output format;
|
|
understands the OpenOCD extensions.
|
|
@end itemize
|
|
|
|
The input format accepts a handful of non-standard extensions.
|
|
These include three opcodes corresponding to SVF extensions
|
|
from Lattice Semiconductor (LCOUNT, LDELAY, LDSR), and
|
|
two opcodes supporting a more accurate translation of SVF
|
|
(XTRST, XWAITSTATE).
|
|
If @emph{xsvfdump} shows a file is using those opcodes, it
|
|
probably will not be usable with other XSVF tools.
|
|
|
|
|
|
@section IPDBG: JTAG-Host server
|
|
@cindex IPDBG JTAG-Host server
|
|
@cindex IPDBG
|
|
|
|
IPDBG is a set of tools to debug IP-Cores. It comprises, among others, a logic analyzer and an arbitrary
|
|
waveform generator. These are synthesize-able hardware descriptions of
|
|
logic circuits in addition to software for control, visualization and further analysis.
|
|
In a session using JTAG for its transport protocol, OpenOCD supports the function
|
|
of a JTAG-Host. The JTAG-Host is needed to connect the circuit over JTAG to the
|
|
control-software. For more details see @url{http://ipdbg.org}.
|
|
|
|
@deffn {Command} {ipdbg} [@option{-start|-stop}] @option{-tap @var{tapname}} @option{-hub @var{ir_value} [@var{dr_length}]} [@option{-port @var{number}}] [@option{-tool @var{number}}] [@option{-vir [@var{vir_value} [@var{length} [@var{instr_code}]]]}]
|
|
Starts or stops a IPDBG JTAG-Host server. Arguments can be specified in any order.
|
|
|
|
Command options:
|
|
@itemize @bullet
|
|
@item @option{-start|-stop} starts or stops a IPDBG JTAG-Host server (default: start).
|
|
@item @option{-tap @var{tapname}} targeting the TAP @var{tapname}.
|
|
@item @option{-hub @var{ir_value}} states that the JTAG hub is
|
|
reachable with dr-scans while the JTAG instruction register has the value @var{ir_value}.
|
|
@item @option{-port @var{number}} tcp port number where the JTAG-Host is listening.
|
|
@item @option{-tool @var{number}} number of the tool/feature. These corresponds to the ports "data_(up/down)_(0..6)" at the JtagHub.
|
|
@item @option{-vir [@var{vir_value} [@var{length} [@var{instr_code}]]]} On some devices, the user data-register is only reachable if there is a
|
|
specific value in a second dr. This second dr is called vir (virtual ir). With this parameter given, the IPDBG satisfies this condition prior an
|
|
access to the IPDBG-Hub. The value shifted into the vir is given by the first parameter @var{vir_value} (default: 0x11). The second
|
|
parameter @var{length} is the length of the vir data register (default: 5). With the @var{instr_code} (default: 0x00e) parameter the ir value to
|
|
shift data through vir can be configured.
|
|
@end itemize
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
|
|
Examples:
|
|
@example
|
|
ipdbg -start -tap xc6s.tap -hub 0x02 -port 4242 -tool 4
|
|
@end example
|
|
Starts a server listening on tcp-port 4242 which connects to tool 4.
|
|
The connection is through the TAP of a Xilinx Spartan 6 on USER1 instruction (tested with a papillion pro board).
|
|
|
|
@example
|
|
ipdbg -start -tap 10m50.tap -hub 0x00C -vir -port 60000 -tool 1
|
|
@end example
|
|
Starts a server listening on tcp-port 60000 which connects to tool 1 (data_up_1/data_down_1).
|
|
The connection is through the TAP of a Intel MAX10 virtual jtag component (sld_instance_index is 0; sld_ir_width is smaller than 5).
|
|
|
|
@node Utility Commands
|
|
@chapter Utility Commands
|
|
@cindex Utility Commands
|
|
|
|
@section RAM testing
|
|
@cindex RAM testing
|
|
|
|
There is often a need to stress-test random access memory (RAM) for
|
|
errors. OpenOCD comes with a Tcl implementation of well-known memory
|
|
testing procedures allowing the detection of all sorts of issues with
|
|
electrical wiring, defective chips, PCB layout and other common
|
|
hardware problems.
|
|
|
|
To use them, you usually need to initialise your RAM controller first;
|
|
consult your SoC's documentation to get the recommended list of
|
|
register operations and translate them to the corresponding
|
|
@command{mww}/@command{mwb} commands.
|
|
|
|
Load the memory testing functions with
|
|
|
|
@example
|
|
source [find tools/memtest.tcl]
|
|
@end example
|
|
|
|
to get access to the following facilities:
|
|
|
|
@deffn {Command} {memTestDataBus} address
|
|
Test the data bus wiring in a memory region by performing a walking
|
|
1's test at a fixed address within that region.
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
|
|
@deffn {Command} {memTestAddressBus} baseaddress size
|
|
Perform a walking 1's test on the relevant bits of the address and
|
|
check for aliasing. This test will find single-bit address failures
|
|
such as stuck-high, stuck-low, and shorted pins.
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
|
|
@deffn {Command} {memTestDevice} baseaddress size
|
|
Test the integrity of a physical memory device by performing an
|
|
increment/decrement test over the entire region. In the process every
|
|
storage bit in the device is tested as zero and as one.
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
|
|
@deffn {Command} {runAllMemTests} baseaddress size
|
|
Run all of the above tests over a specified memory region.
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
|
|
@section Firmware recovery helpers
|
|
@cindex Firmware recovery
|
|
|
|
OpenOCD includes an easy-to-use script to facilitate mass-market
|
|
devices recovery with JTAG.
|
|
|
|
For quickstart instructions run:
|
|
@example
|
|
openocd -f tools/firmware-recovery.tcl -c firmware_help
|
|
@end example
|
|
|
|
@node GDB and OpenOCD
|
|
@chapter GDB and OpenOCD
|
|
@cindex GDB
|
|
OpenOCD complies with the remote gdbserver protocol and, as such, can be used
|
|
to debug remote targets.
|
|
Setting up GDB to work with OpenOCD can involve several components:
|
|
|
|
@itemize
|
|
@item The OpenOCD server support for GDB may need to be configured.
|
|
@xref{gdbconfiguration,,GDB Configuration}.
|
|
@item GDB's support for OpenOCD may need configuration,
|
|
as shown in this chapter.
|
|
@item If you have a GUI environment like Eclipse,
|
|
that also will probably need to be configured.
|
|
@end itemize
|
|
|
|
Of course, the version of GDB you use will need to be one which has
|
|
been built to know about the target CPU you're using. It's probably
|
|
part of the tool chain you're using. For example, if you are doing
|
|
cross-development for ARM on an x86 PC, instead of using the native
|
|
x86 @command{gdb} command you might use @command{arm-none-eabi-gdb}
|
|
if that's the tool chain used to compile your code.
|
|
|
|
@section Connecting to GDB
|
|
@cindex Connecting to GDB
|
|
Use GDB 6.7 or newer with OpenOCD if you run into trouble. For
|
|
instance GDB 6.3 has a known bug that produces bogus memory access
|
|
errors, which has since been fixed; see
|
|
@url{http://osdir.com/ml/gdb.bugs.discuss/2004-12/msg00018.html}
|
|
|
|
OpenOCD can communicate with GDB in two ways:
|
|
|
|
@enumerate
|
|
@item
|
|
A socket (TCP/IP) connection is typically started as follows:
|
|
@example
|
|
target extended-remote localhost:3333
|
|
@end example
|
|
This would cause GDB to connect to the gdbserver on the local pc using port 3333.
|
|
|
|
The extended remote protocol is a super-set of the remote protocol and should
|
|
be the preferred choice. More details are available in GDB documentation
|
|
@url{https://sourceware.org/gdb/onlinedocs/gdb/Connecting.html}
|
|
|
|
To speed-up typing, any GDB command can be abbreviated, including the extended
|
|
remote command above that becomes:
|
|
@example
|
|
tar ext :3333
|
|
@end example
|
|
|
|
@b{Note:} If any backward compatibility issue requires using the old remote
|
|
protocol in place of the extended remote one, the former protocol is still
|
|
available through the command:
|
|
@example
|
|
target remote localhost:3333
|
|
@end example
|
|
|
|
@item
|
|
A pipe connection is typically started as follows:
|
|
@example
|
|
target extended-remote | \
|
|
openocd -c "gdb_port pipe; log_output openocd.log"
|
|
@end example
|
|
This would cause GDB to run OpenOCD and communicate using pipes (stdin/stdout).
|
|
Using this method has the advantage of GDB starting/stopping OpenOCD for the debug
|
|
session. log_output sends the log output to a file to ensure that the pipe is
|
|
not saturated when using higher debug level outputs.
|
|
@end enumerate
|
|
|
|
To list the available OpenOCD commands type @command{monitor help} on the
|
|
GDB command line.
|
|
|
|
@section Sample GDB session startup
|
|
|
|
With the remote protocol, GDB sessions start a little differently
|
|
than they do when you're debugging locally.
|
|
Here's an example showing how to start a debug session with a
|
|
small ARM program.
|
|
In this case the program was linked to be loaded into SRAM on a Cortex-M3.
|
|
Most programs would be written into flash (address 0) and run from there.
|
|
|
|
@example
|
|
$ arm-none-eabi-gdb example.elf
|
|
(gdb) target extended-remote localhost:3333
|
|
Remote debugging using localhost:3333
|
|
...
|
|
(gdb) monitor reset halt
|
|
...
|
|
(gdb) load
|
|
Loading section .vectors, size 0x100 lma 0x20000000
|
|
Loading section .text, size 0x5a0 lma 0x20000100
|
|
Loading section .data, size 0x18 lma 0x200006a0
|
|
Start address 0x2000061c, load size 1720
|
|
Transfer rate: 22 KB/sec, 573 bytes/write.
|
|
(gdb) continue
|
|
Continuing.
|
|
...
|
|
@end example
|
|
|
|
You could then interrupt the GDB session to make the program break,
|
|
type @command{where} to show the stack, @command{list} to show the
|
|
code around the program counter, @command{step} through code,
|
|
set breakpoints or watchpoints, and so on.
|
|
|
|
@section Configuring GDB for OpenOCD
|
|
|
|
OpenOCD supports the gdb @option{qSupported} packet, this enables information
|
|
to be sent by the GDB remote server (i.e. OpenOCD) to GDB. Typical information includes
|
|
packet size and the device's memory map.
|
|
You do not need to configure the packet size by hand,
|
|
and the relevant parts of the memory map should be automatically
|
|
set up when you declare (NOR) flash banks.
|
|
|
|
However, there are other things which GDB can't currently query.
|
|
You may need to set those up by hand.
|
|
As OpenOCD starts up, you will often see a line reporting
|
|
something like:
|
|
|
|
@example
|
|
Info : lm3s.cpu: hardware has 6 breakpoints, 4 watchpoints
|
|
@end example
|
|
|
|
You can pass that information to GDB with these commands:
|
|
|
|
@example
|
|
set remote hardware-breakpoint-limit 6
|
|
set remote hardware-watchpoint-limit 4
|
|
@end example
|
|
|
|
With that particular hardware (Cortex-M3) the hardware breakpoints
|
|
only work for code running from flash memory. Most other ARM systems
|
|
do not have such restrictions.
|
|
|
|
Rather than typing such commands interactively, you may prefer to
|
|
save them in a file and have GDB execute them as it starts, perhaps
|
|
using a @file{.gdbinit} in your project directory or starting GDB
|
|
using @command{gdb -x filename}.
|
|
|
|
@section Programming using GDB
|
|
@cindex Programming using GDB
|
|
@anchor{programmingusinggdb}
|
|
|
|
By default the target memory map is sent to GDB. This can be disabled by
|
|
the following OpenOCD configuration option:
|
|
@example
|
|
gdb_memory_map disable
|
|
@end example
|
|
For this to function correctly a valid flash configuration must also be set
|
|
in OpenOCD. For faster performance you should also configure a valid
|
|
working area.
|
|
|
|
Informing GDB of the memory map of the target will enable GDB to protect any
|
|
flash areas of the target and use hardware breakpoints by default. This means
|
|
that the OpenOCD option @command{gdb_breakpoint_override} is not required when
|
|
using a memory map. @xref{gdbbreakpointoverride,,gdb_breakpoint_override}.
|
|
|
|
To view the configured memory map in GDB, use the GDB command @option{info mem}.
|
|
All other unassigned addresses within GDB are treated as RAM.
|
|
|
|
GDB 6.8 and higher set any memory area not in the memory map as inaccessible.
|
|
This can be changed to the old behaviour by using the following GDB command
|
|
@example
|
|
set mem inaccessible-by-default off
|
|
@end example
|
|
|
|
If @command{gdb_flash_program enable} is also used, GDB will be able to
|
|
program any flash memory using the vFlash interface.
|
|
|
|
GDB will look at the target memory map when a load command is given, if any
|
|
areas to be programmed lie within the target flash area the vFlash packets
|
|
will be used.
|
|
|
|
If the target needs configuring before GDB programming, set target
|
|
event gdb-flash-erase-start:
|
|
@example
|
|
$_TARGETNAME configure -event gdb-flash-erase-start BODY
|
|
@end example
|
|
@xref{targetevents,,Target Events}, for other GDB programming related events.
|
|
|
|
To verify any flash programming the GDB command @option{compare-sections}
|
|
can be used.
|
|
|
|
@section Using GDB as a non-intrusive memory inspector
|
|
@cindex Using GDB as a non-intrusive memory inspector
|
|
@anchor{gdbmeminspect}
|
|
|
|
If your project controls more than a blinking LED, let's say a heavy industrial
|
|
robot or an experimental nuclear reactor, stopping the controlling process
|
|
just because you want to attach GDB is not a good option.
|
|
|
|
OpenOCD does not support GDB non-stop mode (might be implemented in the future).
|
|
Though there is a possible setup where the target does not get stopped
|
|
and GDB treats it as it were running.
|
|
If the target supports background access to memory while it is running,
|
|
you can use GDB in this mode to inspect memory (mainly global variables)
|
|
without any intrusion of the target process.
|
|
|
|
Remove default setting of gdb-attach event. @xref{targetevents,,Target Events}.
|
|
Place following command after target configuration:
|
|
@example
|
|
$_TARGETNAME configure -event gdb-attach @{@}
|
|
@end example
|
|
|
|
If any of installed flash banks does not support probe on running target,
|
|
switch off gdb_memory_map:
|
|
@example
|
|
gdb_memory_map disable
|
|
@end example
|
|
|
|
Ensure GDB is configured without interrupt-on-connect.
|
|
Some GDB versions set it by default, some does not.
|
|
@example
|
|
set remote interrupt-on-connect off
|
|
@end example
|
|
|
|
If you switched gdb_memory_map off, you may want to setup GDB memory map
|
|
manually or issue @command{set mem inaccessible-by-default off}
|
|
|
|
Now you can issue GDB command @command{target extended-remote ...} and inspect memory
|
|
of a running target. Do not use GDB commands @command{continue},
|
|
@command{step} or @command{next} as they synchronize GDB with your target
|
|
and GDB would require stopping the target to get the prompt back.
|
|
|
|
Do not use this mode under an IDE like Eclipse as it caches values of
|
|
previously shown variables.
|
|
|
|
It's also possible to connect more than one GDB to the same target by the
|
|
target's configuration option @code{-gdb-max-connections}. This allows, for
|
|
example, one GDB to run a script that continuously polls a set of variables
|
|
while other GDB can be used interactively. Be extremely careful in this case,
|
|
because the two GDB can easily get out-of-sync.
|
|
|
|
@section RTOS Support
|
|
@cindex RTOS Support
|
|
@anchor{gdbrtossupport}
|
|
|
|
OpenOCD includes RTOS support, this will however need enabling as it defaults to disabled.
|
|
It can be enabled by passing @option{-rtos} arg to the target. @xref{rtostype,,RTOS Type}.
|
|
|
|
@xref{Threads, Debugging Programs with Multiple Threads,
|
|
Debugging Programs with Multiple Threads, gdb, GDB manual}, for details about relevant
|
|
GDB commands.
|
|
|
|
@* An example setup is below:
|
|
|
|
@example
|
|
$_TARGETNAME configure -rtos auto
|
|
@end example
|
|
|
|
This will attempt to auto detect the RTOS within your application.
|
|
|
|
Currently supported rtos's include:
|
|
@itemize @bullet
|
|
@item @option{eCos}
|
|
@item @option{ThreadX}
|
|
@item @option{FreeRTOS}
|
|
@item @option{linux}
|
|
@item @option{ChibiOS}
|
|
@item @option{embKernel}
|
|
@item @option{mqx}
|
|
@item @option{uCOS-III}
|
|
@item @option{nuttx}
|
|
@item @option{RIOT}
|
|
@item @option{hwthread} (This is not an actual RTOS. @xref{usingopenocdsmpwithgdb,,Using OpenOCD SMP with GDB}.)
|
|
@item @option{Zephyr}
|
|
@item @option{rtkernel}
|
|
@end itemize
|
|
|
|
At any time, it's possible to drop the selected RTOS using:
|
|
@example
|
|
$_TARGETNAME configure -rtos none
|
|
@end example
|
|
|
|
Before an RTOS can be detected, it must export certain symbols; otherwise, it cannot
|
|
be used by OpenOCD. Below is a list of the required symbols for each supported RTOS.
|
|
|
|
@table @code
|
|
@item eCos symbols
|
|
Cyg_Thread::thread_list, Cyg_Scheduler_Base::current_thread.
|
|
@item ThreadX symbols
|
|
_tx_thread_current_ptr, _tx_thread_created_ptr, _tx_thread_created_count.
|
|
@item FreeRTOS symbols
|
|
@raggedright
|
|
pxCurrentTCB, pxReadyTasksLists, xDelayedTaskList1, xDelayedTaskList2,
|
|
pxDelayedTaskList, pxOverflowDelayedTaskList, xPendingReadyList,
|
|
uxCurrentNumberOfTasks, uxTopUsedPriority.
|
|
@end raggedright
|
|
@item linux symbols
|
|
init_task.
|
|
@item ChibiOS symbols
|
|
rlist, ch_debug, chSysInit.
|
|
@item embKernel symbols
|
|
Rtos::sCurrentTask, Rtos::sListReady, Rtos::sListSleep,
|
|
Rtos::sListSuspended, Rtos::sMaxPriorities, Rtos::sCurrentTaskCount.
|
|
@item mqx symbols
|
|
_mqx_kernel_data, MQX_init_struct.
|
|
@item uC/OS-III symbols
|
|
OSRunning, OSTCBCurPtr, OSTaskDbgListPtr, OSTaskQty.
|
|
@item nuttx symbols
|
|
g_readytorun, g_tasklisttable.
|
|
@item RIOT symbols
|
|
@raggedright
|
|
sched_threads, sched_num_threads, sched_active_pid, max_threads,
|
|
_tcb_name_offset.
|
|
@end raggedright
|
|
@item Zephyr symbols
|
|
_kernel, _kernel_openocd_offsets, _kernel_openocd_size_t_size
|
|
@item rtkernel symbols
|
|
Multiple struct offsets.
|
|
@end table
|
|
|
|
For most RTOS supported the above symbols will be exported by default. However for
|
|
some, eg. FreeRTOS, uC/OS-III and Zephyr, extra steps must be taken.
|
|
|
|
Zephyr must be compiled with the DEBUG_THREAD_INFO option. This will generate some symbols
|
|
with information needed in order to build the list of threads.
|
|
|
|
FreeRTOS and uC/OS-III RTOSes may require additional OpenOCD-specific file to be linked
|
|
along with the project:
|
|
|
|
@table @code
|
|
@item FreeRTOS
|
|
contrib/rtos-helpers/FreeRTOS-openocd.c
|
|
@item uC/OS-III
|
|
contrib/rtos-helpers/uCOS-III-openocd.c
|
|
@end table
|
|
|
|
@anchor{usingopenocdsmpwithgdb}
|
|
@section Using OpenOCD SMP with GDB
|
|
@cindex SMP
|
|
@cindex RTOS
|
|
@cindex hwthread
|
|
OpenOCD includes a pseudo RTOS called @emph{hwthread} that presents CPU cores
|
|
("hardware threads") in an SMP system as threads to GDB. With this extension,
|
|
GDB can be used to inspect the state of an SMP system in a natural way.
|
|
After halting the system, using the GDB command @command{info threads} will
|
|
list the context of each active CPU core in the system. GDB's @command{thread}
|
|
command can be used to switch the view to a different CPU core.
|
|
The @command{step} and @command{stepi} commands can be used to step a specific core
|
|
while other cores are free-running or remain halted, depending on the
|
|
scheduler-locking mode configured in GDB.
|
|
|
|
@node Tcl Scripting API
|
|
@chapter Tcl Scripting API
|
|
@cindex Tcl Scripting API
|
|
@cindex Tcl scripts
|
|
@section API rules
|
|
|
|
Tcl commands are stateless; e.g. the @command{telnet} command has
|
|
a concept of currently active target, the Tcl API proc's take this sort
|
|
of state information as an argument to each proc.
|
|
|
|
There are three main types of return values: single value, name value
|
|
pair list and lists.
|
|
|
|
Name value pair. The proc 'foo' below returns a name/value pair
|
|
list.
|
|
|
|
@example
|
|
> set foo(me) Duane
|
|
> set foo(you) Oyvind
|
|
> set foo(mouse) Micky
|
|
> set foo(duck) Donald
|
|
@end example
|
|
|
|
If one does this:
|
|
|
|
@example
|
|
> set foo
|
|
@end example
|
|
|
|
The result is:
|
|
|
|
@example
|
|
me Duane you Oyvind mouse Micky duck Donald
|
|
@end example
|
|
|
|
Thus, to get the names of the associative array is easy:
|
|
|
|
@verbatim
|
|
foreach { name value } [set foo] {
|
|
puts "Name: $name, Value: $value"
|
|
}
|
|
@end verbatim
|
|
|
|
Lists returned should be relatively small. Otherwise, a range
|
|
should be passed in to the proc in question.
|
|
|
|
@section Internal low-level Commands
|
|
|
|
By "low-level", we mean commands that a human would typically not
|
|
invoke directly.
|
|
|
|
@itemize
|
|
@item @b{flash banks} <@var{driver}> <@var{base}> <@var{size}> <@var{chip_width}> <@var{bus_width}> <@var{target}> [@option{driver options} ...]
|
|
|
|
Return information about the flash banks
|
|
|
|
@item @b{capture} <@var{command}>
|
|
|
|
Run <@var{command}> and return full log output that was produced during
|
|
its execution. Example:
|
|
|
|
@example
|
|
> capture "reset init"
|
|
@end example
|
|
|
|
@end itemize
|
|
|
|
OpenOCD commands can consist of two words, e.g. "flash banks". The
|
|
@file{startup.tcl} "unknown" proc will translate this into a Tcl proc
|
|
called "flash_banks".
|
|
|
|
@section Tcl RPC server
|
|
@cindex RPC
|
|
|
|
OpenOCD provides a simple RPC server that allows to run arbitrary Tcl
|
|
commands and receive the results.
|
|
|
|
To access it, your application needs to connect to a configured TCP port
|
|
(see @command{tcl_port}). Then it can pass any string to the
|
|
interpreter terminating it with @code{0x1a} and wait for the return
|
|
value (it will be terminated with @code{0x1a} as well). This can be
|
|
repeated as many times as desired without reopening the connection.
|
|
|
|
It is not needed anymore to prefix the OpenOCD commands with
|
|
@code{ocd_} to get the results back. But sometimes you might need the
|
|
@command{capture} command.
|
|
|
|
See @file{contrib/rpc_examples/} for specific client implementations.
|
|
|
|
@section Tcl RPC server notifications
|
|
@cindex RPC Notifications
|
|
|
|
Notifications are sent asynchronously to other commands being executed over
|
|
the RPC server, so the port must be polled continuously.
|
|
|
|
Target event, state and reset notifications are emitted as Tcl associative arrays
|
|
in the following format.
|
|
|
|
@verbatim
|
|
type target_event event [event-name]
|
|
type target_state state [state-name]
|
|
type target_reset mode [reset-mode]
|
|
@end verbatim
|
|
|
|
@deffn {Command} {tcl_notifications} [on/off]
|
|
Toggle output of target notifications to the current Tcl RPC server.
|
|
Only available from the Tcl RPC server.
|
|
Defaults to off.
|
|
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
|
|
@section Tcl RPC server trace output
|
|
@cindex RPC trace output
|
|
|
|
Trace data is sent asynchronously to other commands being executed over
|
|
the RPC server, so the port must be polled continuously.
|
|
|
|
Target trace data is emitted as a Tcl associative array in the following format.
|
|
|
|
@verbatim
|
|
type target_trace data [trace-data-hex-encoded]
|
|
@end verbatim
|
|
|
|
@deffn {Command} {tcl_trace} [on/off]
|
|
Toggle output of target trace data to the current Tcl RPC server.
|
|
Only available from the Tcl RPC server.
|
|
Defaults to off.
|
|
|
|
See an example application here:
|
|
@url{https://github.com/apmorton/OpenOcdTraceUtil} [OpenOcdTraceUtil]
|
|
|
|
@end deffn
|
|
|
|
@node FAQ
|
|
@chapter FAQ
|
|
@cindex faq
|
|
@enumerate
|
|
@anchor{faqrtck}
|
|
@item @b{RTCK, also known as: Adaptive Clocking - What is it?}
|
|
@cindex RTCK
|
|
@cindex adaptive clocking
|
|
@*
|
|
|
|
In digital circuit design it is often referred to as ``clock
|
|
synchronisation'' the JTAG interface uses one clock (TCK or TCLK)
|
|
operating at some speed, your CPU target is operating at another.
|
|
The two clocks are not synchronised, they are ``asynchronous''
|
|
|
|
In order for the two to work together they must be synchronised
|
|
well enough to work; JTAG can't go ten times faster than the CPU,
|
|
for example. There are 2 basic options:
|
|
@enumerate
|
|
@item
|
|
Use a special "adaptive clocking" circuit to change the JTAG
|
|
clock rate to match what the CPU currently supports.
|
|
@item
|
|
The JTAG clock must be fixed at some speed that's enough slower than
|
|
the CPU clock that all TMS and TDI transitions can be detected.
|
|
@end enumerate
|
|
|
|
@b{Does this really matter?} For some chips and some situations, this
|
|
is a non-issue, like a 500MHz ARM926 with a 5 MHz JTAG link;
|
|
the CPU has no difficulty keeping up with JTAG.
|
|
Startup sequences are often problematic though, as are other
|
|
situations where the CPU clock rate changes (perhaps to save
|
|
power).
|
|
|
|
For example, Atmel AT91SAM chips start operation from reset with
|
|
a 32kHz system clock. Boot firmware may activate the main oscillator
|
|
and PLL before switching to a faster clock (perhaps that 500 MHz
|
|
ARM926 scenario).
|
|
If you're using JTAG to debug that startup sequence, you must slow
|
|
the JTAG clock to sometimes 1 to 4kHz. After startup completes,
|
|
JTAG can use a faster clock.
|
|
|
|
Consider also debugging a 500MHz ARM926 hand held battery powered
|
|
device that enters a low power ``deep sleep'' mode, at 32kHz CPU
|
|
clock, between keystrokes unless it has work to do. When would
|
|
that 5 MHz JTAG clock be usable?
|
|
|
|
@b{Solution #1 - A special circuit}
|
|
|
|
In order to make use of this,
|
|
your CPU, board, and JTAG adapter must all support the RTCK
|
|
feature. Not all of them support this; keep reading!
|
|
|
|
The RTCK ("Return TCK") signal in some ARM chips is used to help with
|
|
this problem. ARM has a good description of the problem described at
|
|
this link: @url{http://www.arm.com/support/faqdev/4170.html} [checked
|
|
28/nov/2008]. Link title: ``How does the JTAG synchronisation logic
|
|
work? / how does adaptive clocking work?''.
|
|
|
|
The nice thing about adaptive clocking is that ``battery powered hand
|
|
held device example'' - the adaptiveness works perfectly all the
|
|
time. One can set a break point or halt the system in the deep power
|
|
down code, slow step out until the system speeds up.
|
|
|
|
Note that adaptive clocking may also need to work at the board level,
|
|
when a board-level scan chain has multiple chips.
|
|
Parallel clock voting schemes are good way to implement this,
|
|
both within and between chips, and can easily be implemented
|
|
with a CPLD.
|
|
It's not difficult to have logic fan a module's input TCK signal out
|
|
to each TAP in the scan chain, and then wait until each TAP's RTCK comes
|
|
back with the right polarity before changing the output RTCK signal.
|
|
Texas Instruments makes some clock voting logic available
|
|
for free (with no support) in VHDL form; see
|
|
@url{http://tiexpressdsp.com/index.php/Adaptive_Clocking}
|
|
|
|
@b{Solution #2 - Always works - but may be slower}
|
|
|
|
Often this is a perfectly acceptable solution.
|
|
|
|
In most simple terms: Often the JTAG clock must be 1/10 to 1/12 of
|
|
the target clock speed. But what that ``magic division'' is varies
|
|
depending on the chips on your board.
|
|
@b{ARM rule of thumb} Most ARM based systems require an 6:1 division;
|
|
ARM11 cores use an 8:1 division.
|
|
@b{Xilinx rule of thumb} is 1/12 the clock speed.
|
|
|
|
Note: most full speed FT2232 based JTAG adapters are limited to a
|
|
maximum of 6MHz. The ones using USB high speed chips (FT2232H)
|
|
often support faster clock rates (and adaptive clocking).
|
|
|
|
You can still debug the 'low power' situations - you just need to
|
|
either use a fixed and very slow JTAG clock rate ... or else
|
|
manually adjust the clock speed at every step. (Adjusting is painful
|
|
and tedious, and is not always practical.)
|
|
|
|
It is however easy to ``code your way around it'' - i.e.: Cheat a little,
|
|
have a special debug mode in your application that does a ``high power
|
|
sleep''. If you are careful - 98% of your problems can be debugged
|
|
this way.
|
|
|
|
Note that on ARM you may need to avoid using the @emph{wait for interrupt}
|
|
operation in your idle loops even if you don't otherwise change the CPU
|
|
clock rate.
|
|
That operation gates the CPU clock, and thus the JTAG clock; which
|
|
prevents JTAG access. One consequence is not being able to @command{halt}
|
|
cores which are executing that @emph{wait for interrupt} operation.
|
|
|
|
To set the JTAG frequency use the command:
|
|
|
|
@example
|
|
# Example: 1.234MHz
|
|
adapter speed 1234
|
|
@end example
|
|
|
|
|
|
@item @b{Win32 Pathnames} Why don't backslashes work in Windows paths?
|
|
|
|
OpenOCD uses Tcl and a backslash is an escape char. Use @{ and @}
|
|
around Windows filenames.
|
|
|
|
@example
|
|
> echo \a
|
|
|
|
> echo @{\a@}
|
|
\a
|
|
> echo "\a"
|
|
|
|
>
|
|
@end example
|
|
|
|
|
|
@item @b{Missing: cygwin1.dll} OpenOCD complains about a missing cygwin1.dll.
|
|
|
|
Make sure you have Cygwin installed, or at least a version of OpenOCD that
|
|
claims to come with all the necessary DLLs. When using Cygwin, try launching
|
|
OpenOCD from the Cygwin shell.
|
|
|
|
@item @b{Breakpoint Issue} I'm trying to set a breakpoint using GDB (or a front-end like Insight or
|
|
Eclipse), but OpenOCD complains that "Info: arm7_9_common.c:213
|
|
arm7_9_add_breakpoint(): sw breakpoint requested, but software breakpoints not enabled".
|
|
|
|
GDB issues software breakpoints when a normal breakpoint is requested, or to implement
|
|
source-line single-stepping. On ARMv4T systems, like ARM7TDMI, ARM720T or ARM920T,
|
|
software breakpoints consume one of the two available hardware breakpoints.
|
|
|
|
@item @b{LPC2000 Flash} When erasing or writing LPC2000 on-chip flash, the operation fails at random.
|
|
|
|
Make sure the core frequency specified in the @option{flash lpc2000} line matches the
|
|
clock at the time you're programming the flash. If you've specified the crystal's
|
|
frequency, make sure the PLL is disabled. If you've specified the full core speed
|
|
(e.g. 60MHz), make sure the PLL is enabled.
|
|
|
|
@item @b{Amontec Chameleon} When debugging using an Amontec Chameleon in its JTAG Accelerator configuration,
|
|
I keep getting "Error: amt_jtagaccel.c:184 amt_wait_scan_busy(): amt_jtagaccel timed
|
|
out while waiting for end of scan, rtck was disabled".
|
|
|
|
Make sure your PC's parallel port operates in EPP mode. You might have to try several
|
|
settings in your PC BIOS (ECP, EPP, and different versions of those).
|
|
|
|
@item @b{Data Aborts} When debugging with OpenOCD and GDB (plain GDB, Insight, or Eclipse),
|
|
I get lots of "Error: arm7_9_common.c:1771 arm7_9_read_memory():
|
|
memory read caused data abort".
|
|
|
|
The errors are non-fatal, and are the result of GDB trying to trace stack frames
|
|
beyond the last valid frame. It might be possible to prevent this by setting up
|
|
a proper "initial" stack frame, if you happen to know what exactly has to
|
|
be done, feel free to add this here.
|
|
|
|
@b{Simple:} In your startup code - push 8 registers of zeros onto the
|
|
stack before calling main(). What GDB is doing is ``climbing'' the run
|
|
time stack by reading various values on the stack using the standard
|
|
call frame for the target. GDB keeps going - until one of 2 things
|
|
happen @b{#1} an invalid frame is found, or @b{#2} some huge number of
|
|
stackframes have been processed. By pushing zeros on the stack, GDB
|
|
gracefully stops.
|
|
|
|
@b{Debugging Interrupt Service Routines} - In your ISR before you call
|
|
your C code, do the same - artificially push some zeros onto the stack,
|
|
remember to pop them off when the ISR is done.
|
|
|
|
@b{Also note:} If you have a multi-threaded operating system, they
|
|
often do not @b{in the interest of saving memory} waste these few
|
|
bytes. Painful...
|
|
|
|
|
|
@item @b{JTAG Reset Config} I get the following message in the OpenOCD console (or log file):
|
|
"Warning: arm7_9_common.c:679 arm7_9_assert_reset(): srst resets test logic, too".
|
|
|
|
This warning doesn't indicate any serious problem, as long as you don't want to
|
|
debug your core right out of reset. Your .cfg file specified @option{reset_config
|
|
trst_and_srst srst_pulls_trst} to tell OpenOCD that either your board,
|
|
your debugger or your target uC (e.g. LPC2000) can't assert the two reset signals
|
|
independently. With this setup, it's not possible to halt the core right out of
|
|
reset, everything else should work fine.
|
|
|
|
@item @b{USB Power} When using OpenOCD in conjunction with Amontec JTAGkey and the Yagarto
|
|
toolchain (Eclipse, arm-elf-gcc, arm-elf-gdb), the debugging seems to be
|
|
unstable. When single-stepping over large blocks of code, GDB and OpenOCD
|
|
quit with an error message. Is there a stability issue with OpenOCD?
|
|
|
|
No, this is not a stability issue concerning OpenOCD. Most users have solved
|
|
this issue by simply using a self-powered USB hub, which they connect their
|
|
Amontec JTAGkey to. Apparently, some computers do not provide a USB power
|
|
supply stable enough for the Amontec JTAGkey to be operated.
|
|
|
|
@b{Laptops running on battery have this problem too...}
|
|
|
|
@item @b{GDB Disconnects} When using the Amontec JTAGkey, sometimes OpenOCD crashes with the following
|
|
error message: "Error: gdb_server.c:101 gdb_get_char(): read: 10054".
|
|
What does that mean and what might be the reason for this?
|
|
|
|
Error code 10054 corresponds to WSAECONNRESET, which means that the debugger (GDB)
|
|
has closed the connection to OpenOCD. This might be a GDB issue.
|
|
|
|
@item @b{LPC2000 Flash} In the configuration file in the section where flash device configurations
|
|
are described, there is a parameter for specifying the clock frequency
|
|
for LPC2000 internal flash devices (e.g. @option{flash bank $_FLASHNAME lpc2000
|
|
0x0 0x40000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME lpc2000_v1 14746 calc_checksum}), which must be
|
|
specified in kilohertz. However, I do have a quartz crystal of a
|
|
frequency that contains fractions of kilohertz (e.g. 14,745,600 Hz,
|
|
i.e. 14,745.600 kHz). Is it possible to specify real numbers for the
|
|
clock frequency?
|
|
|
|
No. The clock frequency specified here must be given as an integral number.
|
|
However, this clock frequency is used by the In-Application-Programming (IAP)
|
|
routines of the LPC2000 family only, which seems to be very tolerant concerning
|
|
the given clock frequency, so a slight difference between the specified clock
|
|
frequency and the actual clock frequency will not cause any trouble.
|
|
|
|
@item @b{Command Order} Do I have to keep a specific order for the commands in the configuration file?
|
|
|
|
Well, yes and no. Commands can be given in arbitrary order, yet the
|
|
devices listed for the JTAG scan chain must be given in the right
|
|
order (jtag newdevice), with the device closest to the TDO-Pin being
|
|
listed first. In general, whenever objects of the same type exist
|
|
which require an index number, then these objects must be given in the
|
|
right order (jtag newtap, targets and flash banks - a target
|
|
references a jtag newtap and a flash bank references a target).
|
|
|
|
You can use the ``scan_chain'' command to verify and display the tap order.
|
|
|
|
Also, some commands can't execute until after @command{init} has been
|
|
processed. Such commands include @command{nand probe} and everything
|
|
else that needs to write to controller registers, perhaps for setting
|
|
up DRAM and loading it with code.
|
|
|
|
@anchor{faqtaporder}
|
|
@item @b{JTAG TAP Order} Do I have to declare the TAPS in some
|
|
particular order?
|
|
|
|
Yes; whenever you have more than one, you must declare them in
|
|
the same order used by the hardware.
|
|
|
|
Many newer devices have multiple JTAG TAPs. For example:
|
|
STMicroelectronics STM32 chips have two TAPs, a ``boundary scan TAP'' and
|
|
``Cortex-M3'' TAP. Example: The STM32 reference manual, Document ID:
|
|
RM0008, Section 26.5, Figure 259, page 651/681, the ``TDI'' pin is
|
|
connected to the boundary scan TAP, which then connects to the
|
|
Cortex-M3 TAP, which then connects to the TDO pin.
|
|
|
|
Thus, the proper order for the STM32 chip is: (1) The Cortex-M3, then
|
|
(2) The boundary scan TAP. If your board includes an additional JTAG
|
|
chip in the scan chain (for example a Xilinx CPLD or FPGA) you could
|
|
place it before or after the STM32 chip in the chain. For example:
|
|
|
|
@itemize @bullet
|
|
@item OpenOCD_TDI(output) -> STM32 TDI Pin (BS Input)
|
|
@item STM32 BS TDO (output) -> STM32 Cortex-M3 TDI (input)
|
|
@item STM32 Cortex-M3 TDO (output) -> SM32 TDO Pin
|
|
@item STM32 TDO Pin (output) -> Xilinx TDI Pin (input)
|
|
@item Xilinx TDO Pin -> OpenOCD TDO (input)
|
|
@end itemize
|
|
|
|
The ``jtag device'' commands would thus be in the order shown below. Note:
|
|
|
|
@itemize @bullet
|
|
@item jtag newtap Xilinx tap -irlen ...
|
|
@item jtag newtap stm32 cpu -irlen ...
|
|
@item jtag newtap stm32 bs -irlen ...
|
|
@item # Create the debug target and say where it is
|
|
@item target create stm32.cpu -chain-position stm32.cpu ...
|
|
@end itemize
|
|
|
|
|
|
@item @b{SYSCOMP} Sometimes my debugging session terminates with an error. When I look into the
|
|
log file, I can see these error messages: Error: arm7_9_common.c:561
|
|
arm7_9_execute_sys_speed(): timeout waiting for SYSCOMP
|
|
|
|
TODO.
|
|
|
|
@end enumerate
|
|
|
|
@node Tcl Crash Course
|
|
@chapter Tcl Crash Course
|
|
@cindex Tcl
|
|
|
|
Not everyone knows Tcl - this is not intended to be a replacement for
|
|
learning Tcl, the intent of this chapter is to give you some idea of
|
|
how the Tcl scripts work.
|
|
|
|
This chapter is written with two audiences in mind. (1) OpenOCD users
|
|
who need to understand a bit more of how Jim-Tcl works so they can do
|
|
something useful, and (2) those that want to add a new command to
|
|
OpenOCD.
|
|
|
|
@section Tcl Rule #1
|
|
There is a famous joke, it goes like this:
|
|
@enumerate
|
|
@item Rule #1: The wife is always correct
|
|
@item Rule #2: If you think otherwise, See Rule #1
|
|
@end enumerate
|
|
|
|
The Tcl equal is this:
|
|
|
|
@enumerate
|
|
@item Rule #1: Everything is a string
|
|
@item Rule #2: If you think otherwise, See Rule #1
|
|
@end enumerate
|
|
|
|
As in the famous joke, the consequences of Rule #1 are profound. Once
|
|
you understand Rule #1, you will understand Tcl.
|
|
|
|
@section Tcl Rule #1b
|
|
There is a second pair of rules.
|
|
@enumerate
|
|
@item Rule #1: Control flow does not exist. Only commands
|
|
@* For example: the classic FOR loop or IF statement is not a control
|
|
flow item, they are commands, there is no such thing as control flow
|
|
in Tcl.
|
|
@item Rule #2: If you think otherwise, See Rule #1
|
|
@* Actually what happens is this: There are commands that by
|
|
convention, act like control flow key words in other languages. One of
|
|
those commands is the word ``for'', another command is ``if''.
|
|
@end enumerate
|
|
|
|
@section Per Rule #1 - All Results are strings
|
|
Every Tcl command results in a string. The word ``result'' is used
|
|
deliberately. No result is just an empty string. Remember: @i{Rule #1 -
|
|
Everything is a string}
|
|
|
|
@section Tcl Quoting Operators
|
|
In life of a Tcl script, there are two important periods of time, the
|
|
difference is subtle.
|
|
@enumerate
|
|
@item Parse Time
|
|
@item Evaluation Time
|
|
@end enumerate
|
|
|
|
The two key items here are how ``quoted things'' work in Tcl. Tcl has
|
|
three primary quoting constructs, the [square-brackets] the
|
|
@{curly-braces@} and ``double-quotes''
|
|
|
|
By now you should know $VARIABLES always start with a $DOLLAR
|
|
sign. BTW: To set a variable, you actually use the command ``set'', as
|
|
in ``set VARNAME VALUE'' much like the ancient BASIC language ``let x
|
|
= 1'' statement, but without the equal sign.
|
|
|
|
@itemize @bullet
|
|
@item @b{[square-brackets]}
|
|
@* @b{[square-brackets]} are command substitutions. It operates much
|
|
like Unix Shell `back-ticks`. The result of a [square-bracket]
|
|
operation is exactly 1 string. @i{Remember Rule #1 - Everything is a
|
|
string}. These two statements are roughly identical:
|
|
@example
|
|
# bash example
|
|
X=`date`
|
|
echo "The Date is: $X"
|
|
# Tcl example
|
|
set X [date]
|
|
puts "The Date is: $X"
|
|
@end example
|
|
@item @b{``double-quoted-things''}
|
|
@* @b{``double-quoted-things''} are just simply quoted
|
|
text. $VARIABLES and [square-brackets] are expanded in place - the
|
|
result however is exactly 1 string. @i{Remember Rule #1 - Everything
|
|
is a string}
|
|
@example
|
|
set x "Dinner"
|
|
puts "It is now \"[date]\", $x is in 1 hour"
|
|
@end example
|
|
@item @b{@{Curly-Braces@}}
|
|
@*@b{@{Curly-Braces@}} are magic: $VARIABLES and [square-brackets] are
|
|
parsed, but are NOT expanded or executed. @{Curly-Braces@} are like
|
|
'single-quote' operators in BASH shell scripts, with the added
|
|
feature: @{curly-braces@} can be nested, single quotes can not. @{@{@{this is
|
|
nested 3 times@}@}@} NOTE: [date] is a bad example;
|
|
at this writing, Jim/OpenOCD does not have a date command.
|
|
@end itemize
|
|
|
|
@section Consequences of Rule 1/2/3/4
|
|
|
|
The consequences of Rule 1 are profound.
|
|
|
|
@subsection Tokenisation & Execution.
|
|
|
|
Of course, whitespace, blank lines and #comment lines are handled in
|
|
the normal way.
|
|
|
|
As a script is parsed, each (multi) line in the script file is
|
|
tokenised and according to the quoting rules. After tokenisation, that
|
|
line is immediately executed.
|
|
|
|
Multi line statements end with one or more ``still-open''
|
|
@{curly-braces@} which - eventually - closes a few lines later.
|
|
|
|
@subsection Command Execution
|
|
|
|
Remember earlier: There are no ``control flow''
|
|
statements in Tcl. Instead there are COMMANDS that simply act like
|
|
control flow operators.
|
|
|
|
Commands are executed like this:
|
|
|
|
@enumerate
|
|
@item Parse the next line into (argc) and (argv[]).
|
|
@item Look up (argv[0]) in a table and call its function.
|
|
@item Repeat until End Of File.
|
|
@end enumerate
|
|
|
|
It sort of works like this:
|
|
@example
|
|
for(;;)@{
|
|
ReadAndParse( &argc, &argv );
|
|
|
|
cmdPtr = LookupCommand( argv[0] );
|
|
|
|
(*cmdPtr->Execute)( argc, argv );
|
|
@}
|
|
@end example
|
|
|
|
When the command ``proc'' is parsed (which creates a procedure
|
|
function) it gets 3 parameters on the command line. @b{1} the name of
|
|
the proc (function), @b{2} the list of parameters, and @b{3} the body
|
|
of the function. Note the choice of words: LIST and BODY. The PROC
|
|
command stores these items in a table somewhere so it can be found by
|
|
``LookupCommand()''
|
|
|
|
@subsection The FOR command
|
|
|
|
The most interesting command to look at is the FOR command. In Tcl,
|
|
the FOR command is normally implemented in C. Remember, FOR is a
|
|
command just like any other command.
|
|
|
|
When the ascii text containing the FOR command is parsed, the parser
|
|
produces 5 parameter strings, @i{(If in doubt: Refer to Rule #1)} they
|
|
are:
|
|
|
|
@enumerate 0
|
|
@item The ascii text 'for'
|
|
@item The start text
|
|
@item The test expression
|
|
@item The next text
|
|
@item The body text
|
|
@end enumerate
|
|
|
|
Sort of reminds you of ``main( int argc, char **argv )'' does it not?
|
|
Remember @i{Rule #1 - Everything is a string.} The key point is this:
|
|
Often many of those parameters are in @{curly-braces@} - thus the
|
|
variables inside are not expanded or replaced until later.
|
|
|
|
Remember that every Tcl command looks like the classic ``main( argc,
|
|
argv )'' function in C. In JimTCL - they actually look like this:
|
|
|
|
@example
|
|
int
|
|
MyCommand( Jim_Interp *interp,
|
|
int *argc,
|
|
Jim_Obj * const *argvs );
|
|
@end example
|
|
|
|
Real Tcl is nearly identical. Although the newer versions have
|
|
introduced a byte-code parser and interpreter, but at the core, it
|
|
still operates in the same basic way.
|
|
|
|
@subsection FOR command implementation
|
|
|
|
To understand Tcl it is perhaps most helpful to see the FOR
|
|
command. Remember, it is a COMMAND not a control flow structure.
|
|
|
|
In Tcl there are two underlying C helper functions.
|
|
|
|
Remember Rule #1 - You are a string.
|
|
|
|
The @b{first} helper parses and executes commands found in an ascii
|
|
string. Commands can be separated by semicolons, or newlines. While
|
|
parsing, variables are expanded via the quoting rules.
|
|
|
|
The @b{second} helper evaluates an ascii string as a numerical
|
|
expression and returns a value.
|
|
|
|
Here is an example of how the @b{FOR} command could be
|
|
implemented. The pseudo code below does not show error handling.
|
|
@example
|
|
void Execute_AsciiString( void *interp, const char *string );
|
|
|
|
int Evaluate_AsciiExpression( void *interp, const char *string );
|
|
|
|
int
|
|
MyForCommand( void *interp,
|
|
int argc,
|
|
char **argv )
|
|
@{
|
|
if( argc != 5 )@{
|
|
SetResult( interp, "WRONG number of parameters");
|
|
return ERROR;
|
|
@}
|
|
|
|
// argv[0] = the ascii string just like C
|
|
|
|
// Execute the start statement.
|
|
Execute_AsciiString( interp, argv[1] );
|
|
|
|
// Top of loop test
|
|
for(;;)@{
|
|
i = Evaluate_AsciiExpression(interp, argv[2]);
|
|
if( i == 0 )
|
|
break;
|
|
|
|
// Execute the body
|
|
Execute_AsciiString( interp, argv[3] );
|
|
|
|
// Execute the LOOP part
|
|
Execute_AsciiString( interp, argv[4] );
|
|
@}
|
|
|
|
// Return no error
|
|
SetResult( interp, "" );
|
|
return SUCCESS;
|
|
@}
|
|
@end example
|
|
|
|
Every other command IF, WHILE, FORMAT, PUTS, EXPR, everything works
|
|
in the same basic way.
|
|
|
|
@section OpenOCD Tcl Usage
|
|
|
|
@subsection source and find commands
|
|
@b{Where:} In many configuration files
|
|
@* Example: @b{ source [find FILENAME] }
|
|
@*Remember the parsing rules
|
|
@enumerate
|
|
@item The @command{find} command is in square brackets,
|
|
and is executed with the parameter FILENAME. It should find and return
|
|
the full path to a file with that name; it uses an internal search path.
|
|
The RESULT is a string, which is substituted into the command line in
|
|
place of the bracketed @command{find} command.
|
|
(Don't try to use a FILENAME which includes the "#" character.
|
|
That character begins Tcl comments.)
|
|
@item The @command{source} command is executed with the resulting filename;
|
|
it reads a file and executes as a script.
|
|
@end enumerate
|
|
@subsection format command
|
|
@b{Where:} Generally occurs in numerous places.
|
|
@* Tcl has no command like @b{printf()}, instead it has @b{format}, which is really more like
|
|
@b{sprintf()}.
|
|
@b{Example}
|
|
@example
|
|
set x 6
|
|
set y 7
|
|
puts [format "The answer: %d" [expr @{$x * $y@}]]
|
|
@end example
|
|
@enumerate
|
|
@item The SET command creates 2 variables, X and Y.
|
|
@item The double [nested] EXPR command performs math
|
|
@* The EXPR command produces numerical result as a string.
|
|
@* Refer to Rule #1
|
|
@item The format command is executed, producing a single string
|
|
@* Refer to Rule #1.
|
|
@item The PUTS command outputs the text.
|
|
@end enumerate
|
|
@subsection Body or Inlined Text
|
|
@b{Where:} Various TARGET scripts.
|
|
@example
|
|
#1 Good
|
|
proc someproc @{@} @{
|
|
... multiple lines of stuff ...
|
|
@}
|
|
$_TARGETNAME configure -event FOO someproc
|
|
#2 Good - no variables
|
|
$_TARGETNAME configure -event foo "this ; that;"
|
|
#3 Good Curly Braces
|
|
$_TARGETNAME configure -event FOO @{
|
|
puts "Time: [date]"
|
|
@}
|
|
#4 DANGER DANGER DANGER
|
|
$_TARGETNAME configure -event foo "puts \"Time: [date]\""
|
|
@end example
|
|
@enumerate
|
|
@item The $_TARGETNAME is an OpenOCD variable convention.
|
|
@*@b{$_TARGETNAME} represents the last target created, the value changes
|
|
each time a new target is created. Remember the parsing rules. When
|
|
the ascii text is parsed, the @b{$_TARGETNAME} becomes a simple string,
|
|
the name of the target which happens to be a TARGET (object)
|
|
command.
|
|
@item The 2nd parameter to the @option{-event} parameter is a TCBODY
|
|
@*There are 4 examples:
|
|
@enumerate
|
|
@item The TCLBODY is a simple string that happens to be a proc name
|
|
@item The TCLBODY is several simple commands separated by semicolons
|
|
@item The TCLBODY is a multi-line @{curly-brace@} quoted string
|
|
@item The TCLBODY is a string with variables that get expanded.
|
|
@end enumerate
|
|
|
|
In the end, when the target event FOO occurs the TCLBODY is
|
|
evaluated. Method @b{#1} and @b{#2} are functionally identical. For
|
|
Method @b{#3} and @b{#4} it is more interesting. What is the TCLBODY?
|
|
|
|
Remember the parsing rules. In case #3, @{curly-braces@} mean the
|
|
$VARS and [square-brackets] are expanded later, when the EVENT occurs,
|
|
and the text is evaluated. In case #4, they are replaced before the
|
|
``Target Object Command'' is executed. This occurs at the same time
|
|
$_TARGETNAME is replaced. In case #4 the date will never
|
|
change. @{BTW: [date] is a bad example; at this writing,
|
|
Jim/OpenOCD does not have a date command@}
|
|
@end enumerate
|
|
@subsection Global Variables
|
|
@b{Where:} You might discover this when writing your own procs @* In
|
|
simple terms: Inside a PROC, if you need to access a global variable
|
|
you must say so. See also ``upvar''. Example:
|
|
@example
|
|
proc myproc @{ @} @{
|
|
set y 0 #Local variable Y
|
|
global x #Global variable X
|
|
puts [format "X=%d, Y=%d" $x $y]
|
|
@}
|
|
@end example
|
|
@section Other Tcl Hacks
|
|
@b{Dynamic variable creation}
|
|
@example
|
|
# Dynamically create a bunch of variables.
|
|
for @{ set x 0 @} @{ $x < 32 @} @{ set x [expr @{$x + 1@}]@} @{
|
|
# Create var name
|
|
set vn [format "BIT%d" $x]
|
|
# Make it a global
|
|
global $vn
|
|
# Set it.
|
|
set $vn [expr @{1 << $x@}]
|
|
@}
|
|
@end example
|
|
@b{Dynamic proc/command creation}
|
|
@example
|
|
# One "X" function - 5 uart functions.
|
|
foreach who @{A B C D E@}
|
|
proc [format "show_uart%c" $who] @{ @} "show_UARTx $who"
|
|
@}
|
|
@end example
|
|
|
|
@node License
|
|
@appendix The GNU Free Documentation License.
|
|
@include fdl.texi
|
|
|
|
@node OpenOCD Concept Index
|
|
@comment DO NOT use the plain word ``Index'', reason: CYGWIN filename
|
|
@comment case issue with ``Index.html'' and ``index.html''
|
|
@comment Occurs when creating ``--html --no-split'' output
|
|
@comment This fix is based on: http://sourceware.org/ml/binutils/2006-05/msg00215.html
|
|
@unnumbered OpenOCD Concept Index
|
|
|
|
@printindex cp
|
|
|
|
@node Command and Driver Index
|
|
@unnumbered Command and Driver Index
|
|
@printindex fn
|
|
|
|
@bye
|